0
登录后你可以
  • 下载海量资料
  • 学习在线课程
  • 观看技术视频
  • 写文章/发帖/加入社区
创作中心
发布
  • 发文章

  • 发资料

  • 发帖

  • 提问

  • 发视频

创作活动
DSPIC33EP64GS808-I/PT

DSPIC33EP64GS808-I/PT

  • 厂商:

    ACTEL(微芯科技)

  • 封装:

    TQFP80

  • 描述:

    16-BITDSC,70MIPS,64KBFLASH,

  • 数据手册
  • 价格&库存
DSPIC33EP64GS808-I/PT 数据手册
dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 16-Bit Digital Signal Controllers for Digital Power Applications with Interconnected High-Speed PWM, ADC, PGA and Comparators Operating Conditions Advanced Analog Features • 3.0V to 3.6V, -40°C to +85°C, DC to 70 MIPS • 3.0V to 3.6V, -40°C to +125°C, DC to 60 MIPS • High-Speed ADC module: - 12-bit with four dedicated SAR ADC cores and one shared SAR ADC core - Configurable resolution (up to 12-bit) for each ADC core - Up to 3.25 Msps conversion rate per channel at 12-bit resolution - 11 to 22 single-ended inputs - Dedicated result buffer for each analog channel - Flexible and independent ADC trigger sources - Two digital comparators - Two oversampling filters for increased resolution • Four Rail-to-Rail Comparators with Hysteresis: - Dedicated 12-bit Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) for each analog comparator - Up to two DAC reference outputs - Up to two external reference inputs • Two Programmable Gain Amplifiers: - Single-ended or independent ground reference - Five selectable gains (4x, 8x, 16x, 32x and 64x) - 40 MHz gain bandwidth Flash Architecture • Dual Partition Flash Program Memory with LiveUpdate: - Supports programming while operating - Supports partition soft swap Core: 16-Bit dsPIC33E CPU • • • • Code-Efficient (C and Assembly) Architecture Two 40-Bit Wide Accumulators Single-Cycle (MAC/MPY) with Dual Data Fetch Single-Cycle Mixed-Sign MUL plus Hardware Divide • 32-Bit Multiply Support • Four Additional Working Register Sets (reduces context switching) Clock Management • • • • • ±0.9% Internal Oscillator Programmable PLLs and Oscillator Clock Sources Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) Independent Watchdog Timer (WDT) Fast Wake-up and Start-up Power Management • Low-Power Management modes (Sleep, Idle, Doze) • Integrated Power-on Reset and Brown-out Reset • 0.5 mA/MHz Dynamic Current (typical) • 20 μA IPD Current (typical) Interconnected SMPS Peripherals • Reduces CPU Interaction to Improve Performance • Flexible PWM Trigger Options for ADC Conversions • High-Speed Comparator Truncates PWM (15 ns typical): - Supports Cycle-by-Cycle Current-mode control - Current Reset mode (variable frequency) High-Speed PWM Timers/Output Compare/Input Capture • Eight PWM Generators (two outputs per generator) • Individual Time Base and Duty Cycle for each PWM • 1.04 ns PWM Resolution (frequency, duty cycle, dead time and phase) • Supports Center-Aligned, Redundant, Complementary and True Independent Output modes • Independent Fault and Current-Limit Inputs • Output Override Control • PWM Support for AC/DC, DC/DC, Inverters, PFC and Lighting • Five 16-Bit and up to Two 32-Bit Timers/Counters • Four Output Compare (OC) modules, Configurable as Timers/Counters • Four Input Capture (IC) modules  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 1 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Communication Interfaces Qualification and Class B Support • Two UART modules (15 Mbps): - Supports LIN/J2602 protocols and IrDA® • Three Variable Width SPI modules with Operating modes: - 3-wire SPI - 8x16 or 8x8 FIFO mode - I2S mode • Two I2C modules (up to 1 Mbaud) with SMBus Support • Up to Two CAN modules • Four-Channel DMA • AEC-Q100 REVG (Grade 1, -40°C to +125°C) • Class B Safety Library, IEC 60730 • The 6x6x0.55 mm UQFN Package is Designed and Optimized to ease IPC9592B 2nd Level Temperature Cycle Qualification Debugger Development Support • In-Circuit and In-Application Programming • Five Program and Three Complex Data Breakpoints • IEEE 1149.2 Compatible (JTAG) Boundary Scan • Trace and Run-Time Watch Input/Output Digital Peripherals dsPIC33EP64GS804 CLC PTG Analog Inputs S&H Circuits PGA DMA Analog Comparator DAC Output Constant-Current Source 3 8x2 4 I2C 2 Reference Clock 4 CAN SPI External Interrupts(3) UART 4 PWM(2) Output Compare 5 0 1 2 4 1 11 5 2 0 4 1 1 44 64K 8K 33 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 17 5 2 4 4 1 1 dsPIC33EP128GS704 44 128K 8K 33 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 0 1 2 4 1 17 5 2 0 4 1 1 dsPIC33EP128GS804 44 128K 8K 33 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 17 5 2 4 4 1 1 dsPIC33EP64GS805 48 64K 8K 33 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 17 5 2 4 4 1 1 dsPIC33EP128GS705 48 128K 8K 33 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 0 1 2 4 1 17 5 2 0 4 1 1 dsPIC33EP128GS805 48 128K 8K 33 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 17 5 2 4 4 1 1 dsPIC33EP64GS806 64 64K 8K 51 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 4 4 2 1 dsPIC33EP128GS706 64 128K 8K 51 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 0 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 0 4 2 1 dsPIC33EP128GS806 64 128K 8K 51 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 4 4 2 1 dsPIC33EP64GS708 80 64K 8K 67 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 0 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 0 4 2 1 dsPIC33EP64GS808 80 64K 8K 67 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 4 4 2 1 dsPIC33EP128GS708 80 128K 8K 67 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 0 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 0 4 2 1 dsPIC33EP128GS808 80 128K 8K 67 5 4 4 2 3 8x2 4 2 1 2 4 1 22 5 2 4 4 2 1 Note 1: 2: 3: Packages 12-Bit ADC Remappable Peripherals Input Capture dsPIC33EP128GS702 28 128K 8K 20 • Four Configurable Logic Cells • Peripheral Trigger Generator Timers(1) General Purpose I/O (GPIO) RAM (Bytes) Program Memory Bytes Device Pins • Constant-Current Source (10 µA nominal) • Sink/Source up to 12 mA/15 mA, respectively; Pin-Specific for Standard VOH/VOL • 5V Tolerant Pins • Selectable, Open-Drain Pull-ups and Pull-Downs • External Interrupts on all I/O Pins • Peripheral Pin Select (PPS) to allow Function Remap with Six Virtual I/Os SOIC, QFN-S, UQFN QFN, TQFP TQFP TQFP TQFP The external clock for Timer1, Timer2 and Timer3 is remappable. PWM4 through PWM8 are remappable on 28/44/48-pin devices; on 64-pin devices, only PWM7/PWM8 are remappable. External interrupts, INT0 and INT4, are not remappable. DS70005258C-page 2  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Pin Diagrams 28-Pin SOIC 1 28 AVDD RA0 2 27 AVSS RA1 3 26 RA3 RA2 4 25 RA4 RB0 5 24 RB14 RB9 6 AVDD 7 dsPIC33EP128GS702 Pin MCLR 23 RB13 22 RB12 VSS 8 RB1 9 RB2 10 RB3 11 RB4 12 17 RB6 VDD 13 16 RB5 RB8 14 15 RB15 Pin Function 21 RB11 20 VCAP 19 VSS 18 RB7 Pin Pin Function 1 MCLR 15 PGEC3/SCL2/RP47/RB15 2 AN0/CMP1A/PGA1P1/RP16/RA0 16 TDO/AN19/PGA2N2/RP37/RB5 PGED1/TDI/AN20/SCL1/RP38/RB6 3 AN1/CMP1B/PGA1P2/PGA2P1/RP17/RA1 17 4 AN2/CMP1C/CMP2A/PGA1P3/PGA2P2/RP18/RA2 18 PGEC1/AN21/SDA1/RP39/RB7 5 AN3/CMP1D/CMP2B/PGA2P3/RP32/RB0 19 VSS 6 AN4/CMP2C/CMP3A/ISRC4/RP41/RB9 20 VCAP 7 AVDD 21 TMS/PWM3H/RP43/RB11 8 VSS 22 TCK/PWM3L/RP44/RB12 PWM2H/RP45/RB13 9 OSCI/CLKI/AN6/CMP3C/CMP4A/ISRC2/RP33/RB1 23 10 OSC2/CLKO/AN7/CMP3D/CMP4B/PGA1N2/RP34/RB2(1) 24 PWM2L/RP46/RB14 11 PGED2/DACOUT1/AN18/INT0/RP35/RB3 25 PWM1H/RP20/RA4 PWM1L/RP19/RA3 12 PGEC2/ADTRG31/EXTREF1/RP36/RB4 26 13 VDD 27 AVSS 14 PGED3/SDA2/FLT31/RP40/RB8 28 AVDD Legend: Shaded pins are up to 5 VDC tolerant. RPn represents remappable peripheral functions. See Table 11-12 and Table 11-13 for the complete list of remappable sources. Note 1: At device power-up (POR), a pulse with an amplitude around 2V and a duration greater than 500 µs, may be observed on this device pin independent of pull-down resistors. It is recommended not to use this pin as an output driver unless the circuit being driven can endure this active duration.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 3 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Pin Diagrams (Continued) AVSS RA3 RA4 MCLR AVDD RA1 RA0 28-Pin QFN-S, UQFN 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 RA2 RB0 1 21 2 20 RB9 AVDD VSS 3 19 4 dsPIC33EP128GS702 18 5 17 RB1 6 16 RB2 7 15 RB11 VCAP VSS RB7 9 10 11 12 13 14 RB3 RB4 VDD RB8 RB15 RB5 RB6 8 RB14 RB13 RB12 Pin Pin Function Pin Pin Function 1 AN2/CMP1C/CMP2A/PGA1P3/PGA2P2/RP18/RA2 15 PGEC1/AN21/SDA1/RP39/RB7 2 AN3/CMP1D/CMP2B/PGA2P3/RP32/RB0 16 VSS 3 AN4/CMP2C/CMP3A/ISRC4/RP41/RB9 17 VCAP 4 AVDD 18 TMS/PWM3H/RP46/RB11 5 VSS 19 TCK/PWM3L/RP44/RB12 6 OSCI/CLKI/AN6/CMP3C/CMP4A/ISRC2/RP33/RB1 20 PWM2H/RP45/RB13 7 OSC2/CLKO/AN7/CMP3D/CMP4B/PGA1N2/RP34/RB2(1) 21 PWM2L/RP46/RB14 8 PGED2/DACOUT1/AN18/INT0/RP35/RB3 22 PWM1H/RP20/RA4 PWM1L/RP19/RA3 9 PGEC2/ADTRG31/EXTREF1/RP36/RB4 23 10 VDD 24 AVSS 11 PGED3/SDA2/FLT31/RP40/RB8 25 AVDD 12 PGEC3/SCL2/RP47/RB15 26 MCLR 13 TDO/AN19/PGA2N2/RP37/RB5 27 AN0/CMP1A/PGA1P1/RP16/RA0 14 PGED1/TDI/AN20/SCL1/RP38/RB6 28 AN1/CMP1B/PGA1P2/PGA2P1/RP17/RA1 Legend: Shaded pins are up to 5 VDC tolerant. RPn represents remappable peripheral functions. See Table 11-12 and Table 11-13 for the complete list of remappable sources. Note 1: At device power-up (POR), a pulse with an amplitude around 2V and a duration greater than 500 µs, may be observed on this device pin independent of pull-down resistors. It is recommended not to use this pin as an output driver unless the circuit being driven can endure this active duration. DS70005258C-page 4  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Pin Diagrams (Continued) RB4 RB3 34 35 36 37 VSS RC8 RC7 RC2 32 3 31 4 30 5 29 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 6 28 Pin Function RB0 RA2 22 21 20 RB2 RB1 RC1 VSS VDD RC10 RC9 AVDD RB9 AVDD RC12 RA0 RA1 AVSS AVDD MCLR 19 23 18 24 11 17 25 10 16 26 9 15 27 8 14 7 12 1 38 39 33 2 RA4 RA3 RC0 RC13 Pin 40 41 42 RB6 RB5 RB15 RB8 VDD 43 1 13 RB7 RC4 RC5 RC6 RC3 VSS VCAP RB11 RB12 RB13 RB14 44 44-Pin QFN, TQFP Pin Pin Function PGEC1/AN21/SDA1/RP39/RB7 23 AN2/CMP1C/CMP2A/PGA1P3/PGA2P2/RP18/RA2 AN3/CMP1D/CMP2B/PGA2P3/RP32/RB0 2 AN1ALT/RP52/RC4 24 3 AN0ALT/RP53/RC5 25 AN4/CMP2C/CMP3A/ISRC4/RP41/RB9 4 AN17/RP54/RC6 26 AVDD AN11/PGA1N3/RP57/RC9 5 RP51/RC3 27 6 VSS 28 EXTREF2/AN10/PGA1P4/RP58/RC10 7 VCAP 29 VDD 8 TMS/PWM3H/RP43/RB11 30 VSS 9 TCK/PWM3L/RP44/RB12 31 AN8/CMP4C/PGA2P4/RP49/RC1 10 PWM2H/RP45/RB13 32 OSCI/CLKI/AN6/CMP3C/CMP4A/ISRC2/RP33/RB1 11 PWM2L/RP46/RB14 33 OSC2/CLKO/AN7/CMP3D/CMP4B/PGA1N2/RP34/RB2(1) 12 PWM1H/RP20/RA4 34 PGED2/DACOUT1/AN18/INT0/RP35/RB3 13 PWM1L/RP19/RA3 35 PGEC2/ADTRG31/RP36/RB4 14 FLT12/RP48/RC0 36 EXTREF1/AN9/CMP4D/RP50/RC2 15 FLT11/RP61/RC13 37 ASDA1/RP55/RC7 16 AVSS 38 ASCL1/RP56/RC8 17 AVDD 39 VSS 18 MCLR 40 VDD 19 AVDD 41 PGED3/SDA2/FLT31/RP40/RB8 20 AN14/PGA2N3/RP60/RC12 42 PGEC3/SCL2/RP47/RB15 21 AN0/CMP1A/PGA1P1/RP16/RA0 43 TDO/AN19/PGA2N2/RP37/RB5 22 AN1/CMP1B/PGA1P2/PGA2P1/RP17/RA1 44 PGED1/TDI/AN20/SCL1/RP38/RB6 Legend: Shaded pins are up to 5 VDC tolerant. RPn represents remappable peripheral functions. See Table 11-12 and Table 11-13 for the complete list of remappable sources. Note 1: At device power-up (POR), a pulse with an amplitude around 2V and a duration greater than 500 µs, may be observed on this device pin independent of pull-down resistors. It is recommended not to use this pin as an output driver unless the circuit being driven can endure this active duration.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 5 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Pin Diagrams (Continued) 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 RB6 RB5 RB15 RB8 RD14 VDD VSS RC8 RC7 RC2 RB4 RB3 48-Pin TQFP dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 RB2 RB1 RC1 N/C Vss VDD RC10 RC9 AVDD RB9 RB0 RA2 RA4 RA3 RC0 RC13 RD10 AVSS AVDD MCLR AVDD RC12 RA0 RA1 RB7 RC4 RC5 RC6 RC3 VSS VCAP RD4 RB11 RB12 RB13 RB14 Pin 1 Pin Function Pin Pin Function PGEC1/AN21/SDA1/RP39/RB7 25 AN2/CMP1C/CMP2A/PGA1P3/PGA2P2/RP18/RA2 AN3/CMP1D/CMP2B/PGA2P3/RP32/RB0 2 AN1ALT/RP52/RC4 26 3 AN0ALT/RP53/RC5 27 AN4/CMP2C/CMP3A/ISRC4/RP41/RB9 4 AN17/RP54/RC6 28 AVDD AN11/PGA1N3/RP57/RC9 5 RP51/RC3 29 6 VSS 30 EXTREF2/AN10/PGA1P4/RP58/RC10 7 VCAP 31 VDD 8 RP68/RD4 32 VSS 9 TMS/PWM3H/RP43/RB11 33 N/C 10 TCK/PWM3L/RP44/RB12 34 AN8/CMP4C/PGA2P4/RP49/RC1 11 PWM2H/RP45/RB13 35 OSCI/CLKI/AN6/CMP3C/CMP4A/ISRC2/RP33/RB1 12 PWM2L/RP46/RB14 36 OSC2/CLKO/AN7/CMP3D/CMP4B/PGA1N2/RP34/RB2(1) 13 PWM1H/RP20/RA4 37 PGED2/DACOUT1/AN18/INT0/RP35/RB3 14 PWM1L/RP19/RA3 38 PGEC2/ADTRG31/RP36/RB4 15 FLT12/RP48/RC0 39 EXTREF1/AN9/CMP4D/RP50/RC2 16 FLT11/RP61/RC13 40 ASDA1/RP55/RC7 17 CLC4OUT/FLT10/RP74/RD10 41 ASCL1/RP56/RC8 18 AVSS 42 VSS 19 AVDD 43 VDD 20 MCLR 44 CLC3OUT/RD14 21 AVDD 45 PGED3/SDA2/FLT31/RP40/RB8 22 AN14/PGA2N3/RP60/RC12 46 PGEC3/SCL2/RP47/RB15 23 AN0/CMP1A/PGA1P1/RP16/RA0 47 TDO/AN19/PGA2N2/RP37/RB5 24 AN1/CMP1B/PGA1P2/PGA2P1/RP17/RA1 48 PGED1/TDI/AN20/SCL1/RP38/RB6 Legend: Shaded pins are up to 5 VDC tolerant. RPn represents remappable peripheral functions. See Table 11-12 and Table 11-13 for the complete list of remappable sources. Note 1: At device power-up (POR), a pulse with an amplitude around 2V and a duration greater than 500 µs, may be observed on this device pin independent of pull-down resistors. It is recommended not to use this pin as an output driver unless the circuit being driven can endure this active duration. DS70005258C-page 6  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY RD1 RB14 RB13 RB12 RB11 RD15 RD4 VDD VCAP RC3 RD6 RD5 RC6 RC5 RC4 RB7 Pin Diagrams (Continued) 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 64-Pin TQFP 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 RB6 RD0 RB5 RD11 RB15 RB8 RD8 VSS RD9 RD14 VDD RC8 RC7 RC2 RC14 RB4 RB9 AVDD AVDD AVSS RD7 RD13 RC9 RC10 VSS VDD RC1 RB1 RB2 RD2 RC15 RB3 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 RD3 RA4 RA3 RC0 RC13 RD10 MCLR RD12 VSS VDD AVDD RC12 RA0 RA1 RA2 RB0 Pin 1 Pin Function PWM4L/RP67/RD3 Pin 33 Pin Function PGEC2/ADTRG31/RP36/RB4 2 PWM1H/RP20/RA4 34 RP62/RC14 3 PWM1L/RP19/RA3 35 EXTREF1/AN9/CMP4D/RP50/RC2 ASDA1/RP55/RC7 4 FLT12/RP48/RC0 36 5 FLT11/RP61/RC13 37 ASCL1/RP56/RC8 6 CLC4OUT/FLT10/RP74/RD10 38 VDD CLC3OUT/RD14 7 MCLR 39 8 T5CK/FLT9/RP76/RD12 40 SCK3/RP73/RD9 9 VSS 41 VSS 10 VDD 42 AN5/CMP2D/CMP3B/ISRC3/RP72RD8 11 AVDD 43 PGED3/SDA2/FLT31/RP40/RB8 12 AN14/PGA2N3/RP60/RC12 44 PGEC3/SCL2/RP47/RB15 13 AN0/CMP1A/PGA1P1/RP16/RA0 45 INT4/RP75/RD11 TDO/AN19/PGA2N2/RP37/RB5 14 AN1/CMP1B/PGA1P2/PGA2P1/RP17/RA1 46 15 AN2/CMP1C/CMP2A/PGA1P3/PGA2P2/RP18/RA2 47 T4CK/RP64/RD0 16 AN3/CMP1D/CMP2B/PGA2P3/RP32/RB0 48 PGED1/TDI/AN20/SCL1/RP38/RB6 17 AN4/CMP2C/CMP3A/ISRC4/RP41/RB9 49 PGEC1/AN21/SDA1/RP39/RB7 18 AVDD 50 AN1ALT/RP52/RC4 19 AVDD 51 AN0ALT/RP53/RC5 20 AVSS 52 AN17/RP54/RC6 21 AN15/RP71/RD7 53 AN12/ISRC1/RP69/RD5 22 DACOUT2/AN13/RD13 54 PWM5H/RP70/RD6 23 AN11/PGA1N3/RP57/RC9 55 PWM5L/RP51/RC3 24 EXTREF2/AN10/PGA1P4/RP58/RC10 56 VCAP 25 VSS 57 VDD 26 VDD 58 PWM6H/RP68/RD4 27 AN8/CMP4C/PGA2P4/RP49/RC1 59 PWM6L/RD15 28 OSCI/CLKI/AN6/CMP3C/CMP4A/ISRC2/RP33/RB1 60 TMS/PWM3H/RP43/RB11 29 OSC2/CLKO/AN7/CMP3D/CMP4B/PGA1N2/RP34/RB2(1) 61 TCK/PWM3L/RP44/RB12 30 AN16/RP66/RD2 62 PWM2H/RP45/RB13 31 ASDA2/RP63/RC15 63 PWM2L/RP46/RB14 32 PGED2/DACOUT1/AN18/ASCL2/INT0/RP35/RB3 64 PWM4H/RP65/RD1 Legend: Shaded pins are up to 5 VDC tolerant. RPn represents remappable peripheral functions. See Table 11-12 and Table 11-13 for the complete list of remappable sources. Note 1: At device power-up (POR), a pulse with an amplitude around 2V and a duration greater than 500 µs, may be observed on this device pin independent of pull-down resistors. It is recommended not to use this pin as an output driver unless the circuit being driven can endure this active duration.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 7 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 RB6 RD0 RB5 RD11 RB15 RB8 RD8 RE11 RE10 VSS RD9 RD14 VDD RC8 RC7 RC2 RE9 RE8 RC14 RB4 RB9 RE4 RE5 AVDD AVDD AVSS RD7 RD13 RC9 RC10 VSS VDD RC1 RB1 RB2 RD2 RE6 RE7 RC15 RB3 RD3 RA4 RA3 RE0 RE1 RC0 RC13 RD10 MCLR RD12 VSS VDD RE2 RE3 AVDD RC12 RA0 RA1 RA2 RB0 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 80-Pin TQFP 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 64 63 62 61 RD1 RB14 RB13 RB12 RB11 RE15 RE14 RD15 RD4 VDD VCAP RC3 RD6 RD5 RC6 RC5 RE13 RE12 RC4 RB7 Pin Diagrams (Continued) Pin Pin Function Pin Pin Function 1 PWM4L/RP67/RD3 41 PGEC2/ADTRG31/RP36/RB4 2 PWM1H/RP20/RA4 42 RP62/RC14 3 PWM1L/RP19/RA3 43 RE8 4 PWM8L/RE0 44 RE9 5 PWM8H/RE1 45 EXTREF1/AN9/CMP4D/RP50/RC2 6 FLT12/RP48/RC0 46 ASDA1/RP55/RC7 7 FLT11/RP61/RC13 47 ASCL1/RP56/RC8 8 CLC4OUT/FLT10/RP74/RD10 48 VDD 9 MCLR 49 CLC3OUT/RD14 10 T5CK/FLT9/RP76/RD12 50 SCK3/RP73/RD9 51 VSS 11 VSS 12 VDD 52 FLT21/RE10 13 FLT17/RE2 53 FLT22/RE11 14 FLT18/RE3 54 AN5/CMP2D/CMP3B/ISRC3/RP72/RD8 15 AVDD 55 PGED3/SDA2/FLT31/RP40/RB8 16 AN14/PGA2N3/RP60/RC12 56 PGEC3/SCL2/RP47/RB15 17 AN0/CMP1A/PGA1P1/RP16/RA0 57 INT4/RP75/RD11 18 AN1/CMP1B/PGA1P2/PGA2P1/RP17/RA1 58 TD0/AN19/PGA2N2/RP37/RB5 19 AN2/CMP1C/CMP2A/PGA1P3/PGA2P2/RP18/RA2 59 T4CK/RP64/RD0 20 AN3/CMP1D/CMP2B/PGA2P3/RP32/RB0 60 PGED1/TDI/AN20/SCL1/RP38/RB6 21 AN4/CMP2C/CMP3A/ISRC4/RP41/RB9 61 PGEC1/AN21/SDA1/RP39/RB7 22 RE4 62 AN1ALT/RP52/RC4 23 RE5 63 RE12 24 AVDD 64 RE13 65 AN0ALT/RP53/RC5 25 AVDD 66 AN17/RP54/RC6 26 AVSS 27 AN15/RP71/RD7 67 AN12/ISRC1/RP69/RD5 28 DACOUT2/AN13/RD13 68 PWM5H/RP70/RD6 29 AN11/PGA1N3/RP57/RC9 69 PWM5L/RP51/RC3 30 EXTREF2/AN10/PGA1P4/RP58/RC10 70 VCAP 31 VSS 71 VDD 32 VDD 72 PWM6H/RP68/RD4 33 AN8/CMP4C/PGA2P4/RP49/RC1 73 PWM6L/RD15 34 OSCI/CLKI/AN6/CMP3C/CMP4A/ISRC2/RP33/RB1 74 PWM7L/RE14 75 PWM7H/RE15 35 OSC2/CLKO/AN7/CMP3D/CMP4B/PGA1N2/RP34/RB2(1) 36 AN16/RP66/RD2 76 TMS/PWM3H/RP43/RB11 37 FLT19/RE6 77 TCK/PWM3L/RP44/RB12 38 FLT20/RE7 78 PWM2H/RP45/RB13 39 ASDA2/RP63/RC15 79 PWM2L/RP46/RB14 40 PGED2/DACOUT1/AN18/ASCL2/INT0/RP35/RB3 80 PWM4H/RP65/RD1 Legend: Shaded pins are up to 5 VDC tolerant. RPn represents remappable peripheral functions. See Table 11-12 and Table 11-13 for the complete list of remappable sources. Note 1: At device power-up (POR), a pulse with an amplitude around 2V and a duration greater than 500 µs, may be observed on this device pin independent of pull-down resistors. It is recommended not to use this pin as an output driver unless the circuit being driven can endure this active duration. DS70005258C-page 8  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Table of Contents 1.0 Device Overview ........................................................................................................................................................................ 13 2.0 Guidelines for Getting Started with 16-Bit Digital Signal Controllers.......................................................................................... 17 3.0 CPU............................................................................................................................................................................................ 23 4.0 Memory Organization ................................................................................................................................................................. 33 5.0 Flash Program Memory.............................................................................................................................................................. 63 6.0 Resets ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 71 7.0 Interrupt Controller ..................................................................................................................................................................... 75 8.0 Direct Memory Access (DMA) .................................................................................................................................................... 91 9.0 Oscillator Configuration ............................................................................................................................................................ 105 10.0 Power-Saving Features............................................................................................................................................................ 117 11.0 I/O Ports ................................................................................................................................................................................... 127 12.0 Timer1 ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 171 13.0 Timer2/3 and Timer4/5 ............................................................................................................................................................ 175 14.0 Input Capture............................................................................................................................................................................ 179 15.0 Output Compare....................................................................................................................................................................... 183 16.0 High-Speed PWM..................................................................................................................................................................... 189 17.0 Peripheral Trigger Generator (PTG) Module............................................................................................................................ 217 18.0 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)............................................................................................................................................... 233 19.0 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) ..................................................................................................................................................... 249 20.0 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) ........................................................................................................... 257 21.0 Configurable Logic Cell (CLC).................................................................................................................................................. 263 22.0 High-Speed, 12-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)............................................................................................................ 277 23.0 Controller Area Network (CAN) Module (dsPIC33EPXXXGS80X Devices Only) .................................................................... 311 24.0 High-Speed Analog Comparator .............................................................................................................................................. 337 25.0 Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA) ....................................................................................................................................... 345 26.0 Constant-Current Source ......................................................................................................................................................... 349 27.0 Special Features ...................................................................................................................................................................... 351 28.0 Instruction Set Summary .......................................................................................................................................................... 365 29.0 Development Support............................................................................................................................................................... 375 30.0 Electrical Characteristics .......................................................................................................................................................... 379 31.0 DC and AC Device Characteristics Graphs.............................................................................................................................. 439 32.0 Packaging Information.............................................................................................................................................................. 443 Appendix A: Revision History............................................................................................................................................................. 469 Index ................................................................................................................................................................................................. 471 The Microchip Website ...................................................................................................................................................................... 479 Customer Change Notification Service .............................................................................................................................................. 479 Customer Support .............................................................................................................................................................................. 479 Product Identification System ............................................................................................................................................................ 481  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 9 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TO OUR VALUED CUSTOMERS It is our intention to provide our valued customers with the best documentation possible to ensure successful use of your Microchip products. To this end, we will continue to improve our publications to better suit your needs. Our publications will be refined and enhanced as new volumes and updates are introduced. If you have any questions or comments regarding this publication, please contact the Marketing Communications Department via E-mail at docerrors@microchip.com. We welcome your feedback. Most Current Data Sheet To obtain the most up-to-date version of this data sheet, please register at our Worldwide Website at: http://www.microchip.com You can determine the version of a data sheet by examining its literature number found on the bottom outside corner of any page. The last character of the literature number is the version number, (e.g., DS30000000A is version A of document DS30000000). Errata An errata sheet, describing minor operational differences from the data sheet and recommended workarounds, may exist for current devices. As device/documentation issues become known to us, we will publish an errata sheet. The errata will specify the revision of silicon and revision of document to which it applies. To determine if an errata sheet exists for a particular device, please check with one of the following: • Microchip’s Worldwide Website; http://www.microchip.com • Your local Microchip sales office (see last page) When contacting a sales office, please specify which device, revision of silicon and data sheet (include literature number) you are using. Customer Notification System Register on our website at www.microchip.com to receive the most current information on all of our products. DS70005258C-page 10  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Referenced Sources This device data sheet is based on the following individual chapters of the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”. These documents should be considered as the general reference for the operation of a particular module or device feature. Note 1: To access the documents listed below, browse to the documentation section of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X product page of the Microchip website (www.microchip.com) or select a family reference manual section from the following list. In addition to parameters, features and other documentation, the resulting page provides links to the related family reference manual sections. • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • “dsPIC33E Enhanced CPU” (DS70005158) “dsPIC33E/PIC24E Program Memory” (DS70000613) “Data Memory” (DS70595) “Dual Partition Flash Program Memory” (DS70005156) “Flash Programming” (DS70609) “Reset” (DS70602) “Interrupts” (DS70000600) “Direct Memory Access (DMA)” (DS70348) “Oscillator Module” (DS70005131) “Watchdog Timer and Power-Saving Modes” (DS70615) “I/O Ports” (DS70000598) “Timers” (DS70362) “Input Capture with Dedicated Timer” (DS70000352) “Output Compare with Dedicated Timer” (DS70005159) “High-Speed PWM Module” (DS70000323) “Peripheral Trigger Generator (PTG)” (DS70000669) “Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) with Audio Codec Support” (DS70005136) “Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)” (DS70000195) “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) “Configurable Logic Cell (CLC)” (DS70005298) “12-Bit High-Speed, Multiple SARs A/D Converter (ADC)” (DS70005213) “Enhanced Controller Area Network (ECAN™)” (DS70353) “High-Speed Analog Comparator Module” (DS70005128) “Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA)” (DS70005146) “Device Configuration” (DS70000618) “Watchdog Timer and Power-Saving Modes” (DS70615) “CodeGuard™ Intermediate Security” (DS70005182) “Programming and Diagnostics” (DS70608)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 11 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 12  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 1.0 DEVICE OVERVIEW This document contains device-specific information for the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X Digital Signal Controller (DSC) devices. Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive resource. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to the related section of the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices contain extensive Digital Signal Processor (DSP) functionality with a high-performance, 16-bit MCU architecture. Figure 1-1 shows a general block diagram of the core and peripheral modules. Table 1-1 lists the functions of the various pins shown in the pinout diagrams. 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. FIGURE 1-1: dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY BLOCK DIAGRAM CPU Refer to Figure 3-1 for CPU diagram details. PORTA 16 PORTB Power-up Timer OSC1/CLKI Timing Generation 16 Oscillator Start-up Timer PORTC POR/BOR MCLR VDD, VSS AVDD, AVSS Watchdog Timer PORTD Peripheral Modules PGA1, PGA2 CAN Modules 1-2 PTG ADC Input Captures 1-4 Output Compares 1-4 PORTE I2C1, I2C2 Remappable Pins Constant Current Source CLC 1-4 Analog Comparators 1-4  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. PWMs 8x2 Timers 1-5 SPI1-3 UART1, UART2 Ports DS70005258C-page 13 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 1-1: PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS Pin Name(1) Pin Buffer Type Type PPS Description AN0-AN21 AN0ALT-AN1ALT I I Analog Analog No No Analog input channels. Alternate analog input channels. C1RXR C2RXR C1TX C2TX I I O O ST ST ST ST Yes Yes Yes Yes CAN1 receive. CAN2 receive. CAN1 transmit. CAN2 transmit. CLKI I No CLKO O ST/ CMOS — External clock source input. Always associated with OSC1 pin function. Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in Crystal Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC and EC modes. Always associated with OSC2 pin function. OSC1 I No OSC2 I/O ST/ CMOS — CLC1OUT CLC2OUT CLC3OUT CLC4OUT O O O O DIG DIG DIG DIG Yes Yes No(4) No(4) REFCLKO O — Yes IC1-IC4 I ST Yes Capture Inputs 1 through 4. OCFA OC1-OC4 I O ST — Yes Yes Compare Fault A input (for compare channels). Compare Outputs 1 through 4. INT0 INT1 INT2 INT4 I I I I ST ST ST ST No Yes Yes Yes External Interrupt 0. External Interrupt 1. External Interrupt 2. External Interrupt 4. RA0-RA4 I/O ST No PORTA is a bidirectional I/O port. RB0-RB15 I/O ST No PORTB is a bidirectional I/O port. RC0-RC15 I/O ST No PORTC is a bidirectional I/O port. No No Oscillator crystal input. ST buffer when configured in RC mode; CMOS otherwise. Oscillator crystal output. Connects to crystal or resonator in Crystal Oscillator mode. Optionally functions as CLKO in RC and EC modes. CLC1 output. CLC2 output. CLC3 output. CLC4 output. Reference clock output. RD0-RD15 I/O ST No PORTD is a bidirectional I/O port. RE0-RE15 I/O ST No PORTE is a bidirectional I/O port. T1CK T2CK T3CK T4CK T5CK I I I I I ST ST ST ST ST Yes Yes Yes No No Timer1 external clock input. Timer2 external clock input. Timer3 external clock input. Timer4 external clock input. Timer5 external clock input. U1CTS U1RTS U1RX U1TX BCLK1 I O I O O ST — ST — ST Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes UART1 Clear-to-Send. UART1 Ready-to-Send. UART1 receive. UART1 transmit. UART1 IrDA® baud clock output. Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output Analog = Analog input P = Power ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels O = Output I = Input PPS = Peripheral Pin Select 1: Not all pins are available in all package variants. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for pin availability. 2: PWM4H/L through PWM8H/L are fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS708/808 devices. PWM4H/L through PWM6H/L are fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS706/806 devices. 3: The SCK3 pin is fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS706/806 and dsPIC33EPXXXGS708/808 devices. 4: PPS is available on dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 devices only. DS70005258C-page 14  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 1-1: PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED) Pin Name(1) Pin Buffer Type Type PPS Description U2CTS U2RTS U2RX U2TX BCLK2 I O I O O ST — ST — ST Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes UART2 Clear-to-Send. UART2 Ready-to-Send. UART2 receive. UART2 transmit. UART2 IrDA baud clock output. SCK1 SDI1 SDO1 SS1 I/O I O I/O ST ST — ST Yes Yes Yes Yes Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI1. SPI1 data in. SPI1 data out. SPI1 slave synchronization or frame pulse I/O. SCK2 SDI2 SDO2 SS2 I/O I O I/O ST ST — ST Yes Yes Yes Yes Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI2. SPI2 data in. SPI2 data out. SPI2 slave synchronization or frame pulse I/O. SCK3 SDI3 SDO3 SS3 I/O I O I/O ST ST — ST Yes(3) Yes Yes Yes Synchronous serial clock input/output for SPI3. SPI3 data in. SPI3 data out. SPI3 slave synchronization or frame pulse I/O. SCL1 SDA1 ASCL1 ASDA1 I/O I/O I/O I/O ST ST ST ST No No No No Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C1. Synchronous serial data input/output for I2C1. Alternate synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C1. Alternate synchronous serial data input/output for I2C1. SCL2 SDA2 ASCL2 ASDA2 I/O I/O I/O I/O ST ST ST ST No No No No Synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C2. Synchronous serial data input/output for I2C2. Alternate synchronous serial clock input/output for I2C2. Alternate synchronous serial data input/output for I2C2. TMS TCK TDI TDO I I I O ST ST ST — No No No No JTAG Test mode select pin. JTAG test clock input pin. JTAG test data input pin. JTAG test data output pin. FLT1-FLT8 FLT9-FLT12 FLT17-FLT22 FLT31 PWM1L-PWM3L PWM1H-PWM3H PWM4L-PWM8L(2) PWM4H-PWM8H(2) SYNCI1, SYNCI2 SYNCO1, SYNCO2 I I I I O O O O I O ST ST ST ST — — — — ST — Yes No No No No No Yes Yes Yes Yes PWM Fault Inputs 1 through 8. PWM Fault Inputs 9 through 12. PWM Fault Inputs 17 through 22. PWM Fault Input 31 (Class B Fault). PWM Low Outputs 1 through 3. PWM High Outputs 1 through 3. PWM Low Outputs 4 through 8. PWM High Outputs 4 through 8. PWM Synchronization Inputs 1 and 2. PWM Synchronization Outputs 1 and 2. Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output Analog = Analog input P = Power ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels O = Output I = Input PPS = Peripheral Pin Select 1: Not all pins are available in all package variants. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for pin availability. 2: PWM4H/L through PWM8H/L are fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS708/808 devices. PWM4H/L through PWM6H/L are fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS706/806 devices. 3: The SCK3 pin is fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS706/806 and dsPIC33EPXXXGS708/808 devices. 4: PPS is available on dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 devices only.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 15 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 1-1: PINOUT I/O DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED) Pin Name(1) Pin Buffer Type Type PPS Description CMP1A-CMP4A CMP1B-CMP4B CMP1C-CMP4C CMP1D-CMP4D I I I I Analog Analog Analog Analog No No No No Comparator Channels 1A through 4A inputs. Comparator Channels 1B through 4B inputs. Comparator Channels 1C through 4C inputs. Comparator Channels 1D through 4D inputs. ACMP1-ACMP4 O — Yes Analog Comparator Outputs 1-4. DACOUT1, DACOUT2 O — No DAC Output Voltages 1 and 2. EXTREF1, EXTREF2 I Analog No External Voltage Reference Inputs 1 and 2 for the Reference DACs. PGA1P1-PGA1P4 I Analog No PGA1 Positive Inputs 1 through 4. PGA1N1-PGA1N3 I Analog No PGA1 Negative Inputs 1 through 3. PGA2P1-PGA2P4 I Analog No PGA2 Positive Inputs 1 through 4. PGA2N1-PGA2N3 I Analog No PGA2 Negative Inputs 1 through 3. ADTRG31 I ST No External ADC trigger source. PGED1 PGEC1 PGED2 PGEC2 PGED3 PGEC3 I/O I I/O I I/O I ST ST ST ST ST ST No No No No No No Data I/O pin for Programming/Debugging Communication Channel 1. Clock input pin for Programming/Debugging Communication Channel 1. Data I/O pin for Programming/Debugging Communication Channel 2. Clock input pin for Programming/Debugging Communication Channel 2. Data I/O pin for Programming/Debugging Communication Channel 3. Clock input pin for Programming/Debugging Communication Channel 3. MCLR I/P ST No Master Clear (Reset) input. This pin is an active-low Reset to the device. AVDD P P No Positive supply for analog modules. This pin must be connected at all times. AVSS P P No Ground reference for analog modules. This pin must be connected at all times. VDD P — No Positive supply for peripheral logic and I/O pins. VCAP P — No CPU logic filter capacitor connection. VSS P — No Ground reference for logic and I/O pins. Legend: CMOS = CMOS compatible input or output Analog = Analog input P = Power ST = Schmitt Trigger input with CMOS levels O = Output I = Input PPS = Peripheral Pin Select 1: Not all pins are available in all package variants. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for pin availability. 2: PWM4H/L through PWM8H/L are fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS708/808 devices. PWM4H/L through PWM6H/L are fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS706/806 devices. 3: The SCK3 pin is fixed on dsPIC33EPXXXGS706/806 and dsPIC33EPXXXGS708/808 devices. 4: PPS is available on dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 devices only. DS70005258C-page 16  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 2.0 GUIDELINES FOR GETTING STARTED WITH 16-BIT DIGITAL SIGNAL CONTROLLERS Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to the related section of the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. 2.1 Basic Connection Requirements Getting started with the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family requires attention to a minimal set of device pin connections before proceeding with development. The following is a list of pin names which must always be connected: • All VDD and VSS pins (see Section 2.2 “Decoupling Capacitors”) • All AVDD and AVSS pins regardless if ADC module is not used (see Section 2.2 “Decoupling Capacitors”) • VCAP (see Section 2.3 “CPU Logic Filter Capacitor Connection (VCAP)”) • MCLR pin (see Section 2.4 “Master Clear (MCLR) Pin”) • PGECx/PGEDx pins used for In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) and debugging purposes (see Section 2.5 “ICSP Pins”) • OSC1 and OSC2 pins when external oscillator source is used (see Section 2.6 “External Oscillator Pins”)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 2.2 Decoupling Capacitors The use of decoupling capacitors on every pair of power supply pins, such as VDD, VSS, AVDD and AVSS is required. Consider the following criteria when using decoupling capacitors: • Value and type of capacitor: Recommendation of 0.1 µF (100 nF), 10-20V. This capacitor should be a low-ESR and have resonance frequency in the range of 20 MHz and higher. It is recommended to use ceramic capacitors. • Placement on the printed circuit board: The decoupling capacitors should be placed as close to the pins as possible. It is recommended to place the capacitors on the same side of the board as the device. If space is constricted, the capacitor can be placed on another layer on the PCB using a via; however, ensure that the trace length from the pin to the capacitor is within one-quarter inch (6 mm) in length. • Handling high-frequency noise: If the board is experiencing high-frequency noise, above tens of MHz, add a second ceramic-type capacitor in parallel to the above described decoupling capacitor. The value of the second capacitor can be in the range of 0.01 µF to 0.001 µF. Place this second capacitor next to the primary decoupling capacitor. In high-speed circuit designs, consider implementing a decade pair of capacitances as close to the power and ground pins as possible. For example, 0.1 µF in parallel with 0.001 µF. • Maximizing performance: On the board layout from the power supply circuit, run the power and return traces to the decoupling capacitors first, and then to the device pins. This ensures that the decoupling capacitors are first in the power chain. Equally important is to keep the trace length between the capacitor and the power pins to a minimum, thereby reducing PCB track inductance. DS70005258C-page 17 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 2-1: RECOMMENDED MINIMUM CONNECTION 0.1 µF Ceramic R R1 VSS VCAP VDD 10 µF Tantalum VDD dsPIC33EP VSS VDD 0.1 µF Ceramic VSS VDD AVSS VDD AVDD VSS 0.1 µF Ceramic 0.1 µF Ceramic L1(1) As an option, instead of a hard-wired connection, an inductor (L1) can be substituted between VDD and AVDD to improve ADC noise rejection. The inductor impedance should be less than 1 and the inductor capacity greater than 10 mA. Where: F CNV f = -------------2 1 f = ---------------------- 2 LC  (i.e., ADC Conversion Rate/2) 2 1 L =  ----------------------   2f C  2.2.1 pin provides two specific device During device programming and debugging, the resistance and capacitance that can be added to the pin must be considered. Device programmers and debuggers drive the MCLR pin. Consequently, specific voltage levels (VIH and VIL) and fast signal transitions must not be adversely affected. Therefore, specific values of R and C will need to be adjusted based on the application and PCB requirements. For example, as shown in Figure 2-2, it is recommended that the capacitor, C, be isolated from the MCLR pin during programming and debugging operations. Place the components as shown in Figure 2-2, within one-quarter inch (6 mm) from the MCLR pin. FIGURE 2-2: CPU Logic Filter Capacitor Connection (VCAP) EXAMPLE OF MCLR PIN CONNECTIONS VDD R(1) R1(2) MCLR TANK CAPACITORS On boards with power traces running longer than six inches in length, it is suggested to use a tank capacitor for integrated circuits, including DSCs, to supply a local power source. The value of the tank capacitor should be determined based on the trace resistance that connects the power supply source to the device and the maximum current drawn by the device in the application. In other words, select the tank capacitor so that it meets the acceptable voltage sag at the device. Typical values range from 4.7 µF to 47 µF. 2.3 Master Clear (MCLR) Pin • Device Reset • Device Programming and Debugging. C Note 1: 2.4 The MCLR functions: MCLR 0.1 µF Ceramic The placement of this capacitor should be close to the VCAP pin. It is recommended that the trace length not exceed one-quarter inch (6 mm). See Section 27.4 “On-Chip Voltage Regulator” for details. JP dsPIC33EP C Note 1: R  10 k is recommended. A suggested starting value is 10 k. Ensure that the MCLR pin VIH and VIL specifications are met. 2: R1  470 will limit any current flowing into MCLR from the external capacitor, C, in the event of MCLR pin breakdown due to Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) or Electrical Overstress (EOS). Ensure that the MCLR pin VIH and VIL specifications are met. A low-ESR (< 0.5Ω) capacitor is required on the VCAP pin, which is used to stabilize the voltage regulator output voltage. The VCAP pin must not be connected to VDD and must have a capacitor greater than 4.7 µF (10 µF is recommended), 16V connected to ground. The type can be ceramic or tantalum. See Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics” for additional information. DS70005258C-page 18  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 2.5 ICSP Pins The PGECx and PGEDx pins are used for ICSP and debugging purposes. It is recommended to keep the trace length between the ICSP connector and the ICSP pins on the device as short as possible. If the ICSP connector is expected to experience an ESD event, a series resistor is recommended, with the value in the range of a few tens of Ohms, not to exceed 100 Ohms. Pull-up resistors, series diodes and capacitors on the PGECx and PGEDx pins are not recommended as they will interfere with the programmer/debugger communications to the device. If such discrete components are an application requirement, they should be removed from the circuit during programming and debugging. Alternatively, refer to the AC/DC characteristics and timing requirements information in the respective device Flash programming specification for information on capacitive loading limits and pin Voltage Input High (VIH) and Voltage Input Low (VIL) requirements. Ensure that the “Communication Channel Select” (i.e., PGECx/PGEDx pins) programmed into the device matches the physical connections for the ICSP to MPLAB® PICkit™ 3, MPLAB ICD 3, or MPLAB REAL ICE™. For more information on MPLAB ICD 2, MPLAB ICD 3 and REAL ICE connection requirements, refer to the following documents that are available on the Microchip website. • “Using MPLAB® ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger” (poster) (DS51765) • “Development Tools Design Advisory” (DS51764) • “MPLAB® REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator User’s Guide for MPLAB X IDE” (DS50002085) • “Using MPLAB® REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator” (poster) (DS51749)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 2.6 External Oscillator Pins Many DSCs have options for at least two oscillators: a high-frequency primary oscillator and a low-frequency secondary oscillator. For details, see Section 9.0 “Oscillator Configuration” for details. The oscillator circuit should be placed on the same side of the board as the device. Also, place the oscillator circuit close to the respective oscillator pins, not exceeding one-half inch (12 mm) distance between them. The load capacitors should be placed next to the oscillator itself, on the same side of the board. Use a grounded copper pour around the oscillator circuit to isolate them from surrounding circuits. The grounded copper pour should be routed directly to the MCU ground. Do not run any signal traces or power traces inside the ground pour. Also, if using a two-sided board, avoid any traces on the other side of the board where the crystal is placed. A suggested layout is shown in Figure 2-3. FIGURE 2-3: SUGGESTED PLACEMENT OF THE OSCILLATOR CIRCUIT Main Oscillator Guard Ring Guard Trace Oscillator Pins DS70005258C-page 19 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 2.7 Oscillator Value Conditions on Device Start-up 2.9 If the PLL of the target device is enabled and configured for the device start-up oscillator, the maximum oscillator source frequency must be limited to 3 MHz < FIN < 5.5 MHz to comply with device PLL start-up conditions. This means that if the external oscillator frequency is outside this range, the application must start up in the FRC mode first. The default PLL settings, after a POR with an oscillator frequency outside this range, will violate the device operating speed. Once the device powers up, the application firmware can initialize the PLL SFRs, CLKDIV and PLLFBD, to a suitable value, and then perform a clock switch to the Oscillator + PLL clock source. Note that clock switching must be enabled in the device Configuration Word. 2.8 Targeted Applications • Power Factor Correction (PFC) - Interleaved PFC - Critical Conduction PFC - Bridgeless PFC • DC/DC Converters - Buck, Boost, Forward, Flyback, Push-Pull - Half/Full-Bridge - Phase-Shift Full-Bridge - Resonant Converters • DC/AC - Half/Full-Bridge Inverter - Resonant Inverter Examples of typical application connections are shown in Figure 2-4 through Figure 2-6. Unused I/Os Unused I/O pins should be configured as outputs and driven to a logic low state. Alternatively, connect a 1k to 10k resistor between VSS and unused pins, and drive the output to logic low. FIGURE 2-4: INTERLEAVED PFC VOUT+ |VAC| k1 k4 k2 VAC k3 VOUT- PGA/ADC Channel ADC Channel DS70005258C-page 20 FET Driver FET Driver PWM PGA/ADC Channel PWM PGA/ADC Channel ADC Channel dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 2-5: PHASE-SHIFTED FULL-BRIDGE CONVERTER VIN+ Gate 6 Gate 3 Gate 1 VOUT+ S1 S3 VOUT- Gate 2 Gate 4 Gate 5 Gate 6 Gate 5 VIN- FET Driver k2 PWM ADC Channel k1 Analog Ground Gate 1 S1 FET Driver PWM Gate 3 S3 FET Driver PGA/ADC Channel dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X PWM Gate 2 Gate 4  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 21 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 2-6: OFF-LINE UPS VDC Push-Pull Converter Full-Bridge Inverter VOUT+ VBAT + VOUTGND GND FET Driver FET Driver PWM PWM PGA/ADC ADC or Analog Comp. k3 k2 k1 FET Driver FET Driver FET Driver FET Driver PWM PWM PWM PWM dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X ADC k4 k5 ADC ADC ADC PWM FET Driver k6 + Battery Charger DS70005258C-page 22  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 3.0 CPU Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “dsPIC33E Enhanced CPU” (DS70005158) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family CPU has a 16-bit (data) modified Harvard architecture with an enhanced instruction set, including significant support for Digital Signal Processing (DSP). The CPU has a 24-bit instruction word with a variable length opcode field. The Program Counter (PC) is 23 bits wide and addresses up to 4M x 24 bits of user program memory space. An instruction prefetch mechanism helps maintain throughput and provides predictable execution. Most instructions execute in a single-cycle effective execution rate, with the exception of instructions that change the program flow, the double-word move (MOV.D) instruction, PSV accesses and the table instructions. Overhead-free program loop constructs are supported using the DO and REPEAT instructions, both of which are interruptible at any point. 3.1 Registers The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices have sixteen, 16-bit Working registers in the programmer’s model. Each of the Working registers can act as a Data, Address or Address Offset register. The 16th Working register (W15) operates as a Software Stack Pointer for interrupts and calls. In addition, the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices include four Alternate Working register sets which consist of W0 through W14. The Alternate Working registers can be made persistent to help reduce the saving and restoring of register content during Interrupt Service Routines (ISRs). The Alternate Working registers can be assigned to a specific Interrupt Priority Level (IPL1 through IPL7) by configuring the CTXTx bits in the FALTREG Configuration register. The Alternate Working registers can also be accessed manually by using the CTXTSWP instruction. The CCTXI and MCTXI bits in the CTXTSTAT register can be used to identify the current, and most recent, manually selected Working register sets.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 3.2 Instruction Set The instruction set for dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices has two classes of instructions: the MCU class of instructions and the DSP class of instructions. These two instruction classes are seamlessly integrated into the architecture and execute from a single execution unit. The instruction set includes many addressing modes and was designed for optimum C compiler efficiency. 3.3 Data Space Addressing The base Data Space can be addressed as up to 4K words or 8 Kbytes, and is split into two blocks, referred to as X and Y data memory. Each memory block has its own independent Address Generation Unit (AGU). The MCU class of instructions operates solely through the X memory AGU, which accesses the entire memory map as one linear Data Space. Certain DSP instructions operate through the X and Y AGUs to support dual operand reads, which splits the data address space into two parts. The X and Y Data Space boundary is device-specific. The upper 32 Kbytes of the Data Space memory map can optionally be mapped into Program Space (PS) at any 16K program word boundary. The program-to-Data Space mapping feature, known as Program Space Visibility (PSV), lets any instruction access Program Space as if it were Data Space. Refer to “Data Memory” (DS70595) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for more details on PSV and table accesses. On dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices, overhead-free circular buffers (Modulo Addressing) are supported in both X and Y address spaces. The Modulo Addressing removes the software boundary checking overhead for DSP algorithms. The X AGU Circular Addressing can be used with any of the MCU class of instructions. The X AGU also supports Bit-Reversed Addressing to greatly simplify input or output data re-ordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms. 3.4 Addressing Modes The CPU supports these addressing modes: • • • • • • Inherent (no operand) Relative Literal Memory Direct Register Direct Register Indirect Each instruction is associated with a predefined addressing mode group, depending upon its functional requirements. As many as six addressing modes are supported for each instruction. DS70005258C-page 23 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 3-1: dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY CPU BLOCK DIAGRAM X Address Bus Y Data Bus X Data Bus Interrupt Controller PSV and Table Data Access 24 Control Block 8 Data Latch Data Latch Y Data RAM X Data RAM Address Latch Address Latch 16 Y Address Bus 24 24 PCU PCH PCL Program Counter Loop Stack Control Control Logic Logic Address Latch 16 16 16 16 16 16 24 16 X RAGU X WAGU 16 Y AGU Program Memory EA MUX 16 Data Latch 24 16 Literal Data IR 24 ROM Latch 16 16 16-Bit Working Register Arrays 16 16 16 Divide Support DSP Engine 16-Bit ALU Control Signals to Various Blocks Instruction Decode and Control Power, Reset and Oscillator Modules 16 16 Ports Peripheral Modules DS70005258C-page 24  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 3.5 Programmer’s Model The programmer’s model for the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family is shown in Figure 3-2. All registers in the programmer’s model are memory-mapped and can be manipulated directly by instructions. Table 3-1 lists a description of each register. TABLE 3-1: In addition to the registers contained in the programmer’s model, the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices contain control registers for Modulo Addressing, Bit-Reversed Addressing and interrupts. These registers are described in subsequent sections of this document. All registers associated with the programmer’s model are memory-mapped, as shown in Table 3-1. PROGRAMMER’S MODEL REGISTER DESCRIPTIONS Register(s) Name Description W0 through W15(1) Working Register Array W0 through W14(1) Alternate 1 Working Register Array W14(1) Alternate 2 Working Register Array W0 through W14(1) Alternate 3 Working Register Array (1) Alternate 4 Working Register Array W0 through W0 through W14 ACCA, ACCB 40-Bit DSP Accumulators PC 23-Bit Program Counter SR ALU and DSP Engine STATUS Register SPLIM Stack Pointer Limit Value Register TBLPAG Table Memory Page Address Register DSRPAG Extended Data Space (EDS) Read Page Register RCOUNT REPEAT Loop Counter Register DCOUNT DO Loop Counter Register DOSTARTH(2), DOSTARTL(2) DO Loop Start Address Register (High and Low) DOENDH, DOENDL DO Loop End Address Register (High and Low) CORCON Contains DSP Engine, DO Loop Control and Trap Status bits Note 1: 2: Memory-mapped W0 through W14 represent the value of the register in the currently active CPU context. The DOSTARTH and DOSTARTL registers are read-only.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 25 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 3-2: PROGRAMMER’S MODEL D15 D0 D15 D0 D15 D0 D15 D0 D15 D0 W0 (WREG) W0 W0 W0 W0 W1 W1 W1 W1 W1 W2 W3 W2 W2 W2 W2 W3 W4 W3 W4 W3 W4 W3 W4 W5 W6 W7 W5 W6 W7 W5 W6 W7 W5 W6 W7 W8 W8 W8 W8 W9 W9 W9 W9 W10 W10 W11 W11 W10 W11 W10 W10 W11 W11 W12 W12 W13 W13 W14 W14 W12 W13 W14 W0-W3 W4 W5 DSP Operand Registers Working/Address Registers W6 W7 W8 W9 DSP Address Registers W12 W12 W13 W13 Frame Pointer/W14 W14 Alternate Working/Address Registers Stack Pointer/W15 0 PUSH.S and POP.S Shadows SPLIM Nested DO Stack AD39 DSP Accumulators Stack Pointer Limit 0 AD15 AD31 AD0 ACCA ACCB PC23 0 PC0 0 Program Counter 0 7 TBLPAG 9 Data Table Page Address 0 DSRPAG X Data Space Read Page Address 15 0 REPEAT Loop Counter RCOUNT 15 0 DCOUNT DO Loop Counter and Stack 23 0 DOSTART 0 0 DO Loop Start Address and Stack 23 0 DOEND 0 0 DO Loop End Address and Stack 15 0 CORCON CPU Core Control Register SRL OA OB SA DS70005258C-page 26 SB OAB SAB DA DC IPL2 IPL1 IPL0 RA N OV Z C STATUS Register  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 3.6 CPU Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 3.6.1 KEY RESOURCES • “dsPIC33E Enhanced CPU” (DS70005158) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools DS70005258C-page 27 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 3.7 CPU Control Registers REGISTER 3-1: SR: CPU STATUS REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R-0 R/W-0 OA OB SA(3) SB(3) OAB SAB DA DC bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0(2) R/W-0(2) (1) IPL2 IPL1 (1) R/W-0(2) R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IPL0(1) RA N OV Z C bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’= Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 OA: Accumulator A Overflow Status bit 1 = Accumulator A has overflowed 0 = Accumulator A has not overflowed bit 14 OB: Accumulator B Overflow Status bit 1 = Accumulator B has overflowed 0 = Accumulator B has not overflowed bit 13 SA: Accumulator A Saturation ‘Sticky’ Status bit(3) 1 = Accumulator A is saturated or has been saturated at some time 0 = Accumulator A is not saturated bit 12 SB: Accumulator B Saturation ‘Sticky’ Status bit(3) 1 = Accumulator B is saturated or has been saturated at some time 0 = Accumulator B is not saturated bit 11 OAB: OA || OB Combined Accumulator Overflow Status bit 1 = Accumulator A or B has overflowed 0 = Neither Accumulator A or B has overflowed bit 10 SAB: SA || SB Combined Accumulator ‘Sticky’ Status bit 1 = Accumulator A or B is saturated or has been saturated at some time 0 = Neither Accumulator A or B is saturated bit 9 DA: DO Loop Active bit 1 = DO loop is in progress 0 = DO loop is not in progress bit 8 DC: MCU ALU Half Carry/Borrow bit 1 = A carry-out from the 4th low-order bit (for byte-sized data) or 8th low-order bit (for word-sized data) of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the 4th low-order bit (for byte-sized data) or 8th low-order bit (for word-sized data) of the result occurred Note 1: 2: 3: The IPL bits are concatenated with the IPL bit (CORCON) to form the CPU Interrupt Priority Level. The value in parentheses indicates the IPL, if IPL = 1. User interrupts are disabled when IPL = 1. The IPL Status bits are read-only when the NSTDIS bit (INTCON1) = 1. A data write to the SR register can modify the SA and SB bits by either a data write to SA and SB or by clearing the SAB bit. To avoid a possible SA or SB bit write race condition, the SA and SB bits should not be modified using bit operations. DS70005258C-page 28  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 3-1: SR: CPU STATUS REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 7-5 IPL: CPU Interrupt Priority Level Status bits(1,2) 111 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 7 (15); user interrupts are disabled 110 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 6 (14) 101 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 5 (13) 100 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 4 (12) 011 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 3 (11) 010 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 2 (10) 001 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 1 (9) 000 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 0 (8) bit 4 RA: REPEAT Loop Active bit 1 = REPEAT loop is in progress 0 = REPEAT loop is not in progress bit 3 N: MCU ALU Negative bit 1 = Result was negative 0 = Result was non-negative (zero or positive) bit 2 OV: MCU ALU Overflow bit This bit is used for signed arithmetic (two’s complement). It indicates an overflow of the magnitude that causes the sign bit to change state. 1 = Overflow occurred for signed arithmetic (in this arithmetic operation) 0 = No overflow occurred bit 1 Z: MCU ALU Zero bit 1 = An operation that affects the Z bit has set it at some time in the past 0 = The most recent operation that affects the Z bit has cleared it (i.e., a non-zero result) bit 0 C: MCU ALU Carry/Borrow bit 1 = A carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred 0 = No carry-out from the Most Significant bit of the result occurred Note 1: 2: 3: The IPL bits are concatenated with the IPL bit (CORCON) to form the CPU Interrupt Priority Level. The value in parentheses indicates the IPL, if IPL = 1. User interrupts are disabled when IPL = 1. The IPL Status bits are read-only when the NSTDIS bit (INTCON1) = 1. A data write to the SR register can modify the SA and SB bits by either a data write to SA and SB or by clearing the SAB bit. To avoid a possible SA or SB bit write race condition, the SA and SB bits should not be modified using bit operations.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 29 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 3-2: CORCON: CORE CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 VAR — US1 US0 EDT(1) DL2 DL1 DL0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/C-0 R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SATA SATB SATDW ACCSAT IPL3(2) SFA RND IF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 VAR: Variable Exception Processing Latency Control bit 1 = Variable exception processing latency is enabled 0 = Fixed exception processing latency is enabled bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-12 US: DSP Multiply Unsigned/Signed Control bits 11 = Reserved 10 = DSP engine multiplies are mixed-sign 01 = DSP engine multiplies are unsigned 00 = DSP engine multiplies are signed bit 11 EDT: Early DO Loop Termination Control bit(1) 1 = Terminates executing DO loop at the end of current loop iteration 0 = No effect bit 10-8 DL: DO Loop Nesting Level Status bits 111 = Seven DO loops are active • • • 001 = One DO loop is active 000 = Zero DO loops are active bit 7 SATA: ACCA Saturation Enable bit 1 = Accumulator A saturation is enabled 0 = Accumulator A saturation is disabled bit 6 SATB: ACCB Saturation Enable bit 1 = Accumulator B saturation is enabled 0 = Accumulator B saturation is disabled bit 5 SATDW: Data Space Write from DSP Engine Saturation Enable bit 1 = Data Space write saturation is enabled 0 = Data Space write saturation is disabled bit 4 ACCSAT: Accumulator Saturation Mode Select bit 1 = 9.31 saturation (super saturation) 0 = 1.31 saturation (normal saturation) bit 3 IPL3: CPU Interrupt Priority Level Status bit 3(2) 1 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is greater than 7 0 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 7 or less Note 1: 2: This bit is always read as ‘0’. The IPL3 bit is concatenated with the IPL bits (SR) to form the CPU Interrupt Priority Level. DS70005258C-page 30  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 3-2: CORCON: CORE CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 2 SFA: Stack Frame Active Status bit 1 = Stack frame is active; W14 and W15 address 0x0000 to 0xFFFF, regardless of DSRPAG 0 = Stack frame is not active; W14 and W15 address the base Data Space bit 1 RND: Rounding Mode Select bit 1 = Biased (conventional) rounding is enabled 0 = Unbiased (convergent) rounding is enabled bit 0 IF: Integer or Fractional Multiplier Mode Select bit 1 = Integer mode is enabled for DSP multiply 0 = Fractional mode is enabled for DSP multiply Note 1: 2: This bit is always read as ‘0’. The IPL3 bit is concatenated with the IPL bits (SR) to form the CPU Interrupt Priority Level. REGISTER 3-3: CTXTSTAT: CPU W REGISTER CONTEXT STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — — — — CCTXI2 CCTXI1 CCTXI0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — — — — MCTXI2 MCTXI1 MCTXI0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10-8 CCTXI: Current (W Register) Context Identifier bits 111 = Reserved • • • 101 = Reserved 100 = Alternate Working Register Set 4 is currently in use 011 = Alternate Working Register Set 3 is currently in use 010 = Alternate Working Register Set 2 is currently in use 001 = Alternate Working Register Set 1 is currently in use 000 = Default register set is currently in use bit 7-3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 MCTXI: Manual (W Register) Context Identifier bits 111 = Reserved • • • 101 = Reserved 100 = Alternate Working Register Set 4 was most recently manually selected 011 = Alternate Working Register Set 3 was most recently manually selected 010 = Alternate Working Register Set 2 was most recently manually selected 001 = Alternate Working Register Set 1 was most recently manually selected 000 = Default register set was most recently manually selected  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 31 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 3.8 Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU) The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family ALU is 16 bits wide and is capable of addition, subtraction, bit shifts and logic operations. Unless otherwise mentioned, arithmetic operations are two’s complement in nature. Depending on the operation, the ALU can affect the values of the Carry (C), Zero (Z), Negative (N), Overflow (OV) and Digit Carry (DC) Status bits in the SR register. The C and DC Status bits operate as Borrow and Digit Borrow bits, respectively, for subtraction operations. The ALU can perform 8-bit or 16-bit operations, depending on the mode of the instruction that is used. Data for the ALU operation can come from the W register array or data memory, depending on the addressing mode of the instruction. Likewise, output data from the ALU can be written to the W register array or a data memory location. Refer to the “16-Bit MCU and DSC Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70000157) for information on the SR bits affected by each instruction. The core CPU incorporates hardware support for both multiplication and division. This includes a dedicated hardware multiplier and support hardware for 16-bit divisor division. 3.8.1 16-bit x 16-bit signed 16-bit x 16-bit unsigned 16-bit signed x 5-bit (literal) unsigned 16-bit signed x 16-bit unsigned 16-bit unsigned x 5-bit (literal) unsigned 16-bit unsigned x 16-bit signed 8-bit unsigned x 8-bit unsigned 3.8.2 DIVIDER The divide block supports 32-bit/16-bit and 16-bit/16-bit signed and unsigned integer divide operations with the following data sizes: • • • • DSP Engine The DSP engine consists of a high-speed 17-bit x 17-bit multiplier, a 40-bit barrel shifter and a 40-bit adder/ subtracter (with two target accumulators, round and saturation logic). The DSP engine can also perform inherent accumulatorto-accumulator operations that require no additional data. These instructions are, ADD, SUB and NEG. The DSP engine has options selected through bits in the CPU Core Control register (CORCON), as listed below: • Fractional or Integer DSP Multiply (IF) • Signed, Unsigned or Mixed-Sign DSP Multiply (USx) • Conventional or Convergent Rounding (RND) • Automatic Saturation On/Off for ACCA (SATA) • Automatic Saturation On/Off for ACCB (SATB) • Automatic Saturation On/Off for Writes to Data Memory (SATDW) • Accumulator Saturation mode Selection (ACCSAT) TABLE 3-2: MULTIPLIER Using the high-speed, 17-bit x 17-bit multiplier, the ALU supports unsigned, signed or mixed-sign operation in several MCU Multiplication modes: • • • • • • • 3.9 Instruction DSP INSTRUCTIONS SUMMARY Algebraic Operation ACC Write-Back Yes CLR A=0 ED A = (x – y)2 No 2 EDAC A = A + (x – y) No MAC A = A + (x • y) Yes x2 No MAC A=A+ MOVSAC No change in A Yes MPY A=x•y No MPY A = x2 No MPY.N A=–x•y No MSC A=A–x•y Yes 32-bit signed/16-bit signed divide 32-bit unsigned/16-bit unsigned divide 16-bit signed/16-bit signed divide 16-bit unsigned/16-bit unsigned divide The quotient for all divide instructions ends up in W0 and the remainder in W1. 16-bit signed and unsigned DIV instructions can specify any W register for both the 16-bit divisor (Wn) and any W register (aligned) pair (W(m + 1):Wm) for the 32-bit dividend. The divide algorithm takes one cycle per bit of divisor, so both 32-bit/16-bit and 16-bit/16-bit instructions take the same number of cycles to execute. DS70005258C-page 32  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.0 Note: MEMORY ORGANIZATION This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “dsPIC33E/PIC24E Program Memory” (DS70000613) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family architecture features separate program and data memory spaces, and buses. This architecture also allows the direct access of program memory from the Data Space (DS) during code execution. 4.1 Program Address Space The program address memory space of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices is 4M instructions. The space is addressable by a 24-bit value derived either from the 23-bit PC during program execution, or from table operation or Data Space remapping, as described in Section 4.9 “Interfacing Program and Data Memory Spaces”.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. User application access to the program memory space is restricted to the lower half of the address range (0x000000 to 0x7FFFFF). The exception is the use of TBLRD operations, which use TBLPAG to permit access to calibration data and Device ID sections of the configuration memory space. The program memory maps for dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X devices not operating in Dual Partition mode are shown in Figure 4-1 and Figure 4-2. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices can operate in a Dual Partition Flash Program Memory mode, where the user Program Flash Memory is arranged as two separate address spaces, one for each of the Flash partitions. The Active Partition always starts at address, 0x000000, and contains half of the available Flash memory (64k/128k, depends on device). The Inactive Partition always starts at address, 0x400000, and implements the remaining half of Flash memory. As shown in Figure 4-3 and Figure 4-4, the Active and Inactive Partitions are identical, and both contain unique copies of the Reset vector, Interrupt Vector Tables (IVT and AIVT if enabled) and the Flash Configuration Words. DS70005258C-page 33 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.2 Unique Device Identifier (UDID) The UDID is stored in five read-only locations, located between 800F00h and 800F08h in the device configuration space. Table 4-1 lists the addresses of the identifier words and shows their contents. All dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices are individually encoded during final manufacturing with a Unique Device Identifier or UDID. This feature allows for manufacturing traceability of Microchip Technology devices in applications where this is a requirement. It may also be used by the application manufacturer for any number of things that may require unique identification, such as: TABLE 4-1: • Tracking the device • Unique serial number • Unique security key The UDID comprises five 24-bit program words. When taken together, these fields form a unique 120-bit identifier. FIGURE 4-1: UDID ADDRESSES Name Address Bits 23:16 Bits 15:8 UDID1 800F00 UDID Word 1 UDID2 800F02 UDID Word 2 UDID3 800F04 UDID Word 3 UDID4 800F06 UDID Word 4 UDID5 800F08 UDID Word 5 Bits 7:0 PROGRAM MEMORY MAP FOR dsPIC33EP64GS70X/80X DEVICES GOTO Instruction 0x000000 Reset Address 0x000002 0x000004 0x0001FE 0x000200 User Memory Space Interrupt Vector Table User Program Flash Memory (22,016 instructions) 0x00AF7E 0x00AF80 Device Configuration 0x00AFFE 0x00B000 Unimplemented (Read ‘0’s) Reserved Calibration Data Reserved Configuration Memory Space UDID Reserved User OTP Memory Reserved Write Latches 0x7FFFFE 0x800000 0x800E46 0x800E48 0x800E78 0x800E7A 0x800EFE 0x800F00 0x800F08 0x800F0A 0x800F7E 0x800F80 0x800FFC 0x801000 0xF9FFFE 0xFA0000 0xFA0002 0xFA0004 Reserved DEVID Reserved Note: 0xFEFFFE 0xFF0000 0xFF0002 0xFF0004 0xFFFFFE Memory areas are not shown to scale. DS70005258C-page 34  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY PROGRAM MEMORY MAP FOR dsPIC33EP128GS70X/80X DEVICES User Memory Space FIGURE 4-2: GOTO Instruction 0x000000 Reset Address 0x000002 0x000004 0x0001FE 0x000200 Interrupt Vector Table User Program Flash Memory (44,032 instructions) Device Configuration 0x01577E 0x015780 0x0157FE 0x015800 Unimplemented (Read ‘0’s) Reserved Calibration Data Configuration Memory Space Reserved User OTP Memory Reserved Write Latches 0x800E46 0x800E48 0x800E78 0x800E7A 0x800F7E 0x800F80 0x800FFC 0x801000 0xF9FFFE 0xFA0000 0xFA0002 0xFA0004 Reserved DEVID Reserved Note: 0x7FFFFE 0x800000 0xFEFFFE 0xFF0000 0xFF0002 0xFF0004 0xFFFFFE Memory areas are not shown to scale.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 35 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 4-3: PROGRAM MEMORY MAP FOR dsPIC33EP64GS70X/80X DEVICES (DUAL PARTITION) GOTO Instruction Reset Address Interrupt Vector Table Active Program Flash Memory (11,008 instructions) User Memory Space Device Configuration Unimplemented (Read ‘0’s) GOTO Instruction Reset Address Interrupt Vector Table Inactive Program Flash Memory (11,008 instructions) Device Configuration Unimplemented (Read ‘0’s) Reserved 0x000000 0x000002 0x000004 0x0001FE 0x000200 0x00577E 0x005780 Active Partition 0x0057FE 0x005800 0x3FFFFE 0x400000 0x400002 0x400004 0x4001FE 0x400200 Inactive Partition 0x40577E 0x405780 0x4057FE 0x405800 0x7FFFFE 0x800000 0x800E46 0x800E48 Configuration Memory Space Calibration Data Reserved User OTP Memory Reserved 0x800E78 0x800E7A 0x800F7E 0x800F80 0x800FFC 0x800100 0xF9FFFE 0xFA0000 Write Latches 0xFA0002 0xFA0004 Reserved 0xFEFFFE 0xFF0000 DEVID Reserved 0xFF0002 0xFF0004 0xFFFFFE Note: Memory areas are not shown to scale. DS70005258C-page 36  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 4-4: PROGRAM MEMORY MAP FOR dsPIC33EP128GS70X/80X DEVICES (DUAL PARTITION) GOTO Instruction Reset Address Interrupt Vector Table Active Program Flash Memory (22,016 instructions) User Memory Space Device Configuration Unimplemented (Read ‘0’s) GOTO Instruction Reset Address 0x000000 0x000002 0x000004 0x0001FE 0x000200 0x00AB7E 0x00AB80 Active Partition 0x00ABFE 0x00AC00 0x3FFFFE 0x400000 0x400002 0x400004 Interrupt Vector Table Inactive Program Flash Memory (22,016 instructions) Device Configuration Unimplemented (Read ‘0’s) Reserved 0x4001FE 0x400200 Inactive Partition 0x40AB7E 0x40AB80 0x40ABFE 0x40AC00 0x7FFFFE 0x800000 0x800E46 0x800E48 Configuration Memory Space Calibration Data Reserved User OTP Memory Reserved 0x800E78 0x800E7A 0x800F7E 0x800F80 0x800FFC 0x800100 0xF9FFFE 0xFA0000 Write Latches 0xFA0002 0xFA0004 Reserved 0xFEFFFE 0xFF0000 DEVID Reserved 0xFF0002 0xFF0004 0xFFFFFE Note: Memory areas are not shown to scale.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 37 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.2.1 PROGRAM MEMORY ORGANIZATION 4.2.2 All dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices reserve the addresses between 0x000000 and 0x000200 for hard-coded program execution vectors. A hardware Reset vector is provided to redirect code execution from the default value of the PC on device Reset to the actual start of code. A GOTO instruction is programmed by the user application at address, 0x000000, of Flash memory, with the actual address for the start of code at address, 0x000002, of Flash memory. The program memory space is organized in wordaddressable blocks. Although it is treated as 24 bits wide, it is more appropriate to think of each address of the program memory as a lower and upper word, with the upper byte of the upper word being unimplemented. The lower word always has an even address, while the upper word has an odd address (Figure 4-5). Program memory addresses are always word-aligned on the lower word, and addresses are incremented or decremented by two, during code execution. This arrangement provides compatibility with data memory space addressing and makes data in the program memory space accessible. FIGURE 4-5: msw Address least significant word most significant word 16 8 PC Address (lsw Address) 0 0x000000 0x000002 0x000004 0x000006 00000000 00000000 00000000 00000000 Program Memory ‘Phantom’ Byte (read as ‘0’) DS70005258C-page 38 A more detailed discussion of the Interrupt Vector Tables (IVTs) is provided in Section 7.1 “Interrupt Vector Table”. PROGRAM MEMORY ORGANIZATION 23 0x000001 0x000003 0x000005 0x000007 INTERRUPT AND TRAP VECTORS Instruction Width  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.3 Data Address Space The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family CPU has a separate 16-bit wide data memory space. The Data Space is accessed using separate Address Generation Units (AGUs) for read and write operations. The data memory map is shown in Figure 4-6. All Effective Addresses (EAs) in the data memory space are 16 bits wide and point to bytes within the Data Space. This arrangement gives a base Data Space address range of 64 Kbytes or 32K words. The lower half of the data memory space (i.e., when EA = 0) is used for implemented memory addresses, while the upper half (EA = 1) is reserved for the Program Space Visibility (PSV). dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices implement up to 12 Kbytes of data memory. If an EA points to a location outside of this area, an all-zero word or byte is returned. 4.3.1 DATA SPACE WIDTH The data memory space is organized in byteaddressable, 16-bit wide blocks. Data is aligned in data memory and registers as 16-bit words, but all Data Space EAs resolve to bytes. The Least Significant Bytes (LSBs) of each word have even addresses, while the Most Significant Bytes (MSBs) have odd addresses. 4.3.2 DATA MEMORY ORGANIZATION AND ALIGNMENT To maintain backward compatibility with PIC ® MCU devices and improve Data Space memory usage efficiency, the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family instruction set supports both word and byte operations. As a consequence of byte accessibility, all Effective Address calculations are internally scaled to step through word-aligned memory. For example, the core recognizes that Post-Modified Register Indirect Addressing mode [Ws++] results in a value of Ws + 1 for byte operations and Ws + 2 for word operations. A data byte read, reads the complete word that contains the byte, using the LSb of any EA to determine which byte to select. The selected byte is placed onto the LSB of the data path. That is, data memory and registers are organized as two parallel, byte-wide entities with shared (word) address decode, but separate write lines. Data byte writes only write to the corresponding side of the array or register that matches the byte address.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. All word accesses must be aligned to an even address. Misaligned word data fetches are not supported, so care must be taken when mixing byte and word operations, or translating from 8-bit MCU code. If a misaligned read or write is attempted, an address error trap is generated. If the error occurred on a read, the instruction underway is completed. If the error occurred on a write, the instruction is executed but the write does not occur. In either case, a trap is then executed, allowing the system and/or user application to examine the machine state prior to execution of the address Fault. All byte loads into any W register are loaded into the LSB; the MSB is not modified. A Sign-Extend (SE) instruction is provided to allow user applications to translate 8-bit signed data to 16-bit signed values. Alternatively, for 16-bit unsigned data, user applications can clear the MSB of any W register by executing a Zero-Extend (ZE) instruction on the appropriate address. 4.3.3 SFR SPACE The first 4 Kbytes of the Near Data Space, from 0x0000 to 0x0FFF, is primarily occupied by Special Function Registers (SFRs). These are used by the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family core and peripheral modules for controlling the operation of the device. SFRs are distributed among the modules that they control and are generally grouped together by module. Much of the SFR space contains unused addresses; these are read as ‘0’. Note: 4.3.4 The actual set of peripheral features and interrupts varies by the device. Refer to the corresponding device tables and pinout diagrams for device-specific information. NEAR DATA SPACE The 8-Kbyte area, between 0x0000 and 0x1FFF, is referred to as the Near Data Space. Locations in this space are directly addressable through a 13-bit absolute address field within all memory direct instructions. Additionally, the whole Data Space is addressable using MOV instructions, which support Memory Direct Addressing mode with a 16-bit address field, or by using Indirect Addressing mode using a Working register as an Address Pointer. DS70005258C-page 39 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 4-6: DATA MEMORY MAP FOR dsPIC33EP64GS70X/80X DEVICES MSB Address MSB 4-Kbyte SFR Space LSB Address 16 Bits LSB 0x0000 0x0001 SFR Space 0x0FFE 0x1000 0x0FFF 0x1001 X Data RAM (X) 8-Kbyte SRAM Space 0x1FFF 0x2001 8-Kbyte Near Data Space 0x1FFE 0x2000 Y Data RAM (Y) 0x2FFF 0x3001 0x2FFE 0x3000 0x8001 0x8000 X Data Unimplemented (X) Optionally Mapped into Program Memory 0xFFFF Note: 0xFFFE Memory areas are not shown to scale. DS70005258C-page 40  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.3.5 X AND Y DATA SPACES The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X core has two Data Spaces, X and Y. These Data Spaces can be considered either separate (for some DSP instructions) or as one unified linear address range (for MCU instructions). The Data Spaces are accessed using two Address Generation Units (AGUs) and separate data paths. This feature allows certain instructions to concurrently fetch two words from RAM, thereby enabling efficient execution of DSP algorithms, such as Finite Impulse Response (FIR) filtering and Fast Fourier Transform (FFT). The X Data Space is used by all instructions and supports all addressing modes. X Data Space has separate read and write data buses. The X read data bus is the read data path for all instructions that view Data Space as combined X and Y address space. It is also the X data prefetch path for the dual operand DSP instructions (MAC class). 4.4 Memory Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 4.4.1 KEY RESOURCES • “dsPIC33E/PIC24E Program Memory” (DS70000613) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools The Y Data Space is used in concert with the X Data Space by the MAC class of instructions (CLR, ED, EDAC, MAC, MOVSAC, MPY, MPY.N and MSC) to provide two concurrent data read paths. Both the X and Y Data Spaces support Modulo Addressing mode for all instructions, subject to addressing mode restrictions. Bit-Reversed Addressing mode is only supported for writes to X Data Space. All data memory writes, including in DSP instructions, view Data Space as combined X and Y address space. The boundary between the X and Y Data Spaces is device-dependent and is not user-programmable.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 41 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.5 Special Function Register Maps TABLE 4-2: Register SFR BLOCK 000h Address All Resets Address All Resets Register Address All Resets WREG0 000 0000000000000000 WREG14 01C 0000000000000000 WREG15 01E 0000100000000000 DOSTARTL 03A xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx0 DOSTARTH 03C WREG1 002 0000000000000000 SPLIM 020 0000000000xxxxxx xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx0 DOENDL 03E WREG2 004 0000000000000000 ACCAL xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx0 022 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx DOENDH 040 WREG3 006 0000000000000000 0000000000xxxxxx ACCAH 024 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx SR 042 WREG4 008 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 ACCAU 026 00000000xxxxxxxx CORCON 044 WREG5 0000000000100000 00A 0000000000000000 ACCBL 028 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx MODCON 046 0000000000000000 WREG6 00C 0000000000000000 ACCBH 02A xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx XMODSRT 048 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx0 WREG7 00E 0000000000000000 ACCBU 02C 00000000xxxxxxxx XMODEND 04A xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx1 WREG8 010 0000000000000000 PCL 02E 0000000000000000 YMODSRT 04C xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx0 WREG9 012 0000000000000000 PCH 030 0000000000000000 YMODEND 04E xxxxxxxxxxxxxxx1 WREG10 014 0000000000000000 DSRPAG 032 0000000000000001 XBREV 050 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx WREG11 016 0000000000000000 DSWPAG 034 0000000000000001 DISICNT 052 00xxxxxxxxxxxxxx WREG12 018 0000000000000000 RCOUNT 036 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx TBLPAG 054 00000000xxxxxxxx WREG13 01A 0000000000000000 DCOUNT 038 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CTXTSTAT 05A 0000000000000000 Address All Resets Core Register Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. TABLE 4-3: Register SFR BLOCK 100h Address All Resets TMR5HLD 116 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx IC2CON2 14A 0000000000001101 TMR1 100 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx TMR5 118 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx IC2BUF 14C xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PR1 102 1111111111111111 PR4 11A 1111111111111111 IC2TMR 14E 0000000000000000 T1CON 104 0000000000000000 PR5 11C 1111111111111111 IC3CON1 150 0000000000000000 TMR2 106 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx T4CON 11E 0000000000000000 IC3CON2 152 0000000000001101 TMR3HLD 108 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx T5CON 120 0000000000000000 IC3BUF 154 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx TMR3 10A xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx Input Capture IC3TMR 156 0000000000000000 PR2 10C 1111111111111111 IC1CON1 140 0000000000000000 IC4CON1 158 0000000000000000 PR3 10E 1111111111111111 IC1CON2 142 0000000000001101 IC4CON2 15A 0000000000001101 T2CON 110 0000000000000000 IC1BUF 144 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx IC4BUF 15C xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx T3CON 112 0000000000000000 IC1TMR 146 0000000000000000 IC4TMR 15E 0000000000000000 TMR4 114 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx IC2CON1 148 0000000000000000 Timers Register Address All Resets Register Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. DS70005258C-page 42  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-4: Register SFR BLOCK 200h Address All Resets Address All Resets Register Address All Resets I2C1CONL 200 0001000000000000 U1STA 222 0000000010010000 SPI1BRGH 252 0000000000000000 U1TXREG 224 0000000xxxxxxxxx SPI1IMSKL 254 I2C1CONH 202 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 U1RXREG 226 0000000000000000 SPI1IMSKH 256 I2C1STAT 0000000000000000 204 0000000000000000 U1BRG 228 0000000000000000 SPI1URDTL 258 0000000000000000 I2C1ADD 206 0000000000000000 U2MODE 230 0000000000000000 SPI1URDTH 25A 0000000000000000 I2C1MSK 208 0000000000000000 U2STA 232 0000000010010000 SPI2CON1L 260 0000000000000000 I2C1BRG 20A 0000000000000000 U2TXREG 234 0000000xxxxxxxxx SPI2CON1H 262 0000000000000000 I2C1TRN 20C 0000000011111111 U2RXREG 236 0000000000000000 SPI2CON2L 264 0000000000000000 I2C1RCV 20E 0000000000000000 U2BRG 238 0000000000000000 SPI2CON2H 266 0000000000000000 I2C2CON1 210 0001000000000000 SPI SPI2STATL 268 0000000000101000 I2C2CON2 212 0000000000000000 SPI1CON1L 240 0000000000000000 SPI2STATH 26A 0000000000000000 I2C2STAT 214 0000000000000000 SPI1CON1H 242 0000000000000000 SPI2BUFL 26C 0000000000000000 I2C2ADD 216 0000000000000000 SPI1CON2L 244 0000000000000000 SPI2BUFH 26E 0000000000000000 I2C2MSK 218 0000000000000000 SPI1CON2H 246 0000000000000000 SPI3STAT 270 000xxxxxxxxxxxxx I2C2BRG 21A 0000000000000000 SPI1STATL 248 0000000000101000 SPI2BRGH 272 0000000000000000 I2C2TRN 21C 0000000011111111 SPI1STATH 24A 0000000000000000 SPI2IMSKL 274 0000000000000000 I2C2RCV 21E 0000000000000000 SPI1BUFL 24C 0000000000000000 SPI2IMSKH 276 0000000000000000 SPI1BUFH 24E 0000000000000000 SPI2URDTL 278 0000000000000000 SPI1BRGL 250 000xxxxxxxxxxxxx SPI2URDTH 27A 0000000000000000 Address All Resets I2C1 and I2C2 UART1 and UART2 U1MODE 220 0000000000000000 Register Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. TABLE 4-5: Register SFR BLOCK 300h Address All Resets ADC Register ADCMP0ENH Address All Resets Register 33A 0000000000000000 ADTRIG4L 390 0000000000000000 ADCON1L 300 0000000000000000 ADCMP0LO 33C 0000000000000000 ADTRIG4H 392 0000000000000000 ADCON1H 302 0000000001100000 ADCMP0HI 33E 0000000000000000 ADCMP0CON 3A0 0000000000000000 ADCON2L 304 0000000000000000 ADCMP1ENL 340 0000000000000000 ADCMP1CON 3A4 0000000000000000 ADCON2H 306 0000000000000000 ADCMP1ENH 342 0000000000000000 ADBASE 3C0 0000000000000000 ADCON3L 308 0000000000000000 ADCMP1LO 344 0000000000000000 ADLVLTRGL 3D0 0000000000000000 ADCON3H 30A 0000000000000000 ADCMP1HI 346 0000000000000000 ADLVLTRGH 3D2 0000000000000000 ADCON4L 30C 0000000000000000 ADFL0DAT 368 0000000000000000 ADCORE0L 3D4 0000000000000000 ADCON4H 30E 0000000000000000 ADFL0CON 36A 0000000000000000 ADCORE0H 3D6 0000001100000000 ADMOD0L 310 0000000000000000 ADFL1DAT 36C 0000000000000000 ADCORE1L 3D8 0000000000000000 ADMOD0H 312 0000000000000000 ADFL1CON 36E 0000000000000000 ADCORE1H 3DA 0000001100000000 ADMOD1L 314 0000000000000000 ADTRIG0L 380 0000000000000000 ADCORE2L 3DC 0000000000000000 ADIEL 320 0000000000000000 ADTRIG0H 382 0000000000000000 ADCORE2H 3DE 0000001100000000 ADIEH 322 0000000000000000 ADTRIG1L 384 0000000000000000 ADCORE3L 3E0 0000000000000000 ADCSS1L 328 0000000000000000 ADTRIG1H 386 0000000000000000 ADCORE3H 3E2 0000001100000000 ADCSS1H 32A 0000000000000000 ADTRIG2L 388 0000000000000000 ADEIEL 3F0 0000000000000000 ADSTATL 330 0000000000000000 ADTRIG2H 38A 0000000000000000 ADEIEH 3F2 0000000000000000 ADSTATH 332 0000000000000000 ADTRIG3L 38C 0000000000000000 ADEISTATL 3F8 0000000000000000 ADCMP0ENL 338 0000000000000000 ADTRIG3H 38E 0000000000000000 ADEISTATH 3FA 0000000000000000 Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 43 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-6: Register SFR BLOCK 400h Address All Resets ADC (Continued) Register Address All Resets Register Address All Resets C1FCTRL 486 0000000000000000 C1RXM2EID 4BA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCON5L 400 0000000000000000 C1FIFO 488 0000000000000000 C1RXF1SID 4C4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCON5H 402 0000000000000000 C1INTF 48A 0000000000000000 C1RXF1EID 4C6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCAL0L 404 0000000000000000 C1INTE 48C 0000000000000000 C1RXF2SID 4C8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCAL0H 406 0000000000000000 C1EC 48E 0000000000000000 C1RXF2EID 4CA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCAL1H 40A 0000000000000000 C1CFG1 490 0000000000000000 C1RXF3SID 4CC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF0 40C 0000000000000000 C1CFG2 492 0x000xxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF3EID 4CE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF1 40E 0000000000000000 C1FEN1 494 1111111111111111 C1RXF4SID 4D0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF2 410 0000000000000000 C1FMSKSEL1 498 0000000000000000 C1RXF4EID 4D2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF3 412 0000000000000000 C1FMSKSEL2 49A 0000000000000000 C1RXF5SID 4D4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF4 414 0000000000000000 CAN (WIN (C1CTRL) = 0) C1RXF5EID 4D6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF5 416 0000000000000000 C1RXFUL1 4A0 0000000000000000 C1RXF6SID 4D8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF6 418 0000000000000000 C1RXFUL2 4A2 0000000000000000 C1RXF6EID 4DA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF7 41A 0000000000000000 C1RXOVF1 4A8 0000000000000000 C1RXF7SID 4DC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF8 41C 0000000000000000 C1RXOVF2 4AA 0000000000000000 C1RXF7EID 4DE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF9 41E 0000000000000000 C1TR01CON 4B0 0000000000000000 C1RXF8SID 4E0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF10 420 0000000000000000 C1TR23CON 4B2 0000000000000000 C1RXF8EID 4E2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF11 422 0000000000000000 C1TR45CON 4B4 0000000000000000 C1RXF9SID 4E4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF12 424 0000000000000000 C1TR67CON 4B6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF9EID 4E6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF13 426 0000000000000000 C1RXD 4C0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF10SID 4E8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF14 428 0000000000000000 C1TXD 4C2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF10EID 4EA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF15 42A 0000000000000000 CAN (WIN (C1CTR1) = 1) C1RXF11SID 4EC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF16 42C 0000000000000000 C1BUFPNT1 4A0 0000000000000000 C1RXF11EID 4EE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF17 42E 0000000000000000 C1BUFPNT2 4A2 0000000000000000 C1RXF12SID 4F0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF18 430 0000000000000000 C1BUFPNT3 4A4 0000000000000000 C1RXF12EID 4F2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF19 432 0000000000000000 C1BUFPNT4 4A6 0000000000000000 C1RXF13SID 4F4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF20 434 0000000000000000 C1RXM0SID 4B0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF13EID 4F6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ADCBUF21 436 0000000000000000 C1RXM0EID 4B2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF14SID 4F8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CAN (WIN (C1CTRL) = 0 OR 1) C1RXM1SID 4B4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF14EID 4FA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1CTRL1 480 000010010000000 C1RXM1EID 4B6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1RXF15SID 4FC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1CTRL2 482 000000000000000 CAN C1RXF15EID 4FE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C1VEC 484 000000001000000 C1RXM2SID 4B8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. TABLE 4-7: Register SFR BLOCK 500h Address All Resets 500 0000000000000000 Comparators PGA1CON 504 0000000000000000 CMP1CON 540 0000000000000000 PGA1CAL 506 0000000000000000 CMP1DAC 542 0000000000000000 PGA2CON 508 0000000000000000 CMP2CON 544 0000000000000000 PGA ISRCCON Register PGA2CAL Address All Resets 50A 0000000000000000 Register Address All Resets CMP2DAC 546 0000000000000000 CMP3CON 548 0000000000000000 CMP3DAC 54A 0000000000000000 CMP4CON 54C 0000000000000000 CMP4DAC 54E 0000000000000000 Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. DS70005258C-page 44  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-8: Register SFR BLOCK 600h Address All Resets Address All Resets Address All Resets SPI3CON1L 600 0000000000000000 RPOR8 678 0000000000000000 RPOR9 67A 0000000000000000 RPINR7 6AE 0000000000000000 RPINR8 6B0 SPI3CON1H 602 0000000000000000 RPOR10 67C 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 RPINR11 6B6 SPI3CON2L 604 0000000000000000 RPOR11 0000000000000000 67E 0000000000000000 RPINR12 6B8 SPI3CON2H 606 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 RPOR12 680 0000000000000000 RPINR13 6BA SPI3STATL 608 0000000000000000 0000000000101000 RPOR13 682 0000000000000000 RPINR18 6C4 SPI3STATH 0000000000000000 60A 0000000000000000 RPOR14 684 0000000000000000 RPINR19 6C6 0000000000000000 SPI3BUFL 60C 0000000000000000 RPOR15 686 0000000000000000 RPINR20 6C8 0000000000000000 SPI3BUFH 60E 0000000000000000 RPOR17 68A 0000000000000000 RPINR21 6CA 0000000000000000 SPI3BRGL 610 000xxxxxxxxxxxxx RPOR18 68C 0000000000000000 RPINR22 6CC 0000000000000000 SPI3BRGH 612 0000000000000000 RPOR19 68E 0000000000000000 RPINR23 6CE 0000000000000000 SPI3IMSKL 614 0000000000000000 RPOR20 690 0000000000000000 RPINR26 6D4 0000000000000000 SPI3IMSKH 616 0000000000000000 RPOR21 692 0000000000000000 RPINR29 6DA 0000000000000000 SPI3URDTL 618 0000000000000000 RPOR22 694 0000000000000000 RPINR30 6DC 0000000000000000 SPI3URDTH 61A 0000000000000000 RPOR23 696 0000000000000000 RPINR37 6EA 0000000000000000 RPOR0 668 0000000000000000 RPOR24 698 0000000000000000 RPINR38 6EC 0000000000000000 RPOR1 66A 0000000000000000 RPOR25 69A 0000000000000000 RPINR42 6F4 0000000000000000 RPOR2 66C 0000000000000000 RPOR26 69C 0000000000000000 RPINR43 6F6 0000000000000000 RPOR3 66E 0000000000000000 RPINR0 6A0 0000000000000000 RPINR45 6FA 0000000000000000 RPOR4 670 0000000000000000 RPINR1 6A2 0000000000000000 RPINR46 6FC 0000000000000000 RPOR5 672 0000000000000000 RPINR2 6A4 0000000000000000 RPOR6 674 0000000000000000 RPINR3 6A6 0000000000000000 SPI Register Register Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 45 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-9: Register SFR BLOCK 700h Address All Resets NVM NVMCON 728 Register Address All Resets Register Address All Resets C2INTF 78A 0000000000000000 C2RXF1SID 7C4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 0000000000000000 C2INTE 78C 0000000000000000 C2RXF1EID 7C6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx NVMADR 72A 0000000000000000 C2EC 78E 0000000000000000 C2RXF2SID 7C8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx NVMADRU 72C 0000000000000000 C2CFG1 790 0000000000000000 C2RXF2EID 7CA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx NVMKEY 72E 0000000000000000 C2CFG2 792 0x000xxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF3SID 7CC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx NVMSRCADR 730 0000000000000000 C2FEN1 794 1111111111111111 C2RXF3EID 7CE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx NVMSRCADRH 732 0000000000000000 C2FMSKSEL1 798 0000000000000000 C2RXF4SID 7D0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2FMSKSEL2 79A 0000000000000000 C2RXF4EID 7D2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx System Control RCON 740 0x00x0x01x0xxxxx CAN (WIN (C1CTR1) = 0) OSCCON 742 0000000000000000 C2RXFUL1 CLKDIV 744 0000000000000000 C2RXFUL2 7A2 0000000000000000 C2RXF6SID 7D8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PLLFBD 746 0000000000000000 C2RXOVF1 7A8 0000000000000000 C2RXF6EID 7DA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 7A0 C2RXF5SID 7D4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 0000000000000000 C2RXF5EID 7D6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx OSCTUN 748 0000000000000000 C2RXOVF2 7AA 0000000000000000 C2RXF7SID 7DC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx LFSR 74C 0000000000000000 C2TR01CON 7B0 0000000000000000 C2RXF7EID 7DE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx REFOCON 74E 0000000000000000 C2TR23CON 7B2 0000000000000000 C2RXF8SID 7E0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ACLKCON 750 0000000001000000 C2TR45CON 7B4 0000000000000000 C2RXF8EID 7E2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 7B6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF9SID 7E4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 760 0000000000000000 C2RXD 7C0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF9EID 7E6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 7C2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF10SID 7E8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PMD PMD1 C2TR67CON PMD2 762 0000000000000000 C2TXD PMD3 764 0000000000000000 CAN (WIN (C1CTR1) = 1) PMD4 766 0000000000000000 C2BUFPNT1 C2RXF10EID 7EA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 7A0 0000000000000000 C2RXF11SID 7EC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PMD6 76A 0000000000000000 C2BUFPNT2 7A2 0000000000000000 C2RXF11EID 7EE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PMD7 76C 0000000000000000 C2BUFPNT3 7A4 0000000000000000 C2RXF12SID 7F0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PMD8 76E 0000000000000000 C2BUFPNT4 CAN (WIN (C1CTR1) = 0 or 1) C2RXM0SID 7A6 0000000000000000 C2RXF12EID 7F2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 7B0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF13SID 7F4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2CTRL1 780 0000010010000000 C2RXM0EID 7B2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF13EID 7F6 C2CTRL2 782 0000000000000000 C2RXM1SID 7B4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF14SID 7F8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2VEC 784 0000000001000000 C2RXM1EID 7B6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF14EID 7FA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2FCTRL 786 0000000000000000 C2RXM2SID 7B8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF15SID 7FC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2FIFO 788 0000000000000000 C2RXM2EID 7BA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx C2RXF15EID 7FE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. DS70005258C-page 46  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-10: Register SFR BLOCK 800h Address All Resets Interrupt Controller Register Address All Resets Register Address All Resets IEC9 832 0000000000000000 IPC26 874 0000000001000100 IFS0 800 0000000000000000 IEC10 834 0000000000000000 IPC27 876 0100010000000000 IFS1 802 0000000000000000 IEC11 836 0000000000000000 IPC28 878 0100010001000100 IFS2 804 0000000000000000 IPC0 840 0100010001000100 IPC29 87A 0000000001000100 IFS3 806 0000000000000000 IPC1 842 0100010001000000 IPC35 886 0100010000000000 IFS4 808 0000000000000000 IPC2 844 0100010001000100 IPC36 888 0000000000000000 IFS5 80A 0000000000000000 IPC3 846 0100000001000100 IPC37 88A 0100000000000000 IFS6 80C 0000000000000000 IPC4 848 0100010001000100 IPC38 88C 0100010001000100 IFS7 80E 0000000000000000 IPC5 84A 0000000000000100 IPC39 88E 0100010001000100 IFS8 810 0000000000000000 IPC6 84C 0100010001000000 IPC40 890 0100010001000100 IFS9 812 0000000000000000 IPC7 84E 0100010001000100 IPC41 892 0100010001000100 IFS10 814 0000000000000000 IPC8 850 0000000001000100 IPC42 894 0000000001000100 IFS11 816 0000000000000000 IPC9 852 0000010001000000 IPC43 896 0000010001000000 IEC0 820 0000000000000000 IPC11 856 0000000000000000 IPC44 898 0100010001000000 IEC1 822 0000000000000000 IPC12 858 0000010001000000 IPC45 89A 0000000000000100 IEC2 824 0000000000000000 IPC13 85A 0000010000000000 IPC46 89C 0100010000000000 IEC3 826 0000000000000000 IPC14 85C 0000000001000000 IPC47 89E 0000010001000100 IEC4 828 0000000000000000 IPC16 860 0000010001000000 INTCON1 8C0 0000000000000000 IEC5 82A 0000000000000000 IPC18 864 0000000001000000 INTCON2 8C2 0000000000000000 IEC6 82C 0000000000000000 IPC23 86E 0100010000000000 INTCON3 8C4 0000000000000000 IEC7 82E 0000000000000000 IPC24 870 0000010001000100 INTCON4 8C6 0000000000000000 IEC8 830 0000000000000000 IPC25 872 0100000000000000 INTTREG 8C8 0000000000000000 Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. TABLE 4-11: Register SFR BLOCK 900h Address All Resets Output Compare Register Address All Resets Register Address All Resets OC3R 91A xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CLC2CONH 9CE 0000000000000000 OC1CON1 900 0000000000000000 OC3TMR 91C 0000000000000000 CLC2SEL 9D0 0000000000000000 OC1CON2 902 0000000000001100 OC4CON1 91E 0000000000000000 CLC2GLSL 9D4 0000000000000000 OC1RS 904 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx OC4CON2 920 0000000000001100 CLC2GLSH 9D6 0000000000000000 OC1R 906 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx OC4RS 922 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CLC3CONL 9D8 0000000000000000 OC1TMR 908 0000000000000000 OC4R 924 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CLC3CONH 9DA 0000000000000000 OC2CON1 90A 0000000000000000 OC4TMR 926 0000000000000000 CLC3SEL 9DC 0000000000000000 OC2CON2 90C 0000000000001100 CLC CLC3GLSL 9E0 0000000000000000 OC2RS 90E xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CLC1CONL 9C0 0000000000000000 CLC3GLSH 9E2 0000000000000000 OC2R 910 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CLC1CONH 9C2 0000000000000000 CLC4CONL 9E4 0000000000000000 OC2TMR 912 0000000000000000 CLC1SEL 9C4 0000000000000000 CLC4CONH 9E6 0000000000000000 OC3CON1 914 0000000000000000 CLC1GLSL 9C8 0000000000000000 CLC4SEL 9E8 0000000000000000 OC3CON2 916 0000000000001100 CLC1GLSH 9CA 0000000000000000 CLC4GLSL 9EC 0000000000000000 OC3RS 918 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx CLC2CONL 9CC 0000000000000000 CLC4GLSH 9EE 0000000000000000 Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 47 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-12: Register SFR BLOCK A00h Address All Resets Address All Resets Address All Resets PTGCST AC0 0000000000000000 PTGADJ AD2 0000000000000000 PTGL0 AD4 0000000000000000 PTGQUE7 AE6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE8 AE8 PTGCON AC2 0000000000000000 PTGQPTR AD6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 0000000000000000 PTGQUE9 AEA PTGBTE AC4 0000000000000000 PTGQUE0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx AD8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE10 AEC PTGHOLD AC6 0000000000000000 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE1 ADA xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE11 AEE PTGT0LIM AC8 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx 0000000000000000 PTGQUE2 ADC xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE12 AF0 PTGT1LIM xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx ACA 0000000000000000 PTGQUE3 ADE xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE13 AF2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGSDLIM ACC 0000000000000000 PTGQUE4 AE0 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE14 AF4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGC0LIM ACE 0000000000000000 PTGQUE5 AE2 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGQUE15 AF6 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx PTGC1LIM AD0 0000000000000000 PTGQUE6 AE4 xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx Address All Resets PTG Register Register Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. TABLE 4-13: Register SFR BLOCK B00h Address All Resets Address All Resets DMA0CON B00 0000000000000000 DMA1STBL B18 0000000000000000 DMA3REQ B32 0000000000000000 DMA1STBH B1A 0000000000000000 DMA3STAL B34 DMA0REQ B02 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 DMA1PAD B1C 0000000000000000 DMA3STAH B36 DMA0STAL 0000000000000000 B04 0000000000000000 DMA1CNT B1E 0000000000000000 DMA3STBL B38 0000000000000000 DMA0STAH B06 0000000000000000 DMA2CON B20 0000000000000000 DMA3STBH B3A 0000000000000000 DMA0STBL B08 0000000000000000 DMA2REQ B22 0000000000000000 DMA3PAD B3C 0000000000000000 DMA0STBH B0A 0000000000000000 DMA2STAL B24 0000000000000000 DMA3CNT B3E 0000000000000000 DMA0PAD B0C 0000000000000000 DMA2STAH B26 0000000000000000 DMAPWC BF0 0000000000000000 DMA0CNT B0E 0000000000000000 DMA2STBL B28 0000000000000000 DMARQC BF2 0000000000000000 DMA1CON B10 0000000000000000 DMA2STBH B2A 0000000000000000 DMAPPS BF4 0000000000000000 DMA1REQ B12 0000000000000000 DMA2PAD B2C 0000000000000000 DMALCA BF6 0000000000001111 DMA1STAL B14 0000000000000000 DMA2CNT B2E 0000000000000000 DSADRL BF8 0000000000000000 DMA1STAH B16 0000000000000000 DMA3CON B30 0000000000000000 DSADRH BFA 0000000000000000 DMA Register Register Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. DS70005258C-page 48  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-14: Register SFR BLOCK C00h-D00h Address All Resets PWM Address All Resets FCLCON3 Register C64 0000000000000000 IOCON6 Register Address All Resets CC2 1100000000000000 PTCON C00 0000000000000000 PDC3 C66 0000000000000000 FCLCON6 CC4 0000000000000000 PTCON2 C02 0000000000000000 PHASE3 C68 0000000000000000 PDC6 CC6 0000000000000000 PTPER C04 1111111111111000 DTR3 C6A 0000000000000000 PHASE6 CC8 0000000000000000 SEVTCMP C06 0000000000000000 ALTDTR3 C6C 0000000000000000 DTR6 CCA 0000000000000000 MDC C0A 0000000000000000 SDC3 C6E 0000000000000000 ALTDTR6 CCC 0000000000000000 STCON C0E 0000000000000000 SPHASE3 C70 0000000000000000 SDC6 CCE 0000000000000000 STCON2 C10 0000000000000000 TRIG3 C72 0000000000000000 SPHASE6 CD0 0000000000000000 STPER C12 1111111111111000 TRGCON3 C74 0000000000000000 TRIG6 CD2 0000000000000000 SSEVTCMP C14 0000000000000000 STRIG3 C76 0000000000000000 TRGCON6 CD4 0000000000000000 CHOP C1A 0000000000000000 PWMCAP3 C78 0000000000000000 STRIG6 CD6 0000000000000000 PWMKEY C1E xxxxxxxxxxxxxxxx LEBCON3 C7A 0000000000000000 PWMCAP6 CD8 0000000000000000 LEBDLY3 C7C 0000000000000000 LEBCON6 CDA 0000000000000000 PWM Generator PWMCON1 C20 0000000000000000 AUXCON3 C7E 0000000000000000 LEBDLY6 CDC 0000000000000000 IOCON1 C22 1100000000000000 PWMCON4 C80 0000000000000000 AUXCON6 CDE 0000000000000000 FCLCON1 C24 0000000000000000 IOCON4 C82 1100000000000000 PWMCON7 CE0 0000000000000000 PDC1 C26 0000000000000000 FCLCON4 C84 0000000000000000 IOCON7 CE2 1100000000000000 PHASE1 C28 0000000000000000 PDC4 C86 0000000000000000 FCLCON7 CE4 0000000000000000 DTR1 C2A 0000000000000000 PHASE4 C88 0000000000000000 PDC7 CE6 0000000000000000 ALTDTR1 C2C 0000000000000000 DTR4 C8A 0000000000000000 PHASE7 CE8 0000000000000000 SDC1 C2E 0000000000000000 ALTDTR4 C8C 0000000000000000 DTR7 CEA 0000000000000000 SPHASE1 C30 0000000000000000 SDC4 C8E 0000000000000000 ALTDTR7 CEC 0000000000000000 TRIG1 C32 0000000000000000 SPHASE4 C90 0000000000000000 SDC7 CEE 0000000000000000 TRGCON1 C34 0000000000000000 TRIG4 C92 0000000000000000 SPHASE7 CF0 0000000000000000 STRIG1 C36 0000000000000000 TRGCON4 C94 0000000000000000 TRIG7 CF2 0000000000000000 PWMCAP1 C38 0000000000000000 STRIG4 C96 0000000000000000 TRGCON7 CF4 0000000000000000 LEBCON1 C3A 0000000000000000 PWMCAP4 C98 0000000000000000 STRIG7 CF6 0000000000000000 LEBDLY1 C3C 0000000000000000 LEBCON4 C9A 0000000000000000 PWMCAP7 CF8 0000000000000000 AUXCON1 C3E 0000000000000000 LEBDLY4 C9C 0000000000000000 LEBCON7 CFA 0000000000000000 PWMCON2 C40 0000000000000000 AUXCON4 C9E 0000000000000000 LEBDLY7 CFC 0000000000000000 IOCON2 C42 1100000000000000 PWMCON5 CA0 0000000000000000 AUXCON7 CFE 0000000000000000 FCLCON2 C44 0000000000000000 IOCON5 CA2 1100000000000000 PWMCON8 D00 0000000000000000 PDC2 C46 0000000000000000 FCLCON5 CA4 0000000000000000 IOCON8 D02 1100000000000000 PHASE2 C48 0000000000000000 PDC5 CA6 0000000000000000 FCLCON8 D04 0000000000000000 DTR2 C4A 0000000000000000 PHASE5 CA8 0000000000000000 PDC8 D06 0000000000000000 ALTDTR2 C4C 0000000000000000 DTR5 CAA 0000000000000000 PHASE8 D08 0000000000000000 SDC2 C4E 0000000000000000 ALTDTR5 CAC 0000000000000000 ALTDTR8 D0C 0000000000000000 SPHASE2 C50 0000000000000000 SDC5 CAE 0000000000000000 SDC8 D0E 0000000000000000 TRIG2 C52 0000000000000000 SPHASE5 CB0 0000000000000000 SPHASE8 D10 0000000000000000 TRGCON2 C54 0000000000000000 TRIG5 CB2 0000000000000000 TRIG8 D12 0000000000000000 STRIG2 C56 0000000000000000 TRGCON5 CB4 0000000000000000 TRGCON8 D14 0000000000000000 PWMCAP2 C58 0000000000000000 STRIG5 CB6 0000000000000000 STRIG8 D16 0000000000000000 LEBCON2 C5A 0000000000000000 PWMCAP5 CB8 0000000000000000 PWMCAP8 D18 0000000000000000 LEBDLY2 C5C 0000000000000000 LEBCON5 CBA 0000000000000000 LEBCON8 D1A 0000000000000000 AUXCON2 C5E 0000000000000000 LEBDLY5 CBC 0000000000000000 LEBDLY8 D1C 0000000000000000 PWMCON3 C60 0000000000000000 AUXCON5 CBE 0000000000000000 AUXCON8 D1E 0000000000000000 IOCON3 C62 1100000000000000 PWMCON6 CC0 0000000000000000 Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 49 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 4-15: Register SFR BLOCK E00h-F00h Address All Resets TRISA E00 0000000000011111 PORTC PORTA E02 0000000000000000 TRISC E20 1111011111111111 PORTE LATA E04 0000000000000000 PORTC E22 0000000000000000 ODCA E06 0000000000000000 LATC E24 0000000000000000 CNENA E08 0000000000000000 ODCC E26 CNPUA E0A 0000000000000000 CNENC CNPDA E0C 0000000000000000 ANSELA E0E 0000000000000111 PORTA Register Address All Resets CNPDD E3C 0000000000000000 ANSELD E3E 0010000110100100 TRISE E40 1111111111111111 PORTE E42 0000000000000000 0000000000000000 LATE E44 0000000000000000 E28 0000000000000000 ODCE E46 0000000000000000 CNPUC E2A 0000000000000000 CNENE E48 0000000000000000 CNPDC E2C 0000000000000000 CNPUE E4A 0000000000000000 ANSELC E2E 0001011001110110 CNPDE E4C 0000000000000000 ANSELE E4E 0000000000000000 F88 0000000000000000 ANSELB PORTB Address All Resets E1E 0000001011101111 Register TRISB E10 1111101111111111 PORTD PORTB E12 0000000000000000 TRISD E30 1111111111111111 CPU LATB E14 0000000000000000 PORTD E32 0000000000000000 VISI ODCB E16 0000000000000000 LATD E34 0000000000000000 JTAG CNENB E18 0000000000000000 ODCD E36 0000000000000000 JDATAH FF0 0000000000000000 CNPUB E1A 0000000000000000 CNEND E38 0000000000000000 JDATAL FF2 0000000000000000 CNPDB E1C 0000000000000000 CNPUD E3A 0000000000000000 Legend: x = unknown or indeterminate value. Address values are in hexadecimal. Reset values are in binary. DS70005258C-page 50  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.5.1 PAGED MEMORY SCHEME The paged memory scheme provides access to multiple 32-Kbyte windows in the PSV memory. The Data Space Read Page (DSRPAG) register, in combination with the upper half of the Data Space address, can provide up to 8 Mbytes of PSV address space. The paged data memory space is shown in Figure 4-8. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family architecture extends the available Data Space through a paging scheme, which allows the available Data Space to be accessed using MOV instructions in a linear fashion for pre- and post-modified Effective Addresses (EAs). The upper half of the base Data Space address is used in conjunction with the Data Space Read Page (DSRPAG) register to form the Program Space Visibility (PSV) address. The Program Space (PS) can be accessed with a DSRPAG of 0x200 or greater. Only reads from PS are supported using the DSRPAG register. The Data Space Read Page (DSRPAG) register is located in the SFR space. Construction of the PSV address is shown in Figure 4-7. When DSRPAG = 1 and the base address bit, EA = 1, the DSRPAG bits are concatenated onto EA to form the 24-bit PSV read address. FIGURE 4-7: PROGRAM SPACE VISIBILITY (PSV) READ ADDRESS GENERATION 16-Bit DS EA EA = 0 (DSRPAG = don’t care) 0 No EDS Access Byte Select EA EA DSRPAG =1 1 EA Select DSRPAG Generate PSV Address 1 DSRPAG 9 Bits 15 Bits 24-Bit PSV EA Byte Select Note: DS read access when DSRPAG = 0x000 will force an address error trap.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 51 DS70005258C-page 52 0xFFFF 0x2FFF 0x3000 0x7FFF 0x8000 0x0FFF 0x1000 0x0000 DS_Addr FIGURE 4-8: 32-Kbyte PSV Window 8-Kbyte RAM SFR Registers Local Data Space 0x7FFF 0x0000 0x7FFF 0x7FFF 0x0000 0x0000 0x7FFF 0x0000 DS_Addr (DSRPAG = 0x3FF) No Writes Allowed (DSRPAG = 0x300) No Writes Allowed (DSRPAG = 0x2FF) No Writes Allowed (DSRPAG = 0x200) No Writes Allowed PAGED DATA MEMORY SPACE PSV Program Memory (MSB) PSV Program Memory (lsw) 0x7F_FFFF Program Memory (MSB – ) 0x00_0000 0x7F_FFFF Program Memory (lsw – ) 0x00_0000 Program Space (Instruction & Data) 0xFFFF 0x0000 0xFFFF DS_Addr 0x0000 (TBLPAG = 0x7F) lsw Using TBLRDL/TBLWTL, MSB Using TBLRDH/TBLWTH (TBLPAG = 0x00) lsw Using TBLRDL/TBLWTL, MSB Using TBLRDH/TBLWTH Table Address Space (TBLPAG) dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY When a PSV page overflow or underflow occurs, EA is cleared as a result of the register indirect EA calculation. An overflow or underflow of the EA in the PSV pages can occur at the page boundaries when: • The initial address, prior to modification, addresses the PSV page • The EA calculation uses Pre- or Post-Modified Register Indirect Addressing; however, this does not include Register Offset Addressing In general, when an overflow is detected, the DSRPAG register is incremented and the EA bit is set to keep the base address within the PSV window. When an underflow is detected, the DSRPAG register is decremented and the EA bit is set to keep the base TABLE 4-16: O, Read U, Read U, Read U, Read [++Wn] or [Wn++] [--Wn] or [Wn--] Legend: Note 1: 2: 3: 4: Exceptions to the operation described above arise when entering and exiting the boundaries of Page 0 and PSV spaces. Table 4-16 lists the effects of overflow and underflow scenarios at different boundaries. In the following cases, when overflow or underflow occurs, the EA bit is set and the DSRPAG is not modified; therefore, the EA will wrap to the beginning of the current page: • Register Indirect with Register Offset Addressing • Modulo Addressing • Bit-Reversed Addressing OVERFLOW AND UNDERFLOW SCENARIOS AT PAGE 0 AND PSV SPACE BOUNDARIES(2,3,4) O/U, Operation R/W O, Read address within the PSV window. This creates a linear PSV address space, but only when using Register Indirect Addressing modes. Before DSxPAG DS EA DSRPAG = 0x2FF 1 DSRPAG = 0x3FF After Page Description DSxPAG DS EA Page Description PSV: Last lsw page DSRPAG = 0x300 1 PSV: First MSB page 1 PSV: Last MSB page DSRPAG = 0x3FF 0 See Note 1 DSRPAG = 0x001 1 PSV page DSRPAG = 0x001 0 See Note 1 DSRPAG = 0x200 1 PSV: First lsw page DSRPAG = 0x200 0 See Note 1 DSRPAG = 0x300 1 PSV: First MSB page DSRPAG = 0x2FF 1 PSV: Last lsw page O = Overflow, U = Underflow, R = Read, W = Write The Register Indirect Addressing now addresses a location in the base Data Space (0x0000-0x7FFF). An EDS access, with DSRPAG = 0x000, will generate an address error trap. Only reads from PS are supported using DSRPAG. Pseudolinear Addressing is not supported for large offsets.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 53 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY EXTENDED X DATA SPACE The lower portion of the base address space range, between 0x0000 and 0x7FFF, is always accessible, regardless of the contents of the Data Space Read Page register. It is indirectly addressable through the register indirect instructions. It can be regarded as being located in the default EDS Page 0 (i.e., EDS address range of 0x000000 to 0x007FFF with the base address bit, EA = 0, for this address range). However, Page 0 cannot be accessed through the upper 32 Kbytes, 0x8000 to 0xFFFF, of base Data Space in combination with DSRPAG = 0x000. Consequently, DSRPAG is initialized to 0x001 at Reset. Note 1: DSRPAG should not be used to access Page 0. An EDS access with DSRPAG set to 0x000 will generate an address error trap. 2: Clearing the DSRPAG in software has no effect. The remaining PSV pages are only accessible using the DSRPAG register in combination with the upper 32 Kbytes, 0x8000 to 0xFFFF, of the base address, where base address bit, EA = 1. 4.5.3 When the PC is pushed onto the stack, PC are pushed onto the first available stack word, then PC are pushed into the second available stack location. For a PC push during any CALL instruction, the MSB of the PC is zero-extended before the push, as shown in Figure 4-9. During exception processing, the MSB of the PC is concatenated with the lower eight bits of the CPU STATUS Register, SR. This allows the contents of SRL to be preserved automatically during interrupt processing. Note 1: To maintain system Stack Pointer (W15) coherency, W15 is never subject to (EDS) paging, and is therefore, restricted to an address range of 0x0000 to 0xFFFF. The same applies to W14 when used as a Stack Frame Pointer (SFA = 1). 2: As the stack can be placed in, and can access X and Y spaces, care must be taken regarding its use, particularly with regard to local automatic variables in a C development environment SOFTWARE STACK The W15 register serves as a dedicated Software Stack Pointer (SSP), and is automatically modified by exception processing, subroutine calls and returns; however, W15 can be referenced by any instruction in the same manner as all other W registers. This simplifies reading, writing and manipulating the Stack Pointer (for example, creating stack frames). Note: The Software Stack Pointer always points to the first available free word and fills the software stack, working from lower toward higher addresses. Figure 4-9 illustrates how it pre-decrements for a stack pop (read) and post-increments for a stack push (writes). To protect against misaligned stack accesses, W15 is fixed to ‘0’ by the hardware. W15 is initialized to 0x1000 during all Resets. This address ensures that the SSP points to valid RAM in all dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices and permits stack availability for non-maskable trap exceptions. These can occur before the SSP is initialized by the user software. You can reprogram the SSP during initialization to any location within Data Space. DS70005258C-page 54 FIGURE 4-9: 0x0000 CALL STACK FRAME 15 0 CALL SUBR Stack Grows Toward Higher Address 4.5.2 PC W15 (before CALL) b‘000000000’ PC W15 (after CALL)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.6 Instruction Addressing Modes The addressing modes shown in Table 4-17 form the basis of the addressing modes optimized to support the specific features of individual instructions. The addressing modes provided in the MAC class of instructions differ from those in the other instruction types. 4.6.1 FILE REGISTER INSTRUCTIONS Most file register instructions use a 13-bit address field (f) to directly address data present in the first 8192 bytes of data memory (Near Data Space). Most file register instructions employ a Working register, W0, which is denoted as WREG in these instructions. The destination is typically either the same file register or WREG (with the exception of the MUL instruction), which writes the result to a register or register pair. The MOV instruction allows additional flexibility and can access the entire Data Space. TABLE 4-17: 4.6.2 MCU INSTRUCTIONS The three-operand MCU instructions are of the form: Operand 3 = Operand 1 Operand 2 where Operand 1 is always a Working register (that is, the addressing mode can only be Register Direct), which is referred to as Wb. Operand 2 can be a W register fetched from data memory or a 5-bit literal. The result location can either be a W register or a data memory location. The following addressing modes are supported by MCU instructions: • • • • • Register Direct Register Indirect Register Indirect Post-Modified Register Indirect Pre-Modified 5-Bit or 10-Bit Literal Note: Not all instructions support all the addressing modes given above. Individual instructions can support different subsets of these addressing modes. FUNDAMENTAL ADDRESSING MODES SUPPORTED Addressing Mode Description File Register Direct The address of the file register is specified explicitly. Register Direct The contents of a register are accessed directly. Register Indirect The contents of Wn form the Effective Address (EA). Register Indirect Post-Modified The contents of Wn form the EA. Wn is post-modified (incremented or decremented) by a constant value. Register Indirect Pre-Modified Wn is pre-modified (incremented or decremented) by a signed constant value to form the EA. Register Indirect with Register Offset The sum of Wn and Wb forms the EA. (Register Indexed) Register Indirect with Literal Offset  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. The sum of Wn and a literal forms the EA. DS70005258C-page 55 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.6.3 MOVE AND ACCUMULATOR INSTRUCTIONS Move instructions, and the DSP accumulator class of instructions, provide a greater degree of addressing flexibility than other instructions. In addition to the addressing modes supported by most MCU instructions, move and accumulator instructions also support Register Indirect with Register Offset Addressing mode, also referred to as Register Indexed mode. Note: For the MOV instructions, the addressing mode specified in the instruction can differ for the source and destination EA. However, the 4-bit Wb (Register Offset) field is shared by both source and destination (but typically only used by one). 4.6.4 The dual source operand DSP instructions (CLR, ED, EDAC, MAC, MPY, MPY.N, MOVSAC and MSC), also referred to as MAC instructions, use a simplified set of addressing modes to allow the user application to effectively manipulate the Data Pointers through register indirect tables. The two-source operand prefetch registers must be members of the set {W8, W9, W10, W11}. For data reads, W8 and W9 are always directed to the X RAGU, and W10 and W11 are always directed to the Y AGU. The Effective Addresses generated (before and after modification) must therefore, be valid addresses within X Data Space for W8 and W9, and Y Data Space for W10 and W11. Note: In summary, the following addressing modes are supported by move and accumulator instructions: • • • • • • • • Register Direct Register Indirect Register Indirect Post-modified Register Indirect Pre-modified Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed) Register Indirect with Literal Offset 8-Bit Literal 16-Bit Literal Note: Not all instructions support all the addressing modes given above. Individual instructions may support different subsets of these addressing modes. DS70005258C-page 56 MAC INSTRUCTIONS Register Indirect with Register Offset Addressing mode is available only for W9 (in X space) and W11 (in Y space). In summary, the following addressing modes are supported by the MAC class of instructions: • • • • • Register Indirect Register Indirect Post-Modified by 2 Register Indirect Post-Modified by 4 Register Indirect Post-Modified by 6 Register Indirect with Register Offset (Indexed) 4.6.5 OTHER INSTRUCTIONS Besides the addressing modes outlined previously, some instructions use literal constants of various sizes. For example, BRA (branch) instructions use 16-bit signed literals to specify the branch destination directly, whereas the DISI instruction uses a 14-bit unsigned literal field. In some instructions, such as ULNK, the source of an operand or result is implied by the opcode itself. Certain operations, such as a NOP, do not have any operands.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.7 Modulo Addressing 4.7.1 Modulo Addressing mode is a method of providing an automated means to support circular data buffers using hardware. The objective is to remove the need for software to perform data address boundary checks when executing tightly looped code, as is typical in many DSP algorithms. Modulo Addressing can operate in either Data or Program Space (since the Data Pointer mechanism is essentially the same for both). One circular buffer can be supported in each of the X (which also provides the pointers into Program Space) and Y Data Spaces. Modulo Addressing can operate on any W Register Pointer. However, it is not advisable to use W14 or W15 for Modulo Addressing since these two registers are used as the Stack Frame Pointer and Stack Pointer, respectively. In general, any particular circular buffer can be configured to operate in only one direction, as there are certain restrictions on the buffer start address (for incrementing buffers) or end address (for decrementing buffers), based upon the direction of the buffer. The only exception to the usage restrictions is for buffers that have a power-of-two length. As these buffers satisfy the start and end address criteria, they can operate in a Bidirectional mode (that is, address boundary checks are performed on both the lower and upper address boundaries). START AND END ADDRESS The Modulo Addressing scheme requires that a starting and ending address be specified and loaded into the 16-bit Modulo Buffer Address registers: XMODSRT, XMODEND, YMODSRT and YMODEND (see Table 4-2). Note: Y space Modulo Addressing EA calculations assume word-sized data (LSb of every EA is always clear). The length of a circular buffer is not directly specified. It is determined by the difference between the corresponding start and end addresses. The maximum possible length of the circular buffer is 32K words (64 Kbytes). 4.7.2 W ADDRESS REGISTER SELECTION The Modulo and Bit-Reversed Addressing Control register, MODCON, contains enable flags, as well as a W register field to specify the W Address registers. The XWM and YWM fields select the registers that operate with Modulo Addressing: • If XWM = 1111, X RAGU and X WAGU Modulo Addressing is disabled • If YWM = 1111, Y AGU Modulo Addressing is disabled The X Address Space Pointer W (XWM) register, to which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in MODCON (see Table 4-2). Modulo Addressing is enabled for X Data Space when XWM is set to any value other than ‘1111’ and the XMODEN bit is set (MODCON). The Y Address Space Pointer W (YWM) register, to which Modulo Addressing is to be applied, is stored in MODCON. Modulo Addressing is enabled for Y Data Space when YWM is set to any value other than ‘1111’ and the YMODEN bit (MODCON) is set. FIGURE 4-10: MODULO ADDRESSING OPERATION EXAMPLE Byte Address 0x1100 0x1163 Start Addr = 0x1100 End Addr = 0x1163 Length = 0x0032 words  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. MOV MOV MOV MOV MOV MOV #0x1100, W0 W0, XMODSRT #0x1163, W0 W0, MODEND #0x8001, W0 W0, MODCON MOV #0x0000, W0 ;W0 holds buffer fill value MOV #0x1110, W1 ;point W1 to buffer DO AGAIN, #0x31 MOV W0, [W1++] AGAIN: INC W0, W0 ;set modulo start address ;set modulo end address ;enable W1, X AGU for modulo ;fill the 50 buffer locations ;fill the next location ;increment the fill value DS70005258C-page 57 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.7.3 MODULO ADDRESSING APPLICABILITY Modulo Addressing can be applied to the Effective Address (EA) calculation associated with any W register. Address boundaries check for addresses equal to: • The upper boundary addresses for incrementing buffers • The lower boundary addresses for decrementing buffers It is important to realize that the address boundaries check for addresses less than or greater than the upper (for incrementing buffers) and lower (for decrementing buffers) boundary addresses (not just equal to). Address changes can therefore, jump beyond boundaries and still be adjusted correctly. Note: 4.8 The modulo corrected Effective Address is written back to the register only when Pre-Modify or Post-Modify Addressing mode is used to compute the Effective Address. When an address offset (such as [W7 + W2]) is used, Modulo Addressing correction is performed, but the contents of the register remain unchanged. Bit-Reversed Addressing Bit-Reversed Addressing mode is intended to simplify data reordering for radix-2 FFT algorithms. It is supported by the X AGU for data writes only. The modifier, which can be a constant value or register contents, is regarded as having its bit order reversed. The address source and destination are kept in normal order. Thus, the only operand requiring reversal is the modifier. 4.8.1 BIT-REVERSED ADDRESSING IMPLEMENTATION Bit-Reversed Addressing mode is enabled when all of these situations are met: • BWMx bits (W register selection) in the MODCON register are any value other than ‘1111’ (the stack cannot be accessed using Bit-Reversed Addressing) • The BREN bit is set in the XBREV register • The addressing mode used is Register Indirect with Pre-Increment or Post-Increment If the length of a bit-reversed buffer is M = 2N bytes, the last ‘N’ bits of the data buffer start address must be zeros. XB is the Bit-Reversed Addressing modifier, or ‘pivot point’, which is typically a constant. In the case of an FFT computation, its value is equal to half of the FFT data buffer size. Note: All bit-reversed EA calculations assume word-sized data (LSb of every EA is always clear). The XB value is scaled accordingly to generate compatible (byte) addresses. When enabled, Bit-Reversed Addressing is executed only for Register Indirect with Pre-Increment or PostIncrement Addressing and word-sized data writes. It does not function for any other addressing mode or for byte-sized data and normal addresses are generated instead. When Bit-Reversed Addressing is active, the W Address Pointer is always added to the address modifier (XB) and the offset associated with the Register Indirect Addressing mode is ignored. In addition, as word-sized data is a requirement, the LSb of the EA is ignored (and always clear). Note: Modulo Addressing and Bit-Reversed Addressing can be enabled simultaneously using the same W register, but BitReversed Addressing operation will always take precedence for data writes when enabled. If Bit-Reversed Addressing has already been enabled by setting the BREN (XBREV) bit, a write to the XBREV register should not be immediately followed by an indirect read operation using the W register that has been designated as the Bit-Reversed Pointer. DS70005258C-page 58  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 4-11: BIT-REVERSED ADDRESSING EXAMPLE Sequential Address b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 0 Bit Locations Swapped Left-to-Right Around Center of Binary Value b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b1 b2 b3 b4 0 Bit-Reversed Address Pivot Point TABLE 4-18: XB = 0x0008 for a 16-Word Bit-Reversed Buffer BIT-REVERSED ADDRESSING SEQUENCE (16-ENTRY) Normal Address Bit-Reversed Address A3 A2 A1 A0 Decimal A3 A2 A1 A0 Decimal 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 8 0 0 1 0 2 0 1 0 0 4 0 0 1 1 3 1 1 0 0 12 0 1 0 0 4 0 0 1 0 2 0 1 0 1 5 1 0 1 0 10 0 1 1 0 6 0 1 1 0 6 0 1 1 1 7 1 1 1 0 14 1 0 0 0 8 0 0 0 1 1 1 0 0 1 9 1 0 0 1 9 1 0 1 0 10 0 1 0 1 5 1 0 1 1 11 1 1 0 1 13 1 1 0 0 12 0 0 1 1 3 1 1 0 1 13 1 0 1 1 11 1 1 1 0 14 0 1 1 1 7 1 1 1 1 15 1 1 1 1 15  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 59 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.9 Interfacing Program and Data Memory Spaces Table instructions allow an application to read or write to small areas of the program memory. This capability makes the method ideal for accessing data tables that need to be updated periodically. It also allows access to all bytes of the program word. The remapping method allows an application to access a large block of data on a read-only basis, which is ideal for look-ups from a large table of static data. The application can only access the least significant word of the program word. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family architecture uses a 24-bit wide Program Space (PS) and a 16-bit wide Data Space (DS). The architecture is also a modified Harvard scheme, meaning that data can also be present in the Program Space. To use this data successfully, it must be accessed in a way that preserves the alignment of information in both spaces. Aside from normal execution, the architecture of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices provides two methods by which Program Space can be accessed during operation: • Using table instructions to access individual bytes or words anywhere in the Program Space • Remapping a portion of the Program Space into the Data Space (Program Space Visibility) TABLE 4-19: PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS CONSTRUCTION Program Space Address Access Space Access Type Instruction Access (Code Execution) User TBLRD/TBLWT (Byte/Word Read/Write) User TBLPAG Configuration TBLPAG 0 0xxx xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx xxx0 0xxx xxxx Data EA xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx 1xxx xxxx FIGURE 4-12: PC 0 Data EA xxxx xxxx xxxx xxxx DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM SPACE ADDRESS GENERATION Program Counter(1) Program Counter 0 0 23 Bits EA Table Operations(2) 1/0 TBLPAG 1/0 8 Bits 16 Bits 24 Bits User/Configuration Space Select Note 1: 2: Byte Select The Least Significant bit (LSb) of Program Space addresses is always fixed as ‘0’ to maintain word alignment of data in the Program and Data Spaces. Table operations are not required to be word-aligned. Table Read operations are permitted in the configuration memory space. DS70005258C-page 60  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 4.9.1 DATA ACCESS FROM PROGRAM MEMORY USING TABLE INSTRUCTIONS The TBLRDL and TBLWTL instructions offer a direct method of reading or writing the lower word of any address within the Program Space without going through Data Space. The TBLRDH and TBLWTH instructions are the only method to read or write the upper eight bits of a Program Space word as data. The PC is incremented by two for each successive 24-bit program word. This allows program memory addresses to directly map to Data Space addresses. Program memory can thus be regarded as two 16-bit wide word address spaces, residing side by side, each with the same address range. TBLRDL and TBLWTL access the space that contains the least significant data word. TBLRDH and TBLWTH access the space that contains the upper data byte. Two table instructions are provided to move byte or word-sized (16-bit) data to and from Program Space. Both function as either byte or word operations. • TBLRDL (Table Read Low): - In Word mode, this instruction maps the lower word of the Program Space location (P) to a data address (D) - In Byte mode, either the upper or lower byte of the lower program word is mapped to the lower byte of a data address. The upper byte is selected when Byte Select is ‘1’; the lower byte is selected when it is ‘0’. FIGURE 4-13: • TBLRDH (Table Read High): - In Word mode, this instruction maps the entire upper word of a program address (P) to a data address. The ‘phantom’ byte (D) is always ‘0’. - In Byte mode, this instruction maps the upper or lower byte of the program word to D of the data address in the TBLRDL instruction. The data is always ‘0’ when the upper ‘phantom’ byte is selected (Byte Select = 1). In a similar fashion, two table instructions, TBLWTH and TBLWTL, are used to write individual bytes or words to a Program Space address. The details of their operation are explained in Section 5.0 “Flash Program Memory”. For all table operations, the area of program memory space to be accessed is determined by the Table Page register (TBLPAG). TBLPAG covers the entire program memory space of the device, including user application and configuration spaces. When TBLPAG = 0, the table page is located in the user memory space. When TBLPAG = 1, the page is located in configuration space. ACCESSING PROGRAM MEMORY WITH TABLE INSTRUCTIONS Program Space TBLPAG 02 23 15 0 0x000000 23 16 8 0 00000000 0x020000 0x030000 00000000 00000000 00000000 ‘Phantom’ Byte TBLRDH.B (Wn = 0) TBLRDL.B (Wn = 1) TBLRDL.B (Wn = 0) TBLRDL.W 0x800000  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. The address for the table operation is determined by the data EA within the page defined by the TBLPAG register. Only read operations are shown; write operations are also valid in the user memory area. DS70005258C-page 61 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 62  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 5.0 FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices and then program the device just before shipping the product. This also allows the most recent firmware or a custom firmware to be programmed. Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Dual Partition Flash Program Memory” (DS70005156) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com) Enhanced In-Circuit Serial Programming uses an on-board bootloader, known as the Program Executive, to manage the programming process. Using an SPI data frame format, the Program Executive can erase, program and verify program memory. For more information on Enhanced ICSP, see the device programming specification. RTSP is accomplished using TBLRD (Table Read) and TBLWT (Table Write) instructions. With RTSP, the user application can write program memory data with a single program memory word and erase program memory in blocks or ‘pages’ of 512 instructions (1536 bytes) at a time. 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. 5.1 The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices contain internal Program Flash Memory for storing and executing application code. The memory is readable, writable and erasable during normal operation over the entire VDD range. Regardless of the method used, all programming of Flash memory is done with the Table Read and Table Write instructions. These instructions allow direct read and write access to the program memory space, from the data memory, while the device is in normal operating mode. The 24-bit target address in the program memory is formed using bits of the TBLPAG register and the Effective Address (EA) from a W register, specified in the table instruction, as shown in Figure 5-1. The TBLRDL and the TBLWTL instructions are used to read or write to bits of program memory. TBLRDL and TBLWTL can access program memory in both Word and Byte modes. The TBLRDH and TBLWTH instructions are used to read or write to bits of program memory. TBLRDH and TBLWTH can also access program memory in Word or Byte mode. Flash memory can be programmed in three ways: • In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) programming capability • Enhanced In-Circuit Serial Programming (Enhanced ICSP) • Run-Time Self-Programming (RTSP) ICSP allows for a dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family device to be serially programmed while in the end application circuit. This is done with a programming clock and programming data (PGECx/PGEDx) line, and three other lines for power (VDD), ground (VSS) and Master Clear (MCLR). This allows customers to FIGURE 5-1: Table Instructions and Flash Programming ADDRESSING FOR TABLE REGISTERS 24 Bits Using Program Counter Program Counter 0 0 Working Reg EA Using Table Instruction 1/0 TBLPAG Reg 8 Bits User/Configuration Space Select  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 16 Bits 24-Bit EA Byte Select DS70005258C-page 63 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family Flash program memory array is organized into rows of 64 instructions or 192 bytes. RTSP allows the user application to erase a single page (8 rows or 512 instructions) of memory at a time and to program one row at a time. It is possible to program two instructions at a time as well. The page erase and single row write blocks are edge-aligned, from the beginning of program memory, on boundaries of 1536 bytes and 192 bytes, respectively. Figure 30-14 in Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics” lists the typical erase and programming times. Row programming is performed by loading 192 bytes into data memory and then loading the address of the first byte in that row into the NVMSRCADR register. Once the write has been initiated, the device will automatically load the write latches and increment the NVMSRCADR and the NVMADR(U) registers until all bytes have been programmed. The RPDF bit (NVMCON) selects the format of the stored data in RAM to be either compressed or uncompressed. See Figure 5-2 for data formatting. Compressed data helps to reduce the amount of required RAM by using the upper byte of the second word for the MSB of the second instruction. The basic sequence for RTSP word programming is to use the TBLWTL and TBLWTH instructions to load two of the 24-bit instructions into the write latches found in configuration memory space. Refer to Figure 4-1 through Figure 4-4 for write latch addresses. Programming is performed by unlocking and setting the control bits in the NVMCON register. All erase and program operations may optionally use the NVM interrupt to signal the successful completion of the operation. For example, when performing Flash write operations on the Inactive Partition in Dual Partition mode, where the CPU remains running, it is necessary to wait for the NVM interrupt before programming the next block of Flash program memory. DS70005258C-page 64 FIGURE 5-2: UNCOMPRESSED/ COMPRESSED FORMAT 15 0 7 LSW1 Increasing Address RTSP Operation 0x00 Even Byte Address MSB1 LSW2 0x00 MSB2 UNCOMPRESSED FORMAT (RPDF = 0) 15 Increasing Address 5.2 0 7 LSW1 MSB2 Even Byte Address MSB1 LSW2 COMPRESSED FORMAT (RPDF = 1) 5.3 Programming Operations A complete programming sequence is necessary for programming or erasing the internal Flash in RTSP mode. The processor stalls (waits) until the programming operation is finished. Setting the WR bit (NVMCON) starts the operation and the WR bit is automatically cleared when the operation is finished. 5.3.1 PROGRAMMING ALGORITHM FOR FLASH PROGRAM MEMORY Programmers can program two adjacent words (24 bits x 2) of Program Flash Memory at a time on every other word address boundary (0x000000, 0x000004, 0x000008, etc.). To do this, it is necessary to erase the page that contains the desired address of the location the user wants to change. For protection against accidental operations, the write initiate sequence for NVMKEY must be used to allow any erase or program operation to proceed. After the programming command has been executed, the user application must wait for the programming time until programming is complete. The two instructions following the start of the programming sequence should be NOPs.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 5.4 Dual Partition Flash Configuration For dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices operating in Dual Partition Flash Program Memory modes, the Inactive Partition can be erased and programmed without stalling the processor. The same programming algorithms are used for programming and erasing the Flash in the Inactive Partition, as described in Section 5.2 “RTSP Operation”. On top of the page erase option, the entire Flash memory of the Inactive Partition can be erased by configuring the NVMOP bits in the NVMCON register. Note 1: The application software to be loaded into the Inactive Partition will have the address of the Active Partition. The bootloader firmware will need to offset the address by 0x400000 in order to write to the Inactive Partition. 5.4.1 FLASH PARTITION SWAPPING The Boot Sequence Number is used for determining the Active Partition at start-up and is encoded within the FBTSEQ Configuration register bits. Unlike most Configuration registers, which only utilize the lower 16 bits of the program memory, FBTSEQ is a 24-bit Configuration Word. The Boot Sequence Number (BSEQ) is a 12-bit value and is stored in FBTSEQ twice. The true value is stored in bits, FBTSEQ, and its complement is stored in bits, FBTSEQ. At device Reset, the sequence numbers are read and the partition with the lowest sequence number becomes the Active Partition. If one of the Boot Sequence Numbers is invalid, the device will select the partition with the valid Boot Sequence Number, or default to Partition 1 if both sequence numbers are invalid. See Section 27.0 “Special Features” for more information. The BOOTSWP instruction provides an alternative means of swapping the Active and Inactive Partitions (soft swap) without the need for a device Reset. The BOOTSWP must always be followed by a GOTO instruction. The BOOTSWP instruction swaps the Active and Inactive Partitions, and the PC vectors to the location specified by the GOTO instruction in the newly Active Partition. It is important to note that interrupts should temporarily be disabled while performing the soft swap sequence and that after the partition swap, all peripherals and interrupts which were enabled remain enabled. Additionally, the RAM and stack will maintain state after the switch. As a result, it is recommended that applications using soft swaps jump to a routine that will reinitialize the device in order to ensure the firmware runs as expected. The Configuration registers will have no effect during a soft swap.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. For robustness of operation, in order to execute the BOOTSWP instruction, it is necessary to execute the NVM unlocking sequence as follows: 1. 2. 3. Write 0x55 to NVMKEY. Write 0xAA to NVMKEY. Execute the BOOTSWP instruction. If the unlocking sequence is not performed, the BOOTSWP instruction will be executed as a forced NOP and a GOTO instruction, following the BOOTSWP instruction, will be executed, causing the PC to jump to that location in the current operating partition. The SFTSWP and P2ACTIV bits in the NVMCON register are used to determine a successful swap of the Active and Inactive Partitions, as well as which partition is active. After the BOOTSWP and GOTO instructions, the SFTSWP bit should be polled to verify the partition swap has occurred and then cleared for the next panel swap event. 5.4.2 DUAL PARTITION MODES While operating in Dual Partition mode, the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices have the option for both partitions to have their own defined security segments, as shown in Figure 27-4. Alternatively, the device can operate in Protected Dual Partition mode, where Partition 1 becomes permanently erase/ write-protected. Protected Dual Partition mode allows for a “Factory Default” mode, which provides a fail-safe backup image to be stored in Partition 1. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices can also operate in Privileged Dual Partition mode, where additional security protections are implemented to allow for protection of intellectual property when multiple parties have software within the device. In Privileged Dual Partition mode, both partitions place additional restrictions on the FBSLIM register. These prevent changes to the size of the Boot Segment and General Segment, ensuring that neither segment will be altered. 5.5 Flash Memory Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 5.5.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Dual Partition Flash Program Memory” (DS70005156) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools DS70005258C-page 65 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 5.6 Control Registers Five SFRs are used to write and erase the Program Flash Memory: NVMCON, NVMKEY, NVMADR, NVMADRU and NVMSRCADR/H. The NVMCON register (Register 5-1) selects the operation to be performed (page erase, word/row program, Inactive Partition erase), initiates the program or erase cycle and is used to determine the Active Partition in Dual Partition modes. NVMKEY (Register 5-4) is a write-only register that is used for write protection. To start a programming or erase sequence, the user application must consecutively write 0x55 and 0xAA to the NVMKEY register. DS70005258C-page 66 There are two NVM Address registers: NVMADRU and NVMADR. These two registers, when concatenated, form the 24-bit Effective Address (EA) of the selected word/row for programming operations, or the selected page for erase operations. The NVMADRU register is used to hold the upper eight bits of the EA, while the NVMADR register is used to hold the lower 16 bits of the EA. For row programming operation, data to be written to Program Flash Memory is written into data memory space (RAM) at an address defined by the NVMSRCADR register (location of first element in row programming data).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 5-1: R/SO-0(1) NVMCON: NONVOLATILE MEMORY (NVM) CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0(1) WR WREN R/W-0(1) R/W-0 WRERR NVMSIDL(2) R/C-0 R-0 (6) SFTSWP (6) P2ACTIV R/W-0 R/C-0 RPDF URERR bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — U-0 — U-0 — R/W-0(1) (3,4) NVMOP3 R/W-0(1) NVMOP2 (3,4) R/W-0(1) NVMOP1 (3,4) R/W-0(1) NVMOP0(3,4) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit SO = Settable Only bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 WR: Write Control bit(1) 1 = Initiates a Flash Memory Program or erase operation; the operation is self-timed and the bit is cleared by hardware once the operation is complete 0 = Program or erase operation is complete and inactive bit 14 WREN: Write Enable bit(1) 1 = Enables Flash program/erase operations 0 = Inhibits Flash program/erase operations bit 13 WRERR: Write Sequence Error Flag bit(1) 1 = An improper program or erase sequence attempt, or termination has occurred (bit is set automatically on any set attempt of the WR bit) 0 = The program or erase operation completed normally bit 12 NVMSIDL: NVM Stop in Idle Control bit(2) 1 = Flash voltage regulator goes into Standby mode during Idle mode 0 = Flash voltage regulator is active during Idle mode bit 11 SFTSWP: Partition Soft Swap Status bit(6) 1 = Partitions have been successfully swapped using the BOOTSWP instruction (soft swap) 0 = Awaiting successful partition swap using the BOOTSWP instruction or a device Reset will determine the Active Partition based on the FBTSEQ register bit 10 P2ACTIV: Partition 2 Active Status bit(6) 1 = Partition 2 Flash is mapped into the active region 0 = Partition 1 Flash is mapped into the active region bit 9 RPDF: Row Programming Data Format bit 1 = Row data to be stored in RAM is in compressed format 0 = Row data to be stored in RAM is in uncompressed format Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: 7: These bits can only be reset on a POR. If this bit is set, power consumption will be further reduced (IIDLE) and upon exiting Idle mode, there is a delay (TVREG) before Flash memory becomes operational. All other combinations of NVMOP are unimplemented. Execution of the PWRSAV instruction is ignored while any of the NVM operations are in progress. Two adjacent words on a 4-word boundary are programmed during execution of this operation. Only applicable when operating in Dual Partition mode. The specific Boot mode depends on bits of the programmed data: 11 = Single Partition Flash mode 10 = Dual Partition Flash mode 01 = Protected Dual Partition Flash mode 00 = Reserved  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 67 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 5-1: NVMCON: NONVOLATILE MEMORY (NVM) CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 8 URERR: Row Programming Data Underrun Error bit 1 = Indicates row programming operation has been terminated 0 = No data underrun error is detected bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 NVMOP: NVM Operation Select bits(1,3,4) 1111 = Reserved 1110 = User memory bulk erase operation 1011 = Reserved 1010 = Reserved 1001 = Reserved 1000 = Boot memory double-word program operation in a Dual Partition Flash mode(7) 0101 = Reserved 0100 = Inactive Partition memory erase operation 0011 = Memory page erase operation 0010 = Memory row program operation 0001 = Memory double-word program operation(5) 0000 = Reserved Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: 7: These bits can only be reset on a POR. If this bit is set, power consumption will be further reduced (IIDLE) and upon exiting Idle mode, there is a delay (TVREG) before Flash memory becomes operational. All other combinations of NVMOP are unimplemented. Execution of the PWRSAV instruction is ignored while any of the NVM operations are in progress. Two adjacent words on a 4-word boundary are programmed during execution of this operation. Only applicable when operating in Dual Partition mode. The specific Boot mode depends on bits of the programmed data: 11 = Single Partition Flash mode 10 = Dual Partition Flash mode 01 = Protected Dual Partition Flash mode 00 = Reserved DS70005258C-page 68  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 5-2: R/W-x NVMADR: NONVOLATILE MEMORY LOWER ADDRESS REGISTER R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x NVMADR bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x NVMADR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown NVMADR: Nonvolatile Memory Lower Write Address bits Selects the lower 16 bits of the location to program or erase in Program Flash Memory. This register may be read or written to by the user application. REGISTER 5-3: NVMADRU: NONVOLATILE MEMORY UPPER ADDRESS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x NVMADRU bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 NVMADRU: Nonvolatile Memory Upper Write Address bits Selects the upper eight bits of the location to program or erase in Program Flash Memory. This register may be read or written to by the user application.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 69 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 5-4: NVMKEY: NONVOLATILE MEMORY KEY REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 W-0 W-0 W-0 W-0 W-0 W-0 W-0 W-0 NVMKEY bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 NVMKEY: NVM Key Register bits (write-only) REGISTER 5-5: R/W-0 x = Bit is unknown NVMSRCADR: NVM SOURCE DATA ADDRESS REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 NVMSRCADR R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 NVMSRCADR R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit -n = Value at POR bit 15-0 W = Writable bit ‘1’ = Bit is set U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown NVMSRCADR: NVM Source Data Address bits The RAM address of the data to be programmed into Flash when the NVMOP bits are set to row programming. DS70005258C-page 70  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 6.0 RESETS A simplified block diagram of the Reset module is shown in Figure 6-1. Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Reset” (DS70602) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com) 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The Reset module combines all Reset sources and controls the device Master Reset Signal, SYSRST. The following is a list of device Reset sources: • • • • • • • • POR: Power-on Reset BOR: Brown-out Reset MCLR: Master Clear Pin Reset SWR: RESET Instruction WDTO: Watchdog Timer Time-out Reset CM: Configuration Mismatch Reset TRAPR: Trap Conflict Reset IOPUWR: Illegal Condition Device Reset - Illegal Opcode Reset - Uninitialized W Register Reset - Security Reset FIGURE 6-1: Any active source of Reset will make the SYSRST signal active. On system Reset, some of the registers associated with the CPU and peripherals are forced to a known Reset state, and some are unaffected. Note: Refer to the specific peripheral section or Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” of this data sheet for register Reset states. All types of device Reset set a corresponding status bit in the RCON register to indicate the type of Reset (see Register 6-1). A POR clears all the bits, except for the BOR and POR bits (RCON) that are set. The user application can set or clear any bit, at any time, during code execution. The RCON bits only serve as status bits. Setting a particular Reset status bit in software does not cause a device Reset to occur. The RCON register also has other bits associated with the Watchdog Timer and device power-saving states. The function of these bits is discussed in other sections of this manual. Note: The status bits in the RCON register should be cleared after they are read so that the next RCON register value after a device Reset is meaningful. For all Resets, the default clock source is determined by the FNOSC bits in the FOSCSEL Configuration register. The value of the FNOSCx bits is loaded into the NOSC (OSCCON) bits on Reset, which in turn, initializes the system clock. RESET SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM RESET Instruction Glitch Filter MCLR WDT Module Sleep or Idle VDD BOR Internal Regulator SYSRST VDD Rise Detect POR Trap Conflict Illegal Opcode Uninitialized W Register Security Reset Configuration Mismatch  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 71 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 6.1 Reset Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. DS70005258C-page 72 6.1.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Reset” (DS70602) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER(1) REGISTER 6-1: R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRAPR IOPUWR — — VREGSF — CM VREGS bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 EXTR SWR R/W-0 (2) SWDTEN R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 WDTO SLEEP IDLE BOR POR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 TRAPR: Trap Reset Flag bit 1 = A Trap Conflict Reset has occurred 0 = A Trap Conflict Reset has not occurred bit 14 IOPUWR: Illegal Opcode or Uninitialized W Register Access Reset Flag bit 1 = An illegal opcode detection, an illegal address mode or Uninitialized W register used as an Address Pointer caused a Reset 0 = An illegal opcode or Uninitialized W register Reset has not occurred bit 13-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 VREGSF: Flash Voltage Regulator Standby During Sleep bit 1 = Flash voltage regulator is active during Sleep 0 = Flash voltage regulator goes into Standby mode during Sleep bit 10 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 9 CM: Configuration Mismatch Flag bit 1 = A Configuration Mismatch Reset has occurred 0 = A Configuration Mismatch Reset has not occurred bit 8 VREGS: Voltage Regulator Standby During Sleep bit 1 = Voltage regulator is active during Sleep 0 = Voltage regulator goes into Standby mode during Sleep bit 7 EXTR: External Reset (MCLR) Pin bit 1 = A Master Clear (pin) Reset has occurred 0 = A Master Clear (pin) Reset has not occurred bit 6 SWR: Software RESET (Instruction) Flag bit 1 = A RESET instruction has been executed 0 = A RESET instruction has not been executed bit 5 SWDTEN: Software Enable/Disable of WDT bit(2) 1 = WDT is enabled 0 = WDT is disabled bit 4 WDTO: Watchdog Timer Time-out Flag bit 1 = WDT time-out has occurred 0 = WDT time-out has not occurred Note 1: 2: All of the Reset status bits can be set or cleared in software. Setting one of these bits in software does not cause a device Reset. If the WDTEN Configuration bits are ‘11’ (unprogrammed), the WDT is always enabled, regardless of the SWDTEN bit setting.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 73 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 6-1: RCON: RESET CONTROL REGISTER(1) (CONTINUED) bit 3 SLEEP: Wake-up from Sleep Flag bit 1 = Device has been in Sleep mode 0 = Device has not been in Sleep mode bit 2 IDLE: Wake-up from Idle Flag bit 1 = Device has been in Idle mode 0 = Device has not been in Idle mode bit 1 BOR: Brown-out Reset Flag bit 1 = A Brown-out Reset has occurred 0 = A Brown-out Reset has not occurred bit 0 POR: Power-on Reset Flag bit 1 = A Power-on Reset has occurred 0 = A Power-on Reset has not occurred Note 1: 2: All of the Reset status bits can be set or cleared in software. Setting one of these bits in software does not cause a device Reset. If the WDTEN Configuration bits are ‘11’ (unprogrammed), the WDT is always enabled, regardless of the SWDTEN bit setting. DS70005258C-page 74  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 7.0 INTERRUPT CONTROLLER Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Interrupts” (DS70000600) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. 7.1.1 The Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT), shown in Figure 7-2, is available only when the Boot Segment is defined and the AIVT has been enabled. To enable the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table, the Configuration bit, AIVTDIS in the FSEC register, must be programmed and the AIVTEN bit must be set (INTCON2 = 1). When the AIVT is enabled, all interrupt and exception processes use the alternate vectors instead of the default vectors. The AIVT begins at the start of the last page of the Boot Segment, defined by BSLIM. The second half of the page is no longer usable space. The Boot Segment must be at least two pages to enable the AIVT. Note: The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family interrupt controller reduces the numerous peripheral interrupt request signals to a single interrupt request signal to the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family CPU. The interrupt controller has the following features: • Six Processor Exceptions and Software Traps • Seven User-Selectable Priority Levels • Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) with a Unique Vector for each Interrupt or Exception Source • Fixed Priority within a Specified User Priority Level • Fixed Interrupt Entry and Return Latencies • Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT) for Debug Support 7.1 Interrupt Vector Table The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family Interrupt Vector Table (IVT), shown in Figure 7-1, resides in program memory, starting at location, 000004h. The IVT contains six non-maskable trap vectors and up to 246 sources of interrupts. In general, each interrupt source has its own vector. Each interrupt vector contains a 24-bit wide address. The value programmed into each interrupt vector location is the starting address of the associated Interrupt Service Routine (ISR). ALTERNATE INTERRUPT VECTOR TABLE Although the Boot Segment must be enabled in order to enable the AIVT, application code does not need to be present inside of the Boot Segment. The AIVT (and IVT) will inherit the Boot Segment code protection. The AIVT supports debugging by providing a means to switch between an application and a support environment without requiring the interrupt vectors to be reprogrammed. This feature also enables switching between applications for evaluation of different software algorithms at run time. 7.2 Reset Sequence A device Reset is not a true exception because the interrupt controller is not involved in the Reset process. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices clear their registers in response to a Reset, which forces the PC to zero. The device then begins program execution at location, 0x000000. A GOTO instruction at the Reset address can redirect program execution to the appropriate start-up routine. Note: Any unimplemented or unused vector locations in the IVT should be programmed with the address of a default interrupt handler routine that contains a RESET instruction. Interrupt vectors are prioritized in terms of their natural priority. This priority is linked to their position in the vector table. Lower addresses generally have a higher natural priority. For example, the interrupt associated with Vector 0 takes priority over interrupts at any other vector address.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 75 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY INTERRUPT VECTOR TABLE IVT Decreasing Natural Order Priority FIGURE 7-1: Note: Reset – GOTO Instruction Reset – GOTO Address Oscillator Fail Trap Vector Address Error Trap Vector Generic Hard Trap Vector Stack Error Trap Vector Math Error Trap Vector Reserved Generic Soft Trap Vector Reserved Interrupt Vector 0 Interrupt Vector 1 : : : Interrupt Vector 52 Interrupt Vector 53 Interrupt Vector 54 : : : Interrupt Vector 116 Interrupt Vector 117 Interrupt Vector 118 Interrupt Vector 119 Interrupt Vector 120 : : : Interrupt Vector 244 Interrupt Vector 245 START OF CODE 0x000000 0x000002 0x000004 0x000006 0x000008 0x00000A 0x00000C 0x00000E 0x000010 0x000012 0x000014 0x000016 : : : 0x00007C 0x00007E 0x000080 : : : 0x0000FC 0x0000FE 0x000100 0x000102 0x000104 : : : 0x0001FC 0x0001FE 0x000200 See Table 7-1 for Interrupt Vector Details In Dual Partition Flash modes, each partition has a dedicated Interrupt Vector Table. DS70005258C-page 76  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY AIVT Decreasing Natural Order Priority FIGURE 7-2: Note 1: 2: dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X ALTERNATE INTERRUPT VECTOR TABLE(2) Reserved Reserved Oscillator Fail Trap Vector Address Error Trap Vector Generic Hard Trap Vector Stack Error Trap Vector Math Error Trap Vector Reserved Generic Soft Trap Vector Reserved Interrupt Vector 0 Interrupt Vector 1 : : : Interrupt Vector 52 Interrupt Vector 53 Interrupt Vector 54 : : : Interrupt Vector 116 Interrupt Vector 117 Interrupt Vector 118 Interrupt Vector 119 Interrupt Vector 120 : : : Interrupt Vector 244 Interrupt Vector 245 BSLIM(1) + 0x000000 BSLIM(1) + 0x000002 BSLIM(1) + 0x000004 BSLIM(1) + 0x000006 BSLIM(1) + 0x000008 BSLIM(1) + 0x00000A BSLIM(1) + 0x00000C BSLIM(1) + 0x00000E BSLIM(1) + 0x000010 BSLIM(1) + 0x000012 BSLIM(1) + 0x000014 BSLIM(1) + 0x000016 : : : BSLIM(1) + 0x00007C BSLIM(1) + 0x00007E BSLIM(1) + 0x000080 : : : BSLIM(1) + 0x0000FC BSLIM(1) + 0x0000FE BSLIM(1) + 0x000100 BSLIM(1) + 0x000102 BSLIM(1) + 0x000104 : : : BSLIM(1) + 0x0001FC BSLIM(1) + 0x0001FE See Table 7-1 for Interrupt Vector Details The address depends on the size of the Boot Segment defined by BSLIM. [(BSLIM – 1) x 0x400] + Offset. In Dual Partition Flash modes, each partition has a dedicated Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (if enabled).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 77 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 7-1: INTERRUPT VECTOR DETAILS Interrupt Source Vector # IRQ # IVT Address Interrupt Bit Location Flag Enable Priority Highest Natural Order Priority INT0 – External Interrupt 0 8 0 0x000014 IFS0 INT0IF IEC0 INT0IE IPC0 INT0IP IC1 – Input Capture 1 9 1 0x000016 IFS0 IC1IF IEC0 IC1IE IPC0 IC1IP OC1 – Output Compare 1 10 2 0x000018 IFS0 OC1IF IEC0 OC1IE IPC0 OC1IP T1 – Timer1 11 3 0x00001A IFS0 T1IF IEC0 T1IE IPC0 T1IP DMA0 – DMA Channel 0 12 4 0x00001C IFS0 DMA0IF IEC0 DMA0IE IPC1 DMA0IP IC2 – Input Capture 2 13 5 0x00001E IFS0 IC2IF IEC0 IC2IE IPC1 IC2IP OC2 – Output Compare 2 14 6 0x000020 IFS0 OC2IF IEC0 OC2IE IPC1 OC2IP T2 – Timer2 15 7 0x000022 IFS0 T2IF IEC0 T2IE IPC1 T2IP T3 – Timer3 16 8 0x000024 IFS0 T3IF IEC0 T3IE IPC2 T3IP SPI1TX – SPI1 Transfer Done 17 9 0x000026 IFS0 SPI1TXIF IEC0 SPI1TXIE IPC2 SPI1TXIP SPI1RX – SPI1 Receive Done 18 10 0x000028 IFS0 SPI1RXIF IEC0 SPI1RXIE IPC2 SPI1RXIP U1RX – UART1 Receiver 19 11 0x00002A IFS0 U1RXIF IEC0 U1RXIE IPC2 U1RXIP U1TX – UART1 Transmitter 20 12 0x00002C IFS0 U1TXIF IEC0 U1TXIE IPC3 U1TXIP ADC – ADC Global Convert Done 21 13 0x00002E IFS0 ADCIF IEC0 ADCIE IPC3 ADCIP DMA1 – DMA Channel 1 22 14 0x000030 IFS0 DMA1IF IEC0 DMA1IE IPC3 DMA1IP NVM – NVM Write Complete 23 15 0x000032 IFS0 NVMIF IEC0 NVMIE IPC3 NVMIP SI2C1 – I2C1 Slave Event 24 16 0x000034 IFS1 SI2C1IF IEC1 SI2C1IE IPC4 SI2C1IP MI2C1 – I2C1 Master Event 25 17 0x000036 IFS1 MI2C1IF IEC1 MI2C1IE IPC4 MI2C1IP AC1 – Analog Comparator 1 Interrupt 26 18 0x000038 IFS1 AC1IF IEC1 AC1IE IPC4 AC1IP CN – Input Change Interrupt 27 19 0x00003A IFS1 CNIF IEC1 CNIE IPC4 CNIP INT1 – External Interrupt 1 28 20 0x00003C IFS1 INT1IF IEC1 INT1IE IPC5 INT1IP Reserved 29-31 21-23 0x00003E-0x000043 — — — DMA2 – DMA Channel 2 32 24 0x00044 IFS1 DMA2IF IEC1 DMA2IE IPC6 DMA2IP OC3 – Output Compare 3 33 25 0x000046 IFS1 OC3IF IEC1 OC3IE IPC6 OC3IP OC4 – Output Compare 4 34 26 0x000048 IFS1 OC4IF IEC1 OC4IE IPC6 OC4IP DS70005258C-page 78  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 7-1: INTERRUPT VECTOR DETAILS (CONTINUED) Vector # IRQ # IVT Address T4 – Timer4 35 27 T5 – Timer5 36 INT2 – External Interrupt 2 Interrupt Source Interrupt Bit Location Flag Enable Priority 0x00004A IFS1 T4IF IEC1 T4IE IPC6 T4IP 28 0x00004C IFS1 T5IF IEC1 T5IE IPC7 T5IP 37 29 0x00004E IFS1 INT2IF IEC1 INT2IE IPC7 INT2IP U2RX – UART2 Receiver 38 30 0x000050 IFS1 U2RXIF IEC1 U2RXIE IPC7 U2RXIP U2TX – UART2 Transmitter 39 31 0x000052 IFS1 U2TXIF IEC1 U2TXIE IPC7 U2TXIP SPI2TX – SPI2 Transfer Done 40 32 0x000054 IFS2 SPI2TXIF IEC2 SPI2TXIE IPC8 SPI2TXIP SPI2RX – SPI2 Receive Done 41 33 0x000056 IFS2 SPI2RXIF IEC2 SPI2RXIE IPC8 SPI2RXIP C1RX – CAN1 RX Data Ready 42 34 0x000058 IFS2 C1RXIF IEC2 C1RXIE IPC8 C1RXIP C1 – CAN1 Combined Error 43 35 0x000059 IFS2 C1IF IEC2 C1IE IPC8 C1IP DMA3 – DMA Channel 3 44 36 0x00005A IFS2 DMA3IF IEC2 DMA3IE IPC9 DMA3IP IC3 – Input Capture 3 45 37 0x00005E IFS2 IC3IF IEC2 IC3IE IPC9 IC3IP IC4 – Input Capture 4 46 38 0x000060 IFS2 IC4IF IEC2 IC4IE IPC9 IC4IP 47-56 39-48 0x000062-0x000074 — — — SI2C2 – I2C2 Slave Event Reserved 57 49 0x000076 IFS3 SI2C2IF IEC3 SI2C2IE IPC12 SI2C2IP MI2C2 – I2C2 Master Event 58 50 0x000078 IFS3 MI2C2IF IEC3 MI2C2IE IPC12 MI2C2IP 59-61 51-53 0x00007A-0x00007E — — — INT4 – External Interrupt 4 Reserved 62 54 0x000080 IFS3 INT4IF IEC3 INT4IE IPC13 INT4IP C2RX – CAN2 RX Data Ready 63 55 0x000082 IFS3 C2RXIF IEC3 C2RXIE IPC13 C2RXIP C2 – CAN 2 Combined Error 64 56 0x000083 IFS3 C2IF IEC3 C2IE IPC14 C2IP PSEM – PWM Special Event Match 65 57 0x000086 IFS3 PSEMIF IEC3 PSEMIE IPC14 PSEMIP 66-72 58-64 0x000088-0x000094 — — — U1E – UART1 Error Interrupt Reserved 73 65 0x000096 IFS4 U1EIF IEC4 U1EIE IPC16 U1EIP U2E – UART2 Error Interrupt 74 66 0x000098 IFS4 U2EIF IEC4 U2EIE IPC16 U2EIP Reserved 75-77 67-69 0x00009A-0x0000A2 — — — C1TX – CAN1 TX Data Request 78 70 0x0000A0 IFS4 C1TXIF IEC4 C1TXIE IPC17 C1TXIP C2TX – CAN2 TX Data Request 79 71 0x0000A IFS4 C2TXIF IEC4 C2TXIE IPC17 C2TXIP Reserved 80 72 0x0000A4 — — —  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 79 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 7-1: INTERRUPT VECTOR DETAILS (CONTINUED) Interrupt Source PSES – PWM Secondary Special Event Match Reserved Vector # IRQ # IVT Address 81 73 0x0000A6 Interrupt Bit Location Flag Enable Priority IFS4 PSESIF IEC4 PSESIE IPC18 PSESIP 82-97 74-89 0x0000A8-0x0000C6 — — — SPI3TX – SPI3 Transfer Done 98 90 0x0000C8 IFS5 SPI3TXIF IEC5 SPI3TXIE IPC22 SPI3TXIP SPI3RX – SPI3 Receive Done 99 91 0x0000CA IFS5 SPI3RXIF IEC5 SPI3RXIE IPC22 SPI3RXIP 100-101 92-93 0x0000CC-0x0000CE — — — PWM1 – PWM1 Interrupt Reserved 102 94 0x0000D0 IFS5 PWM1IF IEC5 PWM1IE IPC23 PWM1IP PWM2 – PWM2 Interrupt 103 95 0x0000D2 IFS5 PWM2IF IEC5 PWM2IE IPC23 PWM2IP PWM3 – PWM3 Interrupt 104 96 0x0000D4 IFS6 PWM3IF IEC6 PWM3IE IPC24 PWM3IP PWM4 – PWM4 Interrupt 105 97 0x0000D6 IFS6 PWM4IF IEC6 PWM4IE IPC24 PWM4IP PWM5 – PWM5 Interrupt 106 98 0x0000D8 IFS6 PWM5IF IEC6 PWM5IE IPC24 PWM5IP PWM6 – PWM6 Interrupt 107 99 0x0000DA IFS6 PWM6IF IEC6 PWM6IE IPC24 PWM6IP PWM7 – PWM7 Interrupt 108 100 0x0000DC IFS6 PWM7IF IEC6 PWM7IE IPC25 PWM7IP PWM8 – PWM8 Interrupt 109 101 0x0000DE IFS6 PWM8IF IEC6 PWM8IE IPC25 PWM8IP Reserved 110 102 0x0000E0 — — — AC2 – Analog Comparator 2 Interrupt 111 103 0x0000E2 IFS6 AC2IF IEC6 AC2IE IPC25 AC2IP AC3 – Analog Comparator 3 Interrupt 112 104 0x0000E4 IFS6 AC3IF IEC6 AC3IE IPC26 AC3IP AC4 – Analog Comparator 4 Interrupt 113 105 0x0000E6 IFS6 AC4IF IEC6 AC4IE IPC26 AC4IP — — — Reserved 114-117 106-109 0x0000E8-0x0000EE AN0 Conversion Done 118 110 0x0000F0 IFS6 AN0IF IEC6 AN0IE IPC27 AN0IP AN1 Conversion Done 119 111 0x0000F2 IFS6 AN1IF IEC6 AN1IE IPC27 AN1IP AN2 Conversion Done 120 112 0x0000F4 IFS7 AN2IF IEC7 AN2IE IPC28 AN2IP AN3 Conversion Done 121 113 0x0000F6 IFS7 AN3IF IEC7 AN3IE IPC28 AN3IP AN4 Conversion Done 122 114 0x0000F8 IFS7 AN4IF IEC7 AN4IE IPC28 AN4IP AN5 Conversion Done 123 115 0x0000FA IFS7 AN5IF IEC7 AN5IE IPC28 AN5IP AN6 Conversion Done 124 116 0x0000FC IFS7 AN6IF IEC7 AN6IE IPC29 AN6IP AN7 Conversion Done 125 117 0x0000FE IFS7 AN7IF IEC7 AN7IE IPC29 AN7IP — — — Reserved DS70005258C-page 80 126-131 118-123 0x000100-0x00010A  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 7-1: INTERRUPT VECTOR DETAILS (CONTINUED) Vector # IRQ # IVT Address SPI1 Error Interrupt 132 124 SPI2 Error Interrupt 133 SPI3 Error Interrupt 134 Interrupt Source Reserved Interrupt Bit Location Flag Enable Priority 0x00010C IFS7 SPI1IF IEC7 SPI1IE IPC31 SPI1IP 125 0x00010E IFS7 SPI2IF IEC7 SPI2IE IPC31 SPI2IP 126 0x000110 IFS7 SPI3IF IEC7 SPI3IE IPC31 SPI3IP — — — CLC1 Interrupt 146 138 0x000128 IFS8 CLC1IF IEC8 CLC1IE IPC34 CLC1IP CLC2 Interrupt 147 139 0x00012A IFS8 CLC2IF IEC8 CLC2IE IPC34 CLC2IP CLC3 Interrupt 148 140 0x00012C IFS8 CLC3IF IEC8 CLC3IE IPC35 CLC3IP CLC4 Interrupt 149 141 0x00012E IFS8 CLC4IF IEC8 CLC4IE IPC35 CLC4IP ICD – ICD Application 150 142 0x000130 IFS8 ICDIF IEC8 ICDIE IPC35 ICDIP JTAG – JTAG Programming 151 143 0x000132 IFS8 JTAGIF IEC8 JTAGIE IPC35 JTAGIP Reserved 152 144 0x000134 — — — PTGSTEP – PTG Step 153 145 0x000136 IFS9 IEC9 IPC36 PTGSTEPIF PTGSTEPIE PTGSTEP PTGWDT – PTG WDT Time-out 154 146 0x000138 IFS9 IEC9 PTGWDTIF PTGWDTIE PTG0 – PTG Interrupt Trigger 0 155 147 0x00013A IFS9 PTG0IF IEC9 PTG0IE IPC36 PTG0IP PTG1 – PTG Interrupt Trigger 1 156 148 0x00013C IFS9 PTG1IF IEC9 PTG1IE IPC37 PTG1IP PTG2 – PTG Interrupt Trigger 2 157 149 0x00013E IFS9 PTG2IF IEC9 PTG2IE IPC37 PTG2IP PTG3 – PTG Interrupt Trigger 3 158 150 0x000140 IFS9 PTG3IF IEC9 PTG3IE IPC37 PTG3IP AN8 Conversion Done 159 151 0x000142 IFS9 AN8IF IEC9 AN8IE IPC37 AN8IP AN9 Conversion Done 160 152 0x000144 IFS9 AN9IF IEC9 AN9IE IPC38 AN9IP AN10 Conversion Done 161 153 0x000146 IFS9 AN10IF IEC9 AN10IE IPC38 AN10IP AN11 Conversion Done 162 154 0x000148 IFS9 AN11IF IEC9 AN11IE IPC38 AN11IP AN12 Conversion Done 163 155 0x00014A IFS9 AN12IF IEC9 AN12IE IPC38 AN12IP AN13 Conversion Done 164 156 0x00014C IFS9 AN13IF IEC9 AN13IE IPC39 AN13IP AN14 Conversion Done 165 157 0x00014E IFS9 AN14IF IEC9 AN14IE IPC39 AN14IP AN15 Conversion Done 166 158 0x000150 IFS9 AN15IF IEC9 AN15IE IPC39 AN15IP AN16 Conversion Done 167 159 0x000152 IFS9 AN16IF IEC9 AN16IE IPC39 AN16IP  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 135-145 127-137 0x000112-0x000126 IPC36 PTGWDT DS70005258C-page 81 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 7-1: INTERRUPT VECTOR DETAILS (CONTINUED) Vector # IRQ # IVT Address AN17 Conversion Done 168 160 AN18 Conversion Done 169 AN19 Conversion Done Interrupt Source Interrupt Bit Location Flag Enable Priority 0x000154 IFS10 AN17IF IEC10 AN17IE IPC40 AN17IP 161 0x000156 IFS10 AN18IF IEC10 AN18IE IPC40 AN18IP 170 162 0x000158 IFS10 AN19IF IEC10 AN19IE IPC40 AN19IP AN20 Conversion Done 171 163 0x00015A IFS10 AN20IF IEC10 AN20IE IPC40 AN20IP AN21 Conversion Done 172 164 0x00015C IFS10 AN21IF IEC10 AN21IE IPC41 AN21IP — — — I2C1 – I2C1 Bus Collision Reserved 181 173 0x00016E IFS10 I2C1IF IEC10 I2C1IE IPC43 I2C1IP I2C2 – I2C2 Bus Collision 182 174 0x000170 IFS10 I2C2IF IEC10 I2C2IE IPC43 I2C2IP — — Reserved 173-180 165-172 0x00015C-0x00016C 183-184 175-176 0x000172-0x000174 — ADCMP0 – ADC Digital Comparator 0 185 177 0x000176 IFS11 ADCMP0IF IEC11 IPC44 ADCMP0IE ADCMP0IP ADCMP1 – ADC Digital Comparator 1 186 178 0x000178 IFS11 ADCMP1IF IEC11 IPC44 ADCMP1IE ADCMP1IP ADFLTR0 – ADC Filter 0 187 179 0x00017A IFS11 IEC11 IPC44 ADFLTR0IF ADFLTR0IE ADFLTR0IP ADFLTR1 – ADC Filter 1 188 180 0x00017C IFS11 IEC11 IPC45 ADFLTR1IF ADFLTR1IE ADFLTR1IP Reserved DS70005258C-page 82 189-253 181-245 0x00017E-0x000192 — — —  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 7.3 Interrupt Resources 7.4.3 IECx Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. The IECx registers maintain all of the interrupt enable bits. These control bits are used to individually enable interrupts from the peripherals or external signals. 7.3.1 The IPCx registers are used to set the Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) for each source of interrupt. Each user interrupt source can be assigned to one of seven priority levels. KEY RESOURCES • “Interrupts” (DS70000600) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools 7.4 Interrupt Control and Status Registers dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices implement the following registers for the interrupt controller: • • • • • INTCON1 INTCON2 INTCON3 INTCON4 INTTREG 7.4.1 Global interrupt control functions are controlled from INTCON1, INTCON2, INTCON3 and INTCON4. INTCON1 contains the Interrupt Nesting Disable bit (NSTDIS), as well as the control and status flags for the processor trap sources. The INTCON2 register controls external interrupt request signal behavior, contains the Global Interrupt Enable bit (GIE) and the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table Enable bit (AIVTEN). INTCON3 contains the status flags for the Auxiliary PLL and DO stack overflow status trap sources. 7.4.2 Software IFSx The IFSx registers maintain all of the interrupt request flags. Each source of interrupt has a status bit, which is set by the respective peripherals or external signal and is cleared via software.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 7.4.5 IPCx INTTREG The INTTREG register contains the associated interrupt vector number and the new CPU Interrupt Priority Level, which are latched into the Vector Number of Pending Interrupt bits (VECNUM) and New CPU Interrupt Priority Level bits (ILR) fields in the INTTREG register. The new Interrupt Priority Level is the priority of the pending interrupt. The interrupt sources are assigned to the IFSx, IECx and IPCx registers in the same sequence as they are listed in Table 7-1. For example, the INT0 (External Interrupt 0) is shown as having Vector Number 8 and a natural order priority of 0. Thus, the INT0IF bit is found in IFS0, the INT0IE bit in IEC0 and the INT0IP bits in the first position of IPC0 (IPC0). 7.4.6 INTCON1 THROUGH INTCON4 The INTCON4 register contains the Generated Hard Trap Status bit (SGHT). 7.4.4 STATUS/CONTROL REGISTERS Although these registers are not specifically part of the interrupt control hardware, two of the CPU Control registers contain bits that control interrupt functionality. For more information on these registers, refer to “dsPIC33E Enhanced CPU” (DS70005158) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”. • The CPU STATUS Register, SR, contains the IPL bits (SR). These bits indicate the current CPU Interrupt Priority Level. The user software can change the current CPU Interrupt Priority Level by writing to the IPLx bits. • The CORCON register contains the IPL3 bit which, together with IPL, also indicates the current CPU priority level. IPL3 is a read-only bit so that trap events cannot be masked by the user software. All Interrupt registers are described in Register 7-3 through Register 7-7 in the following pages. DS70005258C-page 83 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY SR: CPU STATUS REGISTER(1) REGISTER 7-1: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R-0 R/W-0 OA OB SA SB OAB SAB DA DC bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0(3) R/W-0(3) R/W-0(3) R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IPL2(2) IPL1(2) IPL0(2) RA N OV Z C bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’= Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown IPL: CPU Interrupt Priority Level Status bits(2,3) 111 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 7 (15); user interrupts are disabled 110 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 6 (14) 101 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 5 (13) 100 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 4 (12) 011 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 3 (11) 010 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 2 (10) 001 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 1 (9) 000 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 0 (8) bit 7-5 Note 1: 2: 3: For complete register details, see Register 3-1. The IPL bits are concatenated with the IPL bit (CORCON) to form the CPU Interrupt Priority Level. The value in parentheses indicates the IPL, if IPL = 1. User interrupts are disabled when IPL = 1. The IPL Status bits are read-only when the NSTDIS bit (INTCON1) = 1. DS70005258C-page 84  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 7-2: CORCON: CORE CONTROL REGISTER(1) R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 VAR — US1 US0 EDT DL2 DL1 DL0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/C-0 R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SATA SATB SATDW ACCSAT IPL3(2) SFA RND IF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’= Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 VAR: Variable Exception Processing Latency Control bit 1 = Variable exception processing is enabled 0 = Fixed exception processing is enabled bit 3 IPL3: CPU Interrupt Priority Level Status bit 3(2) 1 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is greater than 7 0 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 7 or less Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown For complete register details, see Register 3-2. The IPL3 bit is concatenated with the IPL bits (SR) to form the CPU Interrupt Priority Level.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 85 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 7-3: INTCON1: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 NSTDIS OVAERR OVBERR COVAERR COVBERR OVATE OVBTE COVTE bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 SFTACERR DIV0ERR — MATHERR ADDRERR STKERR OSCFAIL — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 NSTDIS: Interrupt Nesting Disable bit 1 = Interrupt nesting is disabled 0 = Interrupt nesting is enabled bit 14 OVAERR: Accumulator A Overflow Trap Flag bit 1 = Trap was caused by overflow of Accumulator A 0 = Trap was not caused by overflow of Accumulator A bit 13 OVBERR: Accumulator B Overflow Trap Flag bit 1 = Trap was caused by overflow of Accumulator B 0 = Trap was not caused by overflow of Accumulator B bit 12 COVAERR: Accumulator A Catastrophic Overflow Trap Flag bit 1 = Trap was caused by catastrophic overflow of Accumulator A 0 = Trap was not caused by catastrophic overflow of Accumulator A bit 11 COVBERR: Accumulator B Catastrophic Overflow Trap Flag bit 1 = Trap was caused by catastrophic overflow of Accumulator B 0 = Trap was not caused by catastrophic overflow of Accumulator B bit 10 OVATE: Accumulator A Overflow Trap Enable bit 1 = Trap overflow of Accumulator A 0 = Trap is disabled bit 9 OVBTE: Accumulator B Overflow Trap Enable bit 1 = Trap overflow of Accumulator B 0 = Trap is disabled bit 8 COVTE: Catastrophic Overflow Trap Enable bit 1 = Trap on catastrophic overflow of Accumulator A or B is enabled 0 = Trap is disabled bit 7 SFTACERR: Shift Accumulator Error Status bit 1 = Math error trap was caused by an invalid accumulator shift 0 = Math error trap was not caused by an invalid accumulator shift bit 6 DIV0ERR: Divide-by-Zero Error Status bit 1 = Math error trap was caused by a divide-by-zero 0 = Math error trap was not caused by a divide-by-zero bit 5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 MATHERR: Math Error Status bit 1 = Math error trap has occurred 0 = Math error trap has not occurred bit 3 ADDRERR: Address Error Trap Status bit 1 = Address error trap has occurred 0 = Address error trap has not occurred DS70005258C-page 86  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 7-3: INTCON1: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 1 (CONTINUED) bit 2 STKERR: Stack Error Trap Status bit 1 = Stack error trap has occurred 0 = Stack error trap has not occurred bit 1 OSCFAIL: Oscillator Failure Trap Status bit 1 = Oscillator failure trap has occurred 0 = Oscillator failure trap has not occurred bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 87 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 7-4: INTCON2: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 2 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 GIE DISI SWTRAP — — — — AIVTEN bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — INT4EP — INT2EP INT1EP INT0EP bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 GIE: Global Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupts and associated IE bits are enabled 0 = Interrupts are disabled, but traps are still enabled bit 14 DISI: DISI Instruction Status bit 1 = DISI instruction is active 0 = DISI instruction is not active bit 13 SWTRAP: Software Trap Status bit 1 = Software trap is enabled 0 = Software trap is disabled bit 12-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8 AIVTEN: Alternate Interrupt Vector Table Enable 1 = Uses Alternate Interrupt Vector Table 0 = Uses standard Interrupt Vector Table bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 INT4EP: External Interrupt 4 Edge Detect Polarity Select bit 1 = Interrupt on negative edge 0 = Interrupt on positive edge bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2 INT2EP: External Interrupt 2 Edge Detect Polarity Select bit 1 = Interrupt on negative edge 0 = Interrupt on positive edge bit 1 INT1EP: External Interrupt 1 Edge Detect Polarity Select bit 1 = Interrupt on negative edge 0 = Interrupt on positive edge bit 0 INT0EP: External Interrupt 0 Edge Detect Polarity Select bit 1 = Interrupt on negative edge 0 = Interrupt on positive edge DS70005258C-page 88 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 7-5: INTCON3: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 3 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — — — — — NAE bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — DOOVR — — — APLL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8 NAE: NVM Address Error Soft Trap Status bit 1 = NVM address error soft trap has occurred 0 = NVM address error soft trap has not occurred bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 DOOVR: DO Stack Overflow Soft Trap Status bit 1 = DO stack overflow soft trap has occurred 0 = DO stack overflow soft trap has not occurred bit 3-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 APLL: Auxiliary PLL Loss of Lock Soft Trap Status bit 1 = APLL lock soft trap has occurred 0 = APLL lock soft trap has not occurred REGISTER 7-6: x = Bit is unknown INTCON4: INTERRUPT CONTROL REGISTER 4 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — — — — — SGHT bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 SGHT: Software Generated Hard Trap Status bit 1 = Software generated hard trap has occurred 0 = Software generated hard trap has not occurred  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 89 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 7-7: INTTREG: INTERRUPT CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 ILR bit 15 bit 8 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 VECNUM bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-8 ILR: New CPU Interrupt Priority Level bits 1111 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 15 • • • 0001 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 1 0000 = CPU Interrupt Priority Level is 0 bit 7-0 VECNUM: Vector Number of Pending Interrupt bits 11111111 = 255, Reserved; do not use • • • 00001001 = 9, IC1 – Input Capture 1 00001000 = 8, INT0 – External Interrupt 0 00000111 = 7, Reserved; do not use 00000110 = 6, Generic soft error trap 00000101 = 5, Reserved; do not use 00000100 = 4, Math error trap 00000011 = 3, Stack error trap 00000010 = 2, Generic hard trap 00000001 = 1, Address error trap 00000000 = 0, Oscillator fail trap DS70005258C-page 90 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 8.0 DIRECT MEMORY ACCESS (DMA) The DMA Controller transfers data between Peripheral Data registers and Data Space SRAM. In addition, DMA can access the entire data memory space. The data memory bus arbiter is utilized when either the CPU or DMA attempts to access SRAM, resulting in potential DMA or CPU Stalls. Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Direct Memory Access (DMA)” (DS70348) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). The DMA Controller supports four independent channels. Each channel can be configured for transfers to or from selected peripherals. The peripherals supported by the DMA Controller include: • • • • • 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. FIGURE 8-1: CAN UART Input Capture Output Compare Timers Refer to Table 8-1 for a complete list of supported peripherals. PERIPHERAL TO DMA CONTROLLER PERIPHERAL DMA Data Memory Arbiter (see Figure 4-10) SRAM  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 91 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY In addition, DMA transfers can be triggered by timers as well as external interrupts. Each DMA channel is unidirectional. Two DMA channels must be allocated to read and write to a peripheral. If more than one channel receives a request to transfer data, a simple fixed priority scheme, based on channel number, dictates which channel completes the transfer and which channel, or channels, are left pending. Each DMA channel moves a block of data, after which, it generates an interrupt to the CPU to indicate that the block is available for processing. The DMA Controller capabilities: provides these functional • Four DMA Channels • Register Indirect with Post-Increment Addressing mode • Register Indirect without Post-Increment Addressing mode TABLE 8-1: • Peripheral Indirect Addressing mode (peripheral generates destination address) • CPU Interrupt after Half or Full Block Transfer Complete • Byte or Word Transfers • Fixed Priority Channel Arbitration • Manual (software) or Automatic (peripheral DMA requests) Transfer Initiation • One-Shot or Auto-Repeat Block Transfer modes • Ping-Pong mode (automatic switch between two SRAM Start addresses after each block transfer complete) • DMA Request for each Channel can be Selected from any Supported Interrupt Source • Debug Support Features The peripherals that can utilize DMA are listed in Table 8-1. DMA CHANNEL TO PERIPHERAL ASSOCIATIONS Peripheral to DMA Association DMAxREQ Register IRQSEL Bits DMAxPAD Register (Values to Read from Peripheral) DMAxPAD Register (Values to Write to Peripheral) INT0 – External Interrupt 0 00000000 — — IC1 – Input Capture 1 00000001 0x0144 (IC1BUF) — IC2 – Input Capture 2 00000101 0x014C (IC2BUF) — IC3 – Input Capture 3 00100101 0x0154 (IC3BUF) — IC4 – Input Capture 4 00100110 0x015C (IC4BUF) — OC1 – Output Compare 1 00000010 — 0x0906 (OC1R) 0x0904 (OC1RS) OC2 – Output Compare 2 00000110 — 0x0910 (OC2R) 0x090E (OC2RS) OC3 – Output Compare 3 00011001 — 0x091A (OC3R) 0x0918 (OC3RS) OC4 – Output Compare 4 00011010 — 0x0924 (OC4R) 0x0922 (OC4RS) TMR2 – Timer2 00000111 — — TMR3 – Timer3 00001000 — — TMR4 – Timer4 00011011 — — TMR5 – Timer5 00011100 — — UART1RX – UART1 Receiver 00001011 0x0226 (U1RXREG) — UART1TX – UART1 Transmitter 00001100 — 0x0224 (U1TXREG) UART2RX – UART2 Receiver 00011110 0x0236 (U2RXREG) — UART2TX – UART2 Transmitter 00011111 — 0x0234 (U2TXREG) CAN1 – RX Data Ready 00100010 0x04C0 (C1RXD) — CAN1 – TX Data Request 01000110 — 0x04C2 (C1TXD) CAN2 – RX Data Ready 00110111 0x07C0(C2RXD) — CAN2 – TX Data Request 01000111 — 0x07C2 (C2TXD) DS70005258C-page 92  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 8-2: DMA CONTROLLER BLOCK DIAGRAM SRAM Peripheral Indirect Address Arbiter DMA Control DMA Controller DMA Ready Peripheral 1 DMA Channels 0 1 2 3 CPU DMA IRQ to DMA and Interrupt Controller Modules DMA X-Bus CPU Peripheral X-Bus CPU CPU DMA DMA Ready Peripheral 2 CPU DMA DMA Ready Peripheral 3 IRQ to DMA and Interrupt Controller Modules IRQ to DMA and Interrupt Controller Modules Non-DMA Peripheral Note: CPU and DMA address buses are not shown for clarity.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 93 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 8.1 DMA Controller Registers Each DMA Controller Channel x (where x = 0 through 3) contains the following registers: • 16-Bit DMA Channel x Control Register (DMAxCON) • 16-Bit DMA Channel x IRQ Select Register (DMAxREQ) • 32-Bit DMA Channel x Start Address Register A (DMAxSTAL/H) • 32-Bit DMA Channel x Start Address Register B (DMAxSTBL/H) • 16-Bit DMA Channel x Peripheral Address Register (DMAxPAD) • 14-Bit DMA Channel x Transfer Count Register (DMAxCNT) REGISTER 8-1: R/W-0 CHEN bit 15 R/W-0 SIZE R/W-0 DIR U-0 — Legend: R = Readable bit -n = Value at POR bit 13 bit 12 bit 11 bit 10-6 bit 5-4 bit 3-2 bit 1-0 R/W-0 HALF R/W-0 NULLW U-0 — U-0 — U-0 — bit 8 R/W-0 AMODE1 bit 7 bit 14 The interrupt flags (DMAxIF) are located in an IFSx register in the interrupt controller. The corresponding interrupt enable control bits (DMAxIE) are located in an IECx register in the interrupt controller and the corresponding interrupt priority control bits (DMAxIP) are located in an IPCx register in the interrupt controller. DMAxCON: DMA CHANNEL x CONTROL REGISTER U-0 — bit 15 Additional status registers (DMAPWC, DMARQC, DMAPPS, DMALCA and DSADRL/H) are common to all DMA Controller channels. These status registers provide information on write and request collisions, as well as on last address and channel access information. W = Writable bit ‘1’ = Bit is set R/W-0 AMODE0 U-0 — U-0 — R/W-0 MODE1 R/W-0 MODE0 bit 0 U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown CHEN: DMA Channel Enable bit 1 = Channel is enabled 0 = Channel is disabled SIZE: DMA Data Transfer Size bit 1 = Byte 0 = Word DIR: Transfer Direction bit (source/destination bus select) 1 = Reads from RAM address, writes to peripheral address 0 = Reads from peripheral address, writes to RAM address HALF: Block Transfer Interrupt Select bit 1 = Initiates interrupt when half of the data has been moved 0 = Initiates interrupt when all of the data has been moved NULLW: Null Data Peripheral Write Mode Select bit 1 = Null data write to peripheral in addition to RAM write (DIR bit must also be clear) 0 = Normal operation Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ AMODE: DMA Channel Addressing Mode Select bits 11 = Reserved 10 = Peripheral Indirect mode 01 = Register Indirect without Post-Increment mode 00 = Register Indirect with Post-Increment mode Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ MODE: DMA Channel Operating Mode Select bits 11 = One-Shot, Ping-Pong modes are enabled (one block transfer from/to each DMA buffer) 10 = Continuous, Ping-Pong modes are enabled 01 = One-Shot, Ping-Pong modes are disabled 00 = Continuous, Ping-Pong modes are disabled DS70005258C-page 94  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-2: R/S-0 FORCE (1) DMAxREQ: DMA CHANNEL x IRQ SELECT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IRQSEL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: S = Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 FORCE: Force DMA Transfer bit(1) 1 = Forces a single DMA transfer (Manual mode) 0 = Automatic DMA transfer initiation by DMA request bit 14-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 IRQSEL: DMA Peripheral IRQ Number Select bits 01000111 = CAN2 – TX data request 01000110 = CAN1 – TX data request 00110111 = CAN2 – RX data ready 00100110 = IC4 – Input Capture 4 00100101 = IC3 – Input Capture 3 00100010 = CAN1 – RX data ready 00011111 = UART2TX – UART2 transmitter 00011110 = UART2RX – UART2 receiver 00011100 = TMR5 – Timer5 00011011 = TMR4 – Timer4 00011010 = OC4 – Output Compare 4 00011001 = OC3 – Output Compare 3 00001100 = UART1TX – UART1 transmitter 00001011 = UART1RX – UART1 receiver 00001000 = TMR3 – Timer3 00000111 = TMR2 – Timer2 00000110 = OC2 – Output Compare 2 00000101 = IC2 – Input Capture 2 00000010 = OC1 – Output Compare 1 00000001 = IC1 – Input Capture 1 00000000 = INT0 – External Interrupt 0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown The FORCE bit cannot be cleared by user software. The FORCE bit is cleared by hardware when the forced DMA transfer is complete or the channel is disabled (CHEN = 0).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 95 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-3: DMAxSTAH: DMA CHANNEL x START ADDRESS REGISTER A (HIGH) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STA bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 STA: DMA Primary Start Address bits (source or destination) REGISTER 8-4: R/W-0 DMAxSTAL: DMA CHANNEL x START ADDRESS REGISTER A (LOW) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STA bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STA bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown STA: DMA Primary Start Address bits (source or destination) DS70005258C-page 96  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-5: DMAxSTBH: DMA CHANNEL x START ADDRESS REGISTER B (HIGH) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STB bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 STB: DMA Secondary Start Address bits (source or destination) REGISTER 8-6: R/W-0 DMAxSTBL: DMA CHANNEL x START ADDRESS REGISTER B (LOW) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STB bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STB bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown STB: DMA Secondary Start Address bits (source or destination)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 97 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY DMAxPAD: DMA CHANNEL x PERIPHERAL ADDRESS REGISTER(1) REGISTER 8-7: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PAD bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PAD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PAD: DMA Peripheral Address Register bits If the channel is enabled (i.e., active), writes to this register may result in unpredictable behavior of the DMA channel and should be avoided. DMAxCNT: DMA CHANNEL x TRANSFER COUNT REGISTER(1) REGISTER 8-8: U-0 U-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNT(2) — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNT R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 (2) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-0 CNT: DMA Transfer Count Register bits(2) Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown If the channel is enabled (i.e., active), writes to this register may result in unpredictable behavior of the DMA channel and should be avoided. The number of DMA transfers = CNT + 1. DS70005258C-page 98  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-9: DSADRH: DMA MOST RECENT RAM HIGH ADDRESS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 DSADR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 DSADR: Most Recent DMA Address Accessed by DMA bits REGISTER 8-10: R-0 DSADRL: DMA MOST RECENT RAM LOW ADDRESS REGISTER R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 DSADR bit 15 bit 8 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 DSADR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown DSADR: Most Recent DMA Address Accessed by DMA bits  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 99 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-11: DMAPWC: DMA PERIPHERAL WRITE COLLISION STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — — — PWCOL3 PWCOL2 PWCOL1 PWCOL0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 PWCOL3: Channel 3 Peripheral Write Collision Flag bit 1 = Write collision is detected 0 = No write collision is detected bit 2 PWCOL2: Channel 2 Peripheral Write Collision Flag bit 1 = Write collision is detected 0 = No write collision is detected bit 1 PWCOL1: Channel 1 Peripheral Write Collision Flag bit 1 = Write collision is detected 0 = No write collision is detected bit 0 PWCOL0: Channel 0 Peripheral Write Collision Flag bit 1 = Write collision is detected 0 = No write collision is detected DS70005258C-page 100 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-12: DMARQC: DMA REQUEST COLLISION STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — — — RQCOL3 RQCOL2 RQCOL1 RQCOL0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 RQCOL3: Channel 3 Transfer Request Collision Flag bit 1 = User FORCE and interrupt-based request collision are detected 0 = No request collision is detected bit 2 RQCOL2: Channel 2 Transfer Request Collision Flag bit 1 = User FORCE and interrupt-based request collision are detected 0 = No request collision is detected bit 1 RQCOL1: Channel 1 Transfer Request Collision Flag bit 1 = User FORCE and interrupt-based request collision are detected 0 = No request collision is detected bit 0 RQCOL0: Channel 0 Transfer Request Collision Flag bit 1 = User FORCE and interrupt-based request collision are detected 0 = No request collision is detected  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 101 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-13: DMALCA: DMA LAST CHANNEL ACTIVE STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R-1 R-1 R-1 R-1 LSTCH bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3-0 LSTCH: Last DMA Controller Channel Active Status bits 1111 = No DMA transfer has occurred since system Reset 1110 = Reserved • • • 0100 = Reserved 0011 = Last data transfer was handled by Channel 3 0010 = Last data transfer was handled by Channel 2 0001 = Last data transfer was handled by Channel 1 0000 = Last data transfer was handled by Channel 0 DS70005258C-page 102 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 8-14: DMAPPS: DMA PING-PONG STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — — — PPST3 PPST2 PPST1 PPST0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 PPST3: Channel 3 Ping-Pong Mode Status Flag bit 1 = DMA3STB register is selected 0 = DMA3STA register is selected bit 2 PPST2: Channel 2 Ping-Pong Mode Status Flag bit 1 = DMA2STB register is selected 0 = DMA2STA register is selected bit 1 PPST1: Channel 1 Ping-Pong Mode Status Flag bit 1 = DMA1STB register is selected 0 = DMA1STA register is selected bit 0 PPST0: Channel 0 Ping-Pong Mode Status Flag bit 1 = DMA0STB register is selected 0 = DMA0STA register is selected  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 103 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 104  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 9.0 OSCILLATOR CONFIGURATION Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Oscillator Module” (DS70005131) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family oscillator system provides: • On-Chip Phase-Locked Loop (PLL) to Boost Internal Operating Frequency on Select Internal and External Oscillator Sources • On-the-Fly Clock Switching between Various Clock Sources • Doze mode for System Power Savings • Fail-Safe Clock Monitor (FSCM) that Detects Clock Failure and Permits Safe Application Recovery or Shutdown • Configuration Bits for Clock Source Selection • Auxiliary PLL for ADC and PWM A simplified diagram of the oscillator system is shown in Figure 9-1. DS70005258C-page 105 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 9-1: OSCILLATOR SYSTEM DIAGRAM Primary Oscillator (POSC) DOZE XT, HS, EC POSCCLK FPLLO S3 PLL S1 OSC2 FVCO XTPLL, HSPLL, ECPLL, FRCPLL S2 S1/S3 FCY(2) DOZE OSC1 (1) POSCMD FRCCLK ÷2 FRCDIV FRC Oscillator FP(2) FRCDIVN FOSC S7 REFERENCE CLOCK OUTPUT TUN FRCDIV ÷ 16 FRCDIV16 FRC LPRC LPRC Oscillator S6 S0 POSCCLK REFCLKO ÷N RPn FOSC ROSEL S5 Clock Fail Clock Switch Reset S0 NOSC FNOSC RODIV WDT, PWRT, FSCM AUXILIARY CLOCK GENERATOR CIRCUIT BLOCK DIAGRAM FRCCLK POSCCLK FVCO(1) 1 APLL x 16 1 Note 1: ACLK PWM/ADC to LFSR 0 0 ASRCSEL ÷N 1 0 GND 0 1 FRCSEL ENAPLL SELACLK APSTSCLR(4) See Figure 9-2 for the source of the FVCO signal. 2: FP refers to the clock source for all the peripherals, while FCY (or MIPS) refers to the clock source for the CPU. Throughout this document, FCY and FP are used interchangeably, except in the case of Doze mode. FP and FCY will be different when Doze mode is used in any ratio other than 1:1. 3: The auxiliary clock postscaler must be configured to divide-by-1 (APSTSCLR = 111) for proper operation of the PWM and ADC modules. DS70005258C-page 106  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 9.1 CPU Clocking System Instruction execution speed or device operating frequency, FCY, is given by Equation 9-1. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices provides six system clock options: EQUATION 9-1: • Fast RC (FRC) Oscillator • FRC Oscillator with Phase-Locked Loop (FRCPLL) • FRC Oscillator with Postscaler • Primary (XT, HS or EC) Oscillator • Primary Oscillator with PLL (XTPLL, HSPLL, ECPLL) • Low-Power RC (LPRC) Oscillator FIGURE 9-2: ÷ N1 FCY = FOSC/2 Figure 9-2 is a block diagram of the PLL module. Equation 9-2 provides the relationship between Input Frequency (FIN) and Output Frequency (FPLLO). Equation 9-3 provides the relationship between Input Frequency (FIN) and VCO Frequency (FVCO). PLL BLOCK DIAGRAM 0.8 MHz < FPLLI(1) < 8.0 MHz FIN DEVICE OPERATING FREQUENCY FPLLO(1)  120 MHz @ +125ºC FPLLO(1)  140 MHz @ +85ºC 120 MHZ < FVCO(1) < 340 MHZ FPLLI PFD VCO FVCO PLLPRE FOSC ÷ N2 PLLPOST ÷M PLLDIV Note 1: This frequency range must be met at all times. EQUATION 9-2: FPLLO CALCULATION FPLLO = FIN  ( PLLDIV + 2 M = FIN  (PLLPRE + 2) 2(PLLPOST + 1) N1  ) ( ) Where: N1 = PLLPRE + 2 N2 = 2 x (PLLPOST + 1) M = PLLDIV + 2 EQUATION 9-3: FVCO CALCULATION FVCO = FIN   2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. PLLDIV + 2 M = FIN  (PLLPRE + 2) N1 () ( ) DS70005258C-page 107 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 9-1: CONFIGURATION BIT VALUES FOR CLOCK SELECTION Oscillator Mode Oscillator Source See Notes POSCMD FNOSC Fast RC Oscillator with Divide-by-n (FRCDIVN) Internal xx 111 1, 2 Fast RC Oscillator with Divide-by-16 Internal xx 110 1 Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC) Internal xx 101 1 Primary Oscillator (HS) with PLL (HSPLL) Primary 10 011 Primary Oscillator (XT) with PLL (XTPLL) Primary 01 011 Primary Oscillator (EC) with PLL (ECPLL) Primary 00 011 Primary Oscillator (HS) Primary 10 010 Primary Oscillator (XT) Primary 01 010 Primary Oscillator (EC) Primary 00 010 1 Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-N and PLL (FRCPLL) Internal xx 001 1 Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) Internal xx 000 1 Note 1: 2: 9.2 1 OSC2 pin function is determined by the OSCIOFNC Configuration bit. This is the default Oscillator mode for an unprogrammed (erased) device. Auxiliary Clock Generation The auxiliary clock generation is used for peripherals that need to operate at a frequency unrelated to the system clock, such as PWM or ADC. The primary oscillator and internal FRC oscillator sources can be used with an Auxiliary PLL (APLL) to obtain the auxiliary clock. The Auxiliary PLL has a fixed 16x multiplication factor. The auxiliary clock has the following configuration restrictions: • For proper PWM operation, auxiliary clock generation must be configured for 120 MHz (see Parameter OS56 in Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics”). If a slower frequency is desired, the PWM Input Clock Prescaler (Divider) Select bits (PCLKDIV) should be used. • To achieve 1.04 ns PWM resolution, the auxiliary clock must use the 16x Auxiliary PLL (APLL). All other clock sources will have a minimum PWM resolution of 8 ns. • If the primary PLL is used as a source for the auxiliary clock, the primary PLL should be configured up to a maximum operation of 30 MIPS or less. DS70005258C-page 108 9.3 Reference Clock Generation The reference clock output logic provides the user with the ability to output a clock signal based on the system clock or the crystal oscillator on a device pin. The user application can specify a wide range of clock scaling prior to outputting the reference clock. 9.4 Oscillator Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 9.4.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Oscillator Module” (DS70005131) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 9.5 Oscillator Control Registers OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER(1) REGISTER 9-1: U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 U-0 R/W-y R/W-y R/W-y — COSC2 COSC1 COSC0 — NOSC2(2) NOSC1(2) NOSC0(2) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 CLKLOCK IOLOCK LOCK — CF(3) — — OSWEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: y = Value set from Configuration bits on POR R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-12 COSC: Current Oscillator Selection bits (read-only) 111 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-n 110 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-16 101 = Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC) 100 = Reserved 011 = Primary Oscillator (XT, HS, EC) with PLL 010 = Primary Oscillator (XT, HS, EC) 001 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-N and PLL (FRCPLL) 000 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) bit 11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10-8 NOSC: New Oscillator Selection bits(2) 111 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-n 110 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-16 101 = Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC) 100 = Reserved 011 = Primary Oscillator (XT, HS, EC) with PLL 010 = Primary Oscillator (XT, HS, EC) 001 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) with Divide-by-N and PLL (FRCPLL) 000 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) bit 7 CLKLOCK: Clock Lock Enable bit 1 = If (FCKSM0 = 1), then clock and PLL configurations are locked; if (FCKSM0 = 0), then clock and PLL configurations may be modified 0 = Clock and PLL selections are not locked, configurations may be modified bit 6 IOLOCK: I/O Lock Enable bit 1 = I/O lock is active 0 = I/O lock is not active bit 5 LOCK: PLL Lock Status bit (read-only) 1 = Indicates that PLL is in lock or PLL start-up timer is satisfied 0 = Indicates that PLL is out of lock, start-up timer is in progress or PLL is disabled Note 1: 2: 3: Writes to this register require an unlock sequence. Direct clock switches between any Primary Oscillator mode with PLL and FRCPLL mode are not permitted. This applies to clock switches in either direction. In these instances, the application must switch to FRC mode as a transitional clock source between the two PLL modes. This bit should only be cleared in software. Setting the bit in software (= 1) will have the same effect as an actual oscillator failure and will trigger an oscillator failure trap.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 109 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-1: OSCCON: OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER(1) (CONTINUED) bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 CF: Clock Fail Detect bit(3) 1 = FSCM has detected a clock failure 0 = FSCM has not detected a clock failure bit 2-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 OSWEN: Oscillator Switch Enable bit 1 = Requests oscillator switch to the selection specified by the NOSC bits 0 = Oscillator switch is complete Note 1: 2: 3: Writes to this register require an unlock sequence. Direct clock switches between any Primary Oscillator mode with PLL and FRCPLL mode are not permitted. This applies to clock switches in either direction. In these instances, the application must switch to FRC mode as a transitional clock source between the two PLL modes. This bit should only be cleared in software. Setting the bit in software (= 1) will have the same effect as an actual oscillator failure and will trigger an oscillator failure trap. DS70005258C-page 110  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-2: CLKDIV: CLOCK DIVISOR REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ROI DOZE2(1) DOZE1(1) DOZE0(1) DOZEN(2,3) FRCDIV2 FRCDIV1 FRCDIV0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-1 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PLLPOST1 PLLPOST0 — PLLPRE4 PLLPRE3 PLLPRE2 PLLPRE1 PLLPRE0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 ROI: Recover on Interrupt bit 1 = Interrupts will clear the DOZEN bit and the processor clock, and the peripheral clock ratio is set to 1:1 0 = Interrupts have no effect on the DOZEN bit bit 14-12 DOZE: Processor Clock Reduction Select bits(1) 111 = FCY divided by 128 110 = FCY divided by 64 101 = FCY divided by 32 100 = FCY divided by 16 011 = FCY divided by 8 (default) 010 = FCY divided by 4 001 = FCY divided by 2 000 = FCY divided by 1 bit 11 DOZEN: Doze Mode Enable bit(2,3) 1 = DOZE field specifies the ratio between the peripheral clocks and the processor clocks 0 = Processor clock and peripheral clock ratio is forced to 1:1 bit 10-8 FRCDIV: Internal Fast RC Oscillator Postscaler bits 111 = FRC divided by 256 110 = FRC divided by 64 101 = FRC divided by 32 100 = FRC divided by 16 011 = FRC divided by 8 010 = FRC divided by 4 001 = FRC divided by 2 000 = FRC divided by 1 (default) bit 7-6 PLLPOST: PLL VCO Output Divider Select bits (also denoted as ‘N2’, PLL postscaler) 11 = Output divided by 8 10 = Reserved 01 = Output divided by 4 (default) 00 = Output divided by 2 bit 5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: 3: The DOZE bits can only be written to when the DOZEN bit is clear. If DOZEN = 1, any writes to DOZE are ignored. This bit is cleared when the ROI bit is set and an interrupt occurs. The DOZEN bit cannot be set if DOZE = 000. If DOZE = 000, any attempt by user software to set the DOZEN bit is ignored.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 111 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-2: bit 4-0 CLKDIV: CLOCK DIVISOR REGISTER (CONTINUED) PLLPRE: PLL Phase Detector Input Divider Select bits (also denoted as ‘N1’, PLL prescaler) 11111 = Input divided by 33 • • • 00001 = Input divided by 3 00000 = Input divided by 2 (default) Note 1: 2: 3: The DOZE bits can only be written to when the DOZEN bit is clear. If DOZEN = 1, any writes to DOZE are ignored. This bit is cleared when the ROI bit is set and an interrupt occurs. The DOZEN bit cannot be set if DOZE = 000. If DOZE = 000, any attempt by user software to set the DOZEN bit is ignored. REGISTER 9-3: PLLFBD: PLL FEEDBACK DIVISOR REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — — — — — PLLDIV8 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PLLDIV bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8-0 PLLDIV: PLL Feedback Divisor bits (also denoted as ‘M’, PLL multiplier) 111111111 = 513 • • • 000110000 = 50 (default) • • • 000000010 = 4 000000001 = 3 000000000 = 2 DS70005258C-page 112  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-4: OSCTUN: FRC OSCILLATOR TUNING REGISTER(1) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TUN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TUN: FRC Oscillator Tuning bits 011111 = Maximum frequency deviation of 1.457% (7.477 MHz) 011110 = Center frequency + 1.41% (7.474 MHz) • • • 000001 = Center frequency + 0.047% (7.373 MHz) 000000 = Center frequency (7.37 MHz nominal) 111111 = Center frequency – 0.047% (7.367 MHz) • • • 100001 = Center frequency – 1.457% (7.263 MHz) 100000 = Minimum frequency deviation of -1.5% (7.259 MHz) Note 1: x = Bit is unknown OSCTUN functionality has been provided to help customers compensate for temperature effects on the FRC frequency over a wide range of temperatures. The tuning step-size is an approximation and is neither characterized nor tested.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 113 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-5: ACLKCON: AUXILIARY CLOCK DIVISOR CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R-0 ENAPLL APLLCK R/W-1 U-0 U-0 SELACLK — — R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 APSTSCLR2 APSTSCLR1 APSTSCLR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-1 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 ASRCSEL FRCSEL — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 ENAPLL: Auxiliary PLL Enable bit 1 = APLL is enabled 0 = APLL is disabled bit 14 APLLCK: APLL Locked Status bit (read-only) 1 = Indicates that Auxiliary PLL is in lock 0 = Indicates that Auxiliary PLL is not in lock bit 13 SELACLK: Select Auxiliary Clock Source for Auxiliary Clock Divider bit 1 = Auxiliary oscillators provide the source clock for the auxiliary clock divider 0 = Primary PLL (FVCO) provides the source clock for the auxiliary clock divider bit 12-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10-8 APSTSCLR: Auxiliary Clock Output Divider bits 111 = Divided by 1 110 = Divided by 2 101 = Divided by 4 100 = Divided by 8 011 = Divided by 16 010 = Divided by 32 001 = Divided by 64 000 = Divided by 256 bit 7 ASRCSEL: Select Reference Clock Source for Auxiliary Clock bit 1 = Primary oscillator is the clock source 0 = No clock input is selected bit 6 FRCSEL: Select Reference Clock Source for Auxiliary PLL bit 1 = Selects the FRC clock for Auxiliary PLL 0 = Input clock source is determined by the ASRCSEL bit setting bit 5-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS70005258C-page 114  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-6: REFOCON: REFERENCE OSCILLATOR CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ROON — ROSSLP ROSEL RODIV3(1) RODIV2(1) RODIV1(1) RODIV0(1) bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 ROON: Reference Oscillator Output Enable bit 1 = Reference oscillator output is enabled on the RPn pin(2) 0 = Reference oscillator output is disabled bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 ROSSLP: Reference Oscillator Run in Sleep bit 1 = Reference oscillator output continues to run in Sleep 0 = Reference oscillator output is disabled in Sleep bit 12 ROSEL: Reference Oscillator Source Select bit 1 = Oscillator crystal is used as the reference clock 0 = System clock is used as the reference clock bit 11-8 RODIV: Reference Oscillator Divider bits(1) 1111 = Reference clock divided by 32,768 1110 = Reference clock divided by 16,384 1101 = Reference clock divided by 8,192 1100 = Reference clock divided by 4,096 1011 = Reference clock divided by 2,048 1010 = Reference clock divided by 1,024 1001 = Reference clock divided by 512 1000 = Reference clock divided by 256 0111 = Reference clock divided by 128 0110 = Reference clock divided by 64 0101 = Reference clock divided by 32 0100 = Reference clock divided by 16 0011 = Reference clock divided by 8 0010 = Reference clock divided by 4 0001 = Reference clock divided by 2 0000 = Reference clock bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown The reference oscillator output must be disabled (ROON = 0) before writing to these bits. This pin is remappable. See Section 11.6 “Peripheral Pin Select (PPS)” for more information.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 115 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 9-7: U-0 LFSR: LINEAR FEEDBACK SHIFT REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LFSR bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LFSR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-0 LFSR: Pseudorandom Data bits DS70005258C-page 116 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 10.0 POWER-SAVING FEATURES 10.1 Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Watchdog Timer and Power-Saving Modes” (DS70615) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices provide the ability to manage power consumption by selectively managing clocking to the CPU and the peripherals. In general, a lower clock frequency and a reduction in the number of peripherals being clocked constitutes lower consumed power. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices manage power consumption in four ways: • • • • The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices allow a wide range of clock frequencies to be selected under application control. If the system clock configuration is not locked, users can choose low-power or high-precision oscillators by simply changing the NOSCx bits (OSCCON). The process of changing a system clock during operation, as well as limitations to the process, are discussed in more detail in Section 9.0 “Oscillator Configuration”. 10.2 Instruction-Based Power-Saving Modes The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices have two special power-saving modes that are entered through the execution of a special PWRSAV instruction. Sleep mode stops clock operation and halts all code execution. Idle mode halts the CPU and code execution, but allows peripheral modules to continue operation. The assembler syntax of the PWRSAV instruction is shown in Example 10-1. Note: can Clock Frequency Instruction-Based Sleep and Idle modes Software-Controlled Doze mode Selective Peripheral Control in Software Clock Frequency and Clock Switching SLEEP_MODE and IDLE_MODE are constants defined in the assembler include file for the selected device. Sleep and Idle modes can be exited as a result of an enabled interrupt, WDT time-out or a device Reset. When the device exits these modes, it is said to “wake-up”. Combinations of these methods can be used to selectively tailor an application’s power consumption while still maintaining critical application features, such as timing-sensitive communications. EXAMPLE 10-1: PWRSAV INSTRUCTION SYNTAX PWRSAV #SLEEP_MODE PWRSAV #IDLE_MODE ; Put the device into Sleep mode ; Put the device into Idle mode  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 117 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 10.2.1 SLEEP MODE 10.2.2 IDLE MODE The following occurs in Sleep mode: The following occurs in Idle mode: • The system clock source is shut down. If an on-chip oscillator is used, it is turned off. • The device current consumption is reduced to a minimum, provided that no I/O pin is sourcing current. • The Fail-Safe Clock Monitor does not operate, since the system clock source is disabled. • The LPRC clock continues to run in Sleep mode if the WDT is enabled. • The WDT, if enabled, is automatically cleared prior to entering Sleep mode. • Some device features or peripherals can continue to operate. This includes items such as the Input Change Notification on the I/O ports or peripherals that use an external clock input. • Any peripheral that requires the system clock source for its operation is disabled. • The CPU stops executing instructions. • The WDT is automatically cleared. • The system clock source remains active. By default, all peripheral modules continue to operate normally from the system clock source, but can also be selectively disabled (see Section 10.4 “Peripheral Module Disable”). • If the WDT or FSCM is enabled, the LPRC also remains active. The device wakes up from Sleep mode on any of the these events: • Any interrupt source that is individually enabled • Any form of device Reset • A WDT time-out On wake-up from Sleep mode, the processor restarts with the same clock source that was active when Sleep mode was entered. For optimal power savings, the internal regulator and the Flash regulator can be configured to go into standby when Sleep mode is entered by clearing the VREGS (RCON) and VREGSF (RCON) bits (default configuration). If the application requires a faster wake-up time, and can accept higher current requirements, the VREGS (RCON) and VREGSF (RCON) bits can be set to keep the internal regulator and the Flash regulator active during Sleep mode. DS70005258C-page 118 The device wakes from Idle mode on any of these events: • Any interrupt that is individually enabled • Any device Reset • A WDT time-out On wake-up from Idle mode, the clock is reapplied to the CPU and instruction execution will begin (two to four clock cycles later), starting with the instruction following the PWRSAV instruction or the first instruction in the ISR. All peripherals also have the option to discontinue operation when Idle mode is entered to allow for increased power savings. This option is selectable in the control register of each peripheral (for example, the TSIDL bit in the Timer1 Control register (T1CON). 10.2.3 INTERRUPTS COINCIDENT WITH POWER SAVE INSTRUCTIONS Any interrupt that coincides with the execution of a PWRSAV instruction is held off until entry into Sleep or Idle mode has completed. The device then wakes up from Sleep or Idle mode.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 10.3 Doze Mode 10.4 Peripheral Module Disable The preferred strategies for reducing power consumption are changing clock speed and invoking one of the power-saving modes. In some circumstances, this cannot be practical. For example, it may be necessary for an application to maintain uninterrupted synchronous communication, even while it is doing nothing else. Reducing system clock speed can introduce communication errors, while using a power-saving mode can stop communications completely. The Peripheral Module Disable (PMD) registers provide a method to disable a peripheral module by stopping all clock sources supplied to that module. When a peripheral is disabled using the appropriate PMD control bit, the peripheral is in a minimum power consumption state. The control and status registers associated with the peripheral are also disabled, so writes to those registers do not have any effect and read values are invalid. Doze mode is a simple and effective alternative method to reduce power consumption while the device is still executing code. In this mode, the system clock continues to operate from the same source and at the same speed. Peripheral modules continue to be clocked at the same speed, while the CPU clock speed is reduced. Synchronization between the two clock domains is maintained, allowing the peripherals to access the SFRs while the CPU executes code at a slower rate. A peripheral module is enabled only if both the associated bit in the PMD register is cleared and the peripheral is supported by the specific dsPIC® DSC variant. If the peripheral is present in the device, it is enabled in the PMD register by default. Doze mode is enabled by setting the DOZEN bit (CLKDIV). The ratio between peripheral and core clock speed is determined by the DOZE bits (CLKDIV). There are eight possible configurations, from 1:1 to 1:128, with 1:1 being the default setting. Programs can use Doze mode to selectively reduce power consumption in event-driven applications. This allows clock-sensitive functions, such as synchronous communications, to continue without interruption while the CPU Idles, waiting for something to invoke an interrupt routine. An automatic return to full-speed CPU operation on interrupts can be enabled by setting the ROI bit (CLKDIV). By default, interrupt events have no effect on Doze mode operation.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Note: 10.5 If a PMD bit is set, the corresponding module is disabled after a delay of one instruction cycle. Similarly, if a PMD bit is cleared, the corresponding module is enabled after a delay of one instruction cycle (assuming the module control registers are already configured to enable module operation). Power-Saving Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 10.5.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Watchdog Timer and Power-Saving Modes” (DS70615) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools DS70005258C-page 119 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-1: PMD1: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 1 R/W-0 T5MD bit 15 R/W-0 T4MD R/W-0 I2C1MD bit 7 R/W-0 U2MD bit 14 bit 13 bit 12 bit 11 bit 10 bit 9 bit 8 bit 7 bit 6 bit 5 bit 4 bit 3 bit 2 R/W-0 T2MD R/W-0 T1MD U-0 — R/W-0 PWMMD U-0 — bit 8 Legend: R = Readable bit -n = Value at POR bit 15 R/W-0 T3MD R/W-0 U1MD R/W-0 SPI2MD W = Writable bit ‘1’ = Bit is set R/W-0 SPI1MD R/W-0 C2MD R/W-0 C1MD R/W-0 ADCMD bit 0 U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown T5MD: Timer5 Module Disable bit 1 = Timer5 module is disabled 0 = Timer5 module is enabled T4MD: Timer4 Module Disable bit 1 = Timer4 module is disabled 0 = Timer4 module is enabled T3MD: Timer3 Module Disable bit 1 = Timer3 module is disabled 0 = Timer3 module is enabled T2MD: Timer2 Module Disable bit 1 = Timer2 module is disabled 0 = Timer2 module is enabled T1MD: Timer1 Module Disable bit 1 = Timer1 module is disabled 0 = Timer1 module is enabled Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ PWMMD: PWM Module Disable bit 1 = PWM module is disabled 0 = PWM module is enabled Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ I2C1MD: I2C1 Module Disable bit 1 = I2C1 module is disabled 0 = I2C1 module is enabled U2MD: UART2 Module Disable bit 1 = UART2 module is disabled 0 = UART2 module is enabled U1MD: UART1 Module Disable bit 1 = UART1 module is disabled 0 = UART1 module is enabled SPI2MD: SPI2 Module Disable bit 1 = SPI2 module is disabled 0 = SPI2 module is enabled SPI1MD: SPI1 Module Disable bit 1 = SPI1 module is disabled 0 = SPI1 module is enabled C2MD: CAN2 Module Disable bit 1 = CAN2 module is disabled 0 = CAN2 module is enabled DS70005258C-page 120  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-1: bit 1 bit 0 PMD1: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 1 (CONTINUED) C1MD: CAN1 Module Disable bit 1 = CAN1 module is disabled 0 = CAN1 module is enabled ADCMD: ADC Module Disable bit 1 = ADC module is disabled 0 = ADC module is enabled  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 121 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-2: PMD2: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 2 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — IC4MD IC3MD IC2MD IC1MD bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — OC4MD OC3MD OC2MD OC1MD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 IC4MD: Input Capture 4 Module Disable bit 1 = Input Capture 4 module is disabled 0 = Input Capture 4 module is enabled bit 10 IC3MD: Input Capture 3 Module Disable bit 1 = Input Capture 3 module is disabled 0 = Input Capture 3 module is enabled bit 9 IC2MD: Input Capture 2 Module Disable bit 1 = Input Capture 2 module is disabled 0 = Input Capture 2 module is enabled bit 8 IC1MD: Input Capture 1 Module Disable bit 1 = Input Capture 1 module is disabled 0 = Input Capture 1 module is enabled bit 7-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 OC4MD: Output Compare 4 Module Disable bit 1 = Output Compare 4 module is disabled 0 = Output Compare 4 module is enabled bit 2 OC3MD: Output Compare 3 Module Disable bit 1 = Output Compare 3 module is disabled 0 = Output Compare 3 module is enabled bit 1 OC2MD: Output Compare 2 Module Disable bit 1 = Output Compare 2 module is disabled 0 = Output Compare 2 module is enabled bit 0 OC1MD: Output Compare 1 Module Disable bit 1 = Output Compare 1 module is disabled 0 = Output Compare 1 module is enabled DS70005258C-page 122 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-3: PMD3: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 3 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — CMPMD — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 — — — — — — I2C2MD — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10 CMPMD: Comparator Module Disable bit 1 = Comparator module is disabled 0 = Comparator module is enabled bit 9-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 I2C2MD: I2C2 Module Disable bit 1 = I2C2 module is disabled 0 = I2C2 module is enabled bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ REGISTER 10-4: x = Bit is unknown PMD4: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 4 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — REFOMD — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 REFOMD: Reference Clock Module Disable bit 1 = Reference clock module is disabled 0 = Reference clock module is enabled bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 123 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-5: PMD6: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 6 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PWM8MD PWM7MD PWM6MD PWM5MD PWM4MD PWM3MD PWM2MD PWM1MD bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — — — — — SPI3MD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 PWM8MD: PWM8 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM8 module is disabled 0 = PWM8 module is enabled bit 14 PWM7MD: PWM7 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM7 module is disabled 0 = PWM7 module is enabled bit 13 PWM6MD: PWM6 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM6 module is disabled 0 = PWM6 module is enabled bit 12 PWM5MD: PWM5 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM5 module is disabled 0 = PWM5 module is enabled bit 11 PWM4MD: PWM4 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM4 module is disabled 0 = PWM4 module is enabled bit 10 PWM3MD: PWM3 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM3 module is disabled 0 = PWM3 module is enabled bit 9 PWM2MD: PWM2 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM2 module is disabled 0 = PWM2 module is enabled bit 8 PWM1MD: PWM1 Module Disable bit 1 = PWM1 module is disabled 0 = PWM1 module is enabled bit 7-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 SPI3MD: SPI3 Module Disable bit 1 = SPI3 module is disabled 0 = SPI3 module is enabled DS70005258C-page 124 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-6: PMD7: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 7 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — CMP4MD CMP3MD CMP2MD CMP1MD bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 — — — DMAMD PTGMD — PGA1MD — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 CMP4MD: CMP4 Module Disable bit 1 = CMP4 module is disabled 0 = CMP4 module is enabled bit 10 CMP3MD: CMP3 Module Disable bit 1 = CMP3 module is disabled 0 = CMP3 module is enabled bit 9 CMP2MD: CMP2 Module Disable bit 1 = CMP2 module is disabled 0 = CMP2 module is enabled bit 8 CMP1MD: CMP1 Module Disable bit 1 = CMP1 module is disabled 0 = CMP1 module is enabled bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 DMAMD: DMA Module Disable bit 1 = DMA module is disabled 0 = DMA module is enabled bit 3 PTGMD: PTG Module Disable bit 1 = PTG module is disabled 0 = PTG module is enabled bit 2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 PGA1MD: PGA1 Module Disable bit 1 = PGA1 module is disabled 0 = PGA1 module is enabled bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 125 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 10-7: PMD8: PERIPHERAL MODULE DISABLE CONTROL REGISTER 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — PGA2MD — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 — — CLC4MD CLC3MD CLC2MD CLC1MD CCSMD — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10 PGA2MD: PGA2 Module Disable bit 1 = PGA2 module is disabled 0 = PGA2 module is enabled bit 9-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5 CLC4MD: CLC4 Module Disable bit 1 = CLC4 module is disabled 0 = CLC4 module is enabled bit 4 CLC3MD: CLC3 Module Disable bit 1 = CLC3 module is disabled 0 = CLC3 module is enabled bit 3 CLC2MD: CLC2 Module Disable bit 1 = CLC2 module is disabled 0 = CLC2 module is enabled bit 2 CLC1MD: CLC1 Module Disable bit 1 = CLC1 module is disabled 0 = CLC1 module is enabled bit 1 CCSMD: Constant-Current Source Module Disable bit 1 = Constant-current source module is disabled 0 = Constant-current source module is enabled bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS70005258C-page 126 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.0 I/O PORTS which a port’s digital output can drive the input of a peripheral that shares the same pin. Figure 11-1 illustrates how ports are shared with other peripherals and the associated I/O pin to which they are connected. Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “I/O Ports” (DS70000598) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). When a peripheral is enabled and the peripheral is actively driving an associated pin, the use of the pin as a general purpose output pin is disabled. The I/O pin can be read, but the output driver for the parallel port bit is disabled. If a peripheral is enabled, but the peripheral is not actively driving a pin, that pin can be driven by a port. 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. Many of the device pins are shared among the peripherals and the Parallel I/O ports. All I/O input ports feature Schmitt Trigger inputs for improved noise immunity. 11.1 Parallel I/O (PIO) Ports Generally, a Parallel I/O port that shares a pin with a peripheral is subservient to the peripheral. The peripheral’s output buffer data and control signals are provided to a pair of multiplexers. The multiplexers select whether the peripheral or the associated port has ownership of the output data and control signals of the I/O pin. The logic also prevents “loop through”, in FIGURE 11-1: All port pins have eight registers directly associated with their operation as digital I/Os. The Data Direction register (TRISx) determines whether the pin is an input or an output. If the data direction bit is a ‘1’, then the pin is an input. All port pins are defined as inputs after a Reset. Reads from the latch (LATx), read the latch. Writes to the latch, write the latch. Reads from the port (PORTx), read the port pins, while writes to the port pins, write the latch. Any bit and its associated data and control registers that are not valid for a particular device are disabled. This means the corresponding LATx and TRISx registers, and the port pin are read as zeros. Table 11-1 through Table 11-5 show ANSELx bits’ availability for device variants. When a pin is shared with another peripheral or function that is defined as an input only, it is nevertheless regarded as a dedicated port because there is no other competing source of outputs. BLOCK DIAGRAM OF A TYPICAL SHARED PORT STRUCTURE Peripheral Module Output Multiplexers Peripheral Input Data Peripheral Module Enable Peripheral Output Enable Peripheral Output Data PIO Module WR TRISx Output Enable 0 1 Output Data 0 Read TRISx Data Bus I/O 1 D Q I/O Pin CK TRISx Latch D WR LATx + WR PORTx Q CK Data Latch Read LATx Input Data Read PORTx  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 127 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 11-1: PORTA PIN AND ANSELA AVAILABILITY PORTA I/O Pins Device RA15 RA14 RA13 RA12 RA11 RA10 RA9 RA8 RA7 RA6 RA5 RA4 RA3 RA2 RA1 RA0 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 — — — — — — — — — — — X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 — — — — — — — — — — — X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 — — — — — — — — — — — X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 — — — — — — — — — — — X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 — — — — — — — — — — — X X X X X ANSELA Bit Present — — — — — — — — — — — — — X X X TABLE 11-2: PORTB PIN AND ANSELB AVAILABILITY PORTB I/O Pins Device RB15 RB14 RB13 RB12 RB11 RB10 RB9 RB8 RB7 RB6 RB5 RB4 RB3 RB2 RB1 RB0 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 X X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 X X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 X X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 X X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 X X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X ANSELB Bit Present — — — — — — X — X X X — X X X X TABLE 11-3: PORTC PIN AND ANSELC AVAILABILITY PORTC I/O Pins Device RC15 RC14 RC13 RC12 RC11 RC10 RC9 RC8 RC7 RC6 RC5 RC4 RC3 RC2 RC1 RC0 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 X X X X — X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 — — X X — X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 — — X X — X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — ANSELC Bit Present — — — X — X X — — X X X — X X — TABLE 11-4: PORTD PIN AND ANSELD AVAILABILITY PORTD I/O Pins Device RD15 RD14 RD13 RD12 RD11 RD10 RD9 RD8 RD7 RD6 RD5 RD4 RD3 RD2 RD1 RD0 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 — X — — — X — — — — — X — — — — dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 — X — — — X — — — — — X — — — — dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — ANSELD Bit Present — — X — — — — X X — X — — X — — TABLE 11-5: X PORTE PIN AND ANSELE AVAILABILITY Device PORTE I/O Pins RE15 RE14 RE13 RE12 RE11 RE10 RE9 RE8 RE7 RE6 RE5 RE4 RE3 RE2 RE1 RE0 dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — ANSELE Bit Present — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — DS70005258C-page 128  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. I/O Port Control Register Maps PORTA REGISTER MAP(1) TABLE 11-6: File Name Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 TRISA — — — — — — — — — — — TRISA PORTA — — — — — — — — — — — RA LATA — — — — — — — — — — — LATA ODCA — — — — — — — — — — — ODCA CNENA — — — — — — — — — — — CNIEA CNPUA — — — — — — — — — — — CNPUA CNPDA — — — — — — — — — — — ANSELA — — — — — — — — — — — Bit 0 CNPDA — — ANSA Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Note 1: Refer to Table 11-1 for bit availability on each pin count variant. PORTB REGISTER MAP(1) TABLE 11-7: File Name Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 TRISB TRISB — PORTB RB — RB LATB — LATB ODCB ODCB — ODCB CNENB CNIEB — CNIEB CNPUB CNPUB — CNPUB CNPDB CNPDB — CNPDB LATB ANSELB — — — — — — Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Note 1: Refer to Table 11-2 for bit availability on each pin count variant. Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 TRISB ANSB9 — ANSB — ANSB Bit 0 DS70005258C-page 129 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 11.2 File Name Bit 15 PORTC REGISTER MAP(1) Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 TRISC TRISC — PORTC RC — RC LATC — LATC ODCC ODCC — ODCC CNENC CNIEC — CNIEC CNPUC CNPUC — CNPUC CNPDC CNPDC — LATC ANSELC — — — ANSC12 — Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 TRISC CNPDC ANSC — — Bit 8 Bit 7 ANSC — ANSC — Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Note 1: Refer to Table 11-3 for bit availability on each pin count variant. TABLE 11-9: File Name Bit 15 PORTD REGISTER MAP(1) Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 TRISD Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 — ANSD5 — — ANSD2 — — RD LATD LATD ODCD ODCD CNEND CNIED CNPUD CNPUD CNPDD  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Bit 5 TRISD PORTD ANSELD Bit 6 CNPDD — — ANSD13 — — — Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Note 1: Refer to Table 11-4 for bit availability on each pin count variant. — ANSD dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY DS70005258C-page 130 TABLE 11-8: File Name Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 TRISE Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 — — — — — — — TRISE PORTE RE LATE LATE ODCE ODCE CNENE CNIEE CNPUE CNPUE CNPDE ANSELE Bit 6 CNPDE — — — — — — Legend: — = unimplemented, read as ‘0’. Note 1: Refer to Table 11-5 for bit availability on each pin count variant. — — — DS70005258C-page 131 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. TABLE 11-10: PORTE REGISTER MAP(1) dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.2.1 OPEN-DRAIN CONFIGURATION In addition to the PORTx, LATx and TRISx registers for data control, port pins can also be individually configured for either digital or open-drain output. This is controlled by the Open-Drain Control x register, ODCx, associated with each port. Setting any of the bits configures the corresponding pin to act as an open-drain output. The open-drain feature allows the generation of outputs other than VDD by using external pull-up resistors. The maximum open-drain voltage allowed on any pin is the same as the maximum VIH specification for that particular pin. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for the available 5V tolerant pins and Table 30-11 for the maximum VIH specification for each pin. 11.3 Configuring Analog and Digital Port Pins The ANSELx register controls the operation of the analog port pins. The port pins that are to function as analog inputs or outputs must have their corresponding ANSELx and TRISx bits set. In order to use port pins for I/O functionality with digital modules, such as timers, UARTs, etc., the corresponding ANSELx bit must be cleared. The ANSELx register has a default value of 0xFFFF; therefore, all pins that share analog functions are analog (not digital) by default. Pins with analog functions affected by the ANSELx registers are listed with a buffer type of analog in the Pinout I/O Descriptions (see Table 1-1). Table 11-1 through Table 11-5 show ANSELx bits’ availability for device variants. If the TRISx bit is cleared (output) while the ANSELx bit is set, the digital output level (VOH or VOL) is converted by an analog peripheral, such as the ADC module or comparator module. When the PORTx register is read, all pins configured as analog input channels are read as cleared (a low level). Pins configured as digital inputs do not convert an analog input. Analog levels on any pin, defined as a digital input (including the ANx pins), can cause the input buffer to consume current that exceeds the device specifications. DS70005258C-page 132 11.3.1 I/O PORT WRITE/READ TIMING One instruction cycle is required between a port direction change or port write operation and a read operation of the same port. Typically, this instruction would be a NOP, as shown in Example 11-1. 11.4 Input Change Notification (ICN) The Input Change Notification function of the I/O ports allows devices to generate interrupt requests to the processor in response to a Change-of-State (COS) on selected input pins. This feature can detect input Change-of-States, even in Sleep mode, when the clocks are disabled. Every I/O port pin can be selected (enabled) for generating an interrupt request on a Change-of-State. Three control registers are associated with the ICN functionality of each I/O port. The CNENx registers contain the ICN interrupt enable control bits for each of the input pins. Setting any of these bits enables an ICN interrupt for the corresponding pins. Each I/O pin also has a weak pull-up and a weak pull-down connected to it. The pull-ups and pulldowns act as a current source, or sink source, connected to the pin, and eliminate the need for external resistors when push button or keypad devices are connected. The pull-ups and pull-downs are enabled separately, using the CNPUx and the CNPDx registers, which contain the control bits for each of the pins. Setting any of the control bits enables the weak pull-ups and/or pull-downs for the corresponding pins. Note: Pull-ups and pull-downs on Input Change Notification pins should always be disabled when the port pin is configured as a digital output. EXAMPLE 11-1: PORT WRITE/READ EXAMPLE MOV 0xFF00, W0 MOV W0, TRISB NOP BTSS PORTB, #13 ; ; ; ; ; ; Configure PORTB as inputs and PORTB as outputs Delay 1 cycle Next Instruction  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.5 I/O Port Control Registers REGISTER 11-1: R/W-1 TRISx: PORTx DATA DIRECTION CONTROL REGISTER(1) R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 TRISx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 TRISx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown TRISx: PORTx Data Direction Control bits 1 = The pin is an input 0 = The pin is an output See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register. REGISTER 11-2: R/W-0 PORTx: I/O PORTx REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PORTx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PORTx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PORTx: I/O PORTx bits 1 = The pin data is ‘1’ 0 = The pin data is ‘0’ See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 133 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY LATx: PORTx DATA LATCH REGISTER(1) REGISTER 11-3: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LATx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LATx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown LATx: PORTx Data Latch bits 1 = The latch content is ‘1’ 0 = The latch content is ‘0’ See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register. ODCx: PORTx OPEN-DRAIN CONTROL REGISTER(1) REGISTER 11-4: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ODCx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ODCx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PORTx: PORTx Open-Drain Control bits 1 = The pin acts as an open-drain output pin if TRISx is ‘0’ 0 = The pin acts as a normal pin See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register. DS70005258C-page 134  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-5: R/W-0 CNENx: INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION INTERRUPT ENABLE x REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNIEx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNIEx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown CNIEx: Input Change Notification Interrupt Enable x bits 1 = Enables interrupt on input change 0 = Disables interrupt on input change See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register. REGISTER 11-6: R/W-0 CNPUx: INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION PULL-UP ENABLE x REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNPUx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNPUx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown CNPUx: Input Change Notification Pull-up Enable bits 1 = Enables pull-up on PORTx pin 0 = Disables pull-up on PORTx pin See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 135 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY CNPDx: INPUT CHANGE NOTIFICATION PULL-DOWN ENABLE x REGISTER(1) REGISTER 11-7: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNPDx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CNPDx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown CNPDx: Input Change Notification Pull-Down Enable x bits 1 = Enables pull-down on PORTx pin 0 = Disables pull-down on PORTx pin See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register. ANSELx: ANALOG SELECT CONTROL x REGISTER(1) REGISTER 11-8: R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 ANSx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 ANSx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown ANSx: Analog PORTx Enable bits 1 = Enables analog PORTx pin 0 = Enables digital PORTx pin See Table 11-1, Table 11-2, Table 11-3, Table 11-4 and Table 11-5 for individual bit availability in this register. DS70005258C-page 136  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.6 Peripheral Pin Select (PPS) A major challenge in general purpose devices is providing the largest possible set of peripheral features, while minimizing the conflict of features on I/O pins. The challenge is even greater on low pin count devices. In an application where more than one peripheral needs to be assigned to a single pin, inconvenient work arounds in application code, or a complete redesign, may be the only option. Peripheral Pin Select configuration provides an alternative to these choices by enabling peripheral set selection and placement on a wide range of I/O pins. By increasing the pinout options available on a particular device, users can better tailor the device to their entire application, rather than trimming the application to fit the device. The Peripheral Pin Select configuration feature operates over a fixed subset of digital I/O pins. Users may independently map the input and/or output of most digital peripherals to any one of these I/O pins. Hardware safeguards are included that prevent accidental or spurious changes to the peripheral mapping once it has been established. 11.6.1 AVAILABLE PINS The number of available pins is dependent on the particular device and its pin count. Pins that support the Peripheral Pin Select feature include the label, “RPn”, in their full pin designation, where “n” is the remappable pin number. “RP” is used to designate pins that support both remappable input and output functions. 11.6.2 AVAILABLE PERIPHERALS The peripherals managed by the Peripheral Pin Select are all digital only peripherals. These include general serial communications (UART and SPI), general purpose timer clock inputs, timer-related peripherals (input capture and output compare) and interrupt-on-change inputs.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. In comparison, some digital only peripheral modules are never included in the Peripheral Pin Select feature. This is because the peripheral’s function requires special I/O circuitry on a specific port and cannot be easily connected to multiple pins. One example includes I2C modules. A similar requirement excludes all modules with analog inputs, such as the ADC Converter. A key difference between remappable and nonremappable peripherals is that remappable peripherals are not associated with a default I/O pin. The peripheral must always be assigned to a specific I/O pin before it can be used. In contrast, non-remappable peripherals are always available on a default pin, assuming that the peripheral is active and not conflicting with another peripheral. When a remappable peripheral is active on a given I/O pin, it takes priority over all other digital I/Os and digital communication peripherals associated with the pin. Priority is given regardless of the type of peripheral that is mapped. Remappable peripherals never take priority over any analog functions associated with the pin. 11.6.3 CONTROLLING PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT Peripheral Pin Select features are controlled through two sets of SFRs: one to map peripheral inputs and one to map outputs. Because they are separately controlled, a particular peripheral’s input and output (if the peripheral has both) can be placed on any selectable function pin without constraint. The association of a peripheral to a peripheralselectable pin is handled in two different ways, depending on whether an input or output is being mapped. DS70005258C-page 137 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.6.4 11.6.4.1 INPUT MAPPING The inputs of the Peripheral Pin Select options are mapped on the basis of the peripheral. That is, a control register associated with a peripheral dictates the pin it will be mapped to. The RPINRx registers are used to configure peripheral input mapping (see Register 11-9 through Register 11-32). Each register contains sets of 8-bit fields, with each set associated with one of the remappable peripherals. Programming a given peripheral’s bit field with an appropriate 8-bit index value maps the RPn pin with the corresponding value, or internal signal, to that peripheral. See Table 11-11 for a list of available inputs. For example, Figure 11-2 illustrates remappable pin selection for the U1RX input. FIGURE 11-2: REMAPPABLE INPUT FOR U1RX U1RXR VSS 0 15 PWM4L U1RX Input to Peripheral 16 RP16 181 RP181 Note: For input only, Peripheral Pin Select functionality does not have priority over TRISx settings. Therefore, when configuring an RPn pin for input, the corresponding bit in the TRISx register must also be configured for input (set to ‘1’). DS70005258C-page 138 Virtual Connections The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices support six virtual RPn pins (RP176-RP181), which are identical in functionality to all other RPn pins, with the exception of pinouts. These six pins are internal to the devices and are not connected to a physical device pin. These pins provide a simple way for inter-peripheral connection without utilizing a physical pin. For example, the output of the analog comparator can be connected to RP176 and the PWM Fault input can be configured for RP176 as well. This configuration allows the analog comparator to trigger PWM Faults without the use of an actual physical pin on the device. TABLE 11-11: REMAPPABLE SOURCES Remap Index Output Function 0 VSS 1 CMP1 2 CMP2 3 CMP3 4 CMP4 5 PWM4H 6 PTGO30 7 PTGO31 8-11 Reserved 12 REFO 13 SYNCO1 14 SYNCO2 15 PWM4L 16-20 RP16-RP20 21-31 Reserved 32-41 RP32-RP41 42 Reserved 43-58 RP43-RP58 59 Reserved 60-76 RP60-RP76 77-175 Reserved 176-181 RP176-RP181  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 11-12: SELECTABLE INPUT SOURCES (MAPS INPUT TO FUNCTION) Input Name(1) Function Name Register Configuration Bits INT1 RPINR0 INT1R External Interrupt 2 INT2 RPINR1 INT2R Timer1 External Clock T1CK RPINR2 T1CKR Timer2 External Clock T2CK RPINR3 T2CKR Timer3 External Clock T3CK RPINR3 T3CKR Input Capture 1 IC1 RPINR7 IC1R Input Capture 2 IC2 RPINR7 IC2R Input Capture 3 IC3 RPINR8 IC3R Input Capture 4 IC4 RPINR8 IC4R External Interrupt 1 Output Compare Fault A OCFA RPINR11 OCFAR PWM Fault 1 FLT1 RPINR12 FLT1R PWM Fault 2 FLT2 RPINR12 FLT2R PWM Fault 3 FLT3 RPINR13 FLT3R PWM Fault 4 UART1 Receive UART1 Clear-to-Send UART2 Receive UART2 Clear-to-Send FLT4 RPINR13 FLT4R U1RX RPINR18 U1RXR U1CTS RPINR18 U1CTSR U2RX RPINR19 U2RXR U2CTS RPINR19 U2CTSR SPI1 Data Input SDI1 RPINR20 SDI1R SPI1 Clock Input SCK1 RPINR20 SCK1R SS1 RPINR21 SS1R CAN1 Receive C1RX PRINR26 C1RXR CAN2 Receive C2RX PRINR26 C2RXR SPI3 Data Input SDI3 RPINR29 SDI3R SPI3 Clock Input SCK3 RPINR29 SCK3R SPI3 Slave Select SS3 RPINR30 SS3R SPI2 Data Input SDI2 RPINR22 SDI2R SPI2 Clock Input SCK2 RPINR22 SCK2R SPI2 Slave Select SS2 RPINR23 SS2R PWM Synchronous Input 1 SYNCI1 RPINR37 SYNCI1R PWM Synchronous Input 2 SYNCI2 RPINR38 SYNCI2R PWM Fault 5 FLT5 RPINR42 FLT5R PWM Fault 6 FLT6 RPINR42 FLT6R PWM Fault 7 FLT7 RPINR43 FLT7R PWM Fault 8 FLT8 RPINR43 FLT8R CLC Input A CLCINA RPINR45 CLCINA CLC Input B CLCINB RPINR46 CLCINB SPI1 Slave Select Note 1: Unless otherwise noted, all inputs use the Schmitt Trigger input buffers.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 139 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.6.5 11.6.5.1 OUTPUT MAPPING In contrast to inputs, the outputs of the Peripheral Pin Select options are mapped on the basis of the pin. In this case, a control register associated with a particular pin dictates the peripheral output to be mapped. The RPORx registers are used to control output mapping. Each register contains sets of 6-bit fields, with each set associated with one RPn pin (see Register 11-33 through Register 11-56). The value of the bit field corresponds to one of the peripherals and that peripheral’s output is mapped to the pin (see Table 11-13 and Figure 11-3). Mapping Limitations The control schema of the peripheral select pins is not limited to a small range of fixed peripheral configurations. There are no mutual or hardware-enforced lockouts between any of the peripheral mapping SFRs. Literally any combination of peripheral mappings, across any or all of the RPn pins, is possible. This includes both many-to-one and one-to-many mappings of peripheral inputs, and outputs to pins. While such mappings may be technically possible from a configuration point of view, they may not be supportable from an electrical point of view. A null output is associated with the output register Reset value of ‘0’. This is done to ensure that remappable outputs remain disconnected from all output pins by default. FIGURE 11-3: MULTIPLEXING REMAPPABLE OUTPUTS FOR RPn RPnR Default U1TX Output SDO2 Output 0 1 2 Output Data CLC3OUT Output CLC4OUT Output DS70005258C-page 140 RPn 65 66  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 11-13: OUTPUT SELECTION FOR REMAPPABLE PINS (RPn) Function RPnR Output Name Default PORT 0000000 RPn tied to Default Pin U1TX 0000001 RPn tied to UART1 Transmit U1RTS 0000010 RPn tied to UART1 Request-to-Send U2TX 0000011 RPn tied to UART2 Transmit U2RTS 0000100 RPn tied to UART2 Request-to-Send SDO1 0000101 RPn tied to SPI1 Data Output SCK1 0000110 RPn tied to SPI1 Clock Output SS1 0000111 RPn tied to SPI1 Slave Select SDO2 0001000 RPn tied to SPI2 Data Output SCK2 0001001 RPn tied to SPI2 Clock Output SS2 0001010 RPn tied to SPI2 Slave Select C1TX 0001110 RPn tied to CAN1 Transmit C2TX 0001111 RPn tied to CAN2 Transmit OC1 0010000 RPn tied to Output Compare 1 Output OC2 0010001 RPn tied to Output Compare 2 Output OC3 0010010 RPn tied to Output Compare 3 Output OC4 0010011 RPn tied to Output Compare 4 Output ACMP1 0011000 RPn tied to Analog Comparator 1 Output ACMP2 0011001 RPn tied to Analog Comparator 2 Output ACMP3 0011010 RPn tied to Analog Comparator 3 Output SDO3 0011111 RPn tied to SPI3 Data Output SCK3 0100000 RPn tied to SPI3 Clock Output SS3 0100001 RPn tied to SPI3 Slave Select SYNCO1 0101101 RPn tied to PWM Primary Master Time Base Sync Output SYNCO2 0101110 RPn tied to PWM Secondary Master Time Base Sync Output REFCLKO 0110001 RPn tied to Reference Clock Output ACMP4 0110010 RPn tied to Analog Comparator 4 Output PWM4H 0110011 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 4 PWM4L 0110100 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 4 PWM5H 0110101 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 5 PWM5L 0110110 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 5 PWM6H 0111001 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 6 PWM6L 0111010 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 6 PWM7H 0111011 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 7 PWM7L 0111100 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 7 PWM8H 0111101 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 8 PWM8L 0111110 RPn tied to PWM Output Pins Associated with PWM Generator 8 CLC1OUT 0111111 RPn tied to CLC1 Output CLC2OUT 1000000 RPn tied to CLC2 Output CLC3OUT(1) 1000001 RPn tied to CLC3 Output CLC4OUT(1) 1000010 RPn tied to CLC4 Output Note 1: PPS outputs are only available on dsPIC33EPXXXGS702 (28-pin) devices.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 141 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.7 1. 2. I/O Helpful Tips In some cases, certain pins, as defined in Table 30-11 under “Injection Current”, have internal protection diodes to VDD and VSS. The term, “Injection Current”, is also referred to as “Clamp Current”. On designated pins, with sufficient external current-limiting precautions by the user, I/O pin input voltages are allowed to be greater or less than the data sheet absolute maximum ratings, with respect to the VSS and VDD supplies. Note that when the user application forward biases either of the high or low-side internal input clamp diodes, that the resulting current being injected into the device, that is clamped internally by the VDD and VSS power rails, may affect the ADC accuracy by four to six counts. I/O pins that are shared with any analog input pin (i.e., ANx) are always analog pins, by default, after any Reset. Consequently, configuring a pin as an analog input pin automatically disables the digital input pin buffer and any attempt to read the digital input level by reading PORTx or LATx will always return a ‘0’, regardless of the digital logic level on the pin. To use a pin as a digital I/O pin on a shared ANx pin, the user application needs to configure the Analog Pin Configuration registers (i.e., ANSELx) in the I/O ports module by setting the appropriate bit that corresponds to that I/O port pin to a ‘0’. Note: Although it is not possible to use a digital input pin when its analog function is enabled, it is possible to use the digital I/O output function, TRISx = 0x0, while the analog function is also enabled. However, this is not recommended, particularly if the analog input is connected to an external analog voltage source, which would create signal contention between the analog signal and the output pin driver. DS70005258C-page 142 3. 4. 5. Most I/O pins have multiple functions. Referring to the device pin diagrams in this data sheet, the priorities of the functions allocated to any pins are indicated by reading the pin name from left-to-right. The left most function name takes precedence over any function to its right in the naming convention. For example: AN16/T2CK/T7CK/RC1; this indicates that AN16 is the highest priority in this example and will supersede all other functions to its right in the list. Those other functions to its right, even if enabled, would not work as long as any other function to its left was enabled. This rule applies to all of the functions listed for a given pin. Each pin has an internal weak pull-up resistor and pull-down resistor that can be configured using the CNPUx and CNPDx registers, respectively. These resistors eliminate the need for external resistors in certain applications. The internal pull-up is up to ~(VDD – 0.8), not VDD. This value is still above the minimum VIH of CMOS and TTL devices. When driving LEDs directly, the I/O pin can source or sink more current than what is specified in the VOH/IOH and VOL/IOL DC characteristics specification. The respective IOH and IOL current rating only applies to maintaining the corresponding output at or above the VOH, and at or below the VOL levels. However, for LEDs, unlike digital inputs of an externally connected device, they are not governed by the same minimum VIH/VIL levels. An I/O pin output can safely sink or source any current less than that listed in the Absolute Maximum Ratings in Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics”of this data sheet. For example: VOH = 2.4V @ IOH = -8 mA and VDD = 3.3V The maximum output current sourced by any 8 mA I/O pin = 12 mA. LED source current < 12 mA is technically permitted. Refer to the VOH/IOH graphs in Section 31.0 “DC and AC Device Characteristics Graphs” for additional information.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 6. The Peripheral Pin Select (PPS) pin mapping rules are as follows: a) Only one “output” function can be active on a given pin at any time, regardless if it is a dedicated or remappable function (one pin, one output). b) It is possible to assign a “remappable output” function to multiple pins and externally short or tie them together for increased current drive. c) If any “dedicated output” function is enabled on a pin, it will take precedence over any remappable “output” function. d) If any “dedicated digital” (input or output) function is enabled on a pin, any number of “input” remappable functions can be mapped to the same pin. e) If any “dedicated analog” function(s) are enabled on a given pin, “digital input(s)” of any kind will all be disabled, although a single “digital output”, at the user’s cautionary discretion, can be enabled and active as long as there is no signal contention with an external analog input signal. For example, it is possible for the ADC to convert the digital output logic level, or to toggle a digital output on a comparator or ADC input, provided there is no external analog input, such as for a built-in self-test. f) Any number of “input” remappable functions can be mapped to the same pin(s) at the same time, including to any pin with a single output from either a dedicated or remappable “output”. g) The TRISx registers control only the digital I/O output buffer. Any other dedicated or remappable active “output” will automatically override the TRISx setting. The TRISx register does not control the digital logic “input” buffer. Remappable digital “inputs” do not automatically override TRISx settings, which means that the TRISx bit must be set to input for pins with only remappable input function(s) assigned. h) All analog pins are enabled by default after any Reset and the corresponding digital input buffer on the pin has been disabled. Only the Analog Pin Select (ANSELx) registers control the digital input buffer, not the TRISx register. The user must disable the analog function on a pin using the Analog Pin Select registers in order to use any “digital input(s)” on a corresponding pin, no exceptions.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 11.8 I/O Ports Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 11.8.1 KEY RESOURCES • “I/O Ports” (DS70000598) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools DS70005258C-page 143 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 11.9 Peripheral Pin Select Registers REGISTER 11-9: RPINR0: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 INT1R7 INT1R6 INT1R5 INT1R4 INT1R3 INT1R2 INT1R1 INT1R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 INT1R: Assign External Interrupt 1 (INT1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ REGISTER 11-10: RPINR1: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 INT2R7 INT2R6 INT2R5 INT2R4 INT2R3 INT2R2 INT2R1 INT2R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 INT2R: Assign External Interrupt 2 (INT2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. DS70005258C-page 144  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-11: RPINR2: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 2 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 T1CKR7 T1CKR6 T1CKR5 T1CKR4 T1CKR3 T1CKR2 T1CKR1 T1CKR0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 T1CKR: Assign Timer1 External Clock (T1CK) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ REGISTER 11-12: RPINR3: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 3 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 T3CKR7 T3CKR6 T3CKR5 T3CKR4 T3CKR3 T3CKR2 T3CKR1 T3CKR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 T2CKR7 T2CKR6 T2CKR5 T2CKR4 T2CKR3 T2CKR2 T2CKR1 T2CKR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 T3CKR: Assign Timer3 External Clock (T3CK) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 T2CKR: Assign Timer2 External Clock (T2CK) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 145 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-13: RPINR7: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 7 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IC2R7 IC2R6 IC2R5 IC2R4 IC2R3 IC2R2 IC2R1 IC2R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IC1R7 IC1R6 IC1R5 IC1R4 IC1R3 IC1R2 IC1R1 IC1R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 IC2R: Assign Input Capture 2 (IC2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 IC1R: Assign Input Capture 1 (IC1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-14: RPINR8: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IC4R7 IC4R6 IC4R5 IC4R4 IC4R3 IC4R2 IC4R1 IC4R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IC3R7 IC3R6 IC3R5 IC3R4 IC3R3 IC3R2 IC3R1 IC3R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 IC4R: Assign Input Capture 4 (IC4) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 IC3R: Assign Input Capture 3 (IC3) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. DS70005258C-page 146  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-15: RPINR11: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 11 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 OCFAR7 OCFAR6 OCFAR5 OCFAR4 OCFAR3 OCFAR2 OCFAR1 OCFAR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 OCFAR: Assign Output Compare Fault A (OCFA) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-16: RPINR12: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 12 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT2R7 FLT2R6 FLT2R5 FLT2R4 FLT2R3 FLT2R2 FLT2R1 FLT2R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT1R7 FLT1R6 FLT1R5 FLT1R4 FLT1R3 FLT1R2 FLT1R1 FLT1R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 FLT2R: Assign PWM Fault 2 (FLT2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 FLT1R: Assign PWM Fault 1 (FLT1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 147 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-17: RPINR13: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 13 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT4R7 FLT4R6 FLT4R5 FLT4R4 FLT4R3 FLT4R2 FLT4R1 FLT4R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT3R7 FLT3R6 FLT3R5 FLT3R4 FLT3R3 FLT3R2 FLT3R1 FLT3R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 FLT4R: Assign PWM Fault 4 (FLT4) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 FLT3R: Assign PWM Fault 3 (FLT3) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-18: RPINR18: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 18 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U1CTSR7 U1CTSR6 U1CTSR5 U1CTSR4 U1CTSR3 U1CTSR2 U1CTSR1 U1CTSR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U1RXR7 U1RXR6 U1RXR5 U1RXR4 U1RXR3 U1RXR2 U1RXR1 U1RXR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 U1CTSR: Assign UART1 Clear-to-Send (U1CTS) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 U1RXR: Assign UART1 Receive (U1RX) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. DS70005258C-page 148  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-19: RPINR19: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 19 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U2CTSR7 U2CTSR6 U2CTSR5 U2CTSR4 U2CTSR3 U2CTSR2 U2CTSR1 U2CTSR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U2RXR7 U2RXR6 U2RXR5 U2RXR4 U2RXR3 U2RXR2 U2RXR1 U2RXR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 U2CTSR: Assign UART2 Clear-to-Send (U2CTS) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 U2RXR: Assign UART2 Receive (U2RX) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-20: RPINR20: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 20 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SCK1INR7 SCK1INR6 SCK1INR5 SCK1INR4 SCK1INR3 SCK1INR2 SCK1INR1 SCK1INR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SDI1R7 SDI1R6 SDI1R5 SDI1R4 SDI1R3 SDI1R2 SDI1R1 SDI1R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 SCK1INR: Assign SPI1 Clock Input (SCK1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 SDI1R: Assign SPI1 Data Input (SDI1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 149 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-21: RPINR21: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 21 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SS1R7 SS1R6 SS1R5 SS1R4 SS1R3 SS1R2 SS1R1 SS1R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 SS1R: Assign SPI1 Slave Select (SS1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-22: RPINR22: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 22 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SCK2INR7 SCK2INR6 SCK2INR5 SCK2INR4 SCK2INR3 SCK2INR2 SCK2INR1 SCK2INR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SDI2R7 SDI2R6 SDI2R5 SDI2R4 SDI2R3 SDI2R2 SDI2R1 SDI2R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 SCK2INR: Assign SPI2 Clock Input (SCK2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 SDI2R: Assign SPI2 Data Input (SDI2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. DS70005258C-page 150  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-23: RPINR23: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 23 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SS2R7 SS2R6 SS2R5 SS2R4 SS2R3 SS2R2 SS2R1 SS2R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 SS2R: Assign SPI2 Slave Select (SS2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-24: RPINR26: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 26 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 C2RXR7 C2RXR6 C2RXR5 C2RXR4 C2RXR3 C2RXR2 C2RXR1 C2RXR0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 C1RXR7 C1RXR6 C1RXR5 C1RXR4 C1RXR3 C1RXR2 C1RXR1 C1RXR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 C2RXR: Assign CAN2 Receive (C2RX) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 C1RXR: Assign CAN1 Receive (C1RX) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 151 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-25: RPINR29: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 29 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SCK3R7 SCK3R6 SCK3R5 SCK3R4 SCK3R3 SCK3R2 SCK3R1 SCK3R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SDI3R7 SDI3R6 SDI3R5 SDI3R4 SDI3R3 SDI3R2 SDI3R1 SDI3R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 SCK3R: Assign SPI3 Clock Input (SCK3) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 SDI3R: Assign SPI3 Data Input (SDI3) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-26: RPINR30: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 30 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SS3R7 SS3R6 SS3R5 SS3R4 SS3R3 SS3R2 SS3R1 SS3R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 SS3R: Assign SPI3 Slave Select (SS3) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. DS70005258C-page 152  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-27: RPINR37: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 37 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SYNCI1R7 SYNCI1R6 SYNCI1R5 SYNCI1R4 SYNCI1R3 SYNCI1R2 SYNCI1R1 SYNCI1R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 SYNCI1R: Assign PWM Synchronization Input 1 (SYNCI1) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ REGISTER 11-28: RPINR38: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 38 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SYNCI2R7 SYNCI2R6 SYNCI2R5 SYNCI2R4 SYNCI2R3 SYNCI2R2 SYNCI2R1 SYNCI2R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 SYNCI2R: Assign PWM Synchronization Input 2 (SYNCI2) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 153 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-29: RPINR42: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 42 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT6R7 FLT6R6 FLT6R5 FLT6R4 FLT6R3 FLT6R2 FLT6R1 FLT6R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT5R7 FLT5R6 FLT5R5 FLT5R4 FLT5R3 FLT5R2 FLT5R1 FLT5R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 FLT6R: Assign PWM Fault 6 (FLT6) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 FLT5R: Assign PWM Fault 5 (FLT5) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. REGISTER 11-30: RPINR43: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 43 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT8R7 FLT8R6 FLT8R5 FLT8R4 FLT8R3 FLT8R2 FLT8R1 FLT8R0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLT7R7 FLT7R6 FLT7R5 FLT7R4 FLT7R3 FLT7R2 FLT7R1 FLT7R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 FLT8R: Assign PWM Fault 8 (FLT8) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 FLT7R: Assign PWM Fault 7 (FLT7) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. DS70005258C-page 154  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-31: RPINR45: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 45 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CLCINAR7 CLCINAR6 CLCINAR5 CLCINAR4 CLCINAR3 CLCINAR2 CLCINAR1 CLCINAR0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 CLCINAR: Assign CLC Input A (CLCINA) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value. bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ REGISTER 11-32: RPINR46: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT INPUT REGISTER 46 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CLCINBR7 CLCINBR6 CLCINBR5 CLCINBR4 CLCINBR3 CLCINBR2 CLCINBR1 CLCINBR0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-0 CLCINBR: Assign CLC Input B (CLCINB) to the Corresponding RPn Pin bits See Table 11-11 which contains a list of remappable inputs for the index value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 155 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-33: RPOR0: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP17R6 RP17R5 RP17R4 RP17R3 RP17R2 RP17R1 RP17R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP16R6 RP16R5 RP16R4 RP16R3 RP16R2 RP16R1 RP16R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP17R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP17 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP16R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP16 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-34: RPOR1: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 1 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP19R6 RP19R5 RP19R4 RP19R3 RP19R2 RP19R1 RP19R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP18R6 RP18R5 RP18R4 RP18R3 RP18R2 RP18R1 RP18R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP19R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP19 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP18R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP18 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 156  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-35: RPOR2: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 2 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP32R6 RP32R5 RP32R4 RP32R3 RP32R2 RP32R1 RP32R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP20R6 RP20R5 RP20R4 RP20R3 RP20R2 RP20R1 RP20R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP32R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP32 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP20R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP20 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-36: RPOR3: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 3 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP34R6 RP34R5 RP34R4 RP34R3 RP34R2 RP34R1 RP34R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP33R6 RP33R5 RP33R4 RP33R3 RP33R2 RP33R1 RP33R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP34R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP34 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP33R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP33 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 157 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-37: RPOR4: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 4 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP36R6 RP36R5 RP36R4 RP36R3 RP36R2 RP36R1 RP36R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP35R6 RP35R5 RP35R4 RP35R3 RP35R2 RP35R1 RP35R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP36R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP36 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP35R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP35 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-38: RPOR5: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 5 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP38R6 RP38R5 RP38R4 RP38R3 RP38R2 RP38R1 RP38R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP37R6 RP37R5 RP37R4 RP37R3 RP37R2 RP37R1 RP37R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP38R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP38 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP37R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP37 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 158  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-39: RPOR6: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 6 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP40R6 RP40R5 RP40R4 RP40R3 RP40R2 RP40R1 RP40R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP39R6 RP39R5 RP39R4 RP39R3 RP39R2 RP39R1 RP39R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP40R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP40 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP39R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP39 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-40: RPOR7: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 7 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP43R6 RP43R5 RP43R4 RP43R3 RP43R2 RP43R1 RP43R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP41R6 RP41R5 RP41R4 RP41R3 RP41R2 RP41R1 RP41R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP43R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP43 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP41R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP41 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 159 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-41: RPOR8: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP45R6 RP45R5 RP45R4 RP45R3 RP45R2 RP45R1 RP45R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP44R6 RP44R5 RP44R4 RP44R3 RP44R2 RP44R1 RP44R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP45R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP45 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP44R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP44 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-42: RPOR9: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 9 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP47R6 RP47R5 RP47R4 RP47R3 RP47R2 RP47R1 RP47R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP46R6 RP46R5 RP46R4 RP46R3 RP46R2 RP46R1 RP46R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP47R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP47 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP46R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP46 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 160  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-43: RPOR10: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 10 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP49R6 RP49R5 RP49R4 RP49R3 RP49R2 RP49R1 RP49R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP48R6 RP48R5 RP48R4 RP48R3 RP48R2 RP48R1 RP48R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP49R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP49 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP48R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP48 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-44: RPOR11: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 11 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP51R6 RP51R5 RP51R4 RP51R3 RP51R2 RP51R1 RP51R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP50R6 RP50R5 RP50R4 RP50R3 RP50R2 RP50R1 RP50R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP51R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP51 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP50R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP50 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 161 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-45: RPOR12: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 12 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP53R6 RP53R5 RP53R4 RP53R3 RP53R2 RP53R1 RP53R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP52R6 RP52R5 RP52R4 RP52R3 RP52R2 RP52R1 RP52R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP53R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP53 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP52R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP52 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-46: RPOR13: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 13 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP55R6 RP55R5 RP55R4 RP55R3 RP55R2 RP55R1 RP55R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP54R6 RP54R5 RP54R4 RP54R3 RP54R2 RP54R1 RP54R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP55R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP55 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP54R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP54 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 162  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-47: RPOR14: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 14 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP57R6 RP57R5 RP57R4 RP57R3 RP57R2 RP57R1 RP57R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP56R6 RP56R5 RP56R4 RP56R3 RP56R2 RP56R1 RP56R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP57R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP57 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP56R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP56 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-48: RPOR15: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 15 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP60R6 RP60R5 RP60R4 RP60R3 RP60R2 RP60R1 RP60R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP58R6 RP58R5 RP58R4 RP58R3 RP58R2 RP58R1 RP58R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP60R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP60 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP58R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP58 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 163 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-49: RPOR16: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 16 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP62R6 RP62R5 RP62R4 RP62R3 RP62R2 RP62R1 RP62R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP61R6 RP61R5 RP61R4 RP61R3 RP61R2 RP61R1 RP61R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP62R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP62 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP61R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP61 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-50: RPOR17: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 17 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP64R6 RP64R5 RP64R4 RP64R3 RP64R2 RP64R1 RP64R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP63R6 RP63R5 RP63R4 RP63R3 RP63R2 RP63R1 RP63R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP64R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP64 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP63R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP63 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 164  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-51: RPOR18: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 18 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP66R6 RP66R5 RP66R4 RP66R3 RP66R2 RP66R1 RP66R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP65R6 RP65R5 RP65R4 RP65R3 RP65R2 RP65R1 RP65R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP66R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP66 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP65R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP65 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-52: RPOR19: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 19 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP68R6 RP68R5 RP68R4 RP68R3 RP68R2 RP68R1 RP68R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP67R6 RP67R5 RP67R4 RP67R3 RP67R2 RP67R1 RP67R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP68R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP68 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP67R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP67 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 165 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-53: RPOR20: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 20 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP70R6 RP70R5 RP70R4 RP70R3 RP70R2 RP70R1 RP70R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP69R6 RP69R5 RP69R4 RP69R3 RP69R2 RP69R1 RP69R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP70R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP70 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP69R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP69 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-54: RPOR21: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 21 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP72R6 RP72R5 RP72R4 RP72R3 RP72R2 RP72R1 RP72R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP71R6 RP71R5 RP71R4 RP71R3 RP71R2 RP71R1 RP71R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP72R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP72 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP71R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP71 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 166  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-55: RPOR22: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 22 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP74R6 RP74R5 RP74R4 RP74R3 RP74R2 RP74R1 RP74R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP73R6 RP73R5 RP73R4 RP73R3 RP73R2 RP73R1 RP73R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP74R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP74 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP73R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP73 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-56: RPOR23: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 23 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP76R6 RP76R5 RP76R4 RP76R3 RP76R2 RP76R1 RP76R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP75R6 RP75R5 RP75R4 RP75R3 RP75R2 RP75R1 RP75R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP76R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP76 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP75R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP75 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 167 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-57: RPOR24: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 24 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP177R6 RP177R5 RP177R4 RP177R3 RP177R2 RP177R1 RP177R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP176R6 RP176R5 RP176R4 RP176R3 RP176R2 RP176R1 RP176R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP177R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP177 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP176R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP176 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) REGISTER 11-58: RPOR25: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 25 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP179R6 RP179R5 RP179R4 RP179R3 RP179R2 RP179R1 RP179R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP178R6 RP178R5 RP178R4 RP178R3 RP178R2 RP178R1 RP178R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP179R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP179 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP178R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP178 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) DS70005258C-page 168  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 11-59: RPOR26: PERIPHERAL PIN SELECT OUTPUT REGISTER 26 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP181R6 RP181R5 RP181R4 RP181R3 RP181R2 RP181R1 RP181R0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — RP180R6 RP180R5 RP180R4 RP180R3 RP180R2 RP180R1 RP180R0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-8 RP181R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP181 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers) bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 RP180R: Peripheral Output Function is Assigned to RP180 Output Pin bits (see Table 11-13 for peripheral function numbers)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 169 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 170  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 12.0 TIMER1 The Timer1 module can operate in one of the following modes: Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Timers” (DS70362) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). • • • • In Timer and Gated Timer modes, the input clock is derived from the internal instruction cycle clock (FCY). In Synchronous and Asynchronous Counter modes, the input clock is derived from the external clock input at the T1CK pin. 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The Timer modes are determined by the following bits: • Timer1 Clock Source Select bit (TCS): T1CON • Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Select bit (TSYNC): T1CON • Timer1 Gated Time Accumulation Enable bit (TGATE): T1CON The Timer1 module is a 16-bit timer that can operate as a free-running interval timer/counter. Timer control bit settings for different operating modes are provided in Table 12-1. The Timer1 module has the following unique features over other timers: TABLE 12-1: • Can be Operated in Asynchronous Counter mode from an External Clock Source • The External Clock Input (T1CK) can Optionally be Synchronized to the Internal Device Clock and the Clock Synchronization is Performed after the prescaler TIMER1 MODE SETTINGS Mode A block diagram of Timer1 is shown in Figure 12-1. FIGURE 12-1: Timer mode Gated Timer mode Synchronous Counter mode Asynchronous Counter mode TCS TGATE TSYNC Timer 0 0 x Gated Timer 0 1 x Synchronous Counter 1 x 1 Asynchronous Counter 1 x 0 16-BIT TIMER1 MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM Falling Edge Detect Gate Sync 1 Set T1IF Flag 0 FP (1) 10 Prescaler (/n) T1CLK TGATE 00 TCKPS TMR1 Reset CLK 0 T1CK x1 Prescaler (/n) Sync TCKPS Note 1: Comparator 1 TSYNC Latch Data ADC Trigger Equal TGATE TCS PR1 FP is the peripheral clock.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 171 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 12.1 Timer1 Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. DS70005258C-page 172 12.1.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Timers” (DS70362) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 12.2 Timer1 Control Register REGISTER 12-1: T1CON: TIMER1 CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 TON(1) — TSIDL — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 — TGATE TCKPS1 TCKPS0 — TSYNC(1) TCS(1) — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 TON: Timer1 On bit(1) 1 = Starts 16-bit Timer1 0 = Stops 16-bit Timer1 bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 TSIDL: Timer1 Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12-7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 TGATE: Timer1 Gated Time Accumulation Enable bit When TCS = 1: This bit is ignored. When TCS = 0: 1 = Gated time accumulation is enabled 0 = Gated time accumulation is disabled bit 5-4 TCKPS: Timer1 Input Clock Prescale Select bits 11 = 1:256 10 = 1:64 01 = 1:8 00 = 1:1 bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2 TSYNC: Timer1 External Clock Input Synchronization Select bit(1) When TCS = 1: 1 = Synchronizes external clock input 0 = Does not synchronize external clock input When TCS = 0: This bit is ignored. bit 1 TCS: Timer1 Clock Source Select bit(1) 1 = External clock is from pin, T1CK (on the rising edge) 0 = Internal clock (FP) bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: x = Bit is unknown When Timer1 is enabled in External Synchronous Counter mode (TCS = 1, TSYNC = 1, TON = 1), any attempts by user software to write to the TMR1 register are ignored.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 173 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 174  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 13.0 TIMER2/3 AND TIMER4/5 Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Timers” (DS70362) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The Timer2/3 and Timer4/5 modules are 32-bit timers, which can also be configured as four independent 16-bit timers with selectable operating modes. As 32-bit timers, Timer2/3 and Timer4/5 operate in three modes: • Two Independent 16-Bit Timers (e.g., Timer2 and Timer3) with all 16-Bit Operating modes (except Asynchronous Counter mode) • Single 32-Bit Timer • Single 32-Bit Synchronous Counter They also support these features: • • • • • Timer Gate Operation Selectable Prescaler Settings Timer Operation during Idle and Sleep modes Interrupt on a 32-Bit Period Register Match Time Base for Input Capture and Output Compare modules (Timer2 and Timer3 only)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Individually, all four of the 16-bit timers can function as synchronous timers or counters. They also offer the features listed previously, except for the event trigger; this is implemented only with Timer2/3. The operating modes and enabled features are determined by setting the appropriate bit(s) in the T2CON, T3CON, T4CON and T5CON registers. T2CON and T4CON are shown in generic form in Register 13-1. T3CON and T5CON are shown in Register 13-2. For 32-bit timer/counter operation, Timer2 and Timer4 are the least significant word (lsw); Timer3 and Timer5 are the most significant word (msw) of the 32-bit timers. Note: For 32-bit operation, T3CON and T5CON control bits are ignored. Only T2CON and T4CON control bits are used for setup and control. Timer2 and Timer4 clock and gate inputs are utilized for the 32-bit timer modules, but an interrupt is generated with the Timer3 and Timer5 interrupt flags. A block diagram for an example 32-bit timer pair (Timer2/3 and Timer4/5) is shown in Figure 13-2. 13.1 Timer Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 13.1.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Timers” (DS70362) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools DS70005258C-page 175 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 13-1: TIMERx BLOCK DIAGRAM (x = 2 THROUGH 5) Falling Edge Detect Gate Sync 1 Set TxIF Flag 0 FP(1) 10 Prescaler (/n) TxCLK TGATE TMRx 00 TCKPS Prescaler (/n) Sync x1 Comparator ADC Trigger(2) Equal TGATE TCKPS TCS PRx FP is the peripheral clock. The ADC trigger is only available on TMR2. FIGURE 13-2: TYPE B/TYPE C TIMER PAIR BLOCK DIAGRAM (32-BIT TIMER) Falling Edge Detect Gate Sync 1 Set TyIF Flag PRx PRy FP(1) lsw 00 TCKPS Sync msw TMRx TGATE Data 10 Prescaler (/n) Prescaler (/n) 0 Equal Comparator TxCK Data Latch CLK TxCK Note 1: 2: Reset TMRy Latch CLK Reset x1 TMRyHLD TCKPS TGATE TCS Data Bus Note 1: 2: Timerx is a Type B timer (x = 2 and 4). Timery is a Type C timer (y = 3 and 5). DS70005258C-page 176  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 13.2 Timer2/3 and Timer4/5 Control Registers REGISTER 13-1: TxCON: (TIMER2 AND TIMER4) CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 TON — TSIDL — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 — TGATE TCKPS1 TCKPS0 T32 — TCS(1) — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 TON: Timerx On bit When T32 = 1: 1 = Starts 32-bit Timerx/y 0 = Stops 32-bit Timerx/y When T32 = 0: 1 = Starts 16-bit Timerx 0 = Stops 16-bit Timerx bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 TSIDL: Timerx Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12-7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 TGATE: Timerx Gated Time Accumulation Enable bit When TCS = 1: This bit is ignored. When TCS = 0: 1 = Gated time accumulation is enabled 0 = Gated time accumulation is disabled bit 5-4 TCKPS: Timerx Input Clock Prescale Select bits 11 = 1:256 10 = 1:64 01 = 1:8 00 = 1:1 bit 3 T32: 32-Bit Timer Mode Select bit 1 = Timerx and Timery form a single 32-bit timer 0 = Timerx and Timery act as two 16-bit timers bit 2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 TCS: Timerx Clock Source Select bit(1) 1 = External clock is from pin, TxCK (on the rising edge) 0 = Internal clock (FP) bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: x = Bit is unknown The TxCK pin is not available on all devices. Refer to the “Pin Diagrams” section for the available pins.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 177 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 13-2: TyCON: (TIMER3 AND TIMER5) CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 TON(1) — TSIDL(2) — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 — TGATE(1) TCKPS1(1) TCKPS0(1) — — TCS(1,3) — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 TON: Timery On bit(1) 1 = Starts 16-bit Timery 0 = Stops 16-bit Timery bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 TSIDL: Timery Stop in Idle Mode bit(2) 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12-7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 TGATE: Timery Gated Time Accumulation Enable bit(1) When TCS = 1: This bit is ignored. When TCS = 0: 1 = Gated time accumulation is enabled 0 = Gated time accumulation is disabled bit 5-4 TCKPS: Timery Input Clock Prescale Select bits(1) 11 = 1:256 10 = 1:64 01 = 1:8 00 = 1:1 bit 3-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 TCS: Timery Clock Source Select bit(1,3) 1 = External clock is from pin, TyCK (on the rising edge) 0 = Internal clock (FP) bit 0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: 3: When 32-bit operation is enabled (TxCON = 1), these bits have no effect on Timery operation; all timer functions are set through TxCON. When 32-bit timer operation is enabled (T32 = 1) in the Timerx Control register (TxCON), the TSIDL bit must be cleared to operate the 32-bit timer in Idle mode. The TyCK pin is not available on all devices. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for the available pins. DS70005258C-page 178  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 14.0 INPUT CAPTURE Key features of the input capture module include: Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Input Capture with Dedicated Timer” (DS70000352) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The input capture module is useful in applications requiring frequency (period) and pulse measurements. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices support four input capture channels. FIGURE 14-1: • Hardware-Configurable for 32-Bit Operation in All modes by Cascading Two Adjacent modules • Synchronous and Trigger modes of Output Compare Operation, with up to 21 User-Selectable Trigger/Sync Sources available • A 4-Level FIFO Buffer for Capturing and Holding Timer Values for Several Events • Configurable Interrupt Generation • Up to Six Clock Sources available for each module, Driving a Separate Internal 16-Bit Counter 14.1 Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 14.1.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Input Capture with Dedicated Timer” (DS70000352) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools INPUT CAPTURE x MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM ICM ICI Event and Interrupt Logic Edge Detect Logic and Clock Synchronizer Prescaler Counter 1:1/4/16 ICx Pin Input Capture Resources Set ICxIF ICTSEL Increment Clock Select ICx Clock Sources Trigger and Sync Sources Trigger and Reset Sync Logic SYNCSEL(1) Note 1: 16 ICxTMR 4-Level FIFO Buffer 16 16 ICxBUF ICOV, ICBNE System Bus The trigger/sync source is enabled by default and is set to Timer3 as a source. This timer must be enabled for proper ICx module operation or the trigger/sync source must be changed to another source option.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 179 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 14.2 Input Capture Registers REGISTER 14-1: ICxCON1: INPUT CAPTURE x CONTROL REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 — — ICSIDL ICTSEL2 ICTSEL1 ICTSEL0 — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 HC/HS/R-0 HC/HS/R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — ICI1 ICI0 ICOV ICBNE ICM2 ICM1 ICM0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HC = Hardware Clearable bit HS = Hardware Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 ICSIDL: Input Capture x Stop in Idle Control bit 1 = Input capture will halt in CPU Idle mode 0 = Input capture will continue to operate in CPU Idle mode bit 12-10 ICTSEL: Input Capture x Timer Select bits 111 = Peripheral clock (FP) is the clock source of the ICx 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = T1CLK is the clock source of the ICx (only the synchronous clock is supported) 011 = T5CLK is the clock source of the ICx 010 = T4CLK is the clock source of the ICx 001 = T2CLK is the clock source of the ICx 000 = T3CLK is the clock source of the ICx bit 9-7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-5 ICI: Number of Captures per Interrupt Select bits (this field is not used if ICM = 001 or 111) 11 = Interrupt on every fourth capture event 10 = Interrupt on every third capture event 01 = Interrupt on every second capture event 00 = Interrupt on every capture event bit 4 ICOV: Input Capture x Overflow Status Flag bit (read-only) 1 = Input capture buffer overflow has occurred 0 = No input capture buffer overflow has occurred bit 3 ICBNE: Input Capture x Buffer Not Empty Status bit (read-only) 1 = Input capture buffer is not empty, at least one more capture value can be read 0 = Input capture buffer is empty bit 2-0 ICM: Input Capture x Mode Select bits 111 = Input Capture x functions as an interrupt pin only in CPU Sleep and Idle modes (rising edge detect only, all other control bits are not applicable) 110 = Unused (module is disabled) 101 = Capture mode, every 16th rising edge (Prescaler Capture mode) 100 = Capture mode, every 4th rising edge (Prescaler Capture mode) 011 = Capture mode, every rising edge (Simple Capture mode) 010 = Capture mode, every falling edge (Simple Capture mode) 001 = Capture mode, every rising and falling edge (Edge Detect mode, ICI is not used in this mode) 000 = Input Capture x is turned off DS70005258C-page 180  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 14-2: ICxCON2: INPUT CAPTURE x CONTROL REGISTER 2 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — — — — — IC32 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 HS/R/W-0 U-0 ICTRIG(2) TRIGSTAT(3) — R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-1 SYNCSEL4(4) SYNCSEL3(4) SYNCSEL2(4) SYNCSEL1(4) SYNCSEL0(4) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HS = Hardware Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8 IC32: Input Capture x 32-Bit Timer Mode Select bit (Cascade mode) 1 = Odd ICx and even ICx form a single 32-bit input capture module(1) 0 = Cascade module operation is disabled bit 7 ICTRIG: Input Capture x Trigger Operation Select bit(2) 1 = Input source is used to trigger the input capture timer (Trigger mode) 0 = Input source is used to synchronize the input capture timer to a timer of another module (Synchronization mode) bit 6 TRIGSTAT: Timer Trigger Status bit(3) 1 = ICxTMR has been triggered and is running 0 = ICxTMR has not been triggered and is being held clear bit 5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: The IC32 bit in both the odd and even ICx must be set to enable Cascade mode. The input source is selected by the SYNCSEL bits of the ICxCON2 register. This bit is set by the selected input source (selected by SYNCSEL bits); it can be read, set and cleared in software. Do not use the ICx module as its own sync or trigger source. This option should only be selected as a trigger source and not as a synchronization source.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 181 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 14-2: ICxCON2: INPUT CAPTURE x CONTROL REGISTER 2 (CONTINUED) SYNCSEL: Input Source Select for Synchronization and Trigger Operation bits(4) 11111 = No sync or trigger source for ICx 11110 = Reserved 11101 = Reserved 11100 = Reserved 11011 = CMP4 module synchronizes or triggers ICx(5) 11010 = CMP3 module synchronizes or triggers ICx(5) 11001 = CMP2 module synchronizes or triggers ICx(5) 11000 = CMP1 module synchronizes or triggers ICx(5) 10111 = Reserved 10110 = Reserved 10101 = Reserved 10100 = Reserved 10011 = IC4 module interrupt synchronizes or triggers ICx 10010 = IC3 module interrupt synchronizes or triggers ICx 10001 = IC2 module interrupt synchronizes or triggers ICx 10000 = IC1 module interrupt synchronizes or triggers ICx 01111 = Timer5 synchronizes or triggers ICx 01110 = Timer4 synchronizes or triggers ICx 01101 = Timer3 synchronizes or triggers ICx (default) 01100 = Timer2 synchronizes or triggers ICx 01011 = Timer1 synchronizes or triggers ICx 01010 = Reserved 01001 = Reserved 01000 = IC4 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00111 = IC3 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00110 = IC2 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00101 = IC1 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00100 = OC4 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00011 = OC3 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00010 = OC2 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00001 = OC1 module synchronizes or triggers ICx 00000 = No sync or trigger source for ICx bit 4-0 Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: The IC32 bit in both the odd and even ICx must be set to enable Cascade mode. The input source is selected by the SYNCSEL bits of the ICxCON2 register. This bit is set by the selected input source (selected by SYNCSEL bits); it can be read, set and cleared in software. Do not use the ICx module as its own sync or trigger source. This option should only be selected as a trigger source and not as a synchronization source. DS70005258C-page 182  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 15.0 OUTPUT COMPARE single output pulse, or a sequence of output pulses, by changing the state of the output pin on the compare match events. The output compare module can also generate interrupts on compare match events. Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Output Compare with Dedicated Timer” (DS70005159) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 15.1 Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 15.1.1 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. KEY RESOURCES • “Output Compare with Dedicated Timer” (DS70005159) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools The output compare module can select one of six available clock sources for its time base. The module compares the value of the timer with the value of one or two Compare registers, depending on the operating mode selected. The state of the output pin changes when the timer value matches the Compare register value. The output compare module generates either a FIGURE 15-1: Output Compare Resources OUTPUT COMPARE x MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM OCxCON1 OCxCON2 OCxR Rollover/Reset OCxR Buffer Clock Select OCx Clock Sources Increment Comparator OCxTMR Reset Trigger and Sync Sources Trigger and Sync Logic Match Event Comparator OCx Pin Match Event Rollover OCx Output and Fault Logic OCFA Match Event OCxRS Buffer SYNCSEL Trigger(1) Rollover/Reset OCxRS OCx Synchronization/Trigger Event OCx Interrupt Reset Note 1: The trigger/sync source is enabled by default and is set to Timer2 as a source. This timer must be enabled for proper OCx module operation or the trigger/sync source must be changed to another source option.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 183 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 15.2 Output Compare Control Registers REGISTER 15-1: OCxCON1: OUTPUT COMPARE x CONTROL REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 — — OCSIDL OCTSEL2 OCTSEL1 OCTSEL0 — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 HSC/R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ENFLTA — — OCFLTA TRIGMODE OCM2 OCM1 OCM0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 OCSIDL: Output Compare x Stop in Idle Mode Control bit 1 = Output Compare x halts in CPU Idle mode 0 = Output Compare x continues to operate in CPU Idle mode bit 12-10 OCTSEL: Output Compare x Clock Select bits 111 = Peripheral clock (FP) 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = T1CLK is the clock source of the OCx (only the synchronous clock is supported) 011 = T5CLK is the clock source of the OCx 010 = T4CLK is the clock source of the OCx 001 = T3CLK is the clock source of the OCx 000 = T2CLK is the clock source of the OCx bit 9-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7 ENFLTA: Fault A Input Enable bit 1 = Output Compare Fault A input (OCFA) is enabled 0 = Output Compare Fault A input (OCFA) is disabled bit 6-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 OCFLTA: PWM Fault A Condition Status bit 1 = PWM Fault A condition on the OCFA pin has occurred 0 = No PWM Fault A condition on the OCFA pin has occurred bit 3 TRIGMODE: Trigger Status Mode Select bit 1 = TRIGSTAT (OCxCON2) is cleared when OCxRS = OCxTMR or in software 0 = TRIGSTAT is cleared only by software Note 1: OCxR and OCxRS are double-buffered in PWM mode only. DS70005258C-page 184  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 15-1: bit 2-0 Note 1: OCxCON1: OUTPUT COMPARE x CONTROL REGISTER 1 (CONTINUED) OCM: Output Compare x Mode Select bits 111 = Center-Aligned PWM mode: Output is set high when OCxTMR = OCxR and set low when OCxTMR = OCxRS(1) 110 = Edge-Aligned PWM mode: Output is set high when OCxTMR = 0 and set low when OCxTMR = OCxR(1) 101 = Double Compare Continuous Pulse mode: Initializes OCx pin low, toggles OCx state continuously on alternate matches of OCxR and OCxRS 100 = Double Compare Single-Shot mode: Initializes OCx pin low, toggles OCx state on matches of OCxR and OCxRS for one cycle 011 = Single Compare mode: Compare event with OCxR, continuously toggles OCx pin 010 = Single Compare Single-Shot mode: Initializes OCx pin high, compare event with OCxR, forces OCx pin low 001 = Single Compare Single-Shot mode: Initializes OCx pin low, compare event with OCxR, forces OCx pin high 000 = Output compare channel is disabled OCxR and OCxRS are double-buffered in PWM mode only.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 185 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 15-2: OCxCON2: OUTPUT COMPARE x CONTROL REGISTER 2 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 FLTMD FLTOUT FLTTRIEN OCINV — — — OC32 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 HS/R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 OCTRIG TRIGSTAT OCTRIS SYNCSEL4 SYNCSEL3 SYNCSEL2 SYNCSEL1 SYNCSEL0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HS = Hardware Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 FLTMD: Fault Mode Select bit 1 = Fault mode is maintained until the Fault source is removed; the corresponding OCFLTA bit is cleared in software and a new PWMx period starts 0 = Fault mode is maintained until the Fault source is removed and a new PWMx period starts bit 14 FLTOUT: Fault Out bit 1 = PWMx output is driven high on a Fault 0 = PWMx output is driven low on a Fault bit 13 FLTTRIEN: Fault Output State Select bit 1 = OCx pin is tri-stated on a Fault condition 0 = OCx pin I/O state is defined by the FLTOUT bit on a Fault condition bit 12 OCINV: Output Compare x Invert bit 1 = OCx output is inverted 0 = OCx output is not inverted bit 11-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8 OC32: Cascade Two OCx Modules Enable bit (32-bit operation) 1 = Cascade module operation is enabled 0 = Cascade module operation is disabled bit 7 OCTRIG: Output Compare x Trigger/Sync Select bit 1 = Triggers OCx from the source designated by the SYNCSELx bits 0 = Synchronizes OCx with the source designated by the SYNCSELx bits bit 6 TRIGSTAT: Timer Trigger Status bit 1 = Timer source has been triggered and is running 0 = Timer source has not been triggered and is being held clear bit 5 OCTRIS: Output Compare x Output Pin Direction Select bit 1 = OCx is tri-stated 0 = OCx module drives the OCx pin Note 1: 2: 3: Do not use the OCx module as its own synchronization or trigger source. When the OCy module is turned off, it sends a trigger out signal. If the OCx module uses the OCy module as a trigger source, the OCy module must be unselected as a trigger source prior to disabling it. For each OCMPx instance, a different PTG trigger out is used: OCMP1 – PTG trigger out [0] OCMP2 – PTG trigger out [1] OCMP3 – PTG trigger out [2] OCMP4 – PTG trigger out [3] DS70005258C-page 186  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 15-2: bit 4-0 OCxCON2: OUTPUT COMPARE x CONTROL REGISTER 2 (CONTINUED) SYNCSEL: Trigger/Synchronization Source Selection bits 11111 = OCxRS compare event is used for synchronization 11110 = INT2 pin synchronizes or triggers OCx 11101 = INT1 pin synchronizes or triggers OCx 11100 = Reserved 11011 = CMP4 module synchronizes or triggers OCx 11010 = CMP3 module synchronizes or triggers OCx 11001 = CMP2 module synchronizes or triggers OCx 11000 = CMP1 module synchronizes or triggers OCx 10111 = Reserved 10110 = Reserved 10101 = Reserved 10100 = Reserved 10011 = IC4 input capture interrupt event synchronizes or triggers OCx 10010 = IC3 input capture interrupt event synchronizes or triggers OCx 10001 = IC2 input capture interrupt event synchronizes or triggers OCx 10000 = IC1 input capture interrupt event synchronizes or triggers OCx 01111 = Timer5 synchronizes or triggers OCx 01110 = Timer4 synchronizes or triggers OCx 01101 = Timer3 synchronizes or triggers OCx 01100 = Timer2 synchronizes or triggers OCx (default) 01011 = Timer1 synchronizes or triggers OCx 01010 = PTG Trigger Output x(3) 01001 = Reserved 01000 = IC4 input capture event synchronizes or triggers OCx 00111 = IC3 input capture event synchronizes or triggers OCx 00110 = IC2 input capture event synchronizes or triggers OCx 00101 = IC1 input capture event synchronizes or triggers OCx 00100 = OC4 module synchronizes or triggers OCx(1,2) 00011 = OC3 module synchronizes or triggers OCx(1,2) 00010 = OC2 module synchronizes or triggers OCx(1,2) 00001 = OC1 module synchronizes or triggers OCx(1,2) 00000 = No sync or trigger source for OCx Note 1: 2: 3: Do not use the OCx module as its own synchronization or trigger source. When the OCy module is turned off, it sends a trigger out signal. If the OCx module uses the OCy module as a trigger source, the OCy module must be unselected as a trigger source prior to disabling it. For each OCMPx instance, a different PTG trigger out is used: OCMP1 – PTG trigger out [0] OCMP2 – PTG trigger out [1] OCMP3 – PTG trigger out [2] OCMP4 – PTG trigger out [3]  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 187 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 188  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 16.0 Note: HIGH-SPEED PWM This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “High-Speed PWM Module” (DS70000323) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). The high-speed PWM on dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices supports a wide variety of PWM modes and output formats. This PWM module is ideal for power conversion applications, such as: • • • • • • • AC/DC Converters DC/DC Converters Power Factor Correction Uninterruptible Power Supply (UPS) Inverters Battery Chargers Digital Lighting 16.1 Features Overview The high-speed PWM module incorporates the following features: • Eight PWMx Generators with Two Outputs per Generator • Two Master Time Base modules • Individual Time Base and Duty Cycle for each PWM Output • Duty Cycle, Dead Time, Phase Shift and a Frequency Resolution of 1.04 ns • Independent Fault and Current-Limit Inputs • Redundant Output • True Independent Output • Center-Aligned PWM mode • Output Override Control • Chop mode (also known as Gated mode) • Special Event Trigger • Dual Trigger from PWMx to Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) • PWMxL and PWMxH Output Pin Swapping • Independent PWMx Frequency, Duty Cycle and Phase-Shift Changes • Enhanced Leading-Edge Blanking (LEB) Functionality • PWM Capture Functionality Note: Figure 16-1 conceptualizes the PWM module in a simplified block diagram. Figure 16-2 illustrates how the module hardware is partitioned for each PWMx output pair for the Complementary PWM mode. The PWM module contains eight PWM generators. The module has up to 16 PWMx output pins: PWM1H/ PWM1L through PWM8H/PWM8L. For complementary outputs, these 16 I/O pins are grouped into high/low pairs. PWM1 through PWM6 can be used to trigger an ADC conversion. 16.2 Feature Description The PWM module is designed for applications that require: • High resolution at high PWM frequencies • The ability to drive Standard Edge-Aligned, Center-Aligned, Complementary mode and Push-Pull mode outputs • The ability to create multiphase PWM outputs Two common, medium power converter topologies are push-pull and half-bridge. These designs require the PWM output signal to be switched between alternate pins, as provided by the Push-Pull PWM mode. Phase-shifted PWM describes the situation where each PWM generator provides outputs, but the phase relationship between the generator outputs is specifiable and changeable. Multiphase PWM is often used to improve DC/DC Converter load transient response, and reduce the size of output filter capacitors and inductors. Multiple DC/DC Converters are often operated in parallel, but phase shifted in time. A single PWM output, operating at 250 kHz, has a period of 4 s but an array of four PWM channels, staggered by 1 s each, yields an effective switching frequency of 1 MHz. Multiphase PWM applications typically use a fixed-phase relationship. Variable phase PWM is useful in Zero Voltage Transition (ZVT) power converters. Here, the PWM duty cycle is always 50% and the power flow is controlled by varying the relative phase shift between the two PWM generators. Duty cycle, dead time, phase shift and frequency resolution is 8.32 ns in Center-Aligned PWM mode.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 189 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 16.2.1 WRITE-PROTECTED REGISTERS On dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices, write protection is implemented for the IOCONx and FCLCONx registers. The write protection feature prevents any inadvertent writes to these registers. This protection feature can be controlled by the PWMLOCK Configuration bit (FDEVOPT). The default state of the write protection feature is enabled (PWMLOCK = 1). The write protection feature can be disabled by configuring PWMLOCK = 0. EXAMPLE 16-1: To gain write access to these locked registers, the user application must write two consecutive values (0xABCD and 0x4321) to the PWMKEY register to perform the unlock operation. The write access to the IOCONx or FCLCONx registers must be the next SFR access following the unlock process. There can be no other SFR accesses during the unlock process and subsequent write access. To write to both the IOCONx and FCLCONx registers requires two unlock operations. The correct unlocking sequence is described in Example 16-1. PWM WRITE-PROTECTED REGISTER UNLOCK SEQUENCE ; Writing to FCLCON1 register requires unlock sequence mov mov mov mov mov mov #0xabcd, w10 #0x4321, w11 #0x0000, w0 w10, PWMKEY w11, PWMKEY w0, FCLCON1 ; ; ; ; ; ; Load first unlock key to w10 register Load second unlock key to w11 register Load desired value of FCLCON1 register in w0 Write first unlock key to PWMKEY register Write second unlock key to PWMKEY register Write desired value to FCLCON1 register ; Set PWM ownership and polarity using the IOCON1 register ; Writing to IOCON1 register requires unlock sequence mov mov mov mov mov mov 16.3 #0xabcd, w10 #0x4321, w11 #0xF000, w0 w10, PWMKEY w11, PWMKEY w0, IOCON1 ; ; ; ; ; ; Load first unlock key to w10 register Load second unlock key to w11 register Load desired value of IOCON1 register in w0 Write first unlock key to PWMKEY register Write second unlock key to PWMKEY register Write desired value to IOCON1 register PWM Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. DS70005258C-page 190 16.3.1 KEY RESOURCES • “High-Speed PWM Module” (DS70000323) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 16-1: HIGH-SPEED PWM MODULE ARCHITECTURAL DIAGRAM SYNCI1/SYNCI2 Data Bus Primary and Secondary Master Time Base Synchronization Signal PWM1 Interrupt SYNCO1/SYNCO2 PWM1H PWM Generator 1 PWM1L Fault, Current Limit Synchronization Signal PWM2 Interrupt PWM2H PWM Generator 2 PWM2L CPU Fault, Current Limit PWM3 through PWM7 Synchronization Signal PWM8 Interrupt PWM8H PWM Generator 8 PWM8L Primary Trigger ADC Module Secondary Trigger Special Event Trigger  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Fault and Current Limit DS70005258C-page 191 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 16-2: SIMPLIFIED CONCEPTUAL BLOCK DIAGRAM OF THE HIGH-SPEED PWM PTCON, PTCON2 STCON, STCON2 Module Control and Timing SYNCI1 SYNCI2 PWMKEY PTPER SEVTCMP Comparator Comparator SYNCO1 Special Event Compare Trigger Special Event Postscaler Special Event Trigger Master Time Base Counter Clock Prescaler PMTMR STPER SEVTCMP Comparator Comparator Primary Master Time Base SYNCO2 Special Event Compare Trigger Special Event Postscaler Special Event Trigger Master Time Base Counter Clock Prescaler SMTMR Master Duty Cycle Register PWM Generator 1 PDCx MUX Master Period Synchronization Master Duty Cycle 16-Bit Data Bus MDC Secondary Master Time Base PWMx Output Mode Control Logic Comparator PWMCAPx ADC Trigger PTMRx Comparator Current-Limit Override Logic TRIGx Fault Override Logic PHASEx SDCx User Override Logic Dead-Time Logic Pin Control Logic PWM1H PWM1L Secondary PWMx MUX Comparator Interrupt Logic Fault and Current-Limit Logic FLTx Master Period SPHASEx Master Duty Cycle Synchronization ADC Trigger STMRx Comparator STRIGx PWMCONx AUXCONx TRGCONx FCLCONx IOCONx LEBCONx ALTDTRx DTRx PWMxH PWM Generator 1 – PWM Generator 8 PWMxL FLTx DS70005258C-page 192  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-1: R/W-0 PTCON: PWM TIME BASE CONTROL REGISTER U-0 R/W-0 — PTEN HSC/R-0 PTSIDL R/W-0 SESTAT R/W-0 R/W-0 (1) SEIEN EIPU R/W-0 SYNCPOL (1) SYNCOEN(1) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 (1) SYNCEN R/W-0 (1) SYNCSRC2 R/W-0 (1) SYNCSRC1 R/W-0 (1) SYNCSRC0 R/W-0 (1) SEVTPS3 SEVTPS2 R/W-0 (1) R/W-0 (1) SEVTPS1 SEVTPS0(1) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 PTEN: PWM Module Enable bit 1 = PWM module is enabled 0 = PWM module is disabled bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 PTSIDL: PWM Time Base Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = PWM time base halts in CPU Idle mode 0 = PWM time base runs in CPU Idle mode bit 12 SESTAT: Special Event Interrupt Status bit 1 = Special event interrupt is pending 0 = Special event interrupt is not pending bit 11 SEIEN: Special Event Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Special event interrupt is enabled 0 = Special event interrupt is disabled bit 10 EIPU: Enable Immediate Period Updates bit(1) 1 = Active Period register is updated immediately 0 = Active Period register updates occur on PWM cycle boundaries bit 9 SYNCPOL: Synchronize Input and Output Polarity bit(1) 1 = SYNCIx/SYNCO1 polarity is inverted (active-low) 0 = SYNCIx/SYNCO1 is active-high bit 8 SYNCOEN: Primary Time Base Synchronization Enable bit(1) 1 = SYNCO1 output is enabled 0 = SYNCO1 output is disabled bit 7 SYNCEN: External Time Base Synchronization Enable bit(1) 1 = External synchronization of primary time base is enabled 0 = External synchronization of primary time base is disabled bit 6-4 SYNCSRC: Synchronous Source Selection bits(1) 111 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Reserved 011 = PTG Trigger Output 17 010 = PTG Trigger Output 16 001 = SYNCI2 000 = SYNCI1 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown These bits should be changed only when PTEN = 0. In addition, when using the SYNCIx feature, the user application must program the Period register with a value that is slightly larger than the expected period of the external synchronization input signal.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 193 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-1: bit 3-0 Note 1: PTCON: PWM TIME BASE CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) SEVTPS: PWM Special Event Trigger Output Postscaler Select bits(1) 1111 = 1:16 postscaler generates a Special Event Trigger on every sixteenth compare match event • • • 0001 = 1:2 postscaler generates a Special Event Trigger on every second compare match event 0000 = 1:1 postscaler generates a Special Event Trigger on every compare match event These bits should be changed only when PTEN = 0. In addition, when using the SYNCIx feature, the user application must program the Period register with a value that is slightly larger than the expected period of the external synchronization input signal. REGISTER 16-2: PTCON2: PWM CLOCK DIVIDER SELECT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PCLKDIV(1) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 PCLKDIV: PWMx Input Clock Prescaler (Divider) Select bits(1) 111 = Reserved 110 = Divide-by-64, maximum PWM timing resolution 101 = Divide-by-32, maximum PWM timing resolution 100 = Divide-by-16, maximum PWM timing resolution 011 = Divide-by-8, maximum PWM timing resolution 010 = Divide-by-4, maximum PWM timing resolution 001 = Divide-by-2, maximum PWM timing resolution 000 = Divide-by-1, maximum PWM timing resolution (power-on default) Note 1: These bits should be changed only when PTEN = 0. Changing the clock selection during operation will yield unpredictable results. DS70005258C-page 194  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-3: R/W-1 PTPER: PWM PRIMARY MASTER TIME BASE PERIOD REGISTER(1,2) R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 PTPER bit 15 bit 8 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 PTPER bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown PTPER: Primary Master Time Base (PMTMR) Period Value bits The PWMx time base has a minimum value of 0x0010 and a maximum value of 0xFFF8. Any period value that is less than 0x0028 must have the Least Significant three bits set to ‘0’, thus yielding a period resolution at 8.32 ns (at fastest auxiliary clock rate). REGISTER 16-4: R/W-0 SEVTCMP: PWM SPECIAL EVENT COMPARE REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SEVTCMP bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SEVTCMP U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-3 SEVTCMP: Special Event Compare Count Value bits bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: x = Bit is unknown One LSB = 1.04 ns (at fastest auxiliary clock rate); therefore, the minimum SEVTCMP resolution is 8.32 ns.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 195 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-5: STCON: PWM SECONDARY MASTER TIME BASE CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 HSC/R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — SESTAT SEIEN EIPU(1) SYNCPOL SYNCOEN bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SYNCEN SYNCSRC2 SYNCSRC1 SYNCSRC0 SEVTPS3 SEVTPS2 SEVTPS1 SEVTPS0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12 SESTAT: Special Event Interrupt Status bit 1 = Secondary special event interrupt is pending 0 = Secondary special event interrupt is not pending bit 11 SEIEN: Special Event Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Secondary special event interrupt is enabled 0 = Secondary special event interrupt is disabled bit 10 EIPU: Enable Immediate Period Updates bit(1) 1 = Active Secondary Period register is updated immediately 0 = Active Secondary Period register updates occur on PWMx cycle boundaries bit 9 SYNCPOL: Synchronize Input and Output Polarity bit 1 = SYNCIx/SYNCO2 polarity is inverted (active-low) 0 = SYNCIx/SYNCO2 polarity is active-high bit 8 SYNCOEN: Secondary Master Time Base Synchronization Enable bit 1 = SYNCO2 output is enabled 0 = SYNCO2 output is disabled bit 7 SYNCEN: External Secondary Master Time Base Synchronization Enable bit 1 = External synchronization of secondary time base is enabled 0 = External synchronization of secondary time base is disabled bit 6-4 SYNCSRC: Secondary Time Base Sync Source Selection bits 111 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Reserved 011 = PTG Trigger Output 17 010 = PTG Trigger Output 16 001 = SYNCI2 000 = SYNCI1 bit 3-0 SEVTPS: PWMx Secondary Special Event Trigger Output Postscaler Select bits 1111 = 1:16 postcaler 0001 = 1:2 postcaler • • • 0000 = 1:1 postscaler Note 1: This bit only applies to the secondary master time base period. DS70005258C-page 196  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-6: STCON2: PWM SECONDARY CLOCK DIVIDER SELECT REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PCLKDIV(1) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 PCLKDIV: PWM Input Clock Prescaler (Divider) Select bits(1) 111 = Reserved 110 = Divide-by-64, maximum PWM timing resolution 101 = Divide-by-32, maximum PWM timing resolution 100 = Divide-by-16, maximum PWM timing resolution 011 = Divide-by-8, maximum PWM timing resolution 010 = Divide-by-4, maximum PWM timing resolution 001 = Divide-by-2, maximum PWM timing resolution 000 = Divide-by-1, maximum PWM timing resolution (power-on default) Note 1: These bits should be changed only when PTEN = 0. Changing the clock selection during operation will yield unpredictable results. REGISTER 16-7: R/W-1 STPER: PWM SECONDARY MASTER TIME BASE PERIOD REGISTER(1,2) R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 STPER bit 15 bit 8 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 STPER bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown STPER: Secondary Master Time Base (SMTMR) Period Value bits The PWMx time base has a minimum value of 0x0010 and a maximum value of 0xFFF8. Any period value that is less than 0x0028 must have the Least Significant 3 bits set to ‘0’, thus yielding a period resolution at 8.32 ns (at fastest auxiliary clock rate).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 197 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY SSEVTCMP: PWM SECONDARY SPECIAL EVENT COMPARE REGISTER(1) REGISTER 16-8: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SSEVTCMP bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SSEVTCMP U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-3 SSEVTCMP: Special Event Compare Count Value bits bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: x = Bit is unknown One LSB = 1.04 ns (at fastest auxiliary clock rate); therefore, the minimum SSEVTCMP resolution is 8.32 ns. CHOP: PWM CHOP CLOCK GENERATOR REGISTER(1) REGISTER 16-9: R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CHPCLKEN — — — — — CHOPCLK6 CHOPCLK5 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 CHOPCLK4 CHOPCLK3 CHOPCLK2 CHOPCLK1 CHOPCLK0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 CHPCLKEN: Enable Chop Clock Generator bit 1 = Chop clock generator is enabled 0 = Chop clock generator is disabled bit 14-10 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 9-3 CHOPCLK: Chop Clock Divider bits Value is in 8.32 ns increments. The frequency of the chop clock signal is given by: Chop Frequency = 1/(16.64 * (CHOP + 1) * Primary Master PWM Input Clock Period). bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: The chop clock generator operates with the primary PWM clock prescaler (PCLKDIV) in the PTCON2 register (Register 16-2). DS70005258C-page 198  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-10: MDC: PWM MASTER DUTY CYCLE REGISTER(1,2) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 MDC bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 MDC bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown MDC: PWM Master Duty Cycle Value bits The smallest pulse width that can be generated on the PWM output corresponds to a value of 0x0008, while the maximum pulse width generated corresponds to a value of Period – 0x0008. As the duty cycle gets closer to 0% or 100% of the PWM period (0 to 40 ns, depending on the mode of operation), PWM duty cycle resolution will increase from one to three LSBs. REGISTER 16-11: PWMKEY: PWM PROTECTION LOCK/UNLOCK KEY REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PWMKEY bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PWMKEY bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown PWMKEY: PWM Protection Lock/Unlock Key Value bits  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 199 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-12: PWMCONx: PWMx CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLTSTAT(1) CLSTAT(1) TRGSTAT FLTIEN CLIEN TRGIEN ITB(3) MDCS(3) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DTC1 DTC0 — — MTBS CAM(2,3,4) XPRES(5) IUE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 FLTSTAT: Fault Interrupt Status bit(1) 1 = Fault interrupt is pending 0 = No Fault interrupt is pending This bit is cleared by setting FLTIEN = 0. bit 14 CLSTAT: Current-Limit Interrupt Status bit(1) 1 = Current-limit interrupt is pending 0 = No current-limit interrupt is pending This bit is cleared by setting CLIEN = 0. bit 13 TRGSTAT: Trigger Interrupt Status bit 1 = Trigger interrupt is pending 0 = No trigger interrupt is pending This bit is cleared by setting TRGIEN = 0. bit 12 FLTIEN: Fault Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Fault interrupt is enabled 0 = Fault interrupt is disabled and the FLTSTAT bit is cleared bit 11 CLIEN: Current-Limit Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Current-limit interrupt is enabled 0 = Current-limit interrupt is disabled and the CLSTAT bit is cleared bit 10 TRGIEN: Trigger Interrupt Enable bit 1 = A trigger event generates an interrupt request 0 = Trigger event interrupts are disabled and the TRGSTAT bit is cleared bit 9 ITB: Independent Time Base Mode bit(3) 1 = PHASEx/SPHASEx registers provide the time base period for this PWMx generator 0 = PTPER register provides timing for this PWMx generator bit 8 MDCS: Master Duty Cycle Register Select bit(3) 1 = MDC register provides duty cycle information for this PWMx generator 0 = PDCx and SDCx registers provide duty cycle information for this PWMx generator Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: Software must clear the interrupt status here and in the corresponding IFSx bit in the interrupt controller. The Independent Time Base mode (ITB = 1) must be enabled to use Center-Aligned mode. If ITB = 0, the CAM bit is ignored. These bits should not be changed after the PWMx is enabled by setting PTEN (PTCON) = 1. Center-Aligned mode ignores the Least Significant three bits of the Duty Cycle, Phase and Dead-Time registers. The highest Center-Aligned mode resolution available is 8.32 ns with the clock prescaler set to the fastest clock. Configure CLMOD (FCLCONx) = 0 and ITB (PWMCONx) = 1 to operate in External Period Reset mode. DS70005258C-page 200  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-12: PWMCONx: PWMx CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) (CONTINUED) bit 7-6 DTC: Dead-Time Control bits 11 = Reserved 10 = Dead-time function is disabled 01 = Negative dead time is actively applied for Complementary Output mode 00 = Positive dead time is actively applied for all Output modes bit 5-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 MTBS: Master Time Base Select bit 1 = PWMx generator uses the secondary master time base for synchronization and the clock source for the PWMx generation logic (if secondary time base is available) 0 = PWMx generator uses the primary master time base for synchronization and the clock source for the PWMx generation logic bit 2 CAM: Center-Aligned Mode Enable bit(2,3,4) 1 = Center-Aligned mode is enabled 0 = Edge-Aligned mode is enabled bit 1 XPRES: External PWMx Reset Control bit(5) 1 = Current-limit source resets the time base for this PWMx generator if it is in Independent Time Base mode 0 = External pins do not affect the PWMx time base bit 0 IUE: Immediate Update Enable bit 1 = Updates to the active Duty Cycle, Phase Offset, Dead-Time and local Time Base Period registers are immediate 0 = Updates to the active Duty Cycle, Phase Offset, Dead-Time and local Time Base Period registers are synchronized to the local PWMx time base Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: Software must clear the interrupt status here and in the corresponding IFSx bit in the interrupt controller. The Independent Time Base mode (ITB = 1) must be enabled to use Center-Aligned mode. If ITB = 0, the CAM bit is ignored. These bits should not be changed after the PWMx is enabled by setting PTEN (PTCON) = 1. Center-Aligned mode ignores the Least Significant three bits of the Duty Cycle, Phase and Dead-Time registers. The highest Center-Aligned mode resolution available is 8.32 ns with the clock prescaler set to the fastest clock. Configure CLMOD (FCLCONx) = 0 and ITB (PWMCONx) = 1 to operate in External Period Reset mode.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 201 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-13: PDCx: PWMx GENERATOR DUTY CYCLE REGISTER (x = 1 to 8)(1,2,3) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PDCx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PDCx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: 3: x = Bit is unknown PDCx: PWMx Generator Duty Cycle Value bits In Independent PWM mode, the PDCx register controls the PWMxH duty cycle only. In the Complementary, Redundant and Push-Pull PWM modes, the PDCx register controls the duty cycle of both the PWMxH and PWMxL. The smallest pulse width that can be generated on the PWMx output corresponds to a value of 0x0008, while the maximum pulse width generated corresponds to a value of Period – 0x0008. As the duty cycle gets closer to 0% or 100% of the PWM period (0 to 40 ns, depending on the mode of operation), PWMx duty cycle resolution will increase from one to three LSBs. REGISTER 16-14: SDCx: PWMx SECONDARY DUTY CYCLE REGISTER (x = 1 to 8)(1,2,3) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SDCx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SDCx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: 3: x = Bit is unknown SDCx: PWMx Secondary Duty Cycle for PWMxL Output Pin bits The SDCx register is used in Independent PWM mode only. When used in Independent PWM mode, the SDCx register controls the PWMxL duty cycle. The smallest pulse width that can be generated on the PWMx output corresponds to a value of 0x0008, while the maximum pulse width generated corresponds to a value of Period – 0x0008. As the duty cycle gets closer to 0% or 100% of the PWM period (0 to 40 ns, depending on the mode of operation), PWMx duty cycle resolution will increase from one to three LSBs. DS70005258C-page 202  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-15: PHASEx: PWMx PRIMARY PHASE-SHIFT REGISTER (x = 1 to 8)(1,2) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PHASEx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PHASEx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown PHASEx: PWMx Phase-Shift Value or Independent Time Base Period for the PWMx Generator bits If PWMCONx = 0, the following applies based on the mode of operation: • Complementary, Redundant and Push-Pull Output mode (IOCONx = 00, 01 or 10); PHASEx = Phase-shift value for PWMxH and PWMxL outputs • True Independent Output mode (IOCONx = 11); PHASEx = Phase-shift value for PWMxH only • When the PHASEx/SPHASEx registers provide the phase shift with respect to the master time base; therefore, the valid range is 0x0000 through period If PWMCONx = 1, the following applies based on the mode of operation: • Complementary, Redundant and Push-Pull Output mode (IOCONx = 00, 01 or 10); PHASEx = Independent time base period value for PWMxH and PWMxL • True Independent Output mode (IOCONx = 11); PHASEx = Independent time base period value for PWMxH only • When the PHASEx/SPHASEx registers provide the local period, the valid range is 0x0000-0xFFF8  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 203 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-16: SPHASEx: PWMx SECONDARY PHASE-SHIFT REGISTER (x = 1 to 8)(1,2) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SPHASEx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SPHASEx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown SPHASEx: Secondary Phase Offset for PWMxL Output Pin bits (used in Independent PWM mode only) If PWMCONx = 0, the following applies based on the mode of operation: • Complementary, Redundant and Push-Pull Output mode (IOCONx = 00, 01 or 10); SPHASEx = Not used • True Independent Output mode (IOCONx = 11), SPHASEx = Phase-shift value for PWMxL only If PWMCONx = 1, the following applies based on the mode of operation: • Complementary, Redundant and Push-Pull Output mode (IOCONx = 00, 01 or 10); SPHASEx = Not used • True Independent Output mode (IOCONx = 11); SPHASEx = Independent time base period value for PWMxL only • When the PHASEx/SPHASEx registers provide the local period, the valid range of values is 0x0010-0xFFF8 DS70005258C-page 204  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-17: DTRx: PWMx DEAD-TIME REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DTRx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DTRx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-0 DTRx: Unsigned 14-Bit Dead-Time Value for PWMx Dead-Time Unit bits REGISTER 16-18: ALTDTRx: PWMx ALTERNATE DEAD-TIME REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ALTDTRx bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ALTDTRx bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-0 ALTDTRx: Unsigned 14-Bit Alternate Dead-Time Value for PWMx Dead-Time Unit bits  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 205 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-19: TRGCONx: PWMx TRIGGER CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 TRGDIV3 TRGDIV2 TRGDIV1 TRGDIV0 — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DTM(1) — TRGSTRT5 TRGSTRT4 TRGSTRT3 TRGSTRT2 TRGSTRT1 TRGSTRT0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 TRGDIV: Trigger # Output Divider bits 1111 = Trigger output for every 16th trigger event 1110 = Trigger output for every 15th trigger event 1101 = Trigger output for every 14th trigger event 1100 = Trigger output for every 13th trigger event 1011 = Trigger output for every 12th trigger event 1010 = Trigger output for every 11th trigger event 1001 = Trigger output for every 10th trigger event 1000 = Trigger output for every 9th trigger event 0111 = Trigger output for every 8th trigger event 0110 = Trigger output for every 7th trigger event 0101 = Trigger output for every 6th trigger event 0100 = Trigger output for every 5th trigger event 0011 = Trigger output for every 4th trigger event 0010 = Trigger output for every 3rd trigger event 0001 = Trigger output for every 2nd trigger event 0000 = Trigger output for every trigger event bit 11-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7 DTM: Dual Trigger Mode bit(1) 1 = Secondary trigger event is combined with the primary trigger event to create a PWM trigger 0 = Secondary trigger event is not combined with the primary trigger event to create a PWM trigger; two separate PWM triggers are generated bit 6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TRGSTRT: Trigger Postscaler Start Enable Select bits 111111 = Wait 63 PWM cycles before generating the first trigger event after the module is enabled • • • 000010 = Wait 2 PWM cycles before generating the first trigger event after the module is enabled 000001 = Wait 1 PWM cycle before generating the first trigger event after the module is enabled 000000 = Wait 0 PWM cycles before generating the first trigger event after the module is enabled Note 1: The secondary PWMx generator cannot generate PWM trigger interrupts. DS70005258C-page 206  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-20: IOCONx: PWMx I/O CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R/W-1 R/W-1 PENH PENL R/W-0 R/W-0 POLH R/W-0 (1) POLL PMOD1 R/W-0 (1) PMOD0 R/W-0 R/W-0 OVRENH OVRENL bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 OVRDAT1 OVRDAT0 R/W-0 FLTDAT1 R/W-0 (2) R/W-0 (2) FLTDAT0 CLDAT1 (2) R/W-0 (2) CLDAT0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SWAP OSYNC bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 PENH: PWMxH Output Pin Ownership bit 1 = PWMx module controls the PWMxH pin 0 = GPIO module controls the PWMxH pin bit 14 PENL: PWMxL Output Pin Ownership bit 1 = PWMx module controls the PWMxL pin 0 = GPIO module controls the PWMxL pin bit 13 POLH: PWMxH Output Pin Polarity bit 1 = PWMxH pin is active-low 0 = PWMxH pin is active-high bit 12 POLL: PWMxL Output Pin Polarity bit 1 = PWMxL pin is active-low 0 = PWMxL pin is active-high bit 11-10 PMOD: PWMx I/O Pin Mode bits(1) 11 = PWMx I/O pin pair is in the True Independent Output mode 10 = PWMx I/O pin pair is in the Push-Pull Output mode 01 = PWMx I/O pin pair is in the Redundant Output mode 00 = PWMx I/O pin pair is in the Complementary Output mode bit 9 OVRENH: Override Enable for PWMxH Pin bit 1 = OVRDAT1 provides data for output on the PWMxH pin 0 = PWMx generator provides data for the PWMxH pin bit 8 OVRENL: Override Enable for PWMxL Pin bit 1 = OVRDAT0 provides data for output on the PWMxL pin 0 = PWMx generator provides data for the PWMxL pin bit 7-6 OVRDAT: Data for PWMxH, PWMxL Pins if Override is Enabled bits If OVRENH = 1, OVRDAT1 provides data for the PWMxH pin. If OVRENL = 1, OVRDAT0 provides data for the PWMxL pin. bit 5-4 FLTDAT: State for PWMxH and PWMxL Pins if FLTMOD are Enabled bits(2) IFLTMOD (FCLCONx) = 0: Normal Fault mode: If Fault is active, then FLTDAT1 provides the state for the PWMxH pin. If Fault is active, then FLTDAT0 provides the state for the PWMxL pin. IFLTMOD (FCLCONx) = 1: Independent Fault mode: If current limit is active, then FLTDAT1 provides the state for the PWMxH pin. If Fault is active, then FLTDAT0 provides the state for the PWMxL pin. Note 1: 2: These bits should not be changed after the PWMx module is enabled (PTEN = 1). State represents the active/inactive state of the PWMx depending on the POLH and POLL bits settings.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 207 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-20: IOCONx: PWMx I/O CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) (CONTINUED) bit 3-2 CLDAT: State for PWMxH and PWMxL Pins if CLMOD is Enabled bits(2) IFLTMOD (FCLCONx) = 0: Normal Fault mode: If current limit is active, then CLDAT1 provides the state for the PWMxH pin. If current limit is active, then CLDAT0 provides the state for the PWMxL pin. IFLTMOD (FCLCONx) = 1: Independent Fault mode: CLDAT bits are ignored. bit 1 SWAP: SWAP PWMxH and PWMxL Pins bit 1 = PWMxH output signal is connected to the PWMxL pins; PWMxL output signal is connected to the PWMxH pins 0 = PWMxH and PWMxL pins are mapped to their respective pins bit 0 OSYNC: Output Override Synchronization bit 1 = Output overrides via the OVRDAT bits are synchronized to the PWMx time base 0 = Output overrides via the OVRDAT bits occur on the next CPU clock boundary Note 1: 2: These bits should not be changed after the PWMx module is enabled (PTEN = 1). State represents the active/inactive state of the PWMx depending on the POLH and POLL bits settings. REGISTER 16-21: TRIGx: PWMx PRIMARY TRIGGER COMPARE VALUE REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRGCMP bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRGCMP U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-3 TRGCMP: Trigger Compare Value bits When the primary PWMx functions in the local time base, this register contains the compare values that can trigger the ADC module. bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS70005258C-page 208  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-22: FCLCONx: PWMx FAULT CURRENT-LIMIT CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IFLTMOD CLSRC4 CLSRC3 CLSRC2 CLSRC1 CLSRC0 CLPOL(1) CLMOD bit 15 bit 8 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLTSRC4 FLTSRC3 FLTSRC2 FLTSRC1 FLTSRC0 FLTPOL(1) FLTMOD1 FLTMOD0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 IFLTMOD: Independent Fault Mode Enable bit 1 = Independent Fault mode: Current-limit input maps FLTDAT1 to the PWMxH output and the Fault input maps FLTDAT0 to the PWMxL output; the CLDAT bits are not used for override functions 0 = Normal Fault mode: Current-Limit mode maps CLDAT bits to the PWMxH and PWMxL outputs; the PWM Fault mode maps FLTDAT to the PWMxH and PWMxL outputs bit 14-10 CLSRC: Current-Limit Control Signal Source Select for PWMx Generator bits 11111 = FLT31 10001 = Reserved 10000 = Analog Comparator 4 01111 = Analog Comparator 3 01110 = Analog Comparator 2 01101 = Analog Comparator 1 01100 = Fault 12 01011 = Fault 11 01010 = Fault 10 01001 = Fault 9 01000 = Fault 8 00111 = Fault 7 00110 = Fault 6 00101 = Fault 5 00100 = Fault 4 00011 = Fault 3 00010 = Fault 2 00001 = Fault 1 00000 = Reserved bit 9 CLPOL: Current-Limit Polarity for PWMx Generator bit(1) 1 = The selected current-limit source is active-low 0 = The selected current-limit source is active-high bit 8 CLMOD: Current-Limit Mode Enable for PWMx Generator bit 1 = Current-Limit mode is enabled 0 = Current-Limit mode is disabled Note 1: These bits should be changed only when PTEN = 0 (PTCON).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 209 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-22: FCLCONx: PWMx FAULT CURRENT-LIMIT CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) (CONTINUED) bit 7-3 FLTSRC: Fault Control Signal Source Select for PWMx Generator bits 11111 = Fault 31 (Default) 11110-10111 = Reserved 10110 = Fault 22 10101 = Fault 21 10100 = Fault 20 10011 = Fault 19 10010 = Fault 18 10001 = Fault 17 10000 = Analog Comparator 4 01111 = Analog Comparator 3 01110 = Analog Comparator 2 01101 = Analog Comparator 1 01100 = Fault 12 01011 = Fault 11 01010 = Fault 10 01001 = Fault 9 01000 = Fault 8 00111 = Fault 7 00110 = Fault 6 00101 = Fault 5 00100 = Fault 4 00011 = Fault 3 00010 = Fault 2 00001 = Fault 1 00000 = Reserved bit 2 FLTPOL: Fault Polarity for PWMx Generator bit(1) 1 = The selected Fault source is active-low 0 = The selected Fault source is active-high bit 1-0 FLTMOD: Fault Mode for PWMx Generator bits 11 = Fault input is disabled 10 = Reserved 01 = The selected Fault source forces the PWMxH, PWMxL pins to FLTDATx values (cycle) 00 = The selected Fault source forces the PWMxH, PWMxL pins to FLTDATx values (latched condition) Note 1: These bits should be changed only when PTEN = 0 (PTCON). DS70005258C-page 210  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-23: STRIGx: PWMx SECONDARY TRIGGER COMPARE VALUE REGISTER (x = 1 to 8)(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STRGCMP bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STRGCMP U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-3 STRGCMP: Secondary Trigger Compare Value bits When the secondary PWMx functions in the local time base, this register contains the compare values that can trigger the ADC module. bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: STRIGx cannot generate the PWM trigger interrupts.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 211 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-24: LEBCONx: PWMx LEADING-EDGE BLANKING (LEB) CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 PHR PHF PLR PLF FLTLEBEN CLLEBEN — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 (1) (1) BPHH BPHL BPLH BPLL BCH BCL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 PHR: PWMxH Rising Edge Trigger Enable bit 1 = Rising edge of PWMxH will trigger the Leading-Edge Blanking counter 0 = Leading-Edge Blanking ignores the rising edge of PWMxH bit 14 PHF: PWMxH Falling Edge Trigger Enable bit 1 = Falling edge of PWMxH will trigger the Leading-Edge Blanking counter 0 = Leading-Edge Blanking ignores the falling edge of PWMxH bit 13 PLR: PWMxL Rising Edge Trigger Enable bit 1 = Rising edge of PWMxL will trigger the Leading-Edge Blanking counter 0 = Leading-Edge Blanking ignores the rising edge of PWMxL bit 12 PLF: PWMxL Falling Edge Trigger Enable bit 1 = Falling edge of PWMxL will trigger the Leading-Edge Blanking counter 0 = Leading-Edge Blanking ignores the falling edge of PWMxL bit 11 FLTLEBEN: Fault Input Leading-Edge Blanking Enable bit 1 = Leading-Edge Blanking is applied to the selected Fault input 0 = Leading-Edge Blanking is not applied to the selected Fault input bit 10 CLLEBEN: Current-Limit Leading-Edge Blanking Enable bit 1 = Leading-Edge Blanking is applied to the selected current-limit input 0 = Leading-Edge Blanking is not applied to the selected current-limit input bit 9-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5 BCH: Blanking in Selected Blanking Signal High Enable bit(1) 1 = State blanking (of current-limit and/or Fault input signals) when the selected blanking signal is high 0 = No blanking when the selected blanking signal is high bit 4 BCL: Blanking in Selected Blanking Signal Low Enable bit(1) 1 = State blanking (of current-limit and/or Fault input signals) when the selected blanking signal is low 0 = No blanking when the selected blanking signal is low bit 3 BPHH: Blanking in PWMxH High Enable bit 1 = State blanking (of current-limit and/or Fault input signals) when the PWMxH output is high 0 = No blanking when the PWMxH output is high bit 2 BPHL: Blanking in PWMxH Low Enable bit 1 = State blanking (of current-limit and/or Fault input signals) when the PWMxH output is low 0 = No blanking when the PWMxH output is low Note 1: The blanking signal is selected via the BLANKSEL bits in the AUXCONx register. DS70005258C-page 212  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-24: LEBCONx: PWMx LEADING-EDGE BLANKING (LEB) CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) (CONTINUED) bit 1 BPLH: Blanking in PWMxL High Enable bit 1 = State blanking (of current-limit and/or Fault input signals) when the PWMxL output is high 0 = No blanking when the PWMxL output is high bit 0 BPLL: Blanking in PWMxL Low Enable bit 1 = State blanking (of current-limit and/or Fault input signals) when the PWMxL output is low 0 = No blanking when the PWMxL output is low Note 1: The blanking signal is selected via the BLANKSEL bits in the AUXCONx register. REGISTER 16-25: LEBDLYx: PWMx LEADING-EDGE BLANKING DELAY REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LEB bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LEB U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-3 LEB: Leading-Edge Blanking Delay for Current-Limit and Fault Inputs bits The value is in 8.32 ns increments. bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 213 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-26: AUXCONx: PWMx AUXILIARY CONTROL REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 HRPDIS HRDDIS — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 BLANKSEL3 BLANKSEL2 BLANKSEL1 BLANKSEL0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — CHOPSEL3 CHOPSEL2 CHOPSEL1 CHOPSEL0 CHOPHEN CHOPLEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 HRPDIS: High-Resolution PWMx Period Disable bit 1 = High-resolution PWMx period is disabled to reduce power consumption 0 = High-resolution PWMx period is enabled bit 14 HRDDIS: High-Resolution PWMx Duty Cycle Disable bit 1 = High-resolution PWMx duty cycle is disabled to reduce power consumption 0 = High-resolution PWMx duty cycle is enabled bit 13-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-8 BLANKSEL: PWMx State Blank Source Select bits The selected state blank signal will block the current-limit and/or Fault input signals (if enabled via the BCH and BCL bits in the LEBCONx register). 1001 = Reserved 1000 = PWM8H is selected as the state blank source 0111 = PWM7H is selected as the state blank source 0110 = PWM6H is selected as the state blank source 0101 = PWM5H is selected as the state blank source 0100 = PWM4H is selected as the state blank source 0011 = PWM3H is selected as the state blank source 0010 = PWM2H is selected as the state blank source 0001 = PWM1H is selected as the state blank source 0000 = No state blanking bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-2 CHOPSEL: PWMx Chop Clock Source Select bits The selected signal will enable and disable (chop) the selected PWMx outputs. 1001 = Reserved 1000 = PWM8H is selected as the chop clock source 0111 = PWM7H is selected as the chop clock source 0110 = PWM6H is selected as the chop clock source 0101 = PWM5H is selected as the chop clock source 0100 = PWM4H is selected as the chop clock source 0011 = PWM3H is selected as the chop clock source 0010 = PWM2H is selected as the chop clock source 0001 = PWM1H is selected as the chop clock source 0000 = Chop clock generator is selected as the chop clock source bit 1 CHOPHEN: PWMxH Output Chopping Enable bit 1 = PWMxH chopping function is enabled 0 = PWMxH chopping function is disabled bit 0 CHOPLEN: PWMxL Output Chopping Enable bit 1 = PWMxL chopping function is enabled 0 = PWMxL chopping function is disabled DS70005258C-page 214  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 16-27: PWMCAPx: PWMx PRIMARY TIME BASE CAPTURE REGISTER (x = 1 to 8) R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 PWMCAP(1,2,3,4) bit 15 bit 8 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 PWMCAP(1,2,3,4) U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-3 PWMCAP: PWMx Primary Time Base Capture Value bits(1,2,3,4) The value in this register represents the captured PWMx time base value when a leading edge is detected on the current-limit input. bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: 3: 4: The capture feature is only available on a primary output (PWMxH). This feature is active only after LEB processing on the current-limit input signal is complete. The minimum capture resolution is 8.32 ns. This feature can be used when the XPRES bit (PWMCONx) is set to ‘0’.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 215 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 216  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 17.0 PERIPHERAL TRIGGER GENERATOR (PTG) MODULE Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Peripheral Trigger Generator (PTG)” (DS70000669) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. 17.1 Module Introduction The Peripheral Trigger Generator (PTG) provides a means to schedule complex, high-speed peripheral operations that would be difficult to achieve using software. The PTG module uses 8-bit commands, called “Steps”, that the user writes to the PTG Queue register (PTGQUE0-PTQUE15) which performs operations, such as wait for input signal, generate output trigger and wait for timer.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. The PTG module has the following major features: • • • • • Multiple Clock Sources Two 16-Bit General Purpose Timers Two 16-Bit General Limit Counters Configurable for Rising or Falling Edge Triggering Generates Processor Interrupts to include: - Four configurable processor interrupts - Interrupt on a Step event in Single-Step mode - Interrupt on a PTG Watchdog Timer time-out • Able to Receive Trigger Signals from these Peripherals: - ADC - PWM - Output Compare - Input Capture - Comparator - INT2 • Able to Trigger or Synchronize to these Peripherals: - Watchdog Timer - Output Compare - Input Capture - ADC - PWM - Comparator DS70005258C-page 217 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 17-1: PTG BLOCK DIAGRAM PTGHOLD PTGL0 PTGADJ Step Command PTGTxLIM PTG General Purpose Timerx PTGCxLIM PTGSDLIM PTG Step Delay Timer PTG Loop Counter x PTGBTE PTGCST Step Command PTGCON Trigger Outputs PTGDIV FP TAD T1CLK T2CLK T3CLK FOSC Clock Inputs 16-Bit Data Bus PTGCLK  PTG Control Logic Step Command Trigger Inputs PTG Interrupts Step Command PWM OC1 OC2 IC1 CMPx ADC INT2 PTGO0 • • • PTGO31 PTG0IF • • • PTG3IF CNVCHSEL PTGQPTR PTG Watchdog Timer(1) PTGQUE0 PTGWDTIF PTGQUE1 Command Decoder PTGQUE14 PTGQUE15 PTGSTEPIF Note 1: This is a dedicated Watchdog Timer for the PTG module and is independent of the device Watchdog Timer. DS70005258C-page 218  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 17.2 PTG Control Registers REGISTER 17-1: R/W-0 PTGCST: PTG CONTROL/STATUS REGISTER U-0 PTGEN — R/W-0 PTGSIDL R/W-0 U-0 PTGTOGL — R/W-0 PTGSWT (2) R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGSSEN PTGIVIS bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 HS-0 PTGSTRT U-0 — PTGWDTO U-0 U-0 — — U-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 (1) PTGITM1 PTGITM0(1) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HS = Hardware Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 PTGEN: PTG Module Enable bit 1 = PTG module is enabled 0 = PTG module is disabled bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 PTGSIDL: PTG Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12 PTGTOGL: PTG TRIG Output Toggle Mode bit 1 = Toggles the state of the PTGOx for each execution of the PTGTRIG command 0 = Each execution of the PTGTRIG command will generate a single PTGOx pulse determined by the value in the PTGPWDx bits bit 11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10 PTGSWT: PTG Software Trigger bit(2) 1 = Triggers the PTG module 0 = No action (clearing this bit will have no effect) bit 9 PTGSSEN: PTG Enable Single-Step bit 1 = Enables Single-Step mode 0 = Disables Single-Step mode bit 8 PTGIVIS: PTG Counter/Timer Visibility Control bit 1 = Reads of the PTGSDLIM, PTGCxLIM or PTGTxLIM registers return the current values of their corresponding Counter/Timer registers (PTGSD, PTGCx, PTGTx) 0 = Reads of the PTGSDLIM, PTGCxLIM or PTGTxLIM registers return the value previously written to those PTG Limit registers bit 7 PTGSTRT: Start PTG Sequencer bit 1 = Starts to sequentially execute commands (Continuous mode) 0 = Stops executing commands bit 6 PTGWDTO: PTG Watchdog Timer Time-out Status bit 1 = PTG Watchdog Timer has timed out 0 = PTG Watchdog Timer has not timed out. bit 5-2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: These bits apply to the PTGWHI and PTGWLO commands only. This bit is only used with the PTGCTRL Step command software trigger option.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 219 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 17-1: bit 1-0 Note 1: 2: PTGCST: PTG CONTROL/STATUS REGISTER (CONTINUED) PTGITM: PTG Input Trigger Command Operating Mode bits(1) 11 = Single level detect with Step delay is not executed on exit of command (regardless of PTGCTRL command) 10 = Single level detect with Step delay is executed on exit of command 01 = Continuous edge detect with Step delay is not executed on exit of command (regardless of PTGCTRL command) 00 = Continuous edge detect with Step delay is executed on exit of command These bits apply to the PTGWHI and PTGWLO commands only. This bit is only used with the PTGCTRL Step command software trigger option. DS70005258C-page 220  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 17-2: PTGCON: PTG CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGCLK2 PTGCLK1 PTGCLK0 PTGDIV4 PTGDIV3 PTGDIV2 PTGDIV1 PTGDIV0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGPWD3 PTGPWD2 PTGPWD1 PTGPWD0 — PTGWDT2 PTGWDT1 PTGWDT0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-13 PTGCLK: Select PTG Module Clock Source bits 111 = CLC2 110 = CLC1 101 = PTG module clock source will be T3CLK 100 = PTG module clock source will be T2CLK 011 = PTG module clock source will be T1CLK 010 = PTG module clock source will be TAD 001 = PTG module clock source will be FOSC 000 = PTG module clock source will be FP bit 12-8 PTGDIV: PTG Module Clock Prescaler (divider) bits 11111 = Divide-by-32 11110 = Divide-by-31 • • • 00001 = Divide-by-2 00000 = Divide-by-1 bit 7-4 PTGPWD: PTG Trigger Output Pulse-Width bits 1111 = All trigger outputs are 16 PTG clock cycles wide 1110 = All trigger outputs are 15 PTG clock cycles wide • • • 0001 = All trigger outputs are 2 PTG clock cycles wide 0000 = All trigger outputs are 1 PTG clock cycle wide bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 PTGWDT: Select PTG Watchdog Timer Time-out Count Value bits 111 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 512 PTG clocks 110 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 256 PTG clocks 101 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 128 PTG clocks 100 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 64 PTG clocks 011 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 32 PTG clocks 010 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 16 PTG clocks 001 = Watchdog Timer will time-out after 8 PTG clocks 000 = Watchdog Timer is disabled  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 221 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY PTGBTE: PTG BROADCAST TRIGGER ENABLE REGISTER(1,2) REGISTER 17-3: U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — ADCTS1 IC4TSS IC3TSS IC2TSS IC1TSS bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 OC4CS OC3CS OC2CS OC1CS OC4TSS OC3TSS OC2TSS OC1TSS bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12 ADCTS1: Sample Trigger PTGO12 for ADCx bit 1 = Generates trigger when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger when the broadcast command is executed bit 11 IC4TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for IC4 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed bit 10 IC3TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for IC3 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed bit 9 IC2TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for IC2 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed bit 8 IC1TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for IC1 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed bit 7 OC4CS: Clock Source for OC4 bit 1 = Generates clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed bit 6 OC3CS: Clock Source for OC3 bit 1 = Generates clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed bit 5 OC2CS: Clock Source for OC2 bit 1 = Generates clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed bit 4 OC1CS: Clock Source for OC1 bit 1 = Generates clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate clock pulse when the broadcast command is executed bit 3 OC4TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for OC4 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed bit 2 OC3TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for OC3 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed Note 1: 2: This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). This register is only used with the PTGCTRL OPTION = 1111 Step command. DS70005258C-page 222  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 17-3: PTGBTE: PTG BROADCAST TRIGGER ENABLE REGISTER(1,2) (CONTINUED) bit 1 OC2TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for OC2 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed bit 0 OC1TSS: Trigger/Synchronization Source for OC1 bit 1 = Generates trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed 0 = Does not generate trigger/synchronization when the broadcast command is executed Note 1: 2: This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). This register is only used with the PTGCTRL OPTION = 1111 Step command.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 223 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY PTGT0LIM: PTG TIMER0 LIMIT REGISTER(1) REGISTER 17-4: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGT0LIM bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGT0LIM bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGT0LIM: PTG Timer0 Limit Register bits General purpose Timer0 Limit register (effective only with a PTGT0 Step command). This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). PTGT1LIM: PTG TIMER1 LIMIT REGISTER(1) REGISTER 17-5: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGT1LIM bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGT1LIM bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGT1LIM: PTG Timer1 Limit Register bits General purpose Timer1 Limit register (effective only with a PTGT1 Step command). This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). DS70005258C-page 224  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 17-6: R/W-0 PTGSDLIM: PTG STEP DELAY LIMIT REGISTER(1,2) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGSDLIM bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGSDLIM bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown PTGSDLIM: PTG Step Delay Limit Register bits Holds a PTG Step delay value, representing the number of additional PTG clocks, between the start of a Step command and the completion of a Step command. A base Step delay of one PTG clock is added to any value written to the PTGSDLIM register (Step Delay = (PTGSDLIM) + 1). This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). REGISTER 17-7: R/W-0 PTGC0LIM: PTG COUNTER 0 LIMIT REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGC0LIM bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGC0LIM bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGC0LIM: PTG Counter 0 Limit Register bits May be used to specify the loop count for the PTGJMPC0 Step command or as a limit register for the General Purpose Counter 0. This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 225 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY PTGC1LIM: PTG COUNTER 1 LIMIT REGISTER(1) REGISTER 17-8: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGC1LIM bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGC1LIM bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGC1LIM: PTG Counter 1 Limit Register bits May be used to specify the loop count for the PTGJMPC1 Step command or as a limit register for the General Purpose Counter 1. This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). PTGHOLD: PTG HOLD REGISTER(1) REGISTER 17-9: R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGHOLD bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGHOLD bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGHOLD: PTG General Purpose Hold Register bits Holds user-supplied data to be copied to the PTGTxLIM, PTGCxLIM, PTGSDLIM or PTGL0 register with the PTGCOPY command. This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). DS70005258C-page 226  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 17-10: PTGADJ: PTG ADJUST REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGADJ bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGADJ bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGADJ: PTG Adjust Register bits This register holds user-supplied data to be added to the PTGTxLIM, PTGCxLIM, PTGSDLIM or PTGL0 register with the PTGADD command. This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). REGISTER 17-11: PTGL0: PTG LITERAL 0 REGISTER(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGL0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGL0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 Note 1: x = Bit is unknown PTGL0: PTG Literal 0 Register bits This register holds the 6-bit value to be written to the CNVCHSEL bits (ADCON3L) with the PTGCTRL Step command. This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 227 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 17-12: PTGQPTR: PTG STEP QUEUE POINTER REGISTER(1) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PTGQPTR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-0 PTGQPTR: PTG Step Queue Pointer Register bits This register points to the currently active Step command in the Step queue. Note 1: This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). REGISTER 17-13: PTGQUEx: PTG STEP QUEUE REGISTER x (x = 0-15)(1,3) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STEP(2x + 1)(2) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 STEP(2x)(2) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 STEP(2x + 1): PTG Step Queue Pointer Register bits(2) A queue location for storage of the STEP(2x +1) command byte. bit 7-0 STEP(2x): PTG Step Queue Pointer Register bits(2) A queue location for storage of the STEP(2x) command byte. Note 1: 2: 3: x = Bit is unknown This register is read-only when the PTG module is executing Step commands (PTGEN = 1 and PTGSTRT = 1). Refer to Table 17-1 for the Step command encoding. The Step registers maintain their values on any type of Reset. DS70005258C-page 228  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 17.3 Step Commands and Format TABLE 17-1: PTG STEP COMMAND FORMAT Step Command Byte: STEPx CMD OPTION bit 7 bit 7-4 Note 1: 2: bit 4 bit 3 CMD Step Command bit 0 Command Description 0000 PTGCTRL Execute control command as described by OPTION 0001 PTGADD Add contents of PTGADJ register to target register as described by OPTION PTGCOPY Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to target register as described by OPTION 001x PTGSTRB Copy the value contained in CMD0:OPTION to the CNVCHSEL bits (ADCON3L) 0100 PTGWHI Wait for a low-to-high edge input from selected PTG trigger input as described by OPTION 0101 PTGWLO Wait for a high-to-low edge input from selected PTG trigger input as described by OPTION 0110 Reserved Reserved 0111 PTGIRQ Generate individual interrupt request as described by OPTION 100x PTGTRIG Generate individual trigger output as described by 101x PTGJMP Copy the value indicated in to the PTG Queue Pointer (PTGQPTR) and jump to that Step queue 110x PTGJMPC0 PTGC0 = PTGC0LIM: Increment the PTG Queue Pointer (PTGQPTR) 111x PTGJMPC1 PTGC1 = PTGC1LIM: Increment the PTG Queue Pointer (PTGQPTR) PTGC0  PTGC0LIM: Increment PTG Counter 0 (PTGC0) and copy the value indicated in to the PTG Queue Pointer (PTGQPTR) and jump to that Step queue PTGC1  PTGC1LIM: Increment PTG Counter 1 (PTGC1) and copy the value indicated in to the PTG Queue Pointer (PTGQPTR) and jump to that Step queue All reserved commands or options will execute but have no effect (i.e., execute as a NOP instruction). Refer to Table 17-2 for the trigger output descriptions.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 229 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 17-1: bit 3-0 PTG STEP COMMAND FORMAT (CONTINUED) Step Command PTGCTRL(1) PTGADD(1) PTGCOPY Note 1: 2: (1) OPTION Option Description 0000 Reserved 0001 Reserved 0010 Disable PTG Step Delay Timer (PTGSD) 0011 Reserved 0100 Reserved 0101 Reserved 0110 Enable PTG Step Delay Timer (PTGSD) 0111 Reserved 1000 Start and wait for the PTG Timer0 to match the PTG Timer0 Limit register 1001 Start and wait for the PTG Timer1 to match the PTG Timer1 Limit register 1010 Reserved 1011 Wait for software trigger bit transition from low-to-high before continuing (PTGSWT = 0 to 1) 1100 Copy contents of the PTG Counter 0 register to the CNVCHSEL bits (ADCON3L) 1101 Copy contents of the PTG Counter 1 register to the CNVCHSEL bits (ADCON3L) 1110 Copy contents of the PTG Literal 0 register to the CNVCHSEL bits (ADCON3L) 1111 Generate the triggers indicated in the PTG Broadcast Trigger Enable register (PTGBTE) 0000 Add contents of PTGADJ register to the PTG Counter 0 Limit register (PTGC0LIM) 0001 Add contents of PTGADJ register to the PTG Counter 1 Limit register (PTGC1LIM) 0010 Add contents of PTGADJ register to the PTG Timer0 Limit register (PTGT0LIM) 0011 Add contents of PTGADJ register to the PTG Timer1 Limit register (PTGT1LIM) 0100 Add contents of PTGADJ register to the PTG Step Delay Limit register (PTGSDLIM) 0101 Add contents of PTGADJ register to the PTG Literal 0 register (PTGL0) 0110 Reserved 0111 Reserved 1000 Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to the PTG Counter 0 Limit register (PTGC0LIM) 1001 Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to the PTG Counter 1 Limit register (PTGC1LIM) 1010 Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to the PTG Timer0 Limit register (PTGT0LIM) 1011 Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to the PTG Timer1 Limit register (PTGT1LIM) 1100 Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to the PTG Step Delay Limit register (PTGSDLIM) 1101 Copy contents of PTGHOLD register to the PTG Literal 0 register (PTGL0) 1110 Reserved 1111 Reserved All reserved commands or options will execute but have no effect (i.e., execute as a NOP instruction). Refer to Table 17-2 for the trigger output descriptions. DS70005258C-page 230  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 17-1: bit 3-0 PTG STEP COMMAND FORMAT (CONTINUED) Step Command OPTION PTGWHI(1) or PTGWLO(1) 0000 PWM Special Event Trigger 0001 PWM master time base synchronization output 0010 PWM1 interrupt 0011 PWM2 interrupt 0100 PWM3 interrupt 0101 PWM4 interrupt 0110 PWM5 interrupt 0111 OC1 trigger event 1000 OC2 trigger event 1001 IC1 trigger event 1010 CMP1 trigger event 1011 CMP2 trigger event 1100 CMP3 trigger event 1101 CMP4 trigger event 1110 ADC conversion done interrupt PTGIRQ(1) 1111 INT2 external interrupt 0000 Generate PTG Interrupt 0 0001 Generate PTG Interrupt 1 0010 Generate PTG Interrupt 2 0011 Generate PTG Interrupt 3 0100 Reserved • • • PTGTRIG(2) • • • 1111 Reserved 00000 PTGO0 00001 PTGO1 • • • Note 1: 2: Option Description • • • 11110 PTGO30 11111 PTGO31 All reserved commands or options will execute but have no effect (i.e., execute as a NOP instruction). Refer to Table 17-2 for the trigger output descriptions.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 231 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 17-2: PTG OUTPUT DESCRIPTIONS PTG Output Number PTG Output Description PTGO0 Trigger/synchronization source for OC1 PTGO1 Trigger/synchronization source for OC2 PTGO2 Trigger/synchronization source for OC3 PTGO3 Trigger/synchronization source for OC4 PTGO4 Clock source for OC1 PTGO5 Clock source for OC2 PTGO6 Clock source for OC3 PTGO7 Clock source for OC4 PTGO8 Trigger/synchronization source for IC1 PTGO9 Trigger/synchronization source for IC2 PTGO10 Trigger/synchronization source for IC3 PTGO11 Trigger/synchronization source for IC4 PTGO12 Sample trigger for ADC PTGO13 Reserved PTGO14 Reserved PTGO15 Reserved PTGO16 PWM time base synchronous source for PWM3 PTGO17 PWM time base synchronous source for PWM4 PTGO18 Reserved PTGO19 Reserved PTGO20 Reserved PTGO21 Reserved PTGO22 Reserved PTGO23 Reserved PTGO24 Reserved PTGO25 Reserved PTGO26 CLC1 input PTGO27 CLC2 input PTGO28 CLC3 input PTGO29 CLC4 input PTGO30 PTG output to PPS input selection, RPI6 PTGO31 PTG output to PPS input selection, RPI7 DS70005258C-page 232  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 18.0 Note: SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE (SPI) This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) with Audio Codec Support” (DS70005136) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) module is a synchronous serial interface useful for communicating with other peripheral or microcontroller devices. These peripheral devices may be serial EEPROMs, shift registers, display drivers, A/D Converters, etc. The SPI module is compatible with the Motorola® SPI and SIOP interfaces. All devices in the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family include three SPI modules. The module supports operation in two buffer modes. In Standard mode, data is shifted through a single serial buffer. In Enhanced Buffer mode, data is shifted through a FIFO buffer. The FIFO level depends on the configured mode. The SPI serial interface consists of four pins: • • • • The SPI module can be configured to operate using two, three or four pins. In the 3-pin mode, SSx is not used. In the 2-pin mode, both SDOx and SSx are not used. The SPI module has the ability to generate three interrupts, reflecting the events that occur during the data communication. The following types of interrupts can be generated: 1. 2. Do not perform Read-Modify-Write operations (such as bit-oriented instructions) on the SPIxBUF register in either Standard or Enhanced Buffer mode. The module also supports a basic framed SPI protocol while operating in either Master or Slave mode. A total of four framed SPI configurations are supported. SPI3 also supports Audio modes. Four different Audio modes are available. • • • • I2S Left Justified Right Justified PCM/DSP In each of these modes, the serial clock is free-running and audio data is always transferred. If an audio protocol data transfer takes place between two devices, then usually one device is the master and the other is the slave. However, audio data can be transferred between two slaves. Because the audio protocols require free-running clocks, the master can be a third party controller. In either case, the master generates two free-running clocks: SCKx and LRC (Left, Right Channel Clock/SSx/FSYNC).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Receive interrupts are signalled by SPIxRXIF. This event occurs when: - RX watermark interrupt - SPIROV = 1 - SPIRBF = 1 - SPIRBE = 1 provided the respective mask bits are enabled in SPIxIMSKL/H. Variable length data can be transmitted and received, from 2 to 32 bits. Note: SDIx: Serial Data Input SDOx: Serial Data Output SCKx: Shift Clock Input or Output SSx: Active-Low Slave Select or Frame Synchronization I/O Pulse Transmit interrupts are signalled by SPIxTXIF. This event occurs when: - TX watermark interrupt - SPITUR = 1 - SPITBF = 1 - SPITBE = 1 provided the respective mask bits are enabled in SPIxIMSKL/H. 3. General interrupts are signalled by SPIxIF. This event occurs when - FRMERR = 1 - SPIBUSY = 1 - SRMT = 1 provided the respective mask bits are enabled in SPIxIMSKL/H. Block diagrams of the module in Standard and Enhanced modes are shown in Figure 18-1 and Figure 18-2. Note: In this section, the SPI modules are referred to together as SPIx, or separately as SPI1, SPI2 or SPI3. Special Function Registers will follow a similar notation. For example, SPIxCON1 and SPIxCON2 refer to the control registers for any of the three SPI modules. DS70005258C-page 233 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY To set up the SPIx module for the Standard Master mode of operation: To set up the SPIx module for the Standard Slave mode of operation: 1. 1. 2. 2. 3. 4. 5. If using interrupts: a) Clear the interrupt flag bits in the respective IFSx register. b) Set the interrupt enable bits in the respective IECx register. c) Write the SPIxIP bits in the respective IPCx register to set the interrupt priority. Write the desired settings to the SPIxCON1L and SPIxCON1H registers with the MSTEN bit (SPIxCON1L) = 1. Clear the SPIROV bit (SPIxSTATL). Enable SPIx operation by setting the SPIEN bit (SPIxCON1L). Write the data to be transmitted to the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. Transmission (and reception) will start as soon as data is written to the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. FIGURE 18-1: 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Clear the SPIxBUF registers. If using interrupts: a) Clear the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. b) Set the interrupt enable bits in the respective IECx register. c) Write the SPIxIP bits in the respective IPCx register to set the interrupt priority. Write the desired settings to the SPIxCON1L, SPIxCON1H and SPIxCON2L registers with the MSTEN bit (SPIxCON1L) = 0. Clear the SMP bit. If the CKE bit (SPIxCON1L) is set, then the SSEN bit (SPIxCON1L) must be set to enable the SSx pin. Clear the SPIROV bit (SPIxSTATL). Enable SPIx operation by setting the SPIEN bit (SPIxCON1L). SPIx MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM (STANDARD MODE) Internal Data Bus Write Read SPIxTXB SPIxRXB SPIxURDT MSb Receive Transmit SPIxTXSR SPIxRXSR SDIx MSb 0 Shift Control SDOx SSx/FSYNC SSx & FSYNC Control Clock Control 1 TXELM = 6’b0 URDTEN Edge Select MCLKEN Baud Rate Generator SCKx Edge Select DS70005258C-page 234 Clock Control REFO Peripheral Clock Enable Master Clock  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY To set up the SPIx module for the Enhanced Buffer Master mode of operation: To set up the SPIx module for the Enhanced Buffer Slave mode of operation: 1. 1. 2. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. If using interrupts: a) Clear the interrupt flag bits in the respective IFSx register. b) Set the interrupt enable bits in the respective IECx register. c) Write the SPIxIP bits in the respective IPCx register. Write the desired settings to the SPIxCON1L, SPIxCON1H and SPIxCON2L registers with MSTEN (SPIxCON1L) = 1. Clear the SPIROV bit (SPIxSTATL). Select Enhanced Buffer mode by setting the ENHBUF bit (SPIxCON1L). Enable SPIx operation by setting the SPIEN bit (SPIxCON1L). Write the data to be transmitted to the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. Transmission (and reception) will start as soon as data is written to the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. FIGURE 18-2: 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Clear the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. If using interrupts: a) Clear the interrupt flag bits in the respective IFSx register. b) Set the interrupt enable bits in the respective IECx register. c) Write the SPIxIP bits in the respective IPCx register to set the interrupt priority. Write the desired settings to the SPIxCON1L, SPIxCON1H and SPIxCON2L registers with the MSTEN bit (SPIxCON1L) = 0. Clear the SMP bit. If the CKE bit is set, then the SSEN bit must be set, thus enabling the SSx pin. Clear the SPIROV bit (SPIxSTATL). Select Enhanced Buffer mode by setting the ENHBUF bit (SPIxCON1L). Enable SPIx operation by setting the SPIEN bit (SPIxCON1L). SPIx MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM (ENHANCED MODE) Internal Data Bus Write Read SPIxRXB SPIxTXB SPIxURDT MSb Transmit Receive SPIxTXSR SPIxRXSR SDIx MSb 0 Shift Control SDOx SSx/FSYNC SSx & FSYNC Control Clock Control 1 TXELM = 6’b0 URDTEN Edge Select MCLKEN Baud Rate Generator SCKx Edge Select  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Clock Control REFO Peripheral Clock Enable Master Clock DS70005258C-page 235 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY To set up the SPIx module for Audio mode: 1. 2. 3. Clear the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. If using interrupts: a) Clear the interrupt flag bits in the respective IFSx register. b) Set the interrupt enable bits in the respective IECx register. a) Write the SPIxIP bits in the respective IPCx register to set the interrupt priority. REGISTER 18-1: R/W-0 6. SPIxCON1L: SPIx CONTROL REGISTER 1 LOW U-0 SPIEN 4. 5. Write the desired settings to the SPIxCON1L, SPIxCON1H and SPIxCON2L registers with AUDEN (SPIxCON1H) = 1. Clear the SPIROV bit (SPIxSTATL). Enable SPIx operation by setting the SPIEN bit (SPIxCON1L). Write the data to be transmitted to the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. Transmission (and reception) will start as soon as data is written to the SPIxBUFL and SPIxBUFH registers. — R/W-0 R/W-0 SPISIDL R/W-0 DISSDO MODE32 (1,4) R/W-0 MODE16 (1,4) R/W-0 R/W-0 SMP CKE(1) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SSEN(2) CKP MSTEN DISSDI DISSCK MCLKEN(3) SPIFE ENHBUF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 SPIEN: SPIx On bit 1 = Enables module 0 = Turns off and resets module, disables clocks, disables interrupt event generation, allows SFR modifications bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 SPISIDL: SPIx Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Halts in CPU Idle mode 0 = Continues to operate in CPU Idle mode bit 12 DISSDO: Disable SDOx Output Port bit 1 = SDOx pin is not used by the module; pin is controlled by port function 0 = SDOx pin is controlled by the module bit 11-10 MODE32 and MODE16: Serial Word Length Select bits(1,4) MODE32 Note 1: 2: 3: 4: MODE16 AUDEN Communication 32-Bit 1 x 0 1 0 0 8-Bit 1 1 24-Bit Data, 32-Bit FIFO, 32-Bit Channel/64-Bit Frame 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 16-Bit 32-Bit Data, 32-Bit FIFO, 32-Bit Channel/64-Bit Frame 16-Bit Data, 16-Bit FIFO, 32-Bit Channel/64-Bit Frame 16-Bit FIFO, 16-Bit Channel/32-Bit Frame When AUDEN (SPIxCON1H) = 1, this module functions as if CKE = 0, regardless of its actual value. When FRMEN = 1, SSEN is not used. MCLKEN can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0. This channel is not meaningful for DSP/PCM mode as LRC follows FRMSYPW. DS70005258C-page 236  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-1: SPIxCON1L: SPIx CONTROL REGISTER 1 LOW (CONTINUED) bit 9 SMP: SPIx Data Input Sample Phase bit Master Mode: 1 = Input data is sampled at the end of data output time 0 = Input data is sampled at the middle of data output time Slave Mode: Input data is always sampled at the middle of data output time, regardless of the SMP setting. bit 8 CKE: SPIx Clock Edge Select bit(1) 1 = Transmit happens on transition from active clock state to Idle clock state 0 = Transmit happens on transition from Idle clock state to active clock state bit 7 SSEN: Slave Select Enable bit (Slave mode)(2) 1 = SSx pin is used by the macro in Slave mode; SSx pin is used as the slave select input 0 = SSx pin is not used by the macro (SSx pin will be controlled by the port I/O) bit 6 CKP: Clock Polarity Select bit 1 = Idle state for clock is a high level; active state is a low level 0 = Idle state for clock is a low level; active state is a high level bit 5 MSTEN: Master Mode Enable bit 1 = Master mode 0 = Slave mode bit 4 DISSDI: Disable SDIx Input Port bit 1 = SDIx pin is not used by the module; pin is controlled by port function 0 = SDIx pin is controlled by the module bit 3 DISSCK: Disable SCKx Output Port bit 1 = SCKx pin is not used by the module; pin is controlled by port function 0 = SCKx pin is controlled by the module bit 2 MCLKEN: Master Clock Enable bit(3) 1 = REFO is used by the Baud Rate Generator (BRG) 0 = Peripheral clock is used by the BRG bit 1 SPIFE: Frame Sync Pulse Edge Select bit 1 = Frame Sync pulse (Idle-to-active edge) coincides with the first bit clock 0 = Frame Sync pulse (Idle-to-active edge) precedes the first bit clock bit 0 ENHBUF: Enhanced Buffer Enable bit 1 = Enhanced Buffer mode is enabled 0 = Enhanced Buffer mode is disabled Note 1: 2: 3: 4: When AUDEN (SPIxCON1H) = 1, this module functions as if CKE = 0, regardless of its actual value. When FRMEN = 1, SSEN is not used. MCLKEN can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0. This channel is not meaningful for DSP/PCM mode as LRC follows FRMSYPW.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 237 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-2: R/W-0 R/W-0 (1) AUDEN SPIxCON1H: SPIx CONTROL REGISTER 1 HIGH SPISGNEXT R/W-0 IGNROV R/W-0 IGNTUR R/W-0 R/W-0 (2) AUDMONO URDTEN R/W-0 (3) R/W-0 (4) AUDMOD1 AUDMOD0(4) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FRMEN FRMSYNC FRMPOL MSSEN FRMSYPW FRMCNT2 FRMCNT1 FRMCNT0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 AUDEN: Audio Codec Support Enable bit(1) 1 = Audio protocol is enabled; MSTEN controls the direction of both SCKx and frame (a.k.a. LRC), and this module functions as if FRMEN = 1, FRMSYNC = MSTEN, FRMCNT = 001 and SMP = 0, regardless of their actual values 0 = Audio protocol is disabled bit 14 SPISGNEXT: SPIx Sign-Extend RX FIFO Read Data Enable bit 1 = Data from RX FIFO is sign-extended 0 = Data from RX FIFO is not sign-extended bit 13 IGNROV: Ignore Receive Overflow bit 1 = A Receive Overflow (ROV) is NOT a critical error; during ROV, data in the FIFO is not overwritten by the receive data 0 = A ROV is a critical error that stops SPI operation bit 12 IGNTUR: Ignore Transmit Underrun bit 1 = A Transmit Underrun (TUR) is NOT a critical error and data indicated by URDTEN is transmitted until the SPIxTXB is not empty 0 = A TUR is a critical error that stops SPI operation bit 11 AUDMONO: Audio Data Format Transmit bit(2) 1 = Audio data is mono (i.e., each data word is transmitted on both left and right channels) 0 = Audio data is stereo bit 10 URDTEN: Transmit Underrun Data Enable bit(3) 1 = Transmits data out of SPIxURDT register during Transmit Underrun conditions 0 = Transmits the last received data during Transmit Underrun conditions bit 9-8 AUDMOD: Audio Protocol Mode Selection bits(4) 11 = PCM/DSP mode 10 = Right Justified mode: This module functions as if SPIFE = 1, regardless of its actual value 01 = Left Justified mode: This module functions as if SPIFE = 1, regardless of its actual value 00 = I2S mode: This module functions as if SPIFE = 0, regardless of its actual value bit 7 FRMEN: Framed SPIx Support bit 1 = Framed SPIx support is enabled (SSx pin is used as the FSYNC input/output) 0 = Framed SPIx support is disabled Note 1: 2: 3: 4: AUDEN can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0. AUDMONO can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0 and is only valid for AUDEN = 1. URDTEN is only valid when IGNTUR = 1. The AUDMOD bits can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0 and are only valid when AUDEN = 1. When NOT in PCM/DSP mode, this module functions as if FRMSYPW = 1, regardless of its actual value. DS70005258C-page 238  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-2: SPIxCON1H: SPIx CONTROL REGISTER 1 HIGH (CONTINUED) bit 6 FRMSYNC: Frame Sync Pulse Direction Control bit 1 = Frame Sync pulse input (slave) 0 = Frame Sync pulse output (master) bit 5 FRMPOL: Frame Sync/Slave Select Polarity bit 1 = Frame Sync pulse/slave select is active-high 0 = Frame Sync pulse/slave select is active-low bit 4 MSSEN: Master Mode Slave Select Enable bit 1 = SPIx slave select support is enabled with polarity determined by FRMPOL (SSx pin is automatically driven during transmission in Master mode) 0 = Slave select SPIx support is disabled (SSx pin will be controlled by port I/O) bit 3 FRMSYPW: Frame Sync Pulse-Width bit 1 = Frame Sync pulse is one serial word length wide (as defined by MODE/WLENGTH) 0 = Frame Sync pulse is one clock (SCK) wide bit 2-0 FRMCNT: Frame Sync Pulse Counter bits Controls the number of serial words transmitted per Sync pulse. 111 = Reserved 110 = Reserved 101 = Generates a Frame Sync pulse on every 32 serial words 100 = Generates a Frame Sync pulse on every 16 serial words 011 = Generates a Frame Sync pulse on every 8 serial words 010 = Generates a Frame Sync pulse on every 4 serial words 001 = Generates a Frame Sync pulse on every 2 serial words (value used by audio protocols) 000 = Generates a Frame Sync pulse on each serial word Note 1: 2: 3: 4: AUDEN can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0. AUDMONO can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0 and is only valid for AUDEN = 1. URDTEN is only valid when IGNTUR = 1. The AUDMOD bits can only be written when the SPIEN bit = 0 and are only valid when AUDEN = 1. When NOT in PCM/DSP mode, this module functions as if FRMSYPW = 1, regardless of its actual value.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 239 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-3: SPIxCON2L: SPIx CONTROL REGISTER 2 LOW U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — U-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 WLENGTH R/W-0 R/W-0 (1,2) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-0 WLENGTH: Variable Word Length bits(1,2) 11111 = 32-bit data 11110 = 31-bit data 11101 = 30-bit data 11100 = 29-bit data 11011 = 28-bit data 11010 = 27-bit data 11001 = 26-bit data 11000 = 25-bit data 10111 = 24-bit data 10110 = 23-bit data 10101 = 22-bit data 10100 = 21-bit data 10011 = 20-bit data 10010 = 19-bit data 10001 = 18-bit data 10000 = 17-bit data 01111 = 16-bit data 01110 = 15-bit data 01101 = 14-bit data 01100 = 13-bit data 01011 = 12-bit data 01010 = 11-bit data 01001 = 10-bit data 01000 = 9-bit data 00111 = 8-bit data 00110 = 7-bit data 00101 = 6-bit data 00100 = 5-bit data 00011 = 4-bit data 00010 = 3-bit data 00001 = 2-bit data 00000 = See MODE bits in SPIxCON1L Note 1: 2: x = Bit is unknown These bits are effective when AUDEN = 0 only. Varying the length by changing these bits does not affect the depth of the TX/RX FIFO. DS70005258C-page 240  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-4: SPIxSTATL: SPIx STATUS REGISTER LOW U-0 U-0 U-0 HS/R/C-0 HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 HSC/R-0 — — — FRMERR SPIBUSY — — SPITUR(1) bit 15 bit 8 HSC/R-0 HS/R/C-0 SRMT SPIROV HSC/R-1 U-0 HSC/R-1 U-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 SPIRBE — SPITBE — SPITBF SPIRBF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit U = Unimplemented, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared HS = Hardware Settable bit bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12 FRMERR: SPIx Frame Error Status bit 1 = Frame error is detected 0 = No frame error is detected bit 11 SPIBUSY: SPIx Activity Status bit 1 = Module is currently busy with some transactions 0 = No ongoing transactions (at time of read) bit 10-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8 SPITUR: SPIx Transmit Underrun Status bit(1) 1 = Transmit buffer has encountered a Transmit Underrun condition 0 = Transmit buffer does not have a Transmit Underrun condition bit 7 SRMT: Shift Register Empty Status bit 1 = No current or pending transactions (i.e., neither SPIxTXB or SPIxTXSR contains data to transmit) 0 = Current or pending transactions bit 6 SPIROV: SPIx Receive Overflow Status bit 1 = A new byte/half-word/word has been completely received when the SPIxRXB was full 0 = No overflow bit 5 SPIRBE: SPIx RX Buffer Empty Status bit 1 = RX buffer is empty 0 = RX buffer is not empty Standard Buffer mode: Automatically set in hardware when SPIxBUF is read from, reading SPIxRXB. Automatically cleared in hardware when SPIx transfers data from SPIxRXSR to SPIxRXB. Enhanced Buffer mode: Indicates RXELM = 000000. bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: SPITUR is cleared when SPIEN = 0. When IGNTUR = 1, SPITUR provides dynamic status of the Transmit Underrun condition, but does not stop RX/TX operation and does not need to be cleared by software.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 241 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-4: SPIxSTATL: SPIx STATUS REGISTER LOW (CONTINUED) bit 3 SPITBE: SPIx Transmit Buffer Empty Status bit 1 = SPIxTXB is empty 0 = SPIxTXB is not empty Standard Buffer mode: Automatically set in hardware when SPIx transfers data from SPIxTXB to SPIxTXSR. Automatically cleared in hardware when SPIxBUF is written, loading SPIxTXB. Enhanced Buffer mode: Indicates TXELM = 000000. bit 2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 SPITBF: SPIx Transmit Buffer Full Status bit 1 = SPIxTXB is full 0 = SPIxTXB not full Standard Buffer mode: Automatically set in hardware when SPIxBUF is written, loading SPIxTXB. Automatically cleared in hardware when SPIx transfers data from SPIxTXB to SPIxTXSR. Enhanced Buffer mode: Indicates TXELM = 111111. bit 0 SPIRBF: SPIx Receive Buffer Full Status bit 1 = SPIxRXB is full 0 = SPIxRXB is not full Standard Buffer mode: Automatically set in hardware when SPIx transfers data from SPIxRXSR to SPIxRXB. Automatically cleared in hardware when SPIxBUF is read from, reading SPIxRXB. Enhanced Buffer mode: Indicates RXELM = 111111. Note 1: SPITUR is cleared when SPIEN = 0. When IGNTUR = 1, SPITUR provides dynamic status of the Transmit Underrun condition, but does not stop RX/TX operation and does not need to be cleared by software. DS70005258C-page 242  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-5: U-0 SPIxSTATH: SPIx STATUS REGISTER HIGH U-0 — — HSC/R-0 (3) RXELM5 HSC/R-0 (2) RXELM4 HSC/R-0 (1) RXELM3 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 RXELM2 RXELM1 RXELM0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — HSC/R-0 (3) TXELM5 HSC/R-0 (2) TXELM4 HSC/R-0 (1) TXELM3 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 TXELM2 TXELM1 TXELM0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-8 RXELM: Receive Buffer Element Count bits (valid in Enhanced Buffer mode)(1,2,3) bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TXELM: Transmit Buffer Element Count bits (valid in Enhanced Buffer mode)(1,2,3) Note 1: 2: 3: RXELM3 and TXELM3 bits are only present when FIFODEPTH = 8 or higher. RXELM4 and TXELM4 bits are only present when FIFODEPTH = 16 or higher. RXELM5 and TXELM5 bits are only present when FIFODEPTH = 32.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 243 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-6: SPIxIMSKL: SPIx INTERRUPT MASK REGISTER LOW U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — FRMERREN BUSYEN — — SPITUREN bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SRMTEN SPIROVEN SPIRBEN — SPITBEN — SPITBFEN SPIRBFEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12 FRMERREN: Enable Interrupt Events via FRMERR bit 1 = Frame error generates an interrupt event 0 = Frame error does not generate an interrupt event bit 11 BUSYEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPIBUSY bit 1 = SPIBUSY generates an interrupt event 0 = SPIBUSY does not generate an interrupt event bit 10-9 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 8 SPITUREN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPITUR bit 1 = Transmit Underrun (TUR) generates an interrupt event 0 = Transmit Underrun does not generate an interrupt event bit 7 SRMTEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SRMT bit 1 = Shift Register Empty (SRMT) generates interrupt events 0 = Shift Register Empty does not generate interrupt events bit 6 SPIROVEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPIROV bit 1 = SPIx Receive Overflow (ROV) generates an interrupt event 0 = SPIx Receive Overflow does not generate an interrupt event bit 5 SPIRBEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPIRBE bit 1 = SPIx RX buffer empty generates an interrupt event 0 = SPIx RX buffer empty does not generate an interrupt event bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 SPITBEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPITBE bit 1 = SPIx transmit buffer empty generates an interrupt event 0 = SPIx transmit buffer empty does not generate an interrupt event bit 2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1 SPITBFEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPITBF bit 1 = SPIx transmit buffer full generates an interrupt event 0 = SPIx transmit buffer full does not generate an interrupt event bit 0 SPIRBFEN: Enable Interrupt Events via SPIRBF bit 1 = SPIx receive buffer full generates an interrupt event 0 = SPIx receive buffer full does not generate an interrupt event DS70005258C-page 244  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 18-7: SPIxIMSKH: SPIx INTERRUPT MASK REGISTER HIGH R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 RXWIEN — RXMSK5(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 RXMSK4(1,4) RXMSK3(1,3) RXMSK2(1,2) R/W-0 R/W-0 RXMSK1(1) RXMSK0(1) bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TXWIEN — TXMSK5(1) TXMSK4(1,4) TXMSK3(1,3) TXMSK2(1,2) TXMSK1(1) TXMSK0(1) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 RXWIEN: Receive Watermark Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Triggers receive buffer element watermark interrupt when RXMSK  RXELM 0 = Disables receive buffer element watermark interrupt bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-8 RXMSK: RX Buffer Mask bits(1,2,3,4) RX mask bits; used in conjunction with the RXWIEN bit. bit 7 TXWIEN: Transmit Watermark Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Triggers transmit buffer element watermark interrupt when TXMSK = TXELM 0 = Disables transmit buffer element watermark interrupt bit 6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 TXMSK: TX Buffer Mask bits(1,2,3,4) TX mask bits; used in conjunction with the TXWIEN bit. Note 1: 2: 3: 4: Mask values higher than FIFODEPTH are not valid. The module will not trigger a match for any value in this case. RXMSK2 and TXMSK2 bits are only present when FIFODEPTH = 8 or higher. RXMSK3 and TXMSK3 bits are only present when FIFODEPTH = 16 or higher. RXMSK4 and TXMSK4 bits are only present when FIFODEPTH = 32.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 245 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 18-3: SPIx MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION (STANDARD MODE) Processor 1 (SPIx Master) Processor 2 (SPIx Slave) SDOx SDIx Serial Receive Buffer (SPIxRXB)(2) Shift Register (SPIxRXSR) LSb MSb Serial Transmit Buffer (SPIxTXB)(2) SDIx SDOx SDOx SDIx Shift Register (SPIxTXSR) MSb Shift Register (SPIxRXSR) Shift Register (SPIxTXSR) MSb LSb MSb LSb Serial Transmit Buffer (SPIxTXB)(2) SCKx Serial Clock SCKx LSb Serial Receive Buffer (SPIxRXB)(2) SSx(1) SPIx Buffer (SPIxBUF)(2) MSTEN (SPIxCON1L) = 1) Note 1: 2: SPIx Buffer (SPIxBUF)(2) MSSEN (SPIxCON1H) = 1 and MSTEN (SPIxCON1L) = 0 Using the SSx pin in Slave mode of operation is optional. User must write transmit data to read the received data from SPIxBUF. The SPIxTXB and SPIxRXB registers are memory-mapped to SPIxBUF. DS70005258C-page 246  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 18-4: SPIx MASTER/SLAVE CONNECTION (ENHANCED BUFFER MODES) Processor 1 (SPIx Master) Processor 2 (SPIx Slave) SDOx SDIx Serial Transmit FIFO (SPIxTXB)(2) Serial Receive FIFO (SPIxRXB)(2) Shift Register (SPIxRXSR) LSb MSb SDIx SDOx SDOx SDIx Shift Register (SPIxTXSR) MSb Shift Register (SPIxRXSR) Shift Register (SPIxTXSR) MSb LSb MSb LSb Serial Transmit FIFO (SPIxTXB)(2) SCKx Serial Clock SCKx LSb Serial Receive FIFO (SPIxRXB)(2) SSx(1) SPIx Buffer (SPIxBUF)(2) SPIx Buffer (SPIxBUF)(2) MSTEN (SPIxCON1L) = 1) Note 1: 2: FIGURE 18-5: MSSEN (SPIxCON1H) = 1 and MSTEN (SPIxCON1L) = 0 Using the SSx pin in Slave mode of operation is optional. User must write transmit data to read the received data from SPIxBUF. The SPIxTXB and SPIxRXB registers are memory-mapped to SPIxBUF. SPIx MASTER, FRAME MASTER CONNECTION DIAGRAM Processor 2 PIC24F (SPIx Master, Frame Master) SDOx SDIx SDOx SDIx SCKx SSx  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Serial Clock SCKx Frame Sync Pulse SSx DS70005258C-page 247 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 18-6: SPIx MASTER, FRAME SLAVE CONNECTION DIAGRAM PIC24F SPIx Master, Frame Slave) Processor 2 SDOx SDIx SDOx SDIx SCKx Serial Clock SSx FIGURE 18-7: Frame Sync Pulse SCKx SSx SPIx SLAVE, FRAME MASTER CONNECTION DIAGRAM Processor 2 PIC24F (SPIx Slave, Frame Master) SDIx SDOx SDOx SDIx Serial Clock SCKx SSx FIGURE 18-8: Frame Sync Pulse SCKx SSx SPIx SLAVE, FRAME SLAVE CONNECTION DIAGRAM Processor 2 PIC24F (SPIx Slave, Frame Slave) SDOx SDIx SDOx SDIx SCKx SSx EQUATION 18-1: Serial Clock Frame Sync Pulse SCKx SSx RELATIONSHIP BETWEEN DEVICE AND SPIx CLOCK SPEED Baud Rate = FPB (2 * (SPIxBRG + 1)) Where: FPB is the Peripheral Bus Clock Frequency. DS70005258C-page 248  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 19.0 INTER-INTEGRATED CIRCUIT (I2C) Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)” (DS70000195) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices contains two Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) modules: I2C1 and I2C2. The I2C module provides complete hardware support for both Slave and Multi-Master modes of the I2C serial communication standard, with a 16-bit interface. The I2C module has a 2-pin interface: • The SCLx/ASCLx pin is clock • The SDAx/ASDAx pin is data  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. The I2C module offers the following key features: • I2C Interface supporting both Master and Slave modes of Operation • I2C Slave mode Supports 7 and 10-Bit Addressing • I2C Master mode Supports 7 and 10-Bit Addressing • I2C Port allows Bidirectional Transfers between Master and Slaves • Serial Clock Synchronization for I2C Port can be used as a Handshake Mechanism to Suspend and Resume Serial Transfer (SCLREL control) • I2C Supports Multi-Master Operation, Detects Bus Collision and Arbitrates Accordingly • System Management Bus (SMBus) Support • Alternate I2C Pin Mapping (ASCLx/ASDAx) 19.1 I2C Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 19.1.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C)” (DS70000195) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools DS70005258C-page 249 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 19-1: I2Cx BLOCK DIAGRAM (x = 1 OR 2) Internal Data Bus I2CxRCV Read SCLx/ASCLx Shift Clock I2CxRSR LSb SDAx/ASDAx Address Match Match Detect Write I2CxMSK Write Read I2CxADD Read Start and Stop Bit Detect Write Start and Stop Bit Generation Control Logic I2CxSTAT Collision Detect Read Write I2CxCONH Acknowledge Generation Read Write Clock Stretching I2CxCONL Read Write I2CxTRN LSb Read Shift Clock Reload Control BRG Down Counter Write I2CxBRG Read FP/2 DS70005258C-page 250  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 19.2 I2C Control Registers REGISTER 19-1: I2CxCONL: I2Cx CONTROL REGISTER LOW R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 HC/R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 I2CEN — I2CSIDL SCLREL STRICT A10M DISSLW SMEN bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 HC/R/W-0 HC/R/W-0 HC/R/W-0 HC/R/W-0 HC/R/W-0 GCEN STREN ACKDT ACKEN RCEN PEN RSEN SEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HC = Hardware Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 I2CEN: I2Cx Enable bit 1 = Enables the I2Cx module and configures the SDAx and SCLx pins as serial port pins 0 = Disables the I2Cx module; all I2C pins are controlled by port functions bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 I2CSIDL: I2Cx Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12 SCLREL: SCLx Release Control bit (when operating as I2C slave) 1 = Releases SCLx clock 0 = Holds SCLx clock low (clock stretch) If STREN = 1: Bit is R/W (i.e., software can write ‘0’ to initiate stretch and write ‘1’ to release clock). It is cleared by hardware at the beginning of every slave data byte transmission. It is cleared by hardware at the end of every slave address byte reception. It is cleared by hardware at the end of every slave data byte reception. If STREN = 0: Bit is R/S (i.e., software can only write ‘1’ to release clock). It is cleared by hardware at the beginning of every slave data byte transmission. It is cleared by hardware at the end of every slave address byte reception. bit 11 STRICT: Strict I2Cx Reserved Address Enable bit 1 = Strict Reserved Addressing is Enabled: In Slave mode, the device will NACK any reserved address. In Master mode, the device is allowed to generate addresses within the reserved address space. 0 = Reserved Addressing is Acknowledged: In Slave mode, the device will ACK any reserved address. In Master mode, the device should not address a slave device with a reserved address. bit 10 A10M: 10-Bit Slave Address bit 1 = I2CxADD is a 10-bit slave address 0 = I2CxADD is a 7-bit slave address bit 9 DISSLW: Disable Slew Rate Control bit 1 = Slew rate control is disabled 0 = Slew rate control is enabled bit 8 SMEN: SMBus Input Levels bit 1 = Enables I/O pin thresholds compliant with SMBus specification 0 = Disables SMBus input thresholds  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 251 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 19-1: I2CxCONL: I2Cx CONTROL REGISTER LOW (CONTINUED) bit 7 GCEN: General Call Enable bit (when operating as I2C slave) 1 = Enables interrupt when a general call address is received in I2CxRSR (module is enabled for reception) 0 = General call address is disabled bit 6 STREN: SCLx Clock Stretch Enable bit (when operating as I2C slave) Used in conjunction with the SCLREL bit. 1 = Enables software controlled clock stretching 0 = Disables software controlled clock stretching bit 5 ACKDT: Acknowledge Data bit (when operating as I2C master, applicable during master receive) Value that is transmitted when the software initiates an Acknowledge sequence. 1 = Sends NACK during Acknowledge 0 = Sends ACK during Acknowledge bit 4 ACKEN: Acknowledge Sequence Enable bit (when operating as I2C master, applicable during master receive) 1 = Initiates Acknowledge sequence on SDAx and SCLx pins and transmits ACKDT data bit; it is cleared by hardware at the end of the master Acknowledge sequence 0 = Acknowledge sequence is not in progress bit 3 RCEN: Receive Enable bit (when operating as I2C master) 1 = Enables Receive mode for I2C; it is cleared by hardware at the end of the eighth bit of the master receive data byte 0 = Receive sequence is not in progress bit 2 PEN: Stop Condition Enable bit (when operating as I2C master) 1 = Initiates Stop condition on SDAx and SCLx pins; it is cleared by hardware at the end of the master Stop sequence 0 = Stop condition is not in progress bit 1 RSEN: Repeated Start Condition Enable bit (when operating as I2C master) 1 = Initiates Repeated Start condition on SDAx and SCLx pins; it is cleared by hardware at the end of the master Repeated Start sequence 0 = Repeated Start condition is not in progress bit 0 SEN: Start Condition Enable bit (when operating as I2C master) 1 = Initiates Start condition on SDAx and SCLx pins; it is cleared by hardware at the end of the master Start sequence 0 = Start condition is not in progress DS70005258C-page 252  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 19-2: I2CxCONH: I2Cx CONTROL REGISTER HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — PCIE SCIE BOEN SDAHT SBCDE AHEN DHEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6 PCIE: Stop Condition Interrupt Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Enables interrupt on detection of Stop condition 0 = Stop detection interrupts are disabled bit 5 SCIE: Start Condition Interrupt Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Enables interrupt on detection of Start or Restart conditions 0 = Start detection interrupts are disabled bit 4 BOEN: Buffer Overwrite Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = I2CxRCV is updated and ACK is generated for a received address/data byte, ignoring the state of the I2COV only if the RBF bit = 0 0 = I2CxRCV is only updated when I2COV is clear bit 3 SDAHT: SDAx Hold Time Selection bit 1 = Minimum of 300 ns hold time on SDAx after the falling edge of SCLx 0 = Minimum of 100 ns hold time on SDAx after the falling edge of SCLx bit 2 SBCDE: Slave Mode Bus Collision Detect Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Enables slave bus collision interrupts 0 = Slave bus collision interrupts are disabled If the rising edge of SCLx and SDAx is sampled low when the module is in a high state, the BCL bit is set and the bus goes Idle. This Detection mode is only valid during data and ACK transmit sequences. bit 1 AHEN: Address Hold Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Following the 8th falling edge of SCLx for a matching received address byte, the SCLREL (I2CxCONL) bit will be cleared and SCLx will be held low 0 = Address holding is disabled bit 0 DHEN: Data Hold Enable bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Following the 8th falling edge of SCLx for a received data byte, the slave hardware clears the SCLREL (I2CxCONL) bit and SCLx is held low 0 = Data holding is disabled  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 253 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 19-3: I2CxSTAT: I2Cx STATUS REGISTER HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 HS/R/C-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 ACKSTAT TRSTAT ACKTIM — — BCL GCSTAT ADD10 bit 15 bit 8 HS/R/C-0 HS/R/C-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R/C-0 HSC/R/C-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 IWCOL I2COV D_A P S R_W RBF TBF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit ‘0’ = Bit is cleared HS = Hardware Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ bit 15 ACKSTAT: Acknowledge Status bit (when operating as I2C master, applicable to master transmit operation) 1 = NACK was received from slave 0 = ACK was received from slave It is set or cleared by hardware at the end of a slave Acknowledge. bit 14 TRSTAT: Transmit Status bit (when operating as I2C master, applicable to master transmit operation) 1 = Master transmit is in progress (8 bits + ACK) 0 = Master transmit is not in progress It is set by hardware at the beginning of master transmission. It is cleared by hardware at the end of slave Acknowledge. bit 13 ACKTIM: Acknowledge Time Status bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = I2C bus is an Acknowledge sequence, set on the 8th falling edge of SCLx 0 = Not an Acknowledge sequence, cleared on the 9th rising edge of SCLx bit 12-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10 BCL: Master Bus Collision Detect bit 1 = A bus collision has been detected during a master operation 0 = No bus collision detected It is set by hardware at detection of a bus collision. bit 9 GCSTAT: General Call Status bit 1 = General call address was received 0 = General call address was not received It is set by hardware when address matches the general call address. It is cleared by hardware at Stop detection. bit 8 ADD10: 10-Bit Address Status bit 1 = 10-bit address was matched 0 = 10-bit address was not matched It is set by hardware at the match of the 2nd byte of the matched 10-bit address. It is cleared by hardware at Stop detection. bit 7 IWCOL: I2Cx Write Collision Detect bit 1 = An attempt to write to the I2CxTRN register failed because the I2C module is busy 0 = No collision It is set by hardware at the occurrence of a write to I2CxTRN while busy (cleared by software). bit 6 I2COV: I2Cx Receive Overflow Flag bit 1 = A byte was received while the I2CxRCV register was still holding the previous byte 0 = No overflow It is set by hardware at an attempt to transfer I2CxRSR to I2CxRCV (cleared by software). DS70005258C-page 254  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 19-3: I2CxSTAT: I2Cx STATUS REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 5 D_A: Data/Address bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Indicates that the last byte received was data 0 = Indicates that the last byte received was a device address It is cleared by hardware at a device address match. It is set by hardware by reception of a slave byte. bit 4 P: Stop bit 1 = Indicates that a Stop bit has been detected last 0 = Stop bit was not detected last It is set or cleared by hardware when a Start, Repeated Start or Stop is detected. bit 3 S: Start bit 1 = Indicates that a Start (or Repeated Start) bit has been detected last 0 = Start bit was not detected last It is set or cleared by hardware when a Start, Repeated Start or Stop is detected. bit 2 R_W: Read/Write Information bit (I2C Slave mode only) 1 = Read – Indicates data transfer is output from the slave 0 = Write – Indicates data transfer is input to the slave It is set or cleared by hardware after reception of an I 2C device address byte. bit 1 RBF: Receive Buffer Full Status bit 1 = Receive is complete, I2CxRCV is full 0 = Receive is not complete, I2CxRCV is empty It is set by hardware when I2CxRCV is written with a received byte. It is cleared by hardware when software reads I2CxRCV. bit 0 TBF: Transmit Buffer Full Status bit 1 = Transmit is in progress, I2CxTRN is full 0 = Transmit is complete, I2CxTRN is empty It is set by hardware when software writes to I2CxTRN. It is cleared by hardware at completion of a data transmission.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 255 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 19-4: I2CxMSK: I2Cx SLAVE MODE ADDRESS MASK REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 AMSK bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 AMSK bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-10 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 9-0 AMSK: Address Mask Select bits For 10-Bit Address: 1 = Enables masking for bit Ax of incoming message address; bit match is not required in this position 0 = Disables masking for bit Ax; bit match is required in this position For 7-Bit Address (I2CxMSK only): 1 = Enables masking for bit Ax + 1 of incoming message address; bit match is not required in this position 0 = Disables masking for bit Ax + 1; bit match is required in this position DS70005258C-page 256  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 20.0 UNIVERSAL ASYNCHRONOUS RECEIVER TRANSMITTER (UART) Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices contains two UART modules. The Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) module is one of the serial I/O modules available in the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X device family. The UART is a full-duplex, asynchronous system that can communicate with peripheral devices, such as personal computers, LIN/J2602, RS-232 and RS-485 interfaces. The module also supports a hardware flow control option with the UxCTS and UxRTS pins, and also includes an IrDA® encoder and decoder. FIGURE 20-1: The primary features of the UARTx module are: • Full-Duplex, 8 or 9-Bit Data Transmission through the UxTX and UxRX Pins • Even, Odd or No Parity Options (for 8-bit data) • One or Two Stop bits • Hardware Flow Control Option with UxCTS and UxRTS Pins • Fully Integrated Baud Rate Generator with 16-Bit Prescaler • Baud Rates Ranging from 4.375 Mbps to 67 bps in 16x mode at 70 MIPS • Baud Rates Ranging from 17.5 Mbps to 267 bps in 4x mode at 70 MIPS • 4-Deep First-In First-Out (FIFO) Transmit Data Buffer • 4-Deep FIFO Receive Data Buffer • Parity, Framing and Buffer Overrun Error Detection • Support for 9-Bit mode with Address Detect (9th bit = 1) • Transmit and Receive Interrupts • A Separate Interrupt for all UARTx Error Conditions • Loopback mode for Diagnostic Support • Support for Sync and Break Characters • Support for Automatic Baud Rate Detection • IrDA® Encoder and Decoder Logic • 16x Baud Clock Output for IrDA Support A simplified block diagram of the UARTx module is shown in Figure 20-1. The UARTx module consists of these key hardware elements: • Baud Rate Generator • Asynchronous Transmitter • Asynchronous Receiver UARTx SIMPLIFIED BLOCK DIAGRAM Baud Rate Generator IrDA® Hardware Flow Control UxRTS/BCLKx UxCTS UARTx Receiver UxRX UARTx Transmitter UxTX  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 257 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 20.1 1. 2. UART Helpful Tips In multi-node, direct connect UART networks, UART receive inputs react to the complementary logic level defined by the URXINV bit (UxMODE), which defines the Idle state, the default of which is logic high (i.e., URXINV = 0). Because remote devices do not initialize at the same time, it is likely that one of the devices, because the RX line is floating, will trigger a Start bit detection and will cause the first byte received, after the device has been initialized, to be invalid. To avoid this situation, the user should use a pullup or pull-down resistor on the RX pin depending on the value of the URXINV bit. a) If URXINV = 0, use a pull-up resistor on the UxRX pin. b) If URXINV = 1, use a pull-down resistor on the UxRX pin. The first character received on a wake-up from Sleep mode, caused by activity on the UxRX pin of the UARTx module, will be invalid. In Sleep mode, peripheral clocks are disabled. By the time the oscillator system has restarted and stabilized from Sleep mode, the baud rate bit sampling clock, relative to the incoming UxRX bit timing, is no longer synchronized, resulting in the first character being invalid; this is to be expected. DS70005258C-page 258 20.2 UART Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 20.2.1 KEY RESOURCES • “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 20.3 UART Control Registers REGISTER 20-1: UxMODE: UARTx MODE REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 UARTEN(1) — USIDL IREN(2) RTSMD — UEN1 UEN0 bit 15 bit 8 HC/R/W-0 R/W-0 HC/R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 WAKE LPBACK ABAUD URXINV BRGH PDSEL1 PDSEL0 STSEL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HC = Hardware Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 UARTEN: UARTx Enable bit(1) 1 = UARTx is enabled; all UARTx pins are controlled by UARTx as defined by UEN 0 = UARTx is disabled; all UARTx pins are controlled by PORT latches; UARTx power consumption is minimal bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 USIDL: UARTx Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12 IREN: IrDA® Encoder and Decoder Enable bit(2) 1 = IrDA encoder and decoder are enabled 0 = IrDA encoder and decoder are disabled bit 11 RTSMD: Mode Selection for UxRTS Pin bit 1 = UxRTS pin is in Simplex mode 0 = UxRTS pin is in Flow Control mode bit 10 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 9-8 UEN: UARTx Pin Enable bits 11 = UxTX, UxRX and BCLKx pins are enabled and used; UxCTS pin is controlled by PORT latches 10 = UxTX, UxRX, UxCTS and UxRTS pins are enabled and used 01 = UxTX, UxRX and UxRTS pins are enabled and used; UxCTS pin is controlled by PORT latches 00 = UxTX and UxRX pins are enabled and used; UxCTS and UxRTS/BCLKx pins are controlled by PORT latches bit 7 WAKE: Wake-up on Start Bit Detect During Sleep Mode Enable bit 1 = UARTx continues to sample the UxRX pin, interrupt is generated on the falling edge; bit is cleared in hardware on the following rising edge 0 = No wake-up is enabled bit 6 LPBACK: UARTx Loopback Mode Select bit 1 = Enables Loopback mode 0 = Loopback mode is disabled Note 1: 2: Refer to “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for information on enabling the UARTx module for receive or transmit operation. This feature is only available for the 16x BRG mode (BRGH = 0).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 259 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 20-1: UxMODE: UARTx MODE REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 5 ABAUD: Auto-Baud Enable bit 1 = Enables baud rate measurement on the next character – requires reception of a Sync field (55h) before other data; cleared in hardware upon completion 0 = Baud rate measurement is disabled or completed bit 4 URXINV: UARTx Receive Polarity Inversion bit 1 = UxRX Idle state is ‘0’ 0 = UxRX Idle state is ‘1’ bit 3 BRGH: High Baud Rate Enable bit 1 = BRG generates 4 clocks per bit period (4x baud clock, High-Speed mode) 0 = BRG generates 16 clocks per bit period (16x baud clock, Standard mode) bit 2-1 PDSEL: Parity and Data Selection bits 11 = 9-bit data, no parity 10 = 8-bit data, odd parity 01 = 8-bit data, even parity 00 = 8-bit data, no parity bit 0 STSEL: Stop Bit Selection bit 1 = Two Stop bits 0 = One Stop bit Note 1: 2: Refer to “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for information on enabling the UARTx module for receive or transmit operation. This feature is only available for the 16x BRG mode (BRGH = 0). DS70005258C-page 260  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 20-2: R/W-0 UxSTA: UARTx STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 UTXISEL1 UTXINV R/W-0 UTXISEL0 U-0 — HC/R/W-0 UTXBRK R/W-0 (1) UTXEN R-0 R-1 UTXBF TRMT bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R-1 R-0 R-0 R/C-0 R-0 URXISEL1 URXISEL0 ADDEN RIDLE PERR FERR OERR URXDA bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Clearable bit HC = Hardware Clearable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15,13 UTXISEL: UARTx Transmission Interrupt Mode Selection bits 11 = Reserved; do not use 10 = Interrupt when a character is transferred to the Transmit Shift Register (TSR), and as a result, the transmit buffer becomes empty 01 = Interrupt when the last character is shifted out of the Transmit Shift Register; all transmit operations are completed 00 = Interrupt when a character is transferred to the Transmit Shift Register (this implies there is at least one character open in the transmit buffer) bit 14 UTXINV: UARTx Transmit Polarity Inversion bit If IREN = 0: 1 = UxTX Idle state is ‘0’ 0 = UxTX Idle state is ‘1’ If IREN = 1: 1 = IrDA® encoded, UxTX Idle state is ‘1’ 0 = IrDA encoded, UxTX Idle state is ‘0’ bit 12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 UTXBRK: UARTx Transmit Break bit 1 = Sends Sync Break on next transmission – Start bit, followed by twelve ‘0’ bits, followed by Stop bit; cleared by hardware upon completion 0 = Sync Break transmission is disabled or completed bit 10 UTXEN: UARTx Transmit Enable bit(1) 1 = Transmit is enabled, UxTX pin is controlled by UARTx 0 = Transmit is disabled, any pending transmission is aborted and buffer is reset; UxTX pin is controlled by the PORT bit 9 UTXBF: UARTx Transmit Buffer Full Status bit (read-only) 1 = Transmit buffer is full 0 = Transmit buffer is not full, at least one more character can be written bit 8 TRMT: Transmit Shift Register Empty bit (read-only) 1 = Transmit Shift Register is empty and transmit buffer is empty (the last transmission has completed) 0 = Transmit Shift Register is not empty, a transmission is in progress or queued bit 7-6 URXISEL: UARTx Receive Interrupt Mode Selection bits 11 = Interrupt is set on UxRSR transfer, making the receive buffer full (i.e., has four data characters) 10 = Interrupt is set on UxRSR transfer, making the receive buffer 3/4 full (i.e., has three data characters) 0x = Interrupt is set when any character is received and transferred from the UxRSR to the receive buffer; receive buffer has one or more characters Note 1: Refer to “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for information on enabling the UARTx module for transmit operation.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 261 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 20-2: UxSTA: UARTx STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 5 ADDEN: Address Character Detect bit (bit 8 of received data = 1) 1 = Address Detect mode is enabled; if 9-bit mode is not selected, this does not take effect 0 = Address Detect mode is disabled bit 4 RIDLE: Receiver Idle bit (read-only) 1 = Receiver is Idle 0 = Receiver is active bit 3 PERR: Parity Error Status bit (read-only) 1 = Parity error has been detected for the current character (character at the top of the receive FIFO) 0 = Parity error has not been detected bit 2 FERR: Framing Error Status bit (read-only) 1 = Framing error has been detected for the current character (character at the top of the receive FIFO) 0 = Framing error has not been detected bit 1 OERR: Receive Buffer Overrun Error Status bit (clear/read-only) 1 = Receive buffer has overflowed 0 = Receive buffer has not overflowed; clearing a previously set OERR bit (1  0 transition) resets the receiver buffer and the UxRSR to the empty state bit 0 URXDA: UARTx Receive Buffer Data Available bit (read-only) 1 = Receive buffer has data, at least one more character can be read 0 = Receive buffer is empty Note 1: Refer to “Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART)” (DS70000582) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for information on enabling the UARTx module for transmit operation. DS70005258C-page 262  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 21.0 CONFIGURABLE LOGIC CELL (CLC) Note: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Configurable Logic Cell (CLC)” (DS70005298) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). FIGURE 21-1: DS1 DS2 DS3 DS4 The Configurable Logic Cell (CLC) module allows the user to specify combinations of signals as inputs to a logic function and to use the logic output to control other peripherals or I/O pins. This provides greater flexibility and potential in embedded designs, since the CLC module can operate outside the limitations of software execution and supports a vast amount of output designs. There are four input gates to the selected logic function. These four input gates select from a pool of up to 32 signals that are selected using four data source selection multiplexers. Figure 21-1 shows an overview of the module. Figure 21-3 shows the details of the data source multiplexers and logic input gate connections. CLCx MODULE G1POL G2POL G3POL G4POL D FCY MODE CLC Inputs (32) Gate 1 LCOUT CLK LCOE LCEN Input Gate 2 Data Gate 3 Selection Gate 4 Gates Q CLCx Output Logic Function Logic TRISx Control CLCx Output See Figure 21-2 See Figure 21-3 LCPOL Interrupt det INTP Set CLCxIF INTN Interrupt det  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 263 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 21-2: CLCx LOGIC FUNCTION COMBINATORIAL OPTIONS AND – OR OR – XOR Gate 1 Gate 1 Gate 2 Logic Output Gate 3 Gate 2 Logic Output Gate 3 Gate 4 Gate 4 MODE = 000 MODE = 001 4-Input AND S-R Latch Gate 1 Gate 1 Gate 2 Gate 2 Logic Output Gate 3 Gate 4 S Gate 3 Q R Gate 4 MODE = 010 MODE = 011 1-Input D Flip-Flop with S and R 2-Input D Flip-Flop with R Gate 4 D Gate 2 S Gate 4 Q Logic Output D Gate 2 Gate 1 Gate 1 Logic Output Q Logic Output R R Gate 3 Gate 3 MODE = 100 MODE = 101 J-K Flip-Flop with R 1-Input Transparent Latch with S and R Gate 4 Gate 2 J Q Logic Output Gate 1 K Gate 4 R Gate 2 D Gate 1 LE Gate 3 S Q Logic Output R Gate 3 MODE = 110 DS70005258C-page 264 MODE = 111  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 21-3: CLCx INPUT SOURCE SELECTION DIAGRAM Data Selection Input 0 Input 1 Input 2 Input 3 Input 4 Input 5 Input 6 Input 7 000 Data Gate 1 Data 1 Non-Inverted G1D1T Data 1 Inverted G1D1N 111 DS1x (CLCxSEL) G1D2T G1D2N Input 8 Input 9 Input 10 Input 11 Input 12 Input 13 Input 14 Input 15 G1D3T Data 2 Non-Inverted Data 2 Inverted G1D4T 000 G1D4N Data Gate 2 Data 3 Non-Inverted Data 3 Inverted Gate 2 (Same as Data Gate 1) Data Gate 3 111 Gate 3 DS3x (CLCxSEL) Input 24 Input 25 Input 26 Input 27 Input 28 Input 29 Input 30 Input 31 G1D3N G1POL (CLCxCONH) 111 DS2x (CLCxSEL) Input 16 Input 17 Input 18 Input 19 Input 20 Input 21 Input 22 Input 23 Gate 1 000 (Same as Data Gate 1) Data Gate 4 000 Gate 4 Data 4 Non-Inverted (Same as Data Gate 1) Data 4 Inverted 111 DS4x (CLCxSEL) Note: All controls are undefined at power-up.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 265 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 21.1 Control Registers The CLCx Input MUX Select register (CLCxSEL) allows the user to select up to four data input sources using the four data input selection multiplexers. Each multiplexer has a list of eight data sources available. The CLCx module is controlled by the following registers: • • • • • CLCxCONL CLCxCONH CLCxSEL CLCxGLSL CLCxGLSH The CLCx Gate Logic Input Select registers (CLCxGLSL and CLCxGLSH) allow the user to select which outputs from each of the selection MUXes are used as inputs to the input gates of the logic cell. Each data source MUX outputs both a true and a negated version of its output. All of these eight signals are enabled, ORed together by the logic cell input gates. The CLCx Control registers (CLCxCONL and CLCxCONH) are used to enable the module and interrupts, control the output enable bit, select output polarity and select the logic function. The CLCx Control registers also allow the user to control the logic polarity of not only the cell output, but also some intermediate variables. REGISTER 21-1: CLCxCONL: CLCx CONTROL REGISTER (LOW) R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 LCEN — — — INTP INTN — — bit 15 bit 8 R-0 R-0 LCOE LCOUT R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LCPOL — — MODE2 MODE1 MODE0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 LCEN: CLCx Enable bit 1 = CLCx is enabled and mixing input signals 0 = CLCx is disabled and has logic zero outputs bit 14-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 INTP: CLCx Positive Edge Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt will be generated when a rising edge occurs on LCOUT 0 = Interrupt will not be generated bit 10 INTN: CLCx Negative Edge Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt will be generated when a falling edge occurs on LCOUT 0 = Interrupt will not be generated bit 9-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7 LCOE: CLCx Port Enable bit 1 = CLCx port pin output is enabled 0 = CLCx port pin output is disabled bit 6 LCOUT: CLCx Data Output Status bit 1 = CLCx output high 0 = CLCx output low bit 5 LCPOL: CLCx Output Polarity Control bit 1 = The output of the module is inverted 0 = The output of the module is not inverted bit 4-3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS70005258C-page 266  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 21-1: bit 2-0 CLCxCONL: CLCx CONTROL REGISTER (LOW) (CONTINUED) MODE: CLCx Mode bits 111 = Single Input Transparent Latch with S and R 110 = JK Flip-Flop with R 101 = Two-Input D Flip-Flop with R 100 = Single Input D Flip-Flop with S and R 011 = SR Latch 010 = Four-Input AND 001 = Four-Input OR-XOR 000 = Four-Input AND-OR REGISTER 21-2: CLCxCONH: CLCx CONTROL REGISTER (HIGH) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — G4POL G3POL G2POL G1POL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 G4POL: Gate 4 Polarity Control bit 1 = Channel 4 logic output is inverted when applied to the logic cell 0 = Channel 4 logic output is not inverted bit 2 G3POL: Gate 3 Polarity Control bit 1 = Channel 3 logic output is inverted when applied to the logic cell 0 = Channel 3 logic output is not inverted bit 1 G2POL: Gate 2 Polarity Control bit 1 = Channel 2 logic output is inverted when applied to the logic cell 0 = Channel 2 logic output is not inverted bit 0 G1POL: Gate 1 Polarity Control bit 1 = Channel 1 logic output is inverted when applied to the logic cell 0 = Channel 1 logic output is not inverted  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 267 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 21-3: U-0 CLCxSEL: CLCx INPUT MUX SELECT REGISTER R/W-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 DS4 U-0 R/W-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 DS3 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 — R/W-0 DS2 R/W-0 U-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DS1 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14-12 DS4: Data Selection MUX 4 Signal Selection bits See Table 21-1 for input selections. bit 11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10-8 DS3: Data Selection MUX 3 Signal Selection bits See Table 21-1 for input selections. bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-4 DS2: Data Selection MUX 2 Signal Selection bits See Table 21-1 for input selections. bit 3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 2-0 DS1: Data Selection MUX 1 Signal Selection bits See Table 21-1 for input selections. DS70005258C-page 268 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 21-1: CLC1 MULTIPLEXER INPUT SOURCES DS4 DS3 DS2 DS1 DSx Signal Source 000 CLCINA 001 System Clock 010 Timer1 Match 011 PWM1H 100 PWM5L 101 High-Speed PWM Clock 110 Timer2 Match 111 Timer3 Match 000 CLCINB 001 CLC2 Out 010 CMP1 Out 011 UART1 TX Out 100 ADC End-of-Conversion 101 DMA Channel 0 Interrupt 110 PWM1L 111 PWM5H 000 CLCINA 001 CLC1 Out 010 CMP2 Out 011 SPI1 SDO Out 100 UART1 RX 101 PWM2H 110 PWM6L 111 OCMP2 Sync Output 000 CLCINB 001 CLC2 Out 010 CMP3 Out 011 SDI1 100 PTGO26 101 ECAN1 110 PWM2L 111 PWM6H  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 269 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 21-2: CLC2 MULTIPLEXER INPUT SOURCES DS4 DS3 DS2 DS1 DSx DS70005258C-page 270 Signal Source 000 CLCINA 001 System Clock 010 Timer1 Match 011 PWM3H 100 PWM7L 101 High-Speed PWM Clock 110 Timer2 Match 111 Timer3 Match 000 CLCINB 001 CLC1 Out 010 CMP1 Out 011 UART2 TX Out 100 ADC End-of-Conversion 101 DMA Channel 0 Interrupt 110 PWM3L 111 PWM7H 000 CLCINA 001 CLC2 Out 010 CMP2 Out 011 SPI2 SDO Out 100 UART2 RX 101 PWM4H 110 PWM8L 111 OCMP2 Sync Output 000 CLCINB 001 CLC1 Out 010 CMP3 Out 011 SDI2 100 PTGO27 101 ECAN1 110 PWM4L 111 PWM8H  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 21-3: CLC3 MULTIPLEXER INPUT SOURCES DS4 DS3 DS2 DS1 DSx Signal Source 000 CLCINA 001 System Clock 010 Timer1 Match 011 PWM5H 100 REFO1 Clock Output 101 High-Speed PWM Clock 110 Timer2 Match 111 PWM3L 000 CLCINB 001 CLC4 Out 010 CMP1 Out 011 PWM5L 100 ADC End-of-Conversion 101 PWM3H 110 ICAP1 Sync Output 111 ICAP2 Sync Output 000 CLCINA 001 CLC3 Out 010 CMP2 Out 011 PWM6H 100 UART1 RX 101 DMA Channel 1 Interrupt 110 OCMP1 Sync Output 111 PWM4L 000 CLCINB 001 CLC4 Out 010 CMP3 Out 011 PWM6L 100 PTGO28 101 PWM4H 110 PC_PWM 111 OCMP3 Sync Output  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 271 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 21-4: CLC4 MULTIPLEXER INPUT SOURCES DSx DS4 DS3 DS2 DS1 000 DS70005258C-page 272 Signal Source CLCINA 001 PWM7H 010 Timer1 Match 011 INTOSC/LPRC Clock 100 REFO1 Clock Output 101 High-Speed PWM Clock 110 Timer2 Match 111 PWM1L 000 CLCINB 001 CLC3 Out 010 CMP1 Out 011 PWM7L 100 ADC End-of-Conversion 101 PWM1H 110 ICAP1 Sync Output 111 ICAP2 Sync Output 000 CLCINA 001 CLC4 Out 010 CMP2 Out 011 PWM8H 100 UART2 RX 101 DMA Channel 1 Interrupt 110 OCMP1 Sync Output 111 PWM2L 000 CLCINB 001 CLC3 Out 010 CMP3 Out 011 PWM8L 100 PTGO29 101 PWM2H 110 PWM Sync Output 111 OCMP3 Sync Output  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 21-4: CLCxGLSL: CLCx GATE LOGIC INPUT SELECT LOW REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 G2D4T G2D4N G2D3T G2D3N G2D2T G2D2N G2D1T G2D1N bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 G1D4T G1D4N G1D3T G1D3N G1D2T G1D2N G1D1T G1D1N bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 G2D4T: Gate 2 Data Source 4 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 14 G2D4N: Gate 2 Data Source 4 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 13 G2D3T: Gate 2 Data Source 3 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 12 G2D3N: Gate 2 Data Source 3 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 11 G2D2T: Gate 2 Data Source 2 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 10 G2D2N: Gate 2 Data Source 2 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 9 G2D1T: Gate 2 Data Source 1 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 8 G2D1N: Gate 2 Data Source 1 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 2 0 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 2 bit 7 G1D4T: Gate 1 Data Source 4 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 bit 6 G1D4N: Gate 1 Data Source 4 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 bit 5 G1D3T: Gate 1 Data Source 3 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 bit 4 G1D3N: Gate 1 Data Source 3 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 273 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 21-4: CLCxGLSL: CLCx GATE LOGIC INPUT SELECT LOW REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 3 G1D2T: Gate 1 Data Source 2 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 bit 2 G1D2N: Gate 1 Data Source 2 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 bit 1 G1D1T: Gate 1 Data Source 1 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 bit 0 G1D1N: Gate 1 Data Source 1 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 1 0 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 1 DS70005258C-page 274  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 21-5: CLCxGLSH: CLCx GATE LOGIC INPUT SELECT HIGH REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 G4D4T G4D4N G4D3T G4D3N G4D2T G4D2N G4D1T G4D1N bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 G3D4T G3D4N G3D3T G3D3N G3D2T G3D2N G3D1T G3D1N bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 G4D4T: Gate 4 Data Source 4 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 14 G4D4N: Gate 4 Data Source 4 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 13 G4D3T: Gate 4 Data Source 3 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 12 G4D3N: Gate 4 Data Source 3 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 11 G4D2T: Gate 4 Data Source 2 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 10 G4D2N: Gate 4 Data Source 2 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 9 G4D1T: Gate 4 Data Source 1 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 8 G4D1N: Gate 4 Data Source 1 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 4 0 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 4 bit 7 G3D4T: Gate 3 Data Source 4 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 4 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 bit 6 G3D4N: Gate 3 Data Source 4 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 4 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 bit 5 G3D3T: Gate 3 Data Source 3 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 3 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 bit 4 G3D3N: Gate 3 Data Source 3 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 3 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 275 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 21-5: CLCxGLSH: CLCx GATE LOGIC INPUT SELECT HIGH REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 3 G3D2T: Gate 3 Data Source 2 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 2 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 bit 2 G3D2N: Gate 3 Data Source 2 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 2 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 bit 1 G3D1T: Gate 3 Data Source 1 True Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 1 non-inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 bit 0 G3D1N: Gate 3 Data Source 1 Negated Enable bit 1 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is enabled for Gate 3 0 = Data Source 1 inverted signal is disabled for Gate 3 DS70005258C-page 276  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 22.0 HIGH-SPEED, 12-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “12-Bit High-Speed, Multiple SARs A/D Converter (ADC)” (DS70005213) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices have a high-speed, 12-bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) that features a low conversion latency, high resolution and oversampling capabilities to improve performance in AC/DC, DC/DC power converters. 22.1 Features Overview The high-speed, 12-bit multiple SARs Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) includes the following features: • Five ADC Cores: Four Dedicated Cores and One Shared (common) Core • User-Configurable Resolution of up to 12 Bits for each Core • Up to 3.25 Msps Conversion Rate per Channel at 12-Bit Resolution • Low Latency Conversion • Up to 22 Analog Input Channels, with a Separate 16-Bit Conversion Result Register for each Input • Conversion Result can be Formatted as Unsigned or Signed Data, on a per Channel Basis, for All Channels • Single-Ended and Pseudodifferential Conversions are available on All ADC Cores  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. • Simultaneous Sampling of up to Five Analog Inputs • Channel Scan Capability • Multiple Conversion Trigger Options for each Core, including: - PWM1 through PWM6 (primary and secondary triggers, and current-limit event trigger) - PWM Special Event Trigger - Timer1/Timer2 period match - Output Compare 1 and event trigger - External pin trigger event (ADTRG31) - Software trigger • Two Integrated Digital Comparators with Dedicated Interrupts: - Multiple comparison options - Assignable to specific analog inputs • Two Oversampling Filters with Dedicated Interrupts: - Provide increased resolution - Assignable to a specific analog input The module consists of five independent SAR ADC cores. Simplified block diagrams of the multiple SARs 12-bit ADC are shown in Figure 22-1, Figure 22-2 and Figure 22-3. The analog inputs (channels) are connected through multiplexers and switches to the Sample-and-Hold (S&H) circuit of each ADC core. The core uses the channel information (the output format, the Measurement mode and the input number) to process the analog sample. When conversion is complete, the result is stored in the result buffer for the specific analog input, and passed to the digital filter and digital comparator if they were configured to use data from this particular channel. The ADC module can sample up to five inputs at a time (four inputs from the dedicated SAR cores and one from the shared SAR core). If multiple ADC inputs request conversion on the shared core, the module will convert them in a sequential manner, starting with the lowest order input. The ADC provides each analog input the ability to specify its own trigger source. This capability allows the ADC to sample and convert analog inputs that are associated with PWM generators operating on independent time bases. DS70005258C-page 277 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 22-1: ADC MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM AVDD AVSS Voltage Reference (REFSEL) AN0 AN7 PGA1(1) Reference Dedicated ADC Core 0(2) Output Data Digital Comparator 0 Clock ADCMP0 Interrupt AN0ALT Digital Comparator 1 AN1 AN18 PGA2(1) ADCMP1 Interrupt Reference Dedicated ADC Core 1(2) Output Data Clock AN1ALT Reference AN2 VBG Reference(1) Dedicated ADC Core 2(2) AN11 Digital Filter 0 ADFL0DAT Digital Filter 1 ADFL1DAT Output Data ADFLTR0 Interrupt ADFLTR1 Interrupt Clock Reference AN3 AN15 Dedicated ADC Core 3(2) ADCBUF0 ADCBUF1 Output Data Clock ADCBUF21 ADCAN21 Interrupt Reference AN4 Shared ADC Core AN21 ADCAN0 Interrupt ADCAN1 Interrupt Output Data Clock Divider (CLKDIV) Clock Selection (CLKSEL) Instruction FRC Clock AUX Clock Note 1: PGA1, PGA2 and the Band Gap Reference (VBG) are internal analog inputs and are not available on device pins. 2: If the dedicated core uses an alternate channel, then shared core function cannot be used. DS70005258C-page 278  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 22-2: DEDICATED ADC CORES 0 TO 3 BLOCK DIAGRAM Positive Input PGAx Alternate Positive Input Positive Input + Selection (CxCHS) Reference Sampleand-Hold 12-Bit SAR ADC Negative Input – Selection (1) (DIFFx) Negative Input Trigger Stops Sampling AVSS ADC Core Clock Divider (ADCS bits) Output Data Clock Note 1: The DIFFx bit for the corresponding positive input channel must be set in order to use the negative differential input. FIGURE 22-3: SHARED ADC CORE BLOCK DIAGRAM AN4 + AN21 Analog Channel Number from Current Trigger AN9(1) Negative Input Selection (DIFFx)(1) Shared Sampleand-Hold 12-Bit SAR ADC ADC Core Clock Divider (SHRADC bits) – Sampling Time Reference Output Data Clock SHRSAMC AVSS Note 1: Differential-mode conversion is not available for the shared ADC core in dsPIC33EPXXGS70X/80X devices. For all other devices, the DIFFx bit for the corresponding positive input channel must be set to use AN9 as the negative differential input.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 279 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 22.2 Analog-to-Digital Converter Resources 22.2.1 Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. REGISTER 22-1: KEY RESOURCES • “12-Bit High-Speed, Multiple SARs A/D Converter (ADC)” (DS70005213) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools ADCON1L: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 1 LOW R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 ADON(1) — ADSIDL — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 (2) — — — — — — — NRE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 ADON: ADC Enable bit(1) 1 = ADC module is enabled 0 = ADC module is off bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 ADSIDL: ADC Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7 NRE: Noise Reduction Enable bit(2) 1 = Holds conversion process for one TADCORE when another core completes conversion to reduce noise between cores 0 = Noise reduction feature is disabled bit 6-3 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 2-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: 2: Set the ADON bit only after the ADC module has been configured. Changing ADC Configuration bits when ADON = 1 will result in unpredictable behavior. If the NRE bit in the ADCON1L register is set, the end of conversion time is adjusted to reduce the noise between ADC cores. Depending on the number of cores converting and the priority of the input, a few additional TADs may be inserted, making the conversion time slightly less deterministic. DS70005258C-page 280  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-2: ADCON1H: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 1 HIGH r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 FORM SHRRES1 SHRRES0 — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 7 FORM: Fractional Data Output Format bit 1 = Fractional 0 = Integer bit 6-5 SHRRES: Shared ADC Core Resolution Selection bits 11 = 12-bit resolution 10 = 10-bit resolution 01 = 8-bit resolution 00 = 6-bit resolution bit 4-0 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 281 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-3: ADCON2L: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 2 LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 r-0 R/W-0 r-0 REFCIE REFERCIE — EIEN — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SHREISEL2(1) SHREISEL1(1) SHREISEL0(1) bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SHRADCS bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 REFCIE: Band Gap and Reference Voltage Ready Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when the band gap will become ready 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for the band gap ready event bit 14 REFERCIE: Band Gap or Reference Voltage Error Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when a band gap or reference voltage error is detected 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for the band gap and reference voltage error event bit 13 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 12 EIEN: Early Interrupts Enable bit 1 = The early interrupt feature is enabled for the input channel interrupts (when the EISTATx flag is set) 0 = The individual interrupts are generated when conversion is done (when the ANxRDY flag is set) bit 11 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 10-8 SHREISEL: Shared Core Early Interrupt Time Selection bits(1) 111 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated eight TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 110 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated seven TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 101 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated six TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 100 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated five TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 011 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated four TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 010 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated three TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 001 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated two TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 000 = Early interrupt is set and interrupt is generated one TADCORE clock prior to when the data is ready bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 SHRADCS: Shared ADC Core Input Clock Divider bits These bits determine the number of TCORESRC (Source Clock Periods) for one shared TADCORE (Core Clock Period). 1111111 = 254 Source Clock Periods • • • 0000011 = 6 Source Clock Periods 0000010 = 4 Source Clock Periods 0000001 = 2 Source Clock Periods 0000000 = 2 Source Clock Periods Note 1: For the 6-bit shared ADC core resolution (SHRRES = 00), the SHREISEL settings, from ‘100’ to ‘111’, are not valid and should not be used. For the 8-bit shared ADC core resolution (SHRRES = 01), the SHREISEL settings, ‘110’ and ‘111’, are not valid and should not be used. DS70005258C-page 282  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-4: ADCON2H: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 2 HIGH HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 r-0 REFRDY REFERR — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 SHRSAMC bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SHRSAMC bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 REFRDY: Band Gap and Reference Voltage Ready Flag bit 1 = Band gap is ready 0 = Band gap is not ready bit 14 REFERR: Band Gap or Reference Voltage Error Flag bit 1 = Band gap was removed after the ADC module was enabled (ADON = 1) 0 = No band gap error was detected bit 13-10 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 9-0 SHRSAMC: Shared ADC Core Sample Time Selection bits These bits specify the number of shared ADC Core Clock Periods (TADCORE) for the shared ADC core sample time. 1111111111 = 1025 TADCORE • • • 0000000001 = 3 TADCORE 0000000000 = 2 TADCORE  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 283 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-5: ADCON3L: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 3 LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 HSC/R-0 R/W-0 HSC/R-0 REFSEL2 REFSEL1 REFSEL0 SUSPEND SUSPCIE SUSPRDY SHRSAMP CNVRTCH bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 HSC/R/W-0 SWLCTRG SWCTRG R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-13 R/W-0 CNVCHSEL5 CNVCHSEL4 CNVCHSEL3 CNVCHSEL2 CNVCHSEL1 CNVCHSEL0 x = Bit is unknown REFSEL: ADC Reference Voltage Selection bits Value VREFH VREFL 000 AVDD AVSS 001-111 = Unimplemented: Do not use bit 12 SUSPEND: All ADC Cores Triggers Disable bit 1 = All new trigger events for all ADC cores are disabled 0 = All ADC cores can be triggered bit 11 SUSPCIE: Suspend All ADC Cores Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when ADC core triggers are suspended (SUSPEND bit = 1) and all previous conversions are finished (SUSPRDY bit becomes set) 0 = Common interrupt is not generated for suspend ADC cores event bit 10 SUSPRDY: All ADC Cores Suspended Flag bit 1 = All ADC cores are suspended (SUSPEND bit = 1) and have no conversions in progress 0 = ADC cores have previous conversions in progress bit 9 SHRSAMP: Shared ADC Core Sampling Direct Control bit This bit should be used with the individual channel conversion trigger controlled by the CNVRTCH bit. It connects an analog input, specified by the CNVCHSEL bits, to the shared ADC core and allows extending the sampling time. This bit is not controlled by hardware and must be cleared before the conversion starts (setting CNVRTCH to ‘1’). 1 = Shared ADC core samples an analog input specified by the CNVCHSEL bits 0 = Sampling is controlled by the shared ADC core hardware bit 8 CNVRTCH: Software Individual Channel Conversion Trigger bit 1 = Single trigger is generated for an analog input specified by the CNVCHSEL bits; when the bit is set, it is automatically cleared by hardware on the next instruction cycle 0 = Next individual channel conversion trigger can be generated bit 7 SWLCTRG: Software Level-Sensitive Common Trigger bit 1 = Triggers are continuously generated for all channels with the software, level-sensitive common trigger selected as a source in the ADTRIGxL and ADTRIGxH registers 0 = No software, level-sensitive common triggers are generated bit 6 SWCTRG: Software Common Trigger bit 1 = Single trigger is generated for all channels with the software, common trigger selected as a source in the ADTRIGxL and ADTRIGxH registers; when the bit is set, it is automatically cleared by hardware on the next instruction cycle 0 = Ready to generate the next software common trigger bit 5-0 CNVCHSEL : Channel Number Selection for Software Individual Channel Conversion Trigger bits These bits define a channel to be converted when the CNVRTCH bit is set. DS70005258C-page 284  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-6: ADCON3H: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 3 HIGH R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CLKSEL1 CLKSEL0 CLKDIV5 CLKDIV4 CLKDIV3 CLKDIV2 CLKDIV1 CLKDIV0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SHREN — — — C3EN C2EN C1EN C0EN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 CLKSEL: ADC Module Clock Source Selection bits 11 = APLL 10 = FRC 01 = FOSC (System Clock x 2) 00 = FSYS (System Clock) bit 13-8 CLKDIV: ADC Module Clock Source Divider bits The divider forms a TCORESRC clock used by all ADC cores (shared and dedicated) from the TSRC ADC module clock source selected by the CLKSEL bits. Then, each ADC core individually divides the TCORESRC clock to get a core-specific TADCORE clock using the ADCS bits in the ADCORExH register or the SHRADCS bits in the ADCON2L register. 111111 = 64 Source Clock Periods • • • 000011 = 4 Source Clock Periods 000010 = 3 Source Clock Periods 000001 = 2 Source Clock Periods 000000 = 1 Source Clock Period bit 7 SHREN: Shared ADC Core Enable bit 1 = Shared ADC core is enabled 0 = Shared ADC core is disabled bit 6-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 C3EN: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Enable bits 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 is enabled 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 is disabled bit 2 C2EN: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Enable bits 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 is enabled 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 is disabled bit 1 C1EN: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Enable bits 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 is enabled 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 is disabled bit 0 C0EN: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Enable bits 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 is enabled 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 is disabled  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 285 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-7: ADCON4L: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 4 LOW U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — SAMC3EN SAMC2EN SAMC1EN SAMC0EN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 SAMC3EN: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Conversion Delay Enable bit 1 = After trigger, the conversion will be delayed and the ADC core will continue sampling during the time specified by the SAMC bits in the ADCORE3L register 0 = After trigger, the sampling will be stopped immediately and the conversion will be started on the next core clock cycle bit 2 SAMC2EN: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Conversion Delay Enable bit 1 = After trigger, the conversion will be delayed and the ADC core will continue sampling during the time specified by the SAMC bits in the ADCORE2L register 0 = After trigger, the sampling will be stopped immediately and the conversion will be started on the next core clock cycle bit 1 SAMC1EN: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Conversion Delay Enable bit 1 = After trigger, the conversion will be delayed and the ADC core will continue sampling during the time specified by the SAMC bits in the ADCORE1L register 0 = After trigger, the sampling will be stopped immediately and the conversion will be started on the next core clock cycle bit 0 SAMC0EN: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Conversion Delay Enable bit 1 = After trigger, the conversion will be delayed and the ADC core will continue sampling during the time specified by the SAMC bits in the ADCORE0L register 0 = After trigger, the sampling will be stopped immediately and the conversion will be started on the next core clock cycle DS70005258C-page 286  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-8: ADCON4H: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 4 HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 C3CHS1 C3CHS0 C2CHS1 C2CHS0 C1CHS1 C1CHS0 C0CHS1 C0CHS0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-6 C3CHS: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Input Channel Selection bits 1x = Reserved 01 = AN15 (differential negative input when DIFF3 (ADMOD0L) = 1) 00 = AN3 bit 5-4 C2CHS: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Input Channel Selection bits 11 = Reserved 10 = VREF band gap 01 = AN11 (differential negative input when DIFF2 (ADMOD0L) = 1) 00 = AN2 bit 3-2 C1CHS: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Input Channel Selection bits 11 = AN1ALT 10 = PGA2 01 = AN18 (differential negative input when DIFF1 (ADMOD0L) = 1) 00 = AN1 bit 1-0 C0CHS: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Input Channel Selection bits 11 = AN0ALT 10 = PGA1 01 = AN7 (differential negative input when DIFF0 (ADMOD0L) = 1) 00 = AN0  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 287 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-9: ADCON5L: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 5 LOW HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 SHRRDY — — — C3RDY C2RDY C1RDY C0RDY bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SHRPWR — — — C3PWR C2PWR C1PWR C0PWR bit 7 bit 0 Legend: U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 SHRRDY: Shared ADC Core Ready Flag bit 1 = ADC core is powered and ready for operation 0 = ADC core is not ready for operation bit 14-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 C3RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Ready Flag bit 1 = ADC core is powered and ready for operation 0 = ADC core is not ready for operation bit 10 C2RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Ready Flag bit 1 = ADC core is powered and ready for operation 0 = ADC core is not ready for operation bit 9 C1RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Ready Flag bit 1 = ADC core is powered and ready for operation 0 = ADC core is not ready for operation bit 8 C0RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Ready Flag bit 1 = ADC core is powered and ready for operation 0 = ADC core is not ready for operation bit 7 SHRPWR: Shared ADC Core x Power Enable bit 1 = ADC Core x is powered 0 = ADC Core x is off bit 6-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 C3PWR: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Power Enable bit 1 = ADC core is powered 0 = ADC core is off bit 2 C2PWR: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Power Enable bit 1 = ADC core is powered 0 = ADC core is off bit 1 C1PWR: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Power Enable bit 1 = ADC core is powered 0 = ADC core is off bit 0 C0PWR: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Power Enable bit 1 = ADC core is powered 0 = ADC core is off DS70005258C-page 288 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-10: ADCON5H: ADC CONTROL REGISTER 5 HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 WARMTIME bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SHRCIE — — — C3CIE C2CIE C1CIE C0CIE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-8 WARMTIME: ADC Dedicated Core x Power-up Delay bits These bits determine the power-up delay in the number of the Core Source Clock Periods (TCORESRC) for all ADC cores. 1111 = 32768 Source Clock Periods 1110 = 16384 Source Clock Periods 1101 = 8192 Source Clock Periods 1100 = 4096 Source Clock Periods 1011 = 2048 Source Clock Periods 1010 = 1024 Source Clock Periods 1001 = 512 Source Clock Periods 1000 = 256 Source Clock Periods 0111 = 128 Source Clock Periods 0110 = 64 Source Clock Periods 0101 = 32 Source Clock Periods 0100 = 16 Source Clock Periods 00xx = 16 Source Clock Periods bit 7 SHRCIE: Shared ADC Core Ready Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when ADC core is powered and ready for operation 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for an ADC core ready event bit 6-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 C3CIE: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Ready Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when ADC Core 3 is powered and ready for operation 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for an ADC Core 3 ready event bit 2 C2CIE: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Ready Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when ADC Core 2 is powered and ready for operation 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for an ADC Core 2 ready event bit 1 C1CIE: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Ready Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when ADC Core 1 is powered and ready for operation 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for an ADC Core 1 ready event bit 0 C0CIE: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Ready Common Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common interrupt will be generated when ADC Core 0 is powered and ready for operation 0 = Common interrupt is disabled for an ADC Core 0 ready event  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 289 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-11: ADCORExL: DEDICATED ADC CORE x CONTROL REGISTER LOW (x = 0 to 3) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 SAMC bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SAMC bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-10 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 9-0 SAMC: Dedicated ADC Core x Conversion Delay Selection bits These bits determine the time between the trigger event and the start of conversion in the number of the Core Clock Periods (TADCORE). During this time, the ADC Core x still continues sampling. This feature is enabled by the SAMCxEN bits in the ADCON4L register. 1111111111 = 1025 TADCORE • • • 0000000001 = 3 TADCORE 0000000000 = 2 TADCORE DS70005258C-page 290  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-12: ADCORExH: DEDICATED ADC CORE x CONTROL REGISTER HIGH (x = 0 to 3)(1) U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-1 — — — EISEL2 EISEL1 EISEL0 RES1 RES0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 ADCS bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-10 EISEL: ADC Core x Early Interrupt Time Selection bits 111 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated eight TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 110 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated seven TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 101 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated six TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 100 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated five TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 011 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated four TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 010 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated three TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 001 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated two TADCORE clocks prior to when the data is ready 000 = Early interrupt is set and an interrupt is generated one TADCORE clock prior to when the data is ready bit 9-8 RES: ADC Core x Resolution Selection bits 11 = 12-bit resolution 10 = 10-bit resolution 01 = 8-bit resolution 00 = 6-bit resolution bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 ADCS: ADC Core x Input Clock Divider bits These bits determine the number of Source Clock Periods (TCORESRC) for one Core Clock Period (TADCORE). 1111111 = 254 Source Clock Periods • • • 0000011 = 6 Source Clock Periods 0000010 = 4 Source Clock Periods 0000001 = 2 Source Clock Periods 0000000 = 2 Source Clock Periods Note 1: For the 6-bit ADC core resolution (RES = 00), the EISEL bits settings, from ‘100’ to ‘111’, are not valid and should not be used. For the 8-bit ADC core resolution (RES = 01), the EISEL bits settings, ‘110’ and ‘111’, are not valid and should not be used.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 291 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-13: ADLVLTRGL: ADC LEVEL-SENSITIVE TRIGGER CONTROL REGISTER LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LVLEN bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LVLEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown LVLEN: Level Trigger for Corresponding Analog Input Enable bits 1 = Input trigger is level-sensitive 0 = Input trigger is edge-sensitive REGISTER 22-14: ADLVLTRGH: ADC LEVEL-SENSITIVE TRIGGER CONTROL REGISTER HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 LVLEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 LVLEN: Level Trigger for Corresponding Analog Input Enable bits 1 = Input trigger is level-sensitive 0 = Input trigger is edge-sensitive DS70005258C-page 292  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-15: ADEIEL: ADC EARLY INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EIEN bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EIEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown EIEN: Early Interrupt Enable for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Early interrupt is enabled for the channel 0 = Early interrupt is disabled for the channel REGISTER 22-16: ADEIEH: ADC EARLY INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EIEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 EIEN: Early Interrupt Enable for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Early interrupt is enabled for the channel 0 = Early interrupt is disabled for the channel  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 293 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-17: ADEISTATL: ADC EARLY INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTER LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EISTAT bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EISTAT bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown EISTAT: Early Interrupt Status for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Early interrupt was generated 0 = Early interrupt was not generated since the last ADCBUFx read REGISTER 22-18: ADEISTATH: ADC EARLY INTERRUPT STATUS REGISTER HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 EISTAT bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 EISTAT: Early Interrupt Status for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Early interrupt was generated 0 = Early interrupt was not generated since the last ADCBUFx read DS70005258C-page 294  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-19: ADMOD0L: ADC INPUT MODE CONTROL REGISTER 0 LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DIFF7 SIGN7 DIFF6 SIGN6 DIFF5 SIGN5 DIFF4 SIGN4 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DIFF3 SIGN3 DIFF2 SIGN2 DIFF1 SIGN1 DIFF0 SIGN0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-1(odd) x = Bit is unknown DIFF: Differential-Mode for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel is differential 0 = Channel is single-ended bit 14-0 (even) SIGN: Output Data Sign for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel output data is signed 0 = Channel output data is unsigned REGISTER 22-20: ADMOD0H: ADC INPUT MODE CONTROL REGISTER 0 HIGH R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DIFF15 SIGN15 DIFF14 SIGN14 DIFF13 SIGN13 DIFF12 SIGN12 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DIFF11 SIGN11 DIFF10 SIGN10 DIFF9 SIGN9 DIFF8 SIGN8 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-1(odd) x = Bit is unknown DIFF: Differential-Mode for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel is differential 0 = Channel is single-ended bit 14-0 (even) SIGN: Output Data Sign for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel output data is signed 0 = Channel output data is unsigned  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 295 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-21: ADMOD1L: ADC INPUT MODE CONTROL REGISTER 1 LOW U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — DIFF21 SIGN21 DIFF20 SIGN20 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 DIFF19 SIGN19 DIFF18 SIGN18 DIFF17 SIGN17 DIFF16 SIGN16 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-1(odd) DIFF: Differential-Mode for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel is differential 0 = Channel is single-ended bit 10-0 (even) SIGN: Output Data Sign for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel output data is signed 0 = Channel output data is unsigned DS70005258C-page 296  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-22: ADIEL: ADC INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER LOW R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IE bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown IE: Common Interrupt Enable bits 1 = Common and individual interrupts are enabled for the corresponding channel 0 = Common and individual interrupts are disabled for the corresponding channel REGISTER 22-23: ADIEH: ADC INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 IE: Common Interrupt Enable bits 1 = Common and individual interrupts are enabled for the corresponding channel 0 = Common and individual interrupts are disabled for the corresponding channel  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 297 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-24: ADSTATL: ADC DATA READY STATUS REGISTER LOW HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 ANRDY bit 15 HSC/R-0 bit 8 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 ANRDY bit 7 bit 0 Legend: U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown ANRDY: Common Interrupt Enable for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel conversion result is ready in the corresponding ADCBUFx register 0 = Channel conversion result is not ready REGISTER 22-25: ADSTATH: ADC DATA READY STATUS REGISTER HIGH U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 ANRDY bit 7 bit 0 Legend: U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 ANRDY: Common Interrupt Enable for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 1 = Channel conversion result is ready in the corresponding ADCBUFx register 0 = Channel conversion result is not ready DS70005258C-page 298  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-26: ADTRIGxL: ADC CHANNEL TRIGGER x SELECTION REGISTER LOW (x = 0 to 5) U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRGSRC(4x+1) bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRGSRC(4x) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-8 TRGSRC(4x+1): Trigger Source Selection for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 11111 = ADTRG31 11110 = PTG Trigger Output 12 11101 = PWM Generator 6 current-limit trigger 11100 = PWM Generator 5 current-limit trigger 11011 = PWM Generator 4 current-limit trigger 11010 = PWM Generator 3 current-limit trigger 11001 = PWM Generator 2 current-limit trigger 11000 = PWM Generator 1 current-limit trigger 10111 = Output Compare 2 trigger 10110 = Output Compare 1 trigger 10101 = CLC2 output 10100 = PWM Generator 6 secondary trigger 10011 = PWM Generator 5 secondary trigger 10010 = PWM Generator 4 secondary trigger 10001 = PWM Generator 3 secondary trigger 10000 = PWM Generator 2 secondary trigger 01111 = PWM Generator 1 secondary trigger 01110 = PWM secondary Special Event Trigger 01101 = Timer2 period match 01100 = Timer1 period match 01011 = CLC1 output 01010 = PWM Generator 6 primary trigger 01001 = PWM Generator 5 primary trigger 01000 = PWM Generator 4 primary trigger 00111 = PWM Generator 3 primary trigger 00110 = PWM Generator 2 primary trigger 00101 = PWM Generator 1 primary trigger 00100 = PWM Special Event Trigger 00011 = Reserved 00010 = Level software trigger 00001 = Common software trigger 00000 = No trigger is enabled bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 299 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-26: ADTRIGxL: ADC CHANNEL TRIGGER x SELECTION REGISTER LOW (x = 0 to 5) (CONTINUED) bit 4-0 TRGSRC(4x): Trigger Source Selection for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 11111 = ADTRG31 11110 = PTG Trigger Output 30 11101 = PWM Generator 6 current-limit trigger 11100 = PWM Generator 5 current-limit trigger 11011 = PWM Generator 4 current-limit trigger 11010 = PWM Generator 3 current-limit trigger 11001 = PWM Generator 2 current-limit trigger 11000 = PWM Generator 1 current-limit trigger 10111 = Output Compare 2 trigger 10110 = Output Compare 1 trigger 10101 = CLC2 output 10100 = PWM Generator 6 secondary trigger 10011 = PWM Generator 5 secondary trigger 10010 = PWM Generator 4 secondary trigger 10001 = PWM Generator 3 secondary trigger 10000 = PWM Generator 2 secondary trigger 01111 = PWM Generator 1 secondary trigger 01110 = PWM secondary Special Event Trigger 01101 = Timer2 period match 01100 = Timer1 period match 01011 = CLC1 output 01010 = PWM Generator 6 primary trigger 01001 = PWM Generator 5 primary trigger 01000 = PWM Generator 4 primary trigger 00111 = PWM Generator 3 primary trigger 00110 = PWM Generator 2 primary trigger 00101 = PWM Generator 1 primary trigger 00100 = PWM Special Event Trigger 00011 = Reserved 00010 = Level software trigger 00001 = Common software trigger 00000 = No trigger is enabled DS70005258C-page 300  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-27: ADTRIGxH: ADC CHANNEL TRIGGER x SELECTION REGISTER HIGH (x = 0 to 5) U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRGSRC(4x+3) bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TRGSRC(4x+2) bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-8 TRGSRC(4x+3): Trigger Source Selection for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 11111 = ADTRG31 11110 = PTG Trigger Output 30 11101 = PWM Generator 6 current-limit trigger 11100 = PWM Generator 5 current-limit trigger 11011 = PWM Generator 4 current-limit trigger 11010 = PWM Generator 3 current-limit trigger 11001 = PWM Generator 2 current-limit trigger 11000 = PWM Generator 1 current-limit trigger 10111 = Output Compare 2 trigger 10110 = Output Compare 1 trigger 10101 = CLC2 output 10100 = PWM Generator 6 secondary trigger 10011 = PWM Generator 5 secondary trigger 10010 = PWM Generator 4 secondary trigger 10001 = PWM Generator 3 secondary trigger 10000 = PWM Generator 2 secondary trigger 01111 = PWM Generator 1 secondary trigger 01110 = PWM secondary Special Event Trigger 01101 = Timer2 period match 01100 = Timer1 period match 01011 = CLC1 output 01010 = PWM Generator 6 primary trigger 01001 = PWM Generator 5 primary trigger 01000 = PWM Generator 4 primary trigger 00111 = PWM Generator 3 primary trigger 00110 = PWM Generator 2 primary trigger 00101 = PWM Generator 1 primary trigger 00100 = PWM Special Event Trigger 00011 = Reserved 00010 = Level software trigger 00001 = Common software trigger 00000 = No trigger is enabled bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 301 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-27: ADTRIGxH: ADC CHANNEL TRIGGER x SELECTION REGISTER HIGH (x = 0 to 5) (CONTINUED) bit 4-0 TRGSRC(4x+2): Trigger Source Selection for Corresponding Analog Inputs bits 11111 = ADTRG31 11110 = PTG Trigger Output 30 11101 = PWM Generator 6 current-limit trigger 11100 = PWM Generator 5 current-limit trigger 11011 = PWM Generator 4 current-limit trigger 11010 = PWM Generator 3 current-limit trigger 11001 = PWM Generator 2 current-limit trigger 11000 = PWM Generator 1 current-limit trigger 10111 = Output Compare 2 trigger 10110 = Output Compare 1 trigger 10101 = CLC2 output 10100 = PWM Generator 6 secondary trigger 10011 = PWM Generator 5 secondary trigger 10010 = PWM Generator 4 secondary trigger 10001 = PWM Generator 3 secondary trigger 10000 = PWM Generator 2 secondary trigger 01111 = PWM Generator 1 secondary trigger 01110 = PWM secondary Special Event Trigger 01101 = Timer2 period match 01100 = Timer1 period match 01011 = CLC1 output 01010 = PWM Generator 6 primary trigger 01001 = PWM Generator 5 primary trigger 01000 = PWM Generator 4 primary trigger 00111 = PWM Generator 3 primary trigger 00110 = PWM Generator 2 primary trigger 00101 = PWM Generator 1 primary trigger 00100 = PWM Special Event Trigger 00011 = Reserved 00010 = Level software trigger 00001 = Common software trigger 00000 = No trigger is enabled DS70005258C-page 302  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-28: ADCAL0L: ADC CALIBRATION REGISTER 0 LOW HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 r-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CAL1RDY — — — — CAL1DIFF CAL1EN CAL1RUN bit 15 bit 8 HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 r-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CAL0RDY — — — — CAL0DIFF CAL0EN CAL0RUN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 CAL1RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Calibration Status Flag bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 calibration is finished 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 calibration is in progress bit 14-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 10 CAL1DIFF: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Differential-Mode Calibration bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 will be calibrated in Differential Input mode 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 will be calibrated in Single-Ended Input mode bit 9 CAL1EN: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Calibration Enable bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 calibration bits (CALxRDY, CALxDIFF and CALxRUN) can be accessed by software 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 1 calibration bits are disabled bit 8 CAL1RUN: Dedicated ADC Core 1 Calibration Start bit 1 = If this bit is set by software, the dedicated ADC Core 1 calibration cycle is started; this bit is automatically cleared by hardware 0 = Software can start the next calibration cycle bit 7 CAL0RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Calibration Status Flag bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 calibration is finished 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 calibration is in progress bit 6-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 2 CAL0DIFF: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Differential-Mode Calibration bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 will be calibrated in Differential Input mode 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 will be calibrated in Single-Ended Input mode bit 1 CAL0EN: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Calibration Enable bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 calibration bits (CALxRDY, CALxDIFF and CALxRUN) can be accessed by software 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 0 calibration bits are disabled bit 0 CAL0RUN: Dedicated ADC Core 0 Calibration Start bit 1 = If this bit is set by software, the dedicated ADC Core 0 calibration cycle is started; this bit is automatically cleared by hardware 0 = Software can start the next calibration cycle  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 303 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-29: ADCAL0H: ADC CALIBRATION REGISTER 0 HIGH HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 r-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CAL3RDY — — — — CAL3DIFF CAL3EN CAL3RUN bit 15 bit 8 HSC/R-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 r-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CAL2RDY — — — — CAL2DIFF CAL2EN CAL2RUN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 CAL3RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Calibration Status Flag bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 calibration is finished 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 calibration is in progress bit 14-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 10 CAL3DIFF: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Differential-Mode Calibration bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 will be calibrated in Differential Input mode 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 will be calibrated in Single-Ended Input mode bit 9 CAL3EN: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Calibration Enable bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 calibration bits (CALxRDY, CALxDIFF and CALxRUN) can be accessed by software 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 3 calibration bits are disabled bit 8 CAL3RUN: Dedicated ADC Core 3 Calibration Start bit 1 = If this bit is set by software, the dedicated ADC Core 3 calibration cycle is started; this bit is automatically cleared by hardware 0 = Software can start the next calibration cycle bit 7 CAL2RDY: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Calibration Status Flag bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 calibration is finished 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 calibration is in progress bit 6-4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 2 CAL2DIFF: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Differential-Mode Calibration bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 will be calibrated in Differential Input mode 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 will be calibrated in Single-Ended Input mode bit 1 CAL2EN: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Calibration Enable bit 1 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 calibration bits (CALxRDY, CALxDIFF and CALxRUN) can be accessed by software 0 = Dedicated ADC Core 2 calibration bits are disabled bit 0 CAL2RUN: Dedicated ADC Core 2 Calibration Start bit 1 = If this bit is set by software, the dedicated ADC Core 2 calibration cycle is started; this bit is automatically cleared by hardware 0 = Software can start the next calibration cycle DS70005258C-page 304  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-30: ADCAL1H: ADC CALIBRATION REGISTER 1 HIGH HS/R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 r-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CSHRRDY — — — — CSHRDIFF CSHREN CSHRRUN bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: r = Reserved bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HS = Hardware Settable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 CSHRRDY: Shared ADC Core Calibration Status Flag bit 1 = Shared ADC core calibration is finished 0 = Shared ADC core calibration is in progress bit 14-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11 Reserved: Maintain as ‘0’ bit 10 CSHRDIFF: Shared ADC Core Differential-Mode Calibration bit 1 = Shared ADC core will be calibrated in Differential Input mode 0 = Shared ADC core will be calibrated in Single-Ended Input mode bit 9 CSHREN: Shared ADC Core Calibration Enable bit 1 = Shared ADC core calibration bits (CSHRRDY, CSHRDIFF and CSHRRUN) can be accessed by software 0 = Shared ADC core calibration bits are disabled bit 8 CSHRRUN: Shared ADC Core Calibration Start bit 1 = If this bit is set by software, the shared ADC core calibration cycle is started; this bit is cleared automatically by hardware 0 = Software can start the next calibration cycle bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 305 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-31: ADCMPxCON: ADC DIGITAL COMPARATOR x CONTROL REGISTER (x = 0 or 1) U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 HSC/R-0 CHNL bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 HC/HS/R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMPEN IE STAT BTWN HIHI HILO LOHI LOLO bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HC = Hardware Clearable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared HS = Hardware Settable bit bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-8 CHNL: Input Channel Number bits If the comparator has detected an event for a channel, this channel number is written to these bits. 11111 = Reserved • • 10110 = Reserved 10101 = AN21 10100 = AN20 • • 00001 = AN1 00000 = AN0 bit 7 CMPEN: Comparator Enable bit 1 = Comparator is enabled 0 = Comparator is disabled and the STAT status bit is cleared bit 6 IE: Comparator Common ADC Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common ADC interrupt will be generated if the comparator detects a comparison event 0 = Common ADC interrupt will not be generated for the comparator bit 5 STAT: Comparator Event Status bit This bit is cleared by hardware when the channel number is read from the CHNL bits. 1 = A comparison event has been detected since the last read of the CHNL bits 0 = A comparison event has not been detected since the last read of the CHNL bits bit 4 BTWN: Between Low/High Comparator Event bit 1 = Generates a comparator event when ADCMPxLO ≤ ADCBUFx < ADCMPxHI 0 = Does not generate a digital comparator event when ADCMPxLO ≤ ADCBUFx < ADCMPxHI bit 3 HIHI: High/High Comparator Event bit 1 = Generates a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx ≥ ADCMPxHI 0 = Does not generate a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx ≥ ADCMPxHI bit 2 HILO: High/Low Comparator Event bit 1 = Generates a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx < ADCMPxHI 0 = Does not generate a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx < ADCMPxHI bit 1 LOHI: Low/High Comparator Event bit 1 = Generates a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx ≥ ADCMPxLO 0 = Does not generate a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx ≥ ADCMPxLO bit 0 LOLO: Low/Low Comparator Event bit 1 = Generates a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx < ADCMPxLO 0 = Does not generate a digital comparator event when ADCBUFx < ADCMPxLO DS70005258C-page 306  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-32: ADCMPxENL: ADC DIGITAL COMPARATOR x CHANNEL ENABLE REGISTER LOW (x = 0 or 1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMPEN bit 15 bit 8 R/W/0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMPEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown CMPEN: Comparator Enable for Corresponding Input Channels bits 1 = Conversion result for corresponding channel is used by the comparator 0 = Conversion result for corresponding channel is not used by the comparator REGISTER 22-33: ADCMPxENH: ADC DIGITAL COMPARATOR x CHANNEL ENABLE REGISTER HIGH (x = 0 or 1) U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMPEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 CMPEN: Comparator Enable for Corresponding Input Channels bits 1 = Conversion result for corresponding channel is used by the comparator 0 = Conversion result for corresponding channel is not used by the comparator  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 307 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-34: ADFLxCON: ADC DIGITAL FILTER x CONTROL REGISTER (x = 0 or 1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 HSC/R-0 FLEN MODE1 MODE0 OVRSAM2 OVRSAM1 OVRSAM0 IE RDY bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 FLCHSEL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ R = Readable bit W = Writable bit HSC = Hardware Settable/Clearable bit -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 FLEN: Filter Enable bit 1 = Filter is enabled 0 = Filter is disabled and the RDY bit is cleared bit 14-13 MODE: Filter Mode bits 11 = Averaging mode 10 = Reserved 01 = Reserved 00 = Oversampling mode bit 12-10 OVRSAM: Filter Averaging/Oversampling Ratio bits If MODE = 00: 111 = 128x (16-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.4 format) 110 = 32x (15-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.3 format) 101 = 8x (14-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.2 format) 100 = 2x (13-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.1 format) 011 = 256x (16-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.4 format) 010 = 64x (15-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.3 format) 001 = 16x (14-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.2 format) 000 = 4x (13-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register is in 12.1 format) If MODE = 11 (12-bit result in the ADFLxDAT register in all instances): 111 = 256x 110 = 128x 101 = 64x 100 = 32x 011 = 16x 010 = 8x 001 = 4x 000 = 2x bit 9 IE: Filter Common ADC Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Common ADC interrupt will be generated when the filter result will be ready 0 = Common ADC interrupt will not be generated for the filter bit 8 RDY: Oversampling Filter Data Ready Flag bit This bit is cleared by hardware when the result is read from the ADFLxDAT register. 1 = Data in the ADFLxDAT register is ready 0 = The ADFLxDAT register has been read and new data in the ADFLxDAT register is not ready bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ DS70005258C-page 308  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 22-34: ADFLxCON: ADC DIGITAL FILTER x CONTROL REGISTER (x = 0 or 1) (CONTINUED) bit 4-0 FLCHSEL: Oversampling Filter Input Channel Selection bits 11111 = Reserved • • • 10110 = Reserved 10101 = AN21 10100 = AN20 • • • 00001 = AN1 00000 = AN0  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 309 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 310  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 23.0 CONTROLLER AREA NETWORK (CAN) MODULE (dsPIC33EPXXXGS80X DEVICES ONLY) Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Enhanced Controller Area Network (ECAN™)” (DS70353) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. 23.1 Overview The Controller Area Network (CAN) module is a serial interface, useful for communicating with other CAN modules or microcontroller devices. This interface/ protocol was designed to allow communications within noisy environments. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS80X devices contain two CAN modules. The CAN module is a communication controller, implementing the CAN 2.0 A/B protocol, as defined in the BOSCH CAN specification. The module supports CAN 1.2, CAN 2.0A, CAN 2.0B Passive and CAN 2.0B Active versions of the protocol. The module implementation is a full CAN system. The CAN specification is not covered within this data sheet. The reader can refer to the BOSCH CAN specification for further details.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. The CAN module features are as follows: • Implementation of the CAN Protocol, CAN 1.2, CAN 2.0A and CAN 2.0B • Standard and Extended Data Frames • 0-8 Bytes of Data Length • Programmable Bit Rate, up to 1 Mbit/sec • Automatic Response to Remote Transmission Requests • Up to Eight Transmit Buffers with Application Specified Prioritization and Abort Capability (each buffer can contain up to 8 bytes of data) • Up to 32 Receive Buffers (each buffer can contain up to 8 bytes of data) • Up to 16 Full (Standard/Extended Identifier) Acceptance Filters • Three Full Acceptance Filter Masks • DeviceNet™ Addressing Support • Programmable Wake-up Functionality with Integrated Low-Pass Filter • Programmable Loopback mode supports Self-Test Operation • Signaling via Interrupt Capabilities for All CAN Receiver and Transmitter Error States • Programmable Clock Source • Programmable Link to Input Capture 2 (IC2) module for Timestamping and Network Synchronization • Low-Power Sleep and Idle modes The CAN bus module consists of a protocol engine and message buffering/control. The CAN protocol engine handles all functions for receiving and transmitting messages on the CAN bus. Messages are transmitted by first loading the appropriate data registers. Status and errors can be checked by reading the appropriate registers. Any message detected on the CAN bus is checked for errors and then matched against filters to see if it should be received and stored in one of the receive registers. DS70005258C-page 311 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 23-1: CANx MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM RxF15 Filter RxF14 Filter RxF13 Filter RxF12 Filter DMA Controller RxF11 Filter RxF10 Filter RxF9 Filter RxF8 Filter TRB7 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF7 Filter TRB6 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF6 Filter TRB5 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF5 Filter TRB4 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF4 Filter TRB3 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF3 Filter TRB2 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF2 Filter RxM2 Mask TRB1 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF1 Filter RxM1 Mask TRB0 TX/RX Buffer Control Register RxF0 Filter RxM0 Mask Transmit Byte Sequencer Message Assembly Buffer CAN Protocol Engine Control Configuration Logic CPU Bus Interrupts CxTX 23.2 CxRX Modes of Operation The CANx module can operate in one of several operation modes selected by the user. These modes include: • • • • • • Initialization mode Disable mode Normal Operation mode Listen Only mode Listen All Messages mode Loopback mode DS70005258C-page 312 Modes are requested by setting the REQOP bits (CxCTRL1). Entry into a mode is Acknowledged by monitoring the OPMODE bits (CxCTRL1). The module does not change the mode and the OPMODEx bits until a change in mode is acceptable, generally during bus Idle time, which is defined as at least eleven consecutive recessive bits.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 23.3 CAN Control Registers REGISTER 23-1: CxCTRL1: CANx CONTROL REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-1 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — CSIDL ABAT CANCKS REQOP2 REQOP1 REQOP0 bit 15 bit 8 R-1 R-0 R-0 U-0 R/W-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 OPMODE2 OPMODE1 OPMODE0 — CANCAP — — WIN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 CSIDL: CANx Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode bit 12 ABAT: Abort All Pending Transmissions bit 1 = Signals all transmit buffers to abort transmission 0 = Module will clear this bit when all transmissions are aborted bit 11 CANCKS: CANx Module Clock (FCAN) Source Select bit 1 = FCAN is equal to 2 * FP 0 = FCAN is equal to FP bit 10-8 REQOP: Request Operation Mode bits 111 = Set Listen All Messages mode 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Set Configuration mode 011 = Set Listen Only mode 010 = Set Loopback mode 001 = Set Disable mode 000 = Set Normal Operation mode bit 7-5 OPMODE: Operation Mode bits 111 = Module is in Listen All Messages mode 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Module is in Configuration mode 011 = Module is in Listen Only mode 010 = Module is in Loopback mode 001 = Module is in Disable mode 000 = Module is in Normal Operation mode bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 CANCAP: CANx Message Receive Timer Capture Event Enable bit 1 = Enables input capture based on CAN message receive 0 = Disables CAN capture bit 2-1 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 0 WIN: SFR Map Window Select bit 1 = Uses filter window 0 = Uses buffer window  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 313 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-2: CxCTRL2: CANx CONTROL REGISTER 2 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 DNCNT bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4-0 DNCNT: DeviceNet™ Filter Bit Number bits 10010-11111 = Invalid selection 10001 = Compare up to Data Byte 3, bit 6 with EID • • • 00001 = Compare up to Data Byte 1, bit 7 with EID 00000 = Do not compare data bytes DS70005258C-page 314 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-3: CxVEC: CANx INTERRUPT CODE REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — — FILHIT4 FILHIT3 FILHIT2 FILHIT1 FILHIT0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 R-1 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — ICODE6 ICODE5 ICODE4 ICODE3 ICODE2 ICODE1 ICODE0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-8 FILHIT: Filter Hit Number bits 10000-11111 = Reserved 01111 = Filter 15 • • • 00001 = Filter 1 00000 = Filter 0 bit 7 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 6-0 ICODE: Interrupt Flag Code bits 1000101-1111111 = Reserved 1000100 = FIFO almost full interrupt 1000011 = Receiver overflow interrupt 1000010 = Wake-up interrupt 1000001 = Error interrupt 1000000 = No interrupt • • • 0010000-0111111 = Reserved 0001111 = RB15 buffer interrupt • • • 0001001 = RB9 buffer interrupt 0001000 = RB8 buffer interrupt 0000111 = TRB7 buffer interrupt 0000110 = TRB6 buffer interrupt 0000101 = TRB5 buffer interrupt 0000100 = TRB4 buffer interrupt 0000011 = TRB3 buffer interrupt 0000010 = TRB2 buffer interrupt 0000001 = TRB1 buffer interrupt 0000000 = TRB0 buffer interrupt  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 315 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-4: R/W-0 DMABS2 bit 15 CxFCTRL: CANx FIFO CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 DMABS1 R/W-0 DMABS0 U-0 — U-0 — U-0 — U-0 — R/W-0 FSA4 R/W-0 FSA3 bit 7 Legend: R = Readable bit -n = Value at POR bit 12-5 bit 4-0 U-0 — U-0 — bit 8 U-0 — bit 15-13 U-0 — W = Writable bit ‘1’ = Bit is set R/W-0 FSA2 R/W-0 FSA1 R/W-0 FSA0 bit 0 U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown DMABS: DMA Buffer Size bits 111 = Reserved 110 = 32 buffers in RAM 101 = 24 buffers in RAM 100 = 16 buffers in RAM 011 = 12 buffers in RAM 010 = 8 buffers in RAM 001 = 6 buffers in RAM 000 = 4 buffers in RAM Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ FSA: FIFO Area Starts with Buffer bits 11111 = Receive Buffer RB31 11110 = Receive Buffer RB30 • • • 00001 = Transmit/Receive Buffer TRB1 00000 = Transmit/Receive Buffer TRB0 DS70005258C-page 316  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-5: CxFIFO: CANx FIFO STATUS REGISTER U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — FBP5 FBP4 FBP3 FBP2 FBP1 FBP0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 — — FNRB5 FNRB4 FNRB3 FNRB2 FNRB1 FNRB0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13-8 FBP: FIFO Buffer Pointer bits 011111 = RB31 buffer 011110 = RB30 buffer • • • 000001 = TRB1 buffer 000000 = TRB0 buffer bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 FNRB: FIFO Next Read Buffer Pointer bits 011111 = RB31 buffer 011110 = RB30 buffer • • • 000001 = TRB1 buffer 000000 = TRB0 buffer  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 317 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-6: CxINTF: CANx INTERRUPT FLAG REGISTER U-0 — bit 15 U-0 — R-0 TXBO R-0 TXBP R-0 RXBP R-0 TXWAR R-0 RXWAR R-0 EWARN bit 8 R/C-0 IVRIF bit 7 R/C-0 WAKIF R/C-0 ERRIF U-0 — R/C-0 FIFOIF R/C-0 RBOVIF R/C-0 RBIF R/C-0 TBIF bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit -n = Value at POR bit 15-14 bit 13 bit 12 bit 11 bit 10 bit 9 bit 8 bit 7 bit 6 bit 5 bit 4 bit 3 bit 2 C = Writable bit, but only ‘0’ can be Written to Clear bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ TXBO: Transmitter in Error State Bus Off bit 1 = Transmitter is in Bus Off state 0 = Transmitter is not in Bus Off state TXBP: Transmitter in Error State Bus Passive bit 1 = Transmitter is in Bus Passive state 0 = Transmitter is not in Bus Passive state RXBP: Receiver in Error State Bus Passive bit 1 = Receiver is in Bus Passive state 0 = Receiver is not in Bus Passive state TXWAR: Transmitter in Error State Warning bit 1 = Transmitter is in Error Warning state 0 = Transmitter is not in Error Warning state RXWAR: Receiver in Error State Warning bit 1 = Receiver is in Error Warning state 0 = Receiver is not in Error Warning state EWARN: Transmitter or Receiver in Error State Warning bit 1 = Transmitter or receiver is in Error Warning state 0 = Transmitter or receiver is not in Error Warning state IVRIF: Invalid Message Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred WAKIF: Bus Wake-up Activity Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred ERRIF: Error Interrupt Flag bit (multiple sources in CxINTF register) 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ FIFOIF: FIFO Almost Full Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred RBOVIF: RX Buffer Overflow Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred DS70005258C-page 318  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-6: bit 1 CxINTF: CANx INTERRUPT FLAG REGISTER (CONTINUED) RBIF: RX Buffer Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred TBIF: TX Buffer Interrupt Flag bit 1 = Interrupt request has occurred 0 = Interrupt request has not occurred bit 0 REGISTER 23-7: CxINTE: CANx INTERRUPT ENABLE REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 IVRIE WAKIE ERRIE — FIFOIE RBOVIE RBIE TBIE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7 IVRIE: Invalid Message Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled bit 6 WAKIE: Bus Wake-up Activity Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled bit 5 ERRIE: Error Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 FIFOIE: FIFO Almost Full Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled bit 2 RBOVIE: RX Buffer Overflow Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled bit 1 RBIE: RX Buffer Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled bit 0 TBIE: TX Buffer Interrupt Enable bit 1 = Interrupt request is enabled 0 = Interrupt request is not enabled  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 319 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-8: CxEC: CANx TRANSMIT/RECEIVE ERROR COUNT REGISTER R-0 R-0 TERRCNT7 TERRCNT6 R-0 R-0 R-0 TERRCNT5 TERRCNT4 TERRCNT3 R-0 R-0 R-0 TERRCNT2 TERRCNT1 TERRCNT0 bit 15 bit 8 R-0 R-0 RERRCNT7 RERRCNT6 R-0 R-0 R-0 RERRCNT5 RERRCNT4 RERRCNT3 R-0 RERRCNT2 R-0 R-0 RERRCNT1 RERRCNT0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 TERRCNT: Transmit Error Count bits bit 7-0 RERRCNT: Receive Error Count bits REGISTER 23-9: x = Bit is unknown CxCFG1: CANx BAUD RATE CONFIGURATION REGISTER 1 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 SJW1 SJW0 BRP5 BRP4 BRP3 BRP2 BRP1 BRP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 7-6 SJW: Synchronization Jump Width bits 11 = Length is 4 x TQ 10 = Length is 3 x TQ 01 = Length is 2 x TQ 00 = Length is 1 x TQ bit 5-0 BRP: Baud Rate Prescaler bits 11 1111 = TQ = 2 x 64 x 1/FCAN • • • 00 0010 = TQ = 2 x 3 x 1/FCAN 00 0001 = TQ = 2 x 2 x 1/FCAN 00 0000 = TQ = 2 x 1 x 1/FCAN DS70005258C-page 320 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-10: CxCFG2: CANx BAUD RATE CONFIGURATION REGISTER 2 U-0 R/W-x U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x — WAKFIL — — — SEG2PH2 SEG2PH1 SEG2PH0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x SEG2PHTS SAM SEG1PH2 SEG1PH1 SEG1PH0 PRSEG2 PRSEG1 PRSEG0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 14 WAKFIL: Select CAN Bus Line Filter for Wake-up bit 1 = Uses CAN bus line filter for wake-up 0 = CAN bus line filter is not used for wake-up bit 13-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10-8 SEG2PH: Phase Segment 2 bits 111 = Length is 8 x TQ • • • 000 = Length is 1 x TQ bit 7 SEG2PHTS: Phase Segment 2 Time Select bit 1 = Freely programmable 0 = Maximum of SEG1PHx bits or Information Processing Time (IPT), whichever is greater bit 6 SAM: Sample of the CAN Bus Line bit 1 = Bus line is sampled three times at the sample point 0 = Bus line is sampled once at the sample point bit 5-3 SEG1PH: Phase Segment 1 bits 111 = Length is 8 x TQ • • • 000 = Length is 1 x TQ bit 2-0 PRSEG: Propagation Time Segment bits 111 = Length is 8 x TQ • • • 000 = Length is 1 x TQ  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 321 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-11: CxFEN1: CANx ACCEPTANCE FILTER ENABLE REGISTER 1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 FLTEN bit 15 bit 8 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 R/W-1 FLTEN bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown FLTEN: Enable Filter n to Accept Messages bits 1 = Enables Filter n 0 = Disables Filter n REGISTER 23-12: CxBUFPNT1: CANx FILTERS 0-3 BUFFER POINTER REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F3BP3 F3BP2 F3BP1 F3BP0 F2BP3 F2BP2 F2BP1 F2BP0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F1BP3 F1BP2 F1BP1 F1BP0 F0BP3 F0BP2 F0BP1 F0BP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 F3BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 3 bits 1111 = Filter hits received in RX FIFO buffer 1110 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 14 • • • 0001 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 1 0000 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 0 bit 11-8 F2BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 2 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 7-4 F1BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 1 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 3-0 F0BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 0 bits (same values as bits 15-12) DS70005258C-page 322  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-13: CxBUFPNT2: CANx FILTERS 4-7 BUFFER POINTER REGISTER 2 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F7BP3 F7BP2 F7BP1 F7BP0 F6BP3 F6BP2 F6BP1 F6BP0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F5BP3 F5BP2 F5BP1 F5BP0 F4BP3 F4BP2 F4BP1 F4BP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 F7BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 7 bits 1111 = Filter hits received in RX FIFO buffer 1110 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 14 • • • 0001 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 1 0000 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 0 bit 11-8 F6BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 6 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 7-4 F5BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 5 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 3-0 F4BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 4 bits (same values as bits 15-12) REGISTER 23-14: CxBUFPNT3: CANx FILTERS 8-11 BUFFER POINTER REGISTER 3 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F11BP3 F11BP2 F11BP1 F11BP0 F10BP3 F10BP2 F10BP1 F10BP0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F9BP3 F9BP2 F9BP1 F9BP0 F8BP3 F8BP2 F8BP1 F8BP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 F11BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 11 bits 1111 = Filter hits received in RX FIFO buffer 1110 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 14 • • • 0001 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 1 0000 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 0 bit 11-8 F10BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 10 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 7-4 F9BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 9 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 3-0 F8BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 8 bits (same values as bits 15-12)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 323 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-15: CxBUFPNT4: CANx FILTERS 12-15 BUFFER POINTER REGISTER 4 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F15BP3 F15BP2 F15BP1 F15BP0 F14BP3 F14BP2 F14BP1 F14BP0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F13BP3 F13BP2 F13BP1 F13BP0 F12BP3 F12BP2 F12BP1 F12BP0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 F15BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 15 bits 1111 = Filter hits received in RX FIFO buffer 1110 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 14 • • • 0001 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 1 0000 = Filter hits received in RX Buffer 0 bit 11-8 F14BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 14 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 7-4 F13BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 13 bits (same values as bits 15-12) bit 3-0 F12BP: RX Buffer Mask for Filter 12 bits (same values as bits 15-12) DS70005258C-page 324  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-16: CxRXFnSID: CANx ACCEPTANCE FILTER n STANDARD IDENTIFIER REGISTER (n = 0-15) R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6 SID5 SID4 SID3 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x U-0 R/W-x U-0 R/W-x R/W-x SID2 SID1 SID0 — EXIDE — EID17 EID16 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-5 SID: Standard Identifier bits 1 = Message address bit, SIDx, must be ‘1’ to match filter 0 = Message address bit, SIDx, must be ‘0’ to match filter bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 EXIDE: Extended Identifier Enable bit If MIDE = 1: 1 = Matches only messages with Extended Identifier addresses 0 = Matches only messages with Standard Identifier addresses If MIDE = 0: Ignores EXIDE bit. bit 2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1-0 EID: Extended Identifier bits 1 = Message address bit, EIDx, must be ‘1’ to match filter 0 = Message address bit, EIDx, must be ‘0’ to match filter REGISTER 23-17: CxRXFnEID: CANx ACCEPTANCE FILTER n EXTENDED IDENTIFIER REGISTER (n = 0-15) R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown EID: Extended Identifier bits 1 = Message address bit, EIDx, must be ‘1’ to match filter 0 = Message address bit, EIDx, must be ‘0’ to match filter  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 325 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-18: CxFMSKSEL1: CANx FILTERS 7-0 MASK SELECTION REGISTER 1 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F7MSK1 F7MSK0 F6MSK1 F6MSK0 F5MSK1 F5MSK0 F4MSK1 F4MSK0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F3MSK1 F3MSK0 F2MSK1 F2MSK0 F1MSK1 F1MSK0 F0MSK1 F0MSK0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-14 F7MSK: Mask Source for Filter 7 bits 11 = Reserved 10 = Acceptance Mask 2 registers contain mask 01 = Acceptance Mask 1 registers contain mask 00 = Acceptance Mask 0 registers contain mask bit 13-12 F6MSK: Mask Source for Filter 6 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 11-10 F5MSK: Mask Source for Filter 5 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 9-8 F4MSK: Mask Source for Filter 4 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 7-6 F3MSK: Mask Source for Filter 3 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 5-4 F2MSK: Mask Source for Filter 2 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 3-2 F1MSK: Mask Source for Filter 1 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 1-0 F0MSK: Mask Source for Filter 0 bits (same values as bits 15-14) DS70005258C-page 326  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-19: CxFMSKSEL2: CANx FILTERS 15-8 MASK SELECTION REGISTER 2 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F15MSK1 F15MSK0 F14MSK1 F14MSK0 F13MSK1 F13MSK0 F12MSK1 F12MSK0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 F11MSK1 F11MSK0 F10MSK1 F10MSK0 F9MSK1 F9MSK0 F8MSK1 F8MSK0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-14 F15MSK: Mask Source for Filter 15 bits 11 = Reserved 10 = Acceptance Mask 2 registers contain mask 01 = Acceptance Mask 1 registers contain mask 00 = Acceptance Mask 0 registers contain mask x = Bit is unknown bit 13-12 F14MSK: Mask Source for Filter 14 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 11-10 F13MSK: Mask Source for Filter 13 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 9-8 F12MSK: Mask Source for Filter 12 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 7-6 F11MSK: Mask Source for Filter 11 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 5-4 F10MSK: Mask Source for Filter 10 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 3-2 F9MSK: Mask Source for Filter 9 bits (same values as bits 15-14) bit 1-0 F8MSK: Mask Source for Filter 8 bits (same values as bits 15-14)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 327 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-20: CxRXMnSID: CANx ACCEPTANCE FILTER MASK n STANDARD IDENTIFIER REGISTER (n = 0-2) R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6 SID5 SID4 SID3 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x U-0 R/W-x U-0 R/W-x R/W-x SID2 SID1 SID0 — MIDE — EID17 EID16 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-5 SID: Standard Identifier bits 1 = Includes bit, SIDx, in filter comparison 0 = Bit, SIDx, is a don’t care in filter comparison bit 4 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 3 MIDE: Identifier Receive Mode bit 1 = Matches only message types (standard or extended address) that correspond to the EXIDE bit in the filter 0 = Matches either standard or extended address message if filters match (i.e., if (Filter SIDx) = (Message SIDx) or if (Filter SIDx/EIDx) = (Message SIDx/EIDx)) bit 2 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 1-0 EID: Extended Identifier bits 1 = Includes bit, EIDx, in filter comparison 0 = Bit, EIDx, is a don’t care in filter comparison REGISTER 23-21: CxRXMnEID: CANx ACCEPTANCE FILTER MASK n EXTENDED IDENTIFIER REGISTER (n = 0-2) R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown EID: Extended Identifier bits 1 = Includes bit, EIDx, in filter comparison 0 = Bit, EIDx, is a don’t care in filter comparison DS70005258C-page 328  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-22: CxRXFUL1: CANx RECEIVE BUFFER FULL REGISTER 1 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXFUL bit 15 bit 8 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXFUL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Writable bit, but only ‘0’ can be Written to Clear bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown RXFUL: Receive Buffer n Full bits 1 = Buffer is full (set by module) 0 = Buffer is empty (cleared by user software) REGISTER 23-23: CxRXFUL2: CANx RECEIVE BUFFER FULL REGISTER 2 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXFUL bit 15 bit 8 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXFUL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Writable bit, but only ‘0’ can be Written to Clear bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown RXFUL: Receive Buffer n Full bits 1 = Buffer is full (set by module) 0 = Buffer is empty (cleared by user software)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 329 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-24: CxRXOVF1: CANx RECEIVE BUFFER OVERFLOW REGISTER 1 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXOVF bit 15 bit 8 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXOVF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Writable bit, but only ‘0’ can be Written to Clear bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown RXOVF: Receive Buffer n Overflow bits 1 = Module attempted to write to a full buffer (set by module) 0 = No overflow condition (cleared by user software) REGISTER 23-25: CxRXOVF2: CANx RECEIVE BUFFER OVERFLOW REGISTER 2 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXOVF bit 15 bit 8 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 R/C-0 RXOVF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: C = Writable bit, but only ‘0’ can be Written to Clear bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-0 x = Bit is unknown RXOVF: Receive Buffer n Overflow bits 1 = Module attempted to write to a full buffer (set by module) 0 = No overflow condition (cleared by user software) DS70005258C-page 330  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 23-26: CxTRmnCON: CANx TX/RX BUFFER mn CONTROL REGISTER (m = 0,2,4,6; n = 1,3,5,7) R/W-0 R-0 R-0 R-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TXENn TXABTn TXLARBn TXERRn TXREQn RTRENn TXnPRI1 TXnPRI0 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R-0 TXENm TXABTm(1) R-0 R-0 TXLARBm(1) TXERRm(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 TXREQm RTRENm TXmPRI1 TXmPRI0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-8 See Definition for bits 7-0, controls Buffer n. bit 7 TXENm: TX/RX Buffer m Selection bit 1 = Buffer, TRBm, is a transmit buffer 0 = Buffer, TRBm, is a receive buffer bit 6 TXABTm: Message Aborted bit(1) 1 = Message was aborted 0 = Message completed transmission successfully bit 5 TXLARBm: Message Lost Arbitration bit(1) 1 = Message lost arbitration while being sent 0 = Message did not lose arbitration while being sent bit 4 TXERRm: Error Detected During Transmission bit(1) 1 = A bus error occurred while the message was being sent 0 = A bus error did not occur while the message was being sent bit 3 TXREQm: Message Send Request bit 1 = Requests that a message be sent; the bit automatically clears when the message is successfully sent 0 = Clearing the bit to ‘0’ while set requests a message abort bit 2 RTRENm: Auto-Remote Transmit Enable bit 1 = When a remote transmit is received, TXREQx will be set 0 = When a remote transmit is received, TXREQx will be unaffected bit 1-0 TXmPRI: Message Transmission Priority bits 11 = Highest message priority 10 = High intermediate message priority 01 = Low intermediate message priority 00 = Lowest message priority Note 1: Note: This bit is cleared when TXREQmn is set. The buffers, SIDx, EIDx, DLCx, Data Field and Receive Status registers, are located in DMA RAM.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 331 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 23.4 CAN Message Buffers CAN Message Buffers are part of RAM memory. They are not CAN Special Function Registers. The user application must directly write into the RAM area that is configured for CAN Message Buffers. The location and size of the buffer area is defined by the user application. BUFFER 21-1: CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x — — — SID10 SID9 SID8 SID7 SID6 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x SID5 SID4 SID3 SID2 SID1 SID0 SRR IDE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-2 SID: Standard Identifier bits bit 1 SRR: Substitute Remote Request bit When IDE = 0: 1 = Message will request remote transmission 0 = Normal message When IDE = 1: The SRR bit must be set to ‘1’. bit 0 IDE: Extended Identifier bit 1 = Message will transmit an Extended Identifier 0 = Message will transmit a Standard Identifier BUFFER 21-2: x = Bit is unknown CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 1 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-0 EID: Extended Identifier bits DS70005258C-page 332 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY ( BUFFER 21-3: CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 2 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x EID5 EID4 EID3 EID2 EID1 EID0 RTR RB1 bit 15 bit 8 U-x U-x U-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x — — — RB0 DLC3 DLC2 DLC1 DLC0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-10 EID: Extended Identifier bits bit 9 RTR: Remote Transmission Request bit When IDE = 1: 1 = Message will request remote transmission 0 = Normal message When IDE = 0: The RTR bit is ignored. bit 8 RB1: Reserved Bit 1 User must set this bit to ‘0’ per CAN protocol. bit 7-5 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 4 RB0: Reserved Bit 0 User must set this bit to ‘0’ per CAN protocol. bit 3-0 DLC: Data Length Code bits BUFFER 21-4: R/W-x x = Bit is unknown CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 3 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 1 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Byte 1: CANx Message Byte 1 bits bit 7-0 Byte 0: CANx Message Byte 0 bits  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 333 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY BUFFER 21-5: R/W-x CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 4 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 3 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 2 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Byte 3: CANx Message Byte 3 bits bit 7-0 Byte 2: CANx Message Byte 2 bits BUFFER 21-6: R/W-x x = Bit is unknown CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 5 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 5 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 4 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Byte 5: CANx Message Byte 5 bits bit 7-0 Byte 4: CANx Message Byte 4 bits DS70005258C-page 334 x = Bit is unknown  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY BUFFER 21-7: R/W-x CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 6 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 7 bit 15 bit 8 R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x Byte 6 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-8 Byte 7: CANx Message Byte 7 bits bit 7-0 Byte 6: CANx Message Byte 6 bits BUFFER 21-8: x = Bit is unknown CANx MESSAGE BUFFER WORD 7 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x R/W-x FILHIT(1) bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15-13 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 12-8 FILHIT: Filter Hit Code bits(1) Encodes number of filter that resulted in writing this buffer. bit 7-0 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ Note 1: x = Bit is unknown Only written by module for receive buffers, unused for transmit buffers.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 335 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 336  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 24.0 HIGH-SPEED ANALOG COMPARATOR Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “High-Speed Analog Comparator Module” (DS70005128) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The high-speed analog comparator module monitors current and/or voltage transients that may be too fast for the CPU and ADC to capture.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 24.1 Features Overview The Switch Mode Power Supply (SMPS) comparator module offers the following major features: • Four Rail-to-Rail Analog Comparators • Dedicated 12-Bit DAC for each Analog Comparator • Up to Six Selectable Input Sources per Comparator: - Four external inputs - Two internal inputs from the PGAx module • Programmable Comparator Hysteresis • Programmable Output Polarity • Up to Two DAC Outputs to Device Pins • Multiple Voltage References for the DAC: - External References (EXTREF1 or EXTREF2) - AVDD • Interrupt Generation Capability • Functional Support for PWMx: - PWM duty cycle control - PWM period control - PWM Fault detected DS70005258C-page 337 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 24.2 Module Description The analog comparator input pins are typically shared with pins used by the Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) module. Both the comparator and the ADC can use the same pins at the same time. This capability enables a user to measure an input voltage with the ADC and detect voltage transients with the comparator. Figure 24-1 shows a functional block diagram of one analog comparator from the high-speed analog comparator module. The analog comparator provides high-speed operation with a typical delay of 15 ns. The negative input of the comparator is always connected to the DACx circuit. The positive input of the comparator is connected to an analog multiplexer that selects the desired source pin. FIGURE 24-1: HIGH-SPEED ANALOG COMPARATOR x MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM INSELx ALTINP PGA1OUT PGA2OUT MUX CMPxA(1) CMPxB(1) CMPxC(1) CMPxD(1) PWM Trigger (remappable I/O) CMPx(1) 0 1 EXTREF RANGE Pulse Stretcher and Digital Filter Status Interrupt Request CMPPOL AVDD MUX EXTREF1(2) DACx(1) DACOE EXTREF2(2,3) 12 DAC1/ DAC3 Output Buffer CMREFx DACOUT1 PGA1OUT DBCC bit FDEVOPT PGAOEN DACOE DAC2/ DAC4 Output Buffer DACOUT2(3) PGA2OUT PGAOEN Note 1: 2: 3: x = 1-4 EXTREF1 is connected to DAC1/DAC3. EXTREF2 is connected to DAC2/DAC4. Not available on all devices. DS70005258C-page 338  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 24.3 Module Applications This module provides a means for the SMPS dsPIC® DSC devices to monitor voltage and currents in a power conversion application. The ability to detect transient conditions and stimulate the dsPIC DSC processor and/or peripherals, without requiring the processor and ADC to constantly monitor voltages or currents, frees the dsPIC DSC to perform other tasks. The comparator module has a high-speed comparator and an associated 12-bit DAC that provides a programmable reference voltage to the inverting input of the comparator. The polarity of the comparator output is user-programmable. The output of the module can be used in the following modes: • • • • • Generate an Interrupt Trigger an ADC Sample and Convert Process Truncate the PWM Signal (current limit) Truncate the PWM Period (current minimum) Disable the PWM Outputs (Fault latch) The output of the comparator module may be used in multiple modes at the same time, such as: 1) generate an interrupt, 2) have the ADC take a sample and convert it, and 3) truncate the PWM output in response to a voltage being detected beyond its expected value. The comparator module can also be used to wake-up the system from Sleep or Idle mode when the analog input voltage exceeds the programmed threshold voltage. 24.4 Each DACx has an output enable bit, DACOE, in the CMPxCON register that enables the DACx reference voltage to be routed to an external output pin (DACOUTx). Refer to Figure 24-1 for connecting the DACx output voltage to the DACOUTx pins. Note 1: Ensure that multiple DACOE bits are not set in software. The output on the DACOUTx pin will be indeterminate if multiple comparators enable the DACx output. 2: DACOUT2 is not available on all devices. 24.5 Pulse Stretcher and Digital Logic The analog comparator can respond to very fast transient signals. After the comparator output is given the desired polarity, the signal is passed to a pulse stretching circuit. The pulse stretching circuit has an asynchronous set function and a delay circuit that ensures the minimum pulse width is three system clock cycles wide to allow the attached circuitry to properly respond to a narrow pulse event. The pulse stretcher circuit is followed by a digital filter. The digital filter is enabled via the FLTREN bit in the CMPxCON register. The digital filter operates with the clock specified via the FCLKSEL bit in the CMPxCON register. The comparator signal must be stable in a high or low state, for at least three of the selected clock cycles, for it to pass through the digital filter. Digital-to-Analog Comparator (DAC) Each analog comparator has a dedicated 12-bit DAC that is used to program the comparator threshold voltage via the CMPxDAC register. The DAC voltage reference source is selected using the EXTREF and RANGE bits in the CMPxCON register. The EXTREF bit selects either the external voltage reference, EXTREFx, or an internal source as the voltage reference source. The EXTREFx input enables users to connect to a voltage reference that better suits their application. The RANGE bit enables AVDD as the voltage reference source for the DAC when an internal voltage reference is selected. Note: EXTREF2 is not available on all devices.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 339 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 24.6 Hysteresis 24.7 An additional feature of the module is hysteresis control. Hysteresis can be enabled or disabled and its amplitude can be controlled by the HYSSEL bits in the CMPxCON register. Three different values are available: 15 mV, 30 mV and 45 mV. It is also possible to select the edge (rising or falling) to which hysteresis is to be applied. Hysteresis control prevents the comparator output from continuously changing state because of small perturbations (noise) at the input (see Figure 24-2). FIGURE 24-2: HYSTERESIS CONTROL Output Analog Comparator Resources Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. 24.7.1 KEY RESOURCES • “High-Speed Analog Comparator Module” (DS70005128) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools Hysteresis Range (15 mV/30 mV/45 mV) Input DS70005258C-page 340  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 24-1: CMPxCON: COMPARATOR x CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMPON — CMPSIDL HYSSEL1 HYSSEL0 FLTREN FCLKSEL DACOE bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 HS/HC-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 INSEL1 INSEL0 EXTREF HYSPOL CMPSTAT ALTINP CMPPOL RANGE bit 7 bit 0 Legend: HC = Hardware Clearable bit HS = Hardware Settable bit R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 CMPON: Comparator Operating Mode bit 1 = Comparator module is enabled 0 = Comparator module is disabled (reduces power consumption) bit 14 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 13 CMPSIDL: Comparator Stop in Idle Mode bit 1 = Discontinues module operation when device enters Idle mode. 0 = Continues module operation in Idle mode If a device has multiple comparators, any CMPSIDL bit set to ‘1’ disables all comparators while in Idle mode. bit 12-11 HYSSEL: Comparator Hysteresis Select bits 11 = 45 mV hysteresis 10 = 30 mV hysteresis 01 = 15 mV hysteresis 00 = No hysteresis is selected bit 10 FLTREN: Digital Filter Enable bit 1 = Digital filter is enabled 0 = Digital filter is disabled bit 9 FCLKSEL: Digital Filter and Pulse Stretcher Clock Select bit 1 = Digital filter and pulse stretcher operate with the PWM clock 0 = Digital filter and pulse stretcher operate with the system clock bit 8 DACOE: DACx Output Enable bit 1 = DACx analog voltage is connected to the DACOUTx pin(1) 0 = DACx analog voltage is not connected to the DACOUTx pin bit 7-6 INSEL: Input Source Select for Comparator bits If ALTINP = 0, Select from Comparator Inputs: 11 = Selects CMPxD input pin 10 = Selects CMPxC input pin 01 = Selects CMPxB input pin 00 = Selects CMPxA input pin If ALTINP = 1, Select from Alternate Inputs: 11 = Reserved 10 = Reserved 01 = Selects PGA2 output 00 = Selects PGA1 output Note 1: DACOUTx can be associated only with a single comparator at any given time. The software must ensure that multiple comparators do not enable the DACx output by setting their respective DACOE bit.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 341 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 24-1: CMPxCON: COMPARATOR x CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) bit 5 EXTREF: Enable External Reference bit 1 = External source provides reference to DACx (maximum DAC voltage is determined by the external voltage source) 0 = AVDD provides reference to DACx (maximum DAC voltage is AVDD) bit 4 HYSPOL: Comparator Hysteresis Polarity Select bit 1 = Hysteresis is applied to the falling edge of the comparator output 0 = Hysteresis is applied to the rising edge of the comparator output bit 3 CMPSTAT: Comparator Current State bit Reflects the current output state of Comparator x, including the setting of the CMPPOL bit. bit 2 ALTINP: Alternate Input Select bit 1 = INSEL bits select alternate inputs 0 = INSEL bits select comparator inputs bit 1 CMPPOL: Comparator Output Polarity Control bit 1 = Output is inverted 0 = Output is non-inverted bit 0 RANGE: DACx Output Voltage Range Select bit 1 = AVDD is the maximum DACx output voltage 0 = Unimplemented, do not use Note 1: DACOUTx can be associated only with a single comparator at any given time. The software must ensure that multiple comparators do not enable the DACx output by setting their respective DACOE bit. DS70005258C-page 342  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 24-2: CMPxDAC: COMPARATOR x DAC CONTROL REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMREF bit 15 bit 8 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 CMREF bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-12 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 11-0 CMREF: Comparator Reference Voltage Select bits 111111111111 • • • = ([CMREF] * (AVDD)/4096) volts (EXTREF = 0) • or ([CMREF] * (EXTREF)/4096) volts (EXTREF = 1) • • 000000000000  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 343 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 344  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 25.0 PROGRAMMABLE GAIN AMPLIFIER (PGA) Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA)” (DS70005146) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. FIGURE 25-1: The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices have two Programmable Gain Amplifiers (PGA1, PGA2). The PGA is an op amp-based, non-inverting amplifier with user-programmable gains. The output of the PGA can be connected to a number of dedicated Sampleand-Hold inputs of the Analog-to-Digital Converter and/ or to the high-speed analog comparator module. The PGA has five selectable gains and may be used as a ground referenced amplifier (single-ended) or used with an independent ground reference point. Key features of the PGA module include: • • • • • Single-Ended or Independent Ground Reference Selectable Gains: 4x, 8x, 16x, 32x and 64x High Gain Bandwidth Rail-to-Rail Output Voltage Wide Input Voltage Range PGAx MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM GAIN = 6 GAIN = 5 GAIN = 4 GAIN = 3 GAIN = 2 Gain of 64x Gain of 32x Gain of 16x Gain of 8x Gain of 4x – PGAx Negative Input PGAxOUT AMPx + PGAx Positive Input PGACAL Note 1: x = 1 and 2.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 345 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 25.1 Module Description input source. To provide an independent ground reference, the PGAxN2 and PGAxN3 pins are available as the negative input source to the PGAx module. The Programmable Gain Amplifiers are used to amplify small voltages (i.e., voltages across burden/shunt resistors) to improve the signal-to-noise ratio of the measured signal. The PGAx output voltage can be read by any of the four dedicated Sample-and-Hold circuits on the ADC module. The output voltage can also be fed to the comparator module for overcurrent/ voltage protection. Figure 25-2 shows a functional block diagram of the PGAx module. Refer to Section 22.0 “High-Speed, 12-Bit Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)” and Section 24.0 “High-Speed Analog Comparator” for more interconnection details. Note 1: Not all PGA positive/negative inputs are available on all devices. Refer to the specific device pinout for available input source pins. The output voltage of the PGAx module can be connected to the DACOUTx pin by setting the PGAOEN bit in the PGAxCON register. When the PGAOEN bit is enabled, the output voltage of PGA1 is connected to DACOUT1 and PGA2 is connected to DACOUT2. For devices with a single DACOUTx pin, the output voltage of PGA2 can be connected to DACOUT1 by configuring the DBCC Configuration bit in the FDEVOPT register (FDEVOPT). The gain of the PGAx module is selectable via the GAIN bits in the PGAxCON register. There are five selectable gains, ranging from 4x to 64x. The SELPI and SELNI bits in the PGAxCON register select one of four positive/negative inputs to the PGAx module. For single-ended applications, the SELNI bits will select the ground as the negative FIGURE 25-2: If both the DACx output voltage and PGAx output voltage are connected to the DACOUTx pin, the resulting output voltage would be a combination of signals. There is no assigned priority between the PGAx module and the DACx module. PGAx FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM INSEL (CMPCONx) SELPI PGAxCAL(1) PGAxCON(1) + – PGAEN GAIN PGAxP1(1) DACx PGAxP2(1) PGACAL PGAxP3(1) CxCHS (ADCON4H) PGAxP4(1) ADC + S&H PGAx(1) GND – PGAxN2(1) PGAxN3(1,3) GND PGAOEN SELNI To DACOUTx Pin(2) Note 1: x = 1 and 2. 2: The DACOUT2 device pin is only available on 64-pin devices. 3: The PGAxN3 input is not available on 28-pin devices. DS70005258C-page 346  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 25.2 PGA Resources 25.2.1 Many useful resources are provided on the main product page of the Microchip website for the devices listed in this data sheet. This product page contains the latest updates and additional information. REGISTER 25-1: KEY RESOURCES • “Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA)” (DS70005146) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” • Code Samples • Application Notes • Software Libraries • Webinars • All Related “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” Sections • Development Tools PGAxCON: PGAx CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PGAEN PGAOEN SELPI2 SELPI1 SELPI0 SELNI2 SELNI1 SELNI0 bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — — — — GAIN2 GAIN1 GAIN0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared bit 15 PGAEN: PGAx Enable bit 1 = PGAx module is enabled 0 = PGAx module is disabled (reduces power consumption) bit 14 PGAOEN: PGAx Output Enable bit 1 = PGAx output is connected to the DACOUTx pin 0 = PGAx output is not connected to the DACOUTx pin bit 13-11 SELPI: PGAx Positive Input Selection bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Reserved 011 = PGAxP4 010 = PGAxP3 001 = PGAxP2 000 = PGAxP1 bit 10-8 SELNI: PGAx Negative Input Selection bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Reserved 011 = Ground (Single-Ended mode) 010 = PGAxN3 001 = PGAxN2 000 = Ground (Single-Ended mode) bit 7-3 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. x = Bit is unknown DS70005258C-page 347 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 25-1: bit 2-0 PGAxCON: PGAx CONTROL REGISTER (CONTINUED) GAIN: PGAx Gain Selection bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Gain of 64x 101 = Gain of 32x 100 = Gain of 16x 011 = Gain of 8x 010 = Gain of 4x 001 = Reserved 000 = Reserved REGISTER 25-2: PGAxCAL: PGAx CALIBRATION REGISTER U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 — — — — — — — — bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 — — R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 PGACAL bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 PGACAL: PGAx Offset Calibration bits The calibration values for PGA1 and PGA2 must be copied from Flash addresses, 0x800E48 and 0x800E4C, respectively, into these bits before the module is enabled. Refer to the calibration data address table (Table 27-3) in Section 27.0 “Special Features” for more information. DS70005258C-page 348  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 26.0 CONSTANT-CURRENT SOURCE Note 1: This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to the related section of the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). 2: Some registers and associated bits described in this section may not be available on all devices. Refer to Section 4.0 “Memory Organization” in this data sheet for device-specific register and bit information. The constant-current source module is a precision current generator and is used in conjunction with the ADC module to measure the resistance of external resistors connected to device pins. FIGURE 26-1: 26.1 Features Overview The constant-current source module offers the following major features: • Constant-Current Generator (10 µA nominal) • Internal Selectable Connection to One of Four Pins • Enable/Disable bit 26.2 Module Description Figure 26-1 shows a functional block diagram of the constant-current source module. It consists of a precision current generator with a nominal value of 10 µA. The module can be enabled and disabled using the ISRCEN bit in the ISRCCON register. The output of the current generator is internally connected to a device pin. The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family can have up to four selectable current source pins. The OUTSEL bits in the ISRCCON register allow selection of the target pin. The current source is calibrated during testing. CONSTANT-CURRENT SOURCE MODULE BLOCK DIAGRAM Constant-Current Source ISRC1 ISRC2 M U X ISRC3 ISRC4 ISRCEN OUTSEL  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 349 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 26.3 Current Source Control Register REGISTER 26-1: ISRCCON: CONSTANT-CURRENT SOURCE CONTROL REGISTER R/W-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 ISRCEN — — — — OUTSEL2(1) R/W-0 R/W-0 OUTSEL1(1) OUTSEL0(1) bit 15 bit 8 U-0 U-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 R/W-0 — — ISRCCAL5 ISRCCAL4 ISRCCAL3 ISRCCAL2 ISRCCAL1 ISRCCAL0 bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Readable bit W = Writable bit U = Unimplemented bit, read as ‘0’ -n = Value at POR ‘1’ = Bit is set ‘0’ = Bit is cleared x = Bit is unknown bit 15 ISRCEN: Constant-Current Source Enable bit 1 = Current source is enabled 0 = Current source is disabled bit 14-11 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 10-8 OUTSEL: Output Constant-Current Select bits(1) 111 = Reserved 110 = Reserved 101 = Reserved 100 = Reserved 011 = Input pin, ISRC4 (AN4) 010 = Input pin, ISRC3 (AN5) 001 = Input pin, ISRC2 (AN6) 000 = Input pin, ISRC1 (AN12) bit 7-6 Unimplemented: Read as ‘0’ bit 5-0 ISRCCAL: Constant-Current Source Calibration bits The calibration value must be copied from Flash address, 0x800E78, into these bits before the module is enabled. Refer to the calibration data address table (Table 27-3) in Section 27.0 “Special Features” for more information. Note 1: ISRC1 and ISCR3 are not available on 28, 44 and 48-pin packages. Refer to the “Pin Diagrams” section for availability. DS70005258C-page 350  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 27.0 Note: SPECIAL FEATURES This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to “Device Configuration” (DS70000618), “Watchdog Timer and Power-Saving Modes” (DS70615) and “CodeGuard™ Intermediate Security” (DS70005182) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip website (www.microchip.com). The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices include several features intended to maximize application flexibility and reliability, and minimize cost through elimination of external components. These are: • • • • • • • Flexible Configuration Watchdog Timer (WDT) Code Protection and CodeGuard™ Security JTAG Boundary Scan Interface In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) In-Circuit Emulation Brown-out Reset (BOR) 27.1 In dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices, the Configuration Words are implemented as volatile memory. This means that configuration data must be programmed each time the device is powered up. Configuration data is stored at the end of the on-chip program memory space, known as the Flash Configuration Words. Their specific locations are shown in Table 27-1 with detailed descriptions in Table 27-2. The configuration data is automatically loaded from the Flash Configuration Words to the proper Configuration Shadow registers during device Resets. For devices operating in Dual Partition Flash modes, the BSEQx bits (FBTSEQ) determine which panel is the Active Partition at start-up and the Configuration Words from that panel are loaded into the Configuration Shadow registers. Note: Configuration data is reloaded on all types of device Resets. When creating applications for these devices, users should always specifically allocate the location of the Flash Configuration Words for configuration data in their code for the compiler. This is to make certain that program code is not stored in this address when the code is compiled. Program code executing out of configuration space will cause a device Reset. Note:  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Configuration Bits Performing a page erase operation on the last page of program memory clears the Flash Configuration Words. DS70005258C-page 351 Name FSEC FBSLIM FSIGN FOSCSEL FOSC FWDT FPOR FICD Address CONFIGURATION REGISTER MAP(3) Device Memory Size (Kbytes) 00AF80 64 015780 128 00AF90 64 015790 128 00AF90 64 015794 128 00AF98 64 015798 128 00AF9C 64 01579C 128 00AFA0 64 0157A0 128 00AFA4 64 0157A4 128 00AFA8 64 0157A8 128 FDEVOPT 00AFAC 64 0157AC 128 FALTREG 00AFB0 64 0157B0 128 FBTSEQ  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. FBOOT(4) Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 00AFFC 64 0157FC 128 801000 — Bits 23-16 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 — AIVTDIS — — — — — — — — Reserved(2) — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — IESO — — — — — — — — — PLLKEN — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — BTSWP — — — — — — — Reserved(1) — JTAGEN — — — — — — — — — — — — — DBCC — — — CSS Bit 8 CWRP Bit 7 Bit 6 GSS — — CTXT4 — Bit 4 Bit 3 GWRP — BSEN — — — — — — IOL1WAY — — Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 BSS BWRP BSLIM WDTWIN CTXT3 FCKSM WINDIS WDTEN — WDTPRE — — — FNOSC OSCIOFNC POSCMD WDTPOST — — Reserved(1) ICS ALTI2C2 ALTI2C1 Reserved(1) CTXT2 IBSEQ — Bit 5 — PWMLOCK CTXT1 BSEQ — — — — — — — — — — — — BTMODE These bits are reserved and must be programmed as ‘1’. This bit is reserved and must be programmed as ‘0’. When operating in Dual Partition Flash mode, each partition will have dedicated Configuration registers. On a device Reset, the configuration values of the Active Partition are read at start-up, but during a soft swap condition, the configuration settings of the newly Active Partition are ignored. FBOOT resides in configuration memory space. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY DS70005258C-page 352 TABLE 27-1: dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 27-2: CONFIGURATION BITS DESCRIPTION Bit Field Description BSS Boot Segment Code-Protect Level bits 11 = Boot Segment is not code-protected other than BWRP 10 = Standard security 0x = High security BSEN Boot Segment Control bit 1 = No Boot Segment is enabled 0 = Boot Segment size is determined by the BSLIM bits BWRP Boot Segment Write-Protect bit 1 = Boot Segment can be written 0 = Boot Segment is write-protected BSLIM Boot Segment Flash Page Address Limit bits Contains the last active Boot Segment page. The value to be programmed is the inverted page address, such that programming additional ‘0’s can only increase the Boot Segment size (i.e., 0x1FFD = 2 Pages or 1024 IW). GSS General Segment Code-Protect Level bits 11 = User program memory is not code-protected 10 = Standard security 0x = High security GWRP General Segment Write-Protect bit 1 = User program memory is not write-protected 0 = User program memory is write-protected CWRP Configuration Segment Write-Protect bit 1 = Configuration data is not write-protected 0 = Configuration data is write-protected CSS Configuration Segment Code-Protect Level bits 111 = Configuration data is not code-protected 110 = Standard security 10x = Enhanced security 0xx = High security BTSWP BOOTSWP Instruction Enable/Disable bit 1 = BOOTSWP instruction is disabled 0 = BOOTSWP instruction is enabled BSEQ Boot Sequence Number bits (Dual Partition modes only) Relative value defining which partition will be active after device Reset; the partition containing a lower boot number will be active. IBSEQ Inverse Boot Sequence Number bits (Dual Partition modes only) The one’s complement of BSEQ; must be calculated by the user and written for device programming. If BSEQx and IBSEQx are not complements of each other, the Boot Sequence Number is considered to be invalid. AIVTDIS(1) Alternate Interrupt Vector Table bit 1 = Alternate Interrupt Vector Table is disabled 0 = Alternate Interrupt Vector Table is enabled if INTCON2 = 1 IESO Two-Speed Oscillator Start-up Enable bit 1 = Starts up device with FRC, then automatically switches to the user-selected oscillator source when ready 0 = Starts up device with the user-selected oscillator source PWMLOCK PWMx Lock Enable bit 1 = Certain PWMx registers may only be written after a key sequence 0 = PWMx registers may be written without a key sequence Note 1: The Boot Segment must be present to use the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 353 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 27-2: CONFIGURATION BITS DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED) Bit Field Description FNOSC Oscillator Selection bits 111 = Fast RC Oscillator with Divide-by-N (FRCDIVN) 110 = Fast RC Oscillator with Divide-by-16 101 = Low-Power RC Oscillator (LPRC) 100 = Reserved; do not use 011 = Primary Oscillator with PLL module (XT+PLL, HS+PLL, EC+PLL) 010 = Primary Oscillator (XT, HS, EC) 001 = Fast RC Oscillator with Divide-by-N with PLL module (FRCPLL) 000 = Fast RC Oscillator (FRC) FCKSM Clock Switching Mode bits 1x = Clock switching is disabled, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is disabled 01 = Clock switching is enabled, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is disabled 00 = Clock switching is enabled, Fail-Safe Clock Monitor is enabled IOL1WAY Peripheral Pin Select Configuration bit 1 = Allows only one reconfiguration 0 = Allows multiple reconfigurations OSCIOFNC OSC2 Pin Function bit (except in XT and HS modes) 1 = OSC2 is the clock output 0 = OSC2 is a general purpose digital I/O pin POSCMD Primary Oscillator Mode Select bits 11 = Primary Oscillator is disabled 10 = HS Crystal Oscillator mode 01 = XT Crystal Oscillator mode 00 = EC (External Clock) mode WDTEN Watchdog Timer Enable bits 11 = Watchdog Timer is always enabled (LPRC oscillator cannot be disabled; clearing the SWDTEN bit in the RCON register will have no effect) 10 = Watchdog Timer is enabled/disabled by user software (LPRC can be disabled by clearing the SWDTEN bit in the RCON register) 01 = Watchdog Timer is enabled only while device is active and is disabled while in Sleep mode; software control is disabled in this mode 00 = Watchdog Timer and SWDTEN bit are disabled WINDIS Watchdog Timer Window Enable bit 1 = Watchdog Timer is in Non-Window mode 0 = Watchdog Timer is in Window mode PLLKEN PLL Lock Enable bit 1 = PLL lock is enabled 0 = PLL lock is disabled WDTPRE Watchdog Timer Prescaler bit 1 = 1:128 0 = 1:32 WDTPOST Watchdog Timer Postscaler bits 1111 = 1:32,768 1110 = 1:16,384 • • • 0001 = 1:2 0000 = 1:1 Note 1: The Boot Segment must be present to use the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table. DS70005258C-page 354  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 27-2: CONFIGURATION BITS DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED) Bit Field Description WDTWIN Watchdog Timer Window Select bits 11 = WDT window is 25% of the WDT period 10 = WDT window is 37.5% of the WDT period 01 = WDT window is 50% of the WDT period 00 = WDT window is 75% of the WDT period ALTI2C1 Alternate I2C1 Pin bit 1 = I2C1 is mapped to the SDA1/SCL1 pins 0 = I2C1 is mapped to the ASDA1/ASCL1 pins ALTI2C2 Alternate I2C2 Pin bit 1 = I2C2 is mapped to the SDA2/SCL2 pins 0 = I2C2 is mapped to the ASDA2/ASCL2 pins JTAGEN JTAG Enable bit 1 = JTAG is enabled 0 = JTAG is disabled ICS ICD Communication Channel Select bits 11 = Communicates on PGEC1 and PGED1 10 = Communicates on PGEC2 and PGED2 01 = Communicates on PGEC3 and PGED3 00 = Reserved, do not use DBCC DACx Output Cross Connection Select bit 1 = No cross connection between DAC outputs 0 = Interconnects DACOUT1 and DACOUT2 CTXT1 Alternate Working Register Set 1 Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) Select bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Assigned to IPL of 7 101 = Assigned to IPL of 6 100 = Assigned to IPL of 5 011 = Assigned to IPL of 4 010 = Assigned to IPL of 3 001 = Assigned to IPL of 2 000 = Assigned to IPL of 1 CTXT2 Alternate Working Register Set 2 Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) Select bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Assigned to IPL of 7 101 = Assigned to IPL of 6 100 = Assigned to IPL of 5 011 = Assigned to IPL of 4 010 = Assigned to IPL of 3 001 = Assigned to IPL of 2 000 = Assigned to IPL of 1 CTXT3 Alternate Working Register Set 3 Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) Select bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Assigned to IPL of 7 101 = Assigned to IPL of 6 100 = Assigned to IPL of 5 011 = Assigned to IPL of 4 010 = Assigned to IPL of 3 001 = Assigned to IPL of 2 000 = Assigned to IPL of 1 Note 1: The Boot Segment must be present to use the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 355 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 27-2: CONFIGURATION BITS DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED) Bit Field Description CTXT4 Alternate Working Register Set 4 Interrupt Priority Level (IPL) Select bits 111 = Reserved 110 = Assigned to IPL of 7 101 = Assigned to IPL of 6 100 = Assigned to IPL of 5 011 = Assigned to IPL of 4 010 = Assigned to IPL of 3 001 = Assigned to IPL of 2 000 = Assigned to IPL of 1 BTMODE Boot Mode Configuration bits 11 = Single Partition mode 10 = Dual Partition mode 01 = Protected Dual Partition mode 00 = Privileged Dual Partition mode Note 1: The Boot Segment must be present to use the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table. DS70005258C-page 356  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 27.2 Device Calibration and Identification The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices have two Identification registers near the end of configuration memory space that store the Device ID (DEVID) and Device Revision (DEVREV). These registers are used to determine the mask, variant and manufacturing information about the device. These registers are read-only and are shown in Register 27-1 and Register 27-2. The PGAx and current source modules on the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices require Calibration Data registers to improve performance of the module over a wide operating range. These Calibration registers are read-only and are stored in configuration memory space. Prior to enabling the module, the calibration data must be read (TBLPAG and Table Read instruction) and loaded into its respective SFR registers. The device calibration addresses are shown in Table 27-3. TABLE 27-3: DEVICE CALIBRATION ADDRESSES(1) Calibration Address Bits 23-16 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 7 Bit 6 Name Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 PGA1CAL 800E48 — — — — — — — — — — — PGA1 Calibration Data PGA2CAL 800E4C — — — — — — — — — — — PGA2 Calibration Data 800E78 — — — — — — — — — — — Current Source Calibration Data ISRCCAL Note 1: The calibration data must be copied into its respective SFR registers prior to enabling the module.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 357 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY REGISTER 27-1: R DEVID: DEVICE ID REGISTER R R R R R R R DEVID bit 23 bit 16 R R R R R R R R DEVID bit 15 bit 8 R R R R R R R R DEVID bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Read-Only bit bit 23-0 DEVID: Device Identifier bits REGISTER 27-2: R U = Unimplemented bit DEVREV: DEVICE REVISION REGISTER R R R R R R R DEVREV bit 23 bit 16 R R R R R R R R DEVREV bit 15 bit 8 R R R R R R R R DEVREV bit 7 bit 0 Legend: R = Read-only bit bit 23-0 U = Unimplemented bit DEVREV: Device Revision bits DS70005258C-page 358  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 27.3 User OTP Memory 27.5 Brown-out Reset (BOR) The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices contain 64 words of user One-Time-Programmable (OTP) memory, located at addresses, 0x800F80 through 0x800FFC. The user OTP Words can be used for storing checksum, code revisions, product information, such as serial numbers, system manufacturing dates, manufacturing lot numbers and other application-specific information. These words can only be written once at program time and not at run time; they can be read at run time. The Brown-out Reset (BOR) module is based on an internal voltage reference circuit that monitors the regulated supply voltage, VCAP. The main purpose of the BOR module is to generate a device Reset when a brown-out condition occurs. Brown-out conditions are generally caused by glitches on the AC mains (for example, missing portions of the AC cycle waveform due to bad power transmission lines or voltage sags due to excessive current draw when a large inductive load is turned on). 27.4 A BOR generates a Reset pulse which resets the device. The BOR selects the clock source based on the device Configuration bit values (FNOSC and POSCMD). On-Chip Voltage Regulator All the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices power their core digital logic at a nominal 1.8V. This can create a conflict for designs that are required to operate at a higher typical voltage, such as 3.3V. To simplify system design, all devices in the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family incorporate an on-chip regulator that allows the device to run its core logic from VDD. The regulator provides power to the core from the other VDD pins. A low-ESR (less than 1 Ohm) capacitor (such as tantalum or ceramic) must be connected to the VCAP pin (Figure 27-1). This helps to maintain the stability of the regulator. The recommended value for the filter capacitor is provided in Table 30-5, located in Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics”. Note: It is important for the low-ESR capacitor to be placed as close as possible to the VCAP pin. FIGURE 27-1: If an Oscillator mode is selected, the BOR activates the Oscillator Start-up Timer (OST). The system clock is held until OST expires. If the PLL is used, the clock is held until the LOCK bit (OSCCON) is ‘1’. Concurrently, the Power-up Timer (PWRT) Time-out (TPWRT) is applied before the internal Reset is released. If TPWRT = 0 and a crystal oscillator is being used, then a nominal delay of TFSCM is applied. The total delay in this case is TFSCM. Refer to Parameter SY35 in Table 30-23 of Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics” for specific TFSCM values. The BOR status bit (RCON) is set to indicate that a BOR has occurred. The BOR circuit continues to operate while in Sleep or Idle modes and resets the device should VDD fall below the BOR threshold voltage. CONNECTIONS FOR THE ON-CHIP VOLTAGE REGULATOR(1,2,3) 3.3V dsPIC33EP VDD VCAP CEFC Note 1: 2: 3: VSS These are typical operating voltages. Refer to Table 30-5 located in Section 30.0 “Electrical Characteristics” for the full operating ranges of VDD and VCAP. It is important for the low-ESR capacitor to be placed as close as possible to the VCAP pin. Typical VCAP pin voltage = 1.8V when VDD ≥ VDDMIN.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 359 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 27.6 Watchdog Timer (WDT) 27.6.2 For dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices, the WDT is driven by the LPRC oscillator. When the WDT is enabled, the clock source is also enabled. 27.6.1 PRESCALER/POSTSCALER The nominal WDT clock source from LPRC is 32 kHz. This feeds a prescaler that can be configured for either 5-bit (divide-by-32) or 7-bit (divide-by-128) operation. The prescaler is set by the WDTPRE Configuration bit. With a 32 kHz input, the prescaler yields a WDT Time-out Period (TWDT), as shown in Parameter SY12 in Table 30-23. A variable postscaler divides down the WDT prescaler output and allows for a wide range of time-out periods. The postscaler is controlled by the WDTPOST Configuration bits (FWDT), which allow the selection of 16 settings, from 1:1 to 1:32,768. Using the prescaler and postscaler time-out periods, ranges from 1 ms to 131 seconds can be achieved. The WDT, prescaler and postscaler are reset: • On any device Reset • On the completion of a clock switch, whether invoked by software (i.e., setting the OSWEN bit after changing the NOSCx bits) or by hardware (i.e., Fail-Safe Clock Monitor) • When a PWRSAV instruction is executed (i.e., Sleep or Idle mode is entered) • When the device exits Sleep or Idle mode to resume normal operation • By a CLRWDT instruction during normal execution Note: The CLRWDT and PWRSAV instructions clear the prescaler and postscaler counts when executed. FIGURE 27-2: SLEEP AND IDLE MODES If the WDT is enabled, it continues to run during Sleep or Idle modes. When the WDT time-out occurs, the device wakes and code execution continues from where the PWRSAV instruction was executed. The corresponding SLEEP or IDLE bit (RCON) needs to be cleared in software after the device wakes up. 27.6.3 ENABLING WDT The WDT is enabled or disabled by the WDTEN Configuration bits in the FWDT Configuration register. When the WDTEN Configuration bits have been programmed to ‘0b11’, the WDT is always enabled. The WDT can be optionally controlled in software when the WDTEN Configuration bits have been programmed to ‘0b10’. The WDT is enabled in software by setting the SWDTEN control bit (RCON). The SWDTEN control bit is cleared on any device Reset. The software WDT option allows the user application to enable the WDT for critical code segments and disables the WDT during non-critical segments for maximum power savings. The WDT Time-out flag bit, WDTO (RCON), is not automatically cleared following a WDT time-out. To detect subsequent WDT events, the flag must be cleared in software. 27.6.4 WDT WINDOW The Watchdog Timer has an optional Windowed mode, enabled by programming the WINDIS bit in the WDT Configuration register (FWDT). In the Windowed mode (WINDIS = 0), the WDT should be cleared based on the settings in the programmable Watchdog Timer Window select bits (WDTWIN). WDT BLOCK DIAGRAM All Device Resets Transition to New Clock Source Exit Sleep or Idle Mode PWRSAV Instruction CLRWDT Instruction Watchdog Timer SWDTEN WDTEN WDT Wake-up RS Prescaler (Divide-by-N1) LPRC Clock Sleep/Idle WDTPOST WDTPRE 1 RS Postscaler (Divide-by-N2) 0 WINDIS WDTWIN WDT Reset WDT Window Select CLRWDT Instruction DS70005258C-page 360  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 27.7 JTAG Interface The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices implement a JTAG interface, which supports boundary scan device testing. Detailed information on this interface is provided in future revisions of the document. Note: 27.8 Refer to “Programming and Diagnostics” (DS70608) in the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for further information on usage, configuration and operation of the JTAG interface. In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™) The dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices can be serially programmed while in the end application circuit. This is done with two lines for clock and data, and three other lines for power, ground and the programming sequence. Serial programming allows customers to manufacture boards with unprogrammed devices and then program the device just before shipping the product. Serial programming also allows the most recent firmware or a custom firmware to be programmed. Refer to the “dsPIC33E/PIC24E Flash Programming Specification for Devices with Volatile Configuration Bits” (DS70663) for details about In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™). Any of the three pairs of programming clock/data pins can be used: • PGEC1 and PGED1 • PGEC2 and PGED2 • PGEC3 and PGED3 27.9 In-Circuit Debugger When MPLAB® ICD 3 or REAL ICE™ emulator is selected as a debugger, the in-circuit debugging functionality is enabled. This function allows simple debugging functions when used with MPLAB IDE. Debugging functionality is controlled through the PGECx (Emulation/ Debug Clock) and PGEDx (Emulation/Debug Data) pin functions. 27.10 Code Protection and CodeGuard™ Security dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X devices offer multiple levels of security for protecting individual intellectual property. The program Flash protection can be broken up into three segments: Boot Segment (BS), General Segment (GS) and Configuration Segment (CS). Boot Segment has the highest security privilege and can be thought to have limited restrictions when accessing other segments. General Segment has the least security and is intended for the end user system code. Configuration Segment contains only the device user configuration data which is located at the end of the program memory space. The code protection features are controlled by the Configuration registers, FSEC and FBSLIM. The FSEC register controls the code-protect level for each segment and if that segment is write-protected. The size of BS and GS will depend on the BSLIM bits setting and if the Alternate Interrupt Vector Table (AIVT) is enabled. The BSLIM bits define the number of pages for BS with each page containing 512 IW. The smallest BS size is one page, which will consist of the Interrupt Vector Table (IVT) and 256 IW of code protection. If the AIVT is enabled, the last page of BS will contain the AIVT and will not contain any BS code. With AIVT enabled, the smallest BS size is now two pages (1024 IW), with one page for the IVT and BS code, and the other page for the AIVT. Write protection of the BS does not cover the AIVT. The last page of BS can always be programmed or erased by BS code. The General Segment will start at the next page and will consume the rest of program Flash except for the Flash Configuration Words. The IVT will assume GS security only if BS is not enabled. The IVT is protected from being programmed or page erased when either security segment has enabled write protection. Note: Refer to “CodeGuard™ Intermediate Security” (DS70005182) in the “dsPIC33/ PIC24 Family Reference Manual” for further information on usage, configuration and operation of CodeGuard Security. Any of the three pairs of debugging clock/data pins can be used: • PGEC1 and PGED1 • PGEC2 and PGED2 • PGEC3 and PGED3 To use the in-circuit debugger function of the device, the design must implement ICSP connections to MCLR, VDD, VSS and the PGECx/PGEDx pin pair. In addition, when the feature is enabled, some of the resources are not available for general use. These resources include the first 80 bytes of data RAM and two I/O pins (PGECx and PGEDx).  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 361 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY The different device security segments are shown in Figure 27-3. Here, all three segments are shown but are not required. If only basic code protection is required, then GS can be enabled independently or combined with CS, if desired. Privileged Dual Partition mode performs the same function as Protected Dual Partition mode, except additional constraints are applied in an effort to prevent code in the Boot Segment and General Segment from being used against each other. FIGURE 27-3: FIGURE 27-4: SECURITY SEGMENTS EXAMPLE FOR dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X DEVICES 0x000000 IVT 0x000200 SECURITY SEGMENTS EXAMPLE FOR dsPIC33EP64GS70X/80X DEVICES (DUAL PARTITION MODES) 0x000000 IVT 0x000200 IVT and AIVT Assume BS Protection BS IVT and AIVT Assume BS Protection AIVT + 256 IW(2) BS AIVT + 256IW(2) BSLIM BSLIM GS GS CS(1) 0x0XXX00 Note 1: 2: If CS is write-protected, the last page (GS + CS) of program memory will be protected from an erase condition. The last half (256 IW) of the last page of BS is unusable program memory. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family devices can be operated in Dual Partition mode, where security is required for each partition. When operating in Dual Partition mode, the Active and Inactive Partitions both contain unique copies of the Reset vector, Interrupt Vector Tables (IVT and AIVT, if enabled) and the Flash Configuration Words. Both partitions have the three security segments described previously. Code may not be executed from the Inactive Partition, but it may be programmed by, and read from, the Active Partition, subject to defined code protection. Figure 27-4 and Figure 27-5 show the different security segments for devices operating in Dual Partition mode. The device may also operate in a Protected Dual Partition mode or in Privileged Dual Partition mode. In Protected Dual Partition mode, Partition 1 is permanently erase/write-protected. This implementation allows for a “Factory Default” mode, which provides a fail-safe backup image to be stored in Partition 1. For example, a fail-safe bootloader can be placed in Partition 1, along with a fail-safe backup code image, which can be used or rewritten into Partition 2 in the event of a failed Flash update to Partition 2. DS70005258C-page 362 CS(1) 0x005800 Unimplemented (read ‘0’s) 0x400000 IVT 0x400200 IVT and AIVT Assume BS Protection BS AIVT + 256 IW(2) BSLIM GS CS(1) Note 1: 2: 0x405800 If CS is write-protected, the last page (GS + CS) of program memory will be protected from an erase condition. The last half (256 IW) of the last page of BS is unusable program memory.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 27-5: SECURITY SEGMENTS EXAMPLE FOR dsPIC33EP128GS70X/80X DEVICES (DUAL PARTITION MODES) 0x000000 IVT 0x000200 IVT and AIVT Assume BS Protection BS AIVT + 256IW(2) BSLIM GS CS(1) 0x00AC00 Unimplemented (read ‘0’s) 0x400000 IVT 0x400200 IVT and AIVT Assume BS Protection BS AIVT + 256 IW(2) BSLIM GS CS(1) Note 1: 2: 0x40AC00 If CS is write-protected, the last page (GS + CS) of program memory will be protected from an erase condition. The last half (256 IW) of the last page of BS is unusable program memory.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 363 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 364  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 28.0 Note: INSTRUCTION SET SUMMARY This data sheet summarizes the features of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/ 80X family of devices. It is not intended to be a comprehensive reference source. To complement the information in this data sheet, refer to the related section of the “dsPIC33/PIC24 Family Reference Manual”, which is available from the Microchip web site (www.microchip.com). The dsPIC33EP instruction set is almost identical to that of the dsPIC30F and dsPIC33F. Most instructions are a single program memory word (24 bits). Only three instructions require two program memory locations. Each single-word instruction is a 24-bit word, divided into an 8-bit opcode, which specifies the instruction type and one or more operands, which further specify the operation of the instruction. The instruction set is highly orthogonal and is grouped into five basic categories: • • • • • Word or byte-oriented operations Bit-oriented operations Literal operations DSP operations Control operations Table 28-1 lists the general symbols used in describing the instructions. The dsPIC33E instruction set summary in Table 28-2 lists all the instructions, along with the status flags affected by each instruction. Most word or byte-oriented W register instructions (including barrel shift instructions) have three operands: • The first source operand, which is typically a register ‘Wb’ without any address modifier • The second source operand, which is typically a register ‘Ws’ with or without an address modifier • The destination of the result, which is typically a register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier However, word or byte-oriented file register instructions have two operands: • The file register specified by the value ‘f’ • The destination, which could be either the file register ‘f’ or the W0 register, which is denoted as ‘WREG’  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Most bit-oriented instructions (including simple rotate/ shift instructions) have two operands: • The W register (with or without an address modifier) or file register (specified by the value of ‘Ws’ or ‘f’) • The bit in the W register or file register (specified by a literal value or indirectly by the contents of register ‘Wb’) The literal instructions that involve data movement can use some of the following operands: • A literal value to be loaded into a W register or file register (specified by ‘k’) • The W register or file register where the literal value is to be loaded (specified by ‘Wb’ or ‘f’) However, literal instructions that involve arithmetic or logical operations use some of the following operands: • The first source operand, which is a register ‘Wb’ without any address modifier • The second source operand, which is a literal value • The destination of the result (only if not the same as the first source operand), which is typically a register ‘Wd’ with or without an address modifier The MAC class of DSP instructions can use some of the following operands: • The accumulator (A or B) to be used (required operand) • The W registers to be used as the two operands • The X and Y address space prefetch operations • The X and Y address space prefetch destinations • The accumulator write back destination The other DSP instructions do not involve any multiplication and can include: • The accumulator to be used (required) • The source or destination operand (designated as Wso or Wdo, respectively) with or without an address modifier • The amount of shift specified by a W register ‘Wn’ or a literal value The control instructions can use some of the following operands: • A program memory address • The mode of the Table Read and Table Write instructions DS70005258C-page 365 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Most instructions are a single word. Certain double-word instructions are designed to provide all the required information in these 48 bits. In the second word, the eight MSbs are ‘0’s. If this second word is executed as an instruction (by itself), it executes as a NOP. The double-word instructions execute in two instruction cycles. Most single-word instructions are executed in a single instruction cycle, unless a conditional test is true or the Program Counter is changed as a result of the instruction, or a PSV or Table Read is performed. In TABLE 28-1: these cases, the execution takes multiple instruction cycles, with the additional instruction cycle(s) executed as a NOP. Certain instructions that involve skipping over the subsequent instruction require either two or three cycles if the skip is performed, depending on whether the instruction being skipped is a single-word or twoword instruction. Moreover, double-word moves require two cycles. Note: For more details on the instruction set, refer to the “16-Bit MCU and DSC Programmer’s Reference Manual” (DS70000157). SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS Field #text Description Means literal defined by “text” (text) Means “content of text” [text] Means “the location addressed by text” {} Optional field or operation a  {b, c, d} a is selected from the set of values b, c, d Register bit field .b Byte mode selection .d Double-Word mode selection .S Shadow register select .w Word mode selection (default) Acc One of two accumulators {A, B} AWB Accumulator Write-Back Destination Address register {W13, [W13]+ = 2} bit4 4-bit bit selection field (used in word addressed instructions) {0...15} C, DC, N, OV, Z MCU Status bits: Carry, Digit Carry, Negative, Overflow, Sticky Zero Expr Absolute address, label or expression (resolved by the linker) f File register address {0x0000...0x1FFF} lit1 1-bit unsigned literal {0,1} lit4 4-bit unsigned literal {0...15} lit5 5-bit unsigned literal {0...31} lit8 8-bit unsigned literal {0...255} lit10 10-bit unsigned literal {0...255} for Byte mode, {0:1023} for Word mode lit14 14-bit unsigned literal {0...16384} lit16 16-bit unsigned literal {0...65535} lit23 23-bit unsigned literal {0...8388608}; LSb must be ‘0’ None Field does not require an entry, can be blank OA, OB, SA, SB DSP Status bits: ACCA Overflow, ACCB Overflow, ACCA Saturate, ACCB Saturate PC Program Counter Slit10 10-bit signed literal {-512...511} Slit16 16-bit signed literal {-32768...32767} Slit6 6-bit signed literal {-16...16} Wb Base W register {W0...W15} Wd Destination W register { Wd, [Wd], [Wd++], [Wd--], [++Wd], [--Wd] } Wdo Destination W register  { Wnd, [Wnd], [Wnd++], [Wnd--], [++Wnd], [--Wnd], [Wnd+Wb] } Wm,Wn Dividend, Divisor Working register pair (Direct Addressing) DS70005258C-page 366  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-1: SYMBOLS USED IN OPCODE DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED) Field Description Wm*Wm Multiplicand and Multiplier Working register pair for Square instructions  {W4 * W4,W5 * W5,W6 * W6,W7 * W7} Wm*Wn Multiplicand and Multiplier Working register pair for DSP instructions  {W4 * W5,W4 * W6,W4 * W7,W5 * W6,W5 * W7,W6 * W7} Wn One of 16 Working registers {W0...W15} Wnd One of 16 Destination Working registers {W0...W15} Wns One of 16 Source Working registers {W0...W15} WREG W0 (Working register used in file register instructions) Ws Source W register { Ws, [Ws], [Ws++], [Ws--], [++Ws], [--Ws] } Wso Source W register  { Wns, [Wns], [Wns++], [Wns--], [++Wns], [--Wns], [Wns+Wb] } Wx X Data Space Prefetch Address register for DSP instructions  {[W8] + = 6, [W8] + = 4, [W8] + = 2, [W8], [W8] - = 6, [W8] - = 4, [W8] - = 2, [W9] + = 6, [W9] + = 4, [W9] + = 2, [W9], [W9] - = 6, [W9] - = 4, [W9] - = 2, [W9 + W12], none} Wxd X Data Space Prefetch Destination register for DSP instructions {W4...W7} Wy Y Data Space Prefetch Address register for DSP instructions  {[W10] + = 6, [W10] + = 4, [W10] + = 2, [W10], [W10] - = 6, [W10] - = 4, [W10] - = 2, [W11] + = 6, [W11] + = 4, [W11] + = 2, [W11], [W11] - = 6, [W11] - = 4, [W11] - = 2, [W11 + W12], none} Wyd Y Data Space Prefetch Destination register for DSP instructions {W4...W7}  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 367 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-2: Base Instr # Assembly Mnemonic 1 ADD 2 3 4 5 ADDC AND ASR BCLR INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW Assembly Syntax # of # of Words Cycles(1) Description Status Flags Affected ADD Acc Add Accumulators 1 1 ADD f f = f + WREG 1 1 OA,OB,SA,SB C,DC,N,OV,Z ADD f,WREG WREG = f + WREG 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADD #lit10,Wn Wd = lit10 + Wd 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADD Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb + Ws 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADD Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb + lit5 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z OA,OB,SA,SB ADD Wso,#Slit4,Acc 16-bit Signed Add to Accumulator 1 1 ADDC f f = f + WREG + (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADDC f,WREG WREG = f + WREG + (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADDC #lit10,Wn Wd = lit10 + Wd + (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADDC Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb + Ws + (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z ADDC Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb + lit5 + (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z AND f f = f .AND. WREG 1 1 N,Z AND f,WREG WREG = f .AND. WREG 1 1 N,Z AND #lit10,Wn Wd = lit10 .AND. Wd 1 1 N,Z AND Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb .AND. Ws 1 1 N,Z AND Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb .AND. lit5 1 1 N,Z ASR f f = Arithmetic Right Shift f 1 1 C,N,OV,Z ASR f,WREG WREG = Arithmetic Right Shift f 1 1 C,N,OV,Z ASR Ws,Wd Wd = Arithmetic Right Shift Ws 1 1 C,N,OV,Z ASR Wb,Wns,Wnd Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by Wns 1 1 N,Z ASR Wb,#lit5,Wnd Wnd = Arithmetic Right Shift Wb by lit5 1 1 N,Z BCLR f,#bit4 Bit Clear f 1 1 None BCLR Ws,#bit4 Bit Clear Ws 1 1 None Swap the Active and Inactive Program Flash Space 1 2 None None 6 BOOTSWP BOOTSWP 7 BRA BRA C,Expr Branch if Carry 1 1 (4) BRA GE,Expr Branch if Greater Than or Equal 1 1 (4) None BRA GEU,Expr Branch if Unsigned Greater Than or Equal 1 1 (4) None BRA GT,Expr Branch if Greater Than 1 1 (4) None BRA GTU,Expr Branch if Unsigned Greater Than 1 1 (4) None BRA LE,Expr Branch if Less Than or Equal 1 1 (4) None BRA LEU,Expr Branch if Unsigned Less Than or Equal 1 1 (4) None BRA LT,Expr Branch if Less Than 1 1 (4) None BRA LTU,Expr Branch if Unsigned Less Than 1 1 (4) None BRA N,Expr Branch if Negative 1 1 (4) None BRA NC,Expr Branch if Not Carry 1 1 (4) None BRA NN,Expr Branch if Not Negative 1 1 (4) None BRA NOV,Expr Branch if Not Overflow 1 1 (4) None BRA NZ,Expr Branch if Not Zero 1 1 (4) None BRA OA,Expr Branch if Accumulator A Overflow 1 1 (4) None BRA OB,Expr Branch if Accumulator B Overflow 1 1 (4) None BRA OV,Expr Branch if Overflow 1 1 (4) None BRA SA,Expr Branch if Accumulator A Saturated 1 1 (4) None BRA SB,Expr Branch if Accumulator B Saturated 1 1 (4) None BRA Expr Branch Unconditionally 1 4 None BRA Z,Expr Branch if Zero 1 1 (4) None None 8 BSET Note 1: BRA Wn Computed Branch 1 4 BSET f,#bit4 Bit Set f 1 1 None BSET Ws,#bit4 Bit Set Ws 1 1 None Read and Read-Modify-Write (e.g., bit operations and logical operations) on non-CPU SFRs incur an additional instruction cycle. DS70005258C-page 368  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-2: Base Instr # Assembly Mnemonic 9 BSW INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED) Assembly Syntax Description # of # of Words Cycles(1) Status Flags Affected BSW.C Ws,Wb Write C bit to Ws 1 1 BSW.Z Ws,Wb Write Z bit to Ws 1 1 None None f,#bit4 Bit Toggle f 1 1 None 10 BTG BTG BTG Ws,#bit4 Bit Toggle Ws 1 1 None 11 BTSC BTSC f,#bit4 Bit Test f, Skip if Clear 1 1 (2 or 3) None BTSC Ws,#bit4 Bit Test Ws, Skip if Clear 1 1 (2 or 3) None BTSS f,#bit4 Bit Test f, Skip if Set 1 1 (2 or 3) None BTSS Ws,#bit4 Bit Test Ws, Skip if Set 1 1 (2 or 3) None BTST f,#bit4 Bit Test f 1 1 Z BTST.C Ws,#bit4 Bit Test Ws to C 1 1 C BTST.Z Ws,#bit4 Bit Test Ws to Z 1 1 Z BTST.C Ws,Wb Bit Test Ws to C 1 1 C Z 12 13 14 15 16 BTSS BTST BTSTS CALL CLR BTST.Z Ws,Wb Bit Test Ws to Z 1 1 BTSTS f,#bit4 Bit Test then Set f 1 1 Z BTSTS.C Ws,#bit4 Bit Test Ws to C, then Set 1 1 C BTSTS.Z Ws,#bit4 Bit Test Ws to Z, then Set 1 1 Z CALL lit23 Call Subroutine 2 4 SFA CALL Wn Call Indirect Subroutine 1 4 SFA CALL.L Wn Call Indirect Subroutine (long address) 1 4 SFA CLR f f = 0x0000 1 1 None CLR WREG WREG = 0x0000 1 1 None CLR Ws Ws = 0x0000 1 1 None CLR Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB Clear Accumulator 1 1 OA,OB,SA,SB Clear Watchdog Timer 1 1 WDTO,Sleep f f=f 1 1 N,Z COM f,WREG WREG = f 1 1 N,Z COM Ws,Wd Wd = Ws 1 1 N,Z CP f Compare f with WREG 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z CP Wb,#lit8 Compare Wb with lit8 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z CP Wb,Ws Compare Wb with Ws (Wb – Ws) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z f Compare f with 0x0000 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z C,DC,N,OV,Z 17 CLRWDT CLRWDT 18 COM COM 19 CP 20 CP0 CP0 CP0 Ws Compare Ws with 0x0000 1 1 21 CPB CPB f Compare f with WREG, with Borrow 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z CPB Wb,#lit8 Compare Wb with lit8, with Borrow 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z CPB Wb,Ws Compare Wb with Ws, with Borrow (Wb – Ws – C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z CPSEQ Wb,Wn Compare Wb with Wn, Skip if = 1 1 (2 or 3) None 22 CPSEQ CPBEQ CPBEQ Wb,Wn,Expr Compare Wb with Wn, Branch if = 1 1 (5) None 23 CPSGT CPSGT Wb,Wn Compare Wb with Wn, Skip if > 1 1 (2 or 3) None CPBGT CPBGT Wb,Wn,Expr Compare Wb with Wn, Branch if > 1 1 (5) None 24 CPSLT CPSLT Wb,Wn Compare Wb with Wn, Skip if < 1 1 (2 or 3) None CPBLT CPBLT Wb,Wn,Expr Compare Wb with Wn, Branch if < 1 1 (5) None 25 CPSNE CPSNE Wb,Wn Compare Wb with Wn, Skip if  1 1 (2 or 3) None CPBNE CPBNE Wb,Wn,Expr Compare Wb with Wn, Branch if  1 1 (5) None Note 1: Read and Read-Modify-Write (e.g., bit operations and logical operations) on non-CPU SFRs incur an additional instruction cycle.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 369 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-2: Base Instr # Assembly Mnemonic 26 CTXTSWP INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED) Assembly Syntax # of # of Words Cycles(1) Description Status Flags Affected CTXTSWP #1it3 Switch CPU Register Context to Context Defined by lit3 1 2 None CTXTSWP Wn Switch CPU Register Context to Context Defined by Wn 1 2 None 27 DAW DAW Wn Wn = Decimal Adjust Wn 1 1 C 28 DEC DEC f f=f–1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z DEC f,WREG WREG = f – 1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z DEC Ws,Wd Wd = Ws – 1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z DEC2 f f=f–2 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z DEC2 f,WREG WREG = f – 2 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z DEC2 Ws,Wd Wd = Ws – 2 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z 29 DEC2 30 DISI DISI #lit14 Disable Interrupts for k Instruction Cycles 1 1 None 31 DIV DIV.S Wm,Wn Signed 16/16-bit Integer Divide 1 18 N,Z,C,OV DIV.SD Wm,Wn Signed 32/16-bit Integer Divide 1 18 N,Z,C,OV DIV.U Wm,Wn Unsigned 16/16-bit Integer Divide 1 18 N,Z,C,OV DIV.UD Wm,Wn Unsigned 32/16-bit Integer Divide 1 18 N,Z,C,OV 32 DIVF DIVF Wm,Wn Signed 16/16-bit Fractional Divide 1 18 N,Z,C,OV 33 DO DO #lit15,Expr Do Code to PC + Expr, lit15 + 1 Times 2 2 None DO Wn,Expr Do Code to PC + Expr, (Wn) + 1 Times 2 2 None 34 ED ED Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd Euclidean Distance (no accumulate) 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB 35 EDAC EDAC Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wy,Wxd Euclidean Distance 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB 36 EXCH EXCH Wns,Wnd Swap Wns with Wnd 1 1 None 37 FBCL FBCL Ws,Wnd Find Bit Change from Left (MSb) Side 1 1 C 38 FF1L FF1L Ws,Wnd Find First One from Left (MSb) Side 1 1 C 39 FF1R FF1R Ws,Wnd Find First One from Right (LSb) Side 1 1 C 40 GOTO GOTO Expr Go to Address 2 4 None GOTO Wn Go to Indirect 1 4 None GOTO.L Wn Go to Indirect (long address) 1 4 None INC f f=f+1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z INC f,WREG WREG = f + 1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z INC Ws,Wd Wd = Ws + 1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z INC2 f f=f+2 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z INC2 f,WREG WREG = f + 2 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z INC2 Ws,Wd Wd = Ws + 2 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z IOR f f = f .IOR. WREG 1 1 N,Z IOR f,WREG WREG = f .IOR. WREG 1 1 N,Z IOR #lit10,Wn Wd = lit10 .IOR. Wd 1 1 N,Z IOR Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb .IOR. Ws 1 1 N,Z IOR Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb .IOR. lit5 1 1 N,Z LAC Wso,#Slit4,Acc Load Accumulator 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB 41 42 43 44 INC INC2 IOR LAC 45 LNK LNK #lit14 Link Frame Pointer 1 1 SFA 46 LSR LSR f f = Logical Right Shift f 1 1 C,N,OV,Z LSR f,WREG WREG = Logical Right Shift f 1 1 C,N,OV,Z LSR Ws,Wd Wd = Logical Right Shift Ws 1 1 C,N,OV,Z LSR Wb,Wns,Wnd Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by Wns 1 1 N,Z LSR Wb,#lit5,Wnd Wnd = Logical Right Shift Wb by lit5 1 1 N,Z MAC Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB Multiply and Accumulate 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB MAC Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd Square and Accumulate 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB 47 MAC Note 1: Read and Read-Modify-Write (e.g., bit operations and logical operations) on non-CPU SFRs incur an additional instruction cycle. DS70005258C-page 370  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-2: Base Instr # Assembly Mnemonic 48 MOV 49 MOVPAG INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED) Assembly Syntax Description # of # of Words Cycles(1) Status Flags Affected MOV f,Wn Move f to Wn 1 1 None MOV f Move f to f 1 1 None MOV f,WREG Move f to WREG 1 1 None MOV #lit16,Wn Move 16-bit Literal to Wn 1 1 None MOV.b #lit8,Wn Move 8-bit Literal to Wn 1 1 None MOV Wn,f Move Wn to f 1 1 None MOV Wso,Wdo Move Ws to Wd 1 1 None MOV WREG,f Move WREG to f 1 1 None MOV.D Wns,Wd Move Double from W(ns):W(ns + 1) to Wd 1 2 None MOV.D Ws,Wnd Move Double from Ws to W(nd + 1):W(nd) 1 2 None MOVPAG #lit10,DSRPAG Move 10-bit Literal to DSRPAG 1 1 None MOVPAG #lit8,TBLPAG Move 8-bit Literal to TBLPAG 1 1 None MOVPAGW Ws, DSRPAG Move Ws to DSRPAG 1 1 None None MOVPAGW Ws, TBLPAG Move Ws to TBLPAG 1 1 50 MOVSAC MOVSAC Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB Prefetch and Store Accumulator 1 1 None 51 MPY MPY Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd Multiply Wm by Wn to Accumulator 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB MPY Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd Square Wm to Accumulator 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB 52 MPY.N MPY.N Wm*Wn,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd -(Multiply Wm by Wn) to Accumulator 1 1 None 53 MSC MSC Wm*Wm,Acc,Wx,Wxd,Wy,Wyd,AWB Multiply and Subtract from Accumulator 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB 54 MUL MUL.SS Wb,Ws,Wnd {Wnd + 1, Wnd} = Signed(Wb) * Signed(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.SS Wb,Ws,Acc Accumulator = Signed(Wb) * Signed(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.SU Wb,Ws,Wnd {Wnd + 1, Wnd} = Signed(Wb) * Unsigned(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.SU Wb,Ws,Acc Accumulator = Signed(Wb) * Unsigned(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.SU Wb,#lit5,Acc Accumulator = Signed(Wb) * Unsigned(lit5) 1 1 None MUL.US Wb,Ws,Wnd {Wnd + 1, Wnd} = Unsigned(Wb) * Signed(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.US Wb,Ws,Acc Accumulator = Unsigned(Wb) * Signed(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.UU Wb,Ws,Wnd {Wnd + 1, Wnd} = Unsigned(Wb) * Unsigned(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.UU Wb,#lit5,Acc Accumulator = Unsigned(Wb) * Unsigned(lit5) 1 1 None MUL.UU Wb,Ws,Acc Accumulator = Unsigned(Wb) * Unsigned(Ws) 1 1 None MULW.SS Wb,Ws,Wnd Wnd = Signed(Wb) * Signed(Ws) 1 1 None MULW.SU Wb,Ws,Wnd Wnd = Signed(Wb) * Unsigned(Ws) 1 1 None MULW.US Wb,Ws,Wnd Wnd = Unsigned(Wb) * Signed(Ws) 1 1 None MULW.UU Wb,Ws,Wnd Wnd = Unsigned(Wb) * Unsigned(Ws) 1 1 None MUL.SU Wb,#lit5,Wnd {Wnd + 1, Wnd} = Signed(Wb) * Unsigned(lit5) 1 1 None MUL.SU Wb,#lit5,Wnd Wnd = Signed(Wb) * Unsigned(lit5) 1 1 None MUL.UU Wb,#lit5,Wnd {Wnd + 1, Wnd} = Unsigned(Wb) * Unsigned(lit5) 1 1 None MUL.UU Wb,#lit5,Wnd Wnd = Unsigned(Wb) * Unsigned(lit5) 1 1 None MUL f W3:W2 = f * WREG 1 1 None Note 1: Read and Read-Modify-Write (e.g., bit operations and logical operations) on non-CPU SFRs incur an additional instruction cycle.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 371 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-2: Base Instr # Assembly Mnemonic 55 NEG 56 57 NOP POP INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED) Assembly Syntax NEG Acc PUSH Status Flags Affected Negate Accumulator 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB C,DC,N,OV,Z NEG f f=f+1 1 1 NEG f,WREG WREG = f + 1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z NEG Ws,Wd Wd = Ws + 1 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z NOP No Operation 1 1 None NOPR No Operation 1 1 None None POP f Pop f from Top-of-Stack (TOS) 1 1 POP Wdo Pop from Top-of-Stack (TOS) to Wdo 1 1 None POP.D Wnd Pop from Top-of-Stack (TOS) to W(nd):W(nd + 1) 1 2 None Pop Shadow Registers 1 1 All f Push f to Top-of-Stack (TOS) 1 1 None PUSH Wso Push Wso to Top-of-Stack (TOS) 1 1 None PUSH.D Wns Push W(ns):W(ns + 1) to Top-of-Stack (TOS) 1 2 None POP.S 58 # of # of Words Cycles(1) Description PUSH Push Shadow Registers 1 1 None 59 PWRSAV PWRSAV #lit1 Go into Sleep or Idle mode 1 1 WDTO,Sleep 60 RCALL RCALL Expr Relative Call 1 4 SFA RCALL Wn Computed Call 1 4 SFA REPEAT #lit15 Repeat Next Instruction lit15 + 1 Times 1 1 None REPEAT Wn Repeat Next Instruction (Wn) + 1 Times 1 1 None Software Device Reset 1 1 None PUSH.S 61 62 REPEAT RESET RESET 63 RETFIE RETFIE 64 RETLW RETLW 65 RETURN RETURN 66 RLC 67 68 69 RLNC RRC RRNC Return from Interrupt 1 6 (5) SFA #lit10,Wn Return with Literal in Wn 1 6 (5) SFA Return from Subroutine 1 6 (5) SFA RLC f f = Rotate Left through Carry f 1 1 C,N,Z RLC f,WREG WREG = Rotate Left through Carry f 1 1 C,N,Z RLC Ws,Wd Wd = Rotate Left through Carry Ws 1 1 C,N,Z RLNC f f = Rotate Left (No Carry) f 1 1 N,Z RLNC f,WREG WREG = Rotate Left (No Carry) f 1 1 N,Z RLNC Ws,Wd Wd = Rotate Left (No Carry) Ws 1 1 N,Z RRC f f = Rotate Right through Carry f 1 1 C,N,Z RRC f,WREG WREG = Rotate Right through Carry f 1 1 C,N,Z RRC Ws,Wd Wd = Rotate Right through Carry Ws 1 1 C,N,Z RRNC f f = Rotate Right (No Carry) f 1 1 N,Z RRNC f,WREG WREG = Rotate Right (No Carry) f 1 1 N,Z RRNC Ws,Wd Wd = Rotate Right (No Carry) Ws 1 1 N,Z 70 SAC SAC Acc,#Slit4,Wdo Store Accumulator 1 1 None SAC.R Acc,#Slit4,Wdo Store Rounded Accumulator 1 1 None 71 SE SE Ws,Wnd Wnd = Sign-Extended Ws 1 1 C,N,Z 72 SETM SETM f f = 0xFFFF 1 1 None SETM WREG WREG = 0xFFFF 1 1 None 73 SFTAC Note 1: SETM Ws Ws = 0xFFFF 1 1 None SFTAC Acc,Wn Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by (Wn) 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB SFTAC Acc,#Slit6 Arithmetic Shift Accumulator by Slit6 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB Read and Read-Modify-Write (e.g., bit operations and logical operations) on non-CPU SFRs incur an additional instruction cycle. DS70005258C-page 372  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 28-2: Base Instr # Assembly Mnemonic 74 SL 75 76 77 78 79 SUB SUBB SUBR SUBBR SWAP INSTRUCTION SET OVERVIEW (CONTINUED) Assembly Syntax Description # of # of Words Cycles(1) Status Flags Affected SL f f = Left Shift f 1 1 C,N,OV,Z SL f,WREG WREG = Left Shift f 1 1 C,N,OV,Z SL Ws,Wd Wd = Left Shift Ws 1 1 C,N,OV,Z SL Wb,Wns,Wnd Wnd = Left Shift Wb by Wns 1 1 N,Z SL Wb,#lit5,Wnd Wnd = Left Shift Wb by lit5 1 1 N,Z SUB Acc Subtract Accumulators 1 1 OA,OB,OAB, SA,SB,SAB SUB f f = f – WREG 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUB f,WREG WREG = f – WREG 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUB #lit10,Wn Wn = Wn – lit10 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUB Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb – Ws 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUB Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb – lit5 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBB f f = f – WREG – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBB f,WREG WREG = f – WREG – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBB #lit10,Wn Wn = Wn – lit10 – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBB Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb – Ws – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBB Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb – lit5 – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBR f f = WREG – f 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBR f,WREG WREG = WREG – f 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBR Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Ws – Wb 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBR Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = lit5 – Wb 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBBR f f = WREG – f – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBBR f,WREG WREG = WREG – f – (C) 1 1 SUBBR Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Ws – Wb – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SUBBR Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = lit5 – Wb – (C) 1 1 C,DC,N,OV,Z SWAP.b Wn Wn = Nibble Swap Wn 1 1 None SWAP Wn Wn = Byte Swap Wn 1 1 None None 80 TBLRDH TBLRDH Ws,Wd Read Prog to Wd 1 5 81 TBLRDL TBLRDL Ws,Wd Read Prog to Wd 1 5 None 82 TBLWTH TBLWTH Ws,Wd Write Ws to Prog 1 2 None Ws,Wd Write Ws to Prog 1 2 None Unlink Frame Pointer 1 1 SFA 83 TBLWTL TBLWTL 84 ULNK ULNK 85 XOR XOR f f = f .XOR. WREG 1 1 N,Z XOR f,WREG WREG = f .XOR. WREG 1 1 N,Z XOR #lit10,Wn Wd = lit10 .XOR. Wd 1 1 N,Z XOR Wb,Ws,Wd Wd = Wb .XOR. Ws 1 1 N,Z XOR Wb,#lit5,Wd Wd = Wb .XOR. lit5 1 1 N,Z ZE Ws,Wnd Wnd = Zero-Extend Ws 1 1 C,Z,N 86 ZE Note 1: Read and Read-Modify-Write (e.g., bit operations and logical operations) on non-CPU SFRs incur an additional instruction cycle.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 373 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 374  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 29.0 DEVELOPMENT SUPPORT The PIC® microcontrollers (MCU) and dsPIC® digital signal controllers (DSC) are supported with a full range of software and hardware development tools: • Integrated Development Environment - MPLAB® X IDE Software • Compilers/Assemblers/Linkers - MPLAB XC Compiler - MPASMTM Assembler - MPLINKTM Object Linker/ MPLIBTM Object Librarian - MPLAB Assembler/Linker/Librarian for Various Device Families • Simulators - MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator • Emulators - MPLAB REAL ICE™ In-Circuit Emulator • In-Circuit Debuggers/Programmers - MPLAB ICD 3 - PICkit™ 3 • Device Programmers - MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer • Low-Cost Demonstration/Development Boards, Evaluation Kits and Starter Kits • Third-party development tools 29.1 MPLAB X Integrated Development Environment Software The MPLAB X IDE is a single, unified graphical user interface for Microchip and third-party software, and hardware development tool that runs on Windows®, Linux and Mac OS® X. Based on the NetBeans IDE, MPLAB X IDE is an entirely new IDE with a host of free software components and plug-ins for highperformance application development and debugging. Moving between tools and upgrading from software simulators to hardware debugging and programming tools is simple with the seamless user interface. With complete project management, visual call graphs, a configurable watch window and a feature-rich editor that includes code completion and context menus, MPLAB X IDE is flexible and friendly enough for new users. With the ability to support multiple tools on multiple projects with simultaneous debugging, MPLAB X IDE is also suitable for the needs of experienced users. Feature-Rich Editor: • Color syntax highlighting • Smart code completion makes suggestions and provides hints as you type • Automatic code formatting based on user-defined rules • Live parsing User-Friendly, Customizable Interface: • Fully customizable interface: toolbars, toolbar buttons, windows, window placement, etc. • Call graph window Project-Based Workspaces: • • • • Multiple projects Multiple tools Multiple configurations Simultaneous debugging sessions File History and Bug Tracking: • Local file history feature • Built-in support for Bugzilla issue tracker  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 375 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 29.2 MPLAB XC Compilers The MPLAB XC Compilers are complete ANSI C compilers for all of Microchip’s 8, 16 and 32-bit MCU and DSC devices. These compilers provide powerful integration capabilities, superior code optimization and ease of use. MPLAB XC Compilers run on Windows, Linux or MAC OS X. For easy source level debugging, the compilers provide debug information that is optimized to the MPLAB X IDE. The free MPLAB XC Compiler editions support all devices and commands, with no time or memory restrictions, and offer sufficient code optimization for most applications. MPLAB XC Compilers include an assembler, linker and utilities. The assembler generates relocatable object files that can then be archived or linked with other relocatable object files and archives to create an executable file. MPLAB XC Compiler uses the assembler to produce its object file. Notable features of the assembler include: • • • • • • Support for the entire device instruction set Support for fixed-point and floating-point data Command-line interface Rich directive set Flexible macro language MPLAB X IDE compatibility 29.3 MPASM Assembler The MPASM Assembler is a full-featured, universal macro assembler for PIC10/12/16/18 MCUs. The MPASM Assembler generates relocatable object files for the MPLINK Object Linker, Intel® standard HEX files, MAP files to detail memory usage and symbol reference, absolute LST files that contain source lines and generated machine code, and COFF files for debugging. The MPASM Assembler features include: 29.4 MPLINK Object Linker/ MPLIB Object Librarian The MPLINK Object Linker combines relocatable objects created by the MPASM Assembler. It can link relocatable objects from precompiled libraries, using directives from a linker script. The MPLIB Object Librarian manages the creation and modification of library files of precompiled code. When a routine from a library is called from a source file, only the modules that contain that routine will be linked in with the application. This allows large libraries to be used efficiently in many different applications. The object linker/library features include: • Efficient linking of single libraries instead of many smaller files • Enhanced code maintainability by grouping related modules together • Flexible creation of libraries with easy module listing, replacement, deletion and extraction 29.5 MPLAB Assembler, Linker and Librarian for Various Device Families MPLAB Assembler produces relocatable machine code from symbolic assembly language for PIC24, PIC32 and dsPIC DSC devices. MPLAB XC Compiler uses the assembler to produce its object file. The assembler generates relocatable object files that can then be archived or linked with other relocatable object files and archives to create an executable file. Notable features of the assembler include: • • • • • • Support for the entire device instruction set Support for fixed-point and floating-point data Command-line interface Rich directive set Flexible macro language MPLAB X IDE compatibility • Integration into MPLAB X IDE projects • User-defined macros to streamline assembly code • Conditional assembly for multipurpose source files • Directives that allow complete control over the assembly process DS70005258C-page 376  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 29.6 MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator The MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator allows code development in a PC-hosted environment by simulating the PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs on an instruction level. On any given instruction, the data areas can be examined or modified and stimuli can be applied from a comprehensive stimulus controller. Registers can be logged to files for further run-time analysis. The trace buffer and logic analyzer display extend the power of the simulator to record and track program execution, actions on I/O, most peripherals and internal registers. The MPLAB X SIM Software Simulator fully supports symbolic debugging using the MPLAB XC Compilers, and the MPASM and MPLAB Assemblers. The software simulator offers the flexibility to develop and debug code outside of the hardware laboratory environment, making it an excellent, economical software development tool. 29.7 MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System The MPLAB REAL ICE In-Circuit Emulator System is Microchip’s next generation high-speed emulator for Microchip Flash DSC and MCU devices. It debugs and programs all 8, 16 and 32-bit MCU, and DSC devices with the easy-to-use, powerful graphical user interface of the MPLAB X IDE. The emulator is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a high-speed USB 2.0 interface and is connected to the target with either a connector compatible with in-circuit debugger systems (RJ-11) or with the new high-speed, noise tolerant, LowVoltage Differential Signal (LVDS) interconnection (CAT5). The emulator is field upgradable through future firmware downloads in MPLAB X IDE. MPLAB REAL ICE offers significant advantages over competitive emulators including full-speed emulation, run-time variable watches, trace analysis, complex breakpoints, logic probes, a ruggedized probe interface and long (up to three meters) interconnection cables.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 29.8 MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger System The MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger System is Microchip’s most cost-effective, high-speed hardware debugger/programmer for Microchip Flash DSC and MCU devices. It debugs and programs PIC Flash microcontrollers and dsPIC DSCs with the powerful, yet easy-to-use graphical user interface of the MPLAB IDE. The MPLAB ICD 3 In-Circuit Debugger probe is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a highspeed USB 2.0 interface and is connected to the target with a connector compatible with the MPLAB ICD 2 or MPLAB REAL ICE systems (RJ-11). MPLAB ICD 3 supports all MPLAB ICD 2 headers. 29.9 PICkit 3 In-Circuit Debugger/ Programmer The MPLAB PICkit 3 allows debugging and programming of PIC and dsPIC Flash microcontrollers at a most affordable price point using the powerful graphical user interface of the MPLAB IDE. The MPLAB PICkit 3 is connected to the design engineer’s PC using a fullspeed USB interface and can be connected to the target via a Microchip debug (RJ-11) connector (compatible with MPLAB ICD 3 and MPLAB REAL ICE). The connector uses two device I/O pins and the Reset line to implement in-circuit debugging and In-Circuit Serial Programming™ (ICSP™). 29.10 MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer The MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer is a universal, CE compliant device programmer with programmable voltage verification at VDDMIN and VDDMAX for maximum reliability. It features a large LCD display (128 x 64) for menus and error messages, and a modular, detachable socket assembly to support various package types. The ICSP cable assembly is included as a standard item. In Stand-Alone mode, the MPLAB PM3 Device Programmer can read, verify and program PIC devices without a PC connection. It can also set code protection in this mode. The MPLAB PM3 connects to the host PC via an RS-232 or USB cable. The MPLAB PM3 has high-speed communications and optimized algorithms for quick programming of large memory devices, and incorporates an MMC card for file storage and data applications. DS70005258C-page 377 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 29.11 Demonstration/Development Boards, Evaluation Kits and Starter Kits A wide variety of demonstration, development and evaluation boards for various PIC MCUs and dsPIC DSCs allows quick application development on fully functional systems. Most boards include prototyping areas for adding custom circuitry and provide application firmware and source code for examination and modification. The boards support a variety of features, including LEDs, temperature sensors, switches, speakers, RS-232 interfaces, LCD displays, potentiometers and additional EEPROM memory. 29.12 Third-Party Development Tools Microchip also offers a great collection of tools from third-party vendors. These tools are carefully selected to offer good value and unique functionality. • Device Programmers and Gang Programmers from companies, such as SoftLog and CCS • Software Tools from companies, such as Gimpel and Trace Systems • Protocol Analyzers from companies, such as Saleae and Total Phase • Demonstration Boards from companies, such as MikroElektronika, Digilent® and Olimex • Embedded Ethernet Solutions from companies, such as EZ Web Lynx, WIZnet and IPLogika® The demonstration and development boards can be used in teaching environments, for prototyping custom circuits and for learning about various microcontroller applications. In addition to the PICDEM™ and dsPICDEM™ demonstration/development board series of circuits, Microchip has a line of evaluation kits and demonstration software for analog filter design, KEELOQ® security ICs, CAN, IrDA®, PowerSmart battery management, SEEVAL® evaluation system, Sigma-Delta ADC, flow rate sensing, plus many more. Also available are starter kits that contain everything needed to experience the specified device. This usually includes a single application and debug capability, all on one board. Check the Microchip web page (www.microchip.com) for the complete list of demonstration, development and evaluation kits. DS70005258C-page 378  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 30.0 ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS This section provides an overview of the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family electrical characteristics. Additional information will be provided in future revisions of this document as it becomes available. Absolute maximum ratings for the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family are listed below. Exposure to these maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Functional operation of the device at these, or any other conditions above the parameters indicated in the operation listings of this specification, is not implied. Absolute Maximum Ratings(1) Ambient temperature under bias.............................................................................................................-40°C to +125°C Storage temperature .............................................................................................................................. -65°C to +150°C Voltage on VDD with respect to VSS .......................................................................................................... -0.3V to +4.0V Voltage on any pin that is not 5V tolerant with respect to VSS(3)..................................................... -0.3V to (VDD + 0.3V) Voltage on any 5V tolerant pin with respect to VSS when VDD  3.0V(3) ................................................... -0.3V to +5.5V Voltage on any 5V tolerant pin with respect to Vss when VDD < 3.0V(3) ................................................... -0.3V to +3.6V Maximum current out of VSS pin ...........................................................................................................................300 mA Maximum current into VDD pin(2) ...........................................................................................................................300 mA Maximum current sunk/sourced by any 4x I/O pin..................................................................................................15 mA Maximum current sunk/sourced by any 8x I/O pin ..................................................................................................25 mA Maximum current sunk by all ports(2) ....................................................................................................................200 mA Note 1: Stresses above those listed under “Absolute Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to the device. This is a stress rating only and functional operation of the device at those, or any other conditions above those indicated in the operation listings of this specification, is not implied. Exposure to maximum rating conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. 2: Maximum allowable current is a function of device maximum power dissipation (see Table 30-2). 3: See the “Pin Diagrams” section for the 5V tolerant pins.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 379 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 30.1 DC Characteristics TABLE 30-1: OPERATING MIPS vs. VOLTAGE Characteristic VDD Range (in Volts) — — Note 1: Maximum MIPS Temperature Range (in °C) dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X Family 3.0V to 3.6V(1) -40°C to +85°C 70 3.0V to 3.6V(1) -40°C to +125°C 60 Device is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN. Analog modules (ADC, PGAs and comparators) may have degraded performance. Device functionality is tested but not characterized. Refer to Parameter BO10 in Table 30-13 for the minimum and maximum BOR values. TABLE 30-2: THERMAL OPERATING CONDITIONS Rating Symbol Min. Typ. Max. Unit Operating Junction Temperature Range TJ -40 — +125 °C Operating Ambient Temperature Range TA -40 — +85 °C Operating Junction Temperature Range TJ -40 — +140 °C Operating Ambient Temperature Range TA -40 — +125 °C Industrial Temperature Devices Extended Temperature Devices Power Dissipation: Internal Chip Power Dissipation: PINT = VDD x (IDD –  IOH) PD PINT + PI/O W PDMAX (TJ – TA)/JA W I/O Pin Power Dissipation: I/O =  ({VDD – VOH} x IOH) +  (VOL x IOL) Maximum Allowed Power Dissipation TABLE 30-3: THERMAL PACKAGING CHARACTERISTICS Characteristic Symbol Typ. Max. Unit Notes Package Thermal Resistance, 80-Pin TQFP 12x12x1 mm JA 53.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 64-Pin TQFP 10x10x1 mm JA 49.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 48-Pin TQFP 7x7x1 mm JA 63.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 44-Pin QFN 8x8 mm JA 29.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 44-Pin TQFP 10x10x1 mm JA 50.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 28-Pin QFN-S 6x6x0.9 mm JA 30.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 28-Pin UQFN 6x6x0.55 mm JA 26.0 — °C/W 1 Package Thermal Resistance, 28-Pin SOIC 7.50 mm JA 70.0 — °C/W 1 Note 1: Junction to ambient thermal resistance, Theta-JA (JA) numbers are achieved by package simulations. DS70005258C-page 380  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-4: DC TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(1) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions 3.0 — 3.6 V — — 1.95 V +25°C, +85°C, +125°C — — 2.0 V -40°C Operating Voltage DC10 VDD DC12 VDR Supply Voltage (2) RAM Retention Voltage DC16 VPOR VDD Start Voltage to Ensure Internal Power-on Reset Signal — — VSS V DC17 SVDD VDD Rise Rate to Ensure Internal Power-on Reset Signal 1.0 — — V/ms Note 1: 2: 0V-3V in 3 ms Device is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN. Analog modules (ADC, PGAs and comparators) may have degraded performance. Device functionality is tested but not characterized. Refer to Parameter BO10 in Table 30-13 for the minimum and maximum BOR values. This is the limit to which VDD may be lowered and the RAM contents will always be retained. TABLE 30-5: FILTER CAPACITOR (CEFC) SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions (unless otherwise stated): Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Param No. Symbol CEFC Note 1: Characteristics External Filter Capacitor Value(1) Min. Typ. Max. Units Comments 4.7 — 10 F Capacitor must have a low series resistance ( (VDD + 0.3) for pins that are not 5V tolerant only. Digital 5V tolerant pins do not have internal high-side diodes to VDD and cannot tolerate any “positive” input injection current. | Injection Currents | > 0 can affect the ADC results by approximately 4-6 counts. Any number and/or combination of I/O pins not excluded under IICL or IICH conditions are permitted provided the mathematical “absolute instantaneous” sum of the input injection currents from all pins do not exceed the specified limit. Characterized but not tested. DS70005258C-page 386  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-11: DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN INPUT SPECIFICATIONS (CONTINUED) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. IIL Characteristic Min. Typ.(1) Max. Units Conditions Input Leakage Current(2,3) DI50 I/O Pins 5V Tolerant(4) -1 — +1 A VSS  VPIN  VDD, pin at high-impedance DI51 I/O Pins Not 5V Tolerant(4) -1 — +1 A VSS  VPIN  VDD, pin at high-impedance, -40°C  TA  +85°C DI51a I/O Pins Not 5V Tolerant(4) -1 — +1 A Analog pins shared with external reference pins, -40°C  TA  +85°C DI51b I/O Pins Not 5V Tolerant(4) -1 — +1 A VSS  VPIN  VDD, pin at high-impedance, -40°C  TA  +125°C DI51c I/O Pins Not 5V Tolerant(4) -1 — +1 A Analog pins shared with external reference pins, -40°C  TA  +125°C DI55 MCLR -5 — +5 A VSS VPIN VDD DI56 OSC1 -5 — +5 A VSS VPIN VDD, XT and HS modes Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: 7: 8: 9: Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current can be measured at different input voltages. Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for the 5V tolerant I/O pins. VIL Source < (VSS – 0.3). Characterized but not tested. VIH Source > (VDD + 0.3) for pins that are not 5V tolerant only. Digital 5V tolerant pins do not have internal high-side diodes to VDD and cannot tolerate any “positive” input injection current. | Injection Currents | > 0 can affect the ADC results by approximately 4-6 counts. Any number and/or combination of I/O pins not excluded under IICL or IICH conditions are permitted provided the mathematical “absolute instantaneous” sum of the input injection currents from all pins do not exceed the specified limit. Characterized but not tested.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 387 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-11: DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN INPUT SPECIFICATIONS (CONTINUED) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Characteristic Min. Typ.(1) Max. Units Conditions DI60a IICL Input Low Injection Current 0 — -5(5,8) mA All pins except VDD, VSS, AVDD, AVSS, MCLR, VCAP and RB7 DI60b IICH Input High Injection Current 0 — +5(6,7,8) mA All pins except VDD, VSS, AVDD, AVSS, MCLR, VCAP, RB7 and all 5V tolerant pins(7) DI60c IICT Total Input Injection Current (sum of all I/O and control pins) -20(9) — +20(9) mA Absolute instantaneous sum of all ± input injection currents from all I/O pins ( | IICL | + | IICH | )  IICT Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 6: 7: 8: 9: Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The leakage current on the MCLR pin is strongly dependent on the applied voltage level. The specified levels represent normal operating conditions. Higher leakage current can be measured at different input voltages. Negative current is defined as current sourced by the pin. See the “Pin Diagrams” section for the 5V tolerant I/O pins. VIL Source < (VSS – 0.3). Characterized but not tested. VIH Source > (VDD + 0.3) for pins that are not 5V tolerant only. Digital 5V tolerant pins do not have internal high-side diodes to VDD and cannot tolerate any “positive” input injection current. | Injection Currents | > 0 can affect the ADC results by approximately 4-6 counts. Any number and/or combination of I/O pins not excluded under IICL or IICH conditions are permitted provided the mathematical “absolute instantaneous” sum of the input injection currents from all pins do not exceed the specified limit. Characterized but not tested. DS70005258C-page 388  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-12: DC CHARACTERISTICS: I/O PIN OUTPUT SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol DO10 VOL DO20 VOH DO20A VOH1 Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units Output Low Voltage 4x Sink Driver Pins(2) — — 0.4 V VDD = 3.3V, IOL  6 mA, -40°C  TA  +85°C, IOL  5 mA, +85°C  TA  +125°C Output Low Voltage 8x Sink Driver Pins(3) — — 0.4 V VDD = 3.3V, IOL  12 mA, -40°C  TA  +85°C, IOL  8 mA, +85°C  TA  +125°C Output High Voltage 4x Source Driver Pins(2) 2.4 — — V IOH  -10 mA, VDD = 3.3V Output High Voltage 8x Source Driver Pins(3) 2.4 — — V IOH  -15 mA, VDD = 3.3V Output High Voltage 4x Source Driver Pins(2) 1.5(1) — — V IOH  -14 mA, VDD = 3.3V (1) — — IOH  -12 mA, VDD = 3.3V 3.0(1) — — IOH  -7 mA, VDD = 3.3V 1.5(1) — — 2.0(1) — — IOH  -18 mA, VDD = 3.3V 3.0(1) — — IOH  -10 mA, VDD = 3.3V Output High Voltage 8x Source Driver Pins(3) Note 1: 2: 3: 2.0 V Conditions IOH  -22 mA, VDD = 3.3V Parameters are characterized but not tested. Includes RA0-RA2, RB0-RB1, RB9, RC1-RC2, RC9-RC10, RC12, RD7, RD8, RE4-RE5, RE8-RE9 and RE12-RE13 pins. Includes all I/O pins that are not 4x driver pins (see Note 2). TABLE 30-13: ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS: BOR Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(1) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic Min.(2) Typ. Max. Units BOR Event on VDD Transition High-to-Low 2.65 — 2.95 V Conditions VDD (Notes 2 and 3) BO10 VBOR Note 1: Device is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but will have degraded performance. Device functionality is tested, but not characterized. Analog modules (ADC, PGAs and comparators) may have degraded performance. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested in manufacturing. The VBOR specification is relative to VDD. 2: 3:  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 389 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-14: DC CHARACTERISTICS: PROGRAM MEMORY Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Characteristic Min. Typ.(1) Max. 10,000 — — Units Conditions Program Flash Memory D130 EP Cell Endurance D131 VPR VDD for Read 3.0 — 3.6 V D132b VPEW VDD for Self-Timed Write 3.0 — 3.6 V D134 TRETD Characteristic Retention 20 — — Year Provided no other specifications are violated, -40C to +125C D135 IDDP Supply Current during Programming(2) — 10 — mA D136 IPEAK Instantaneous Peak Current During Start-up — — 150 mA D137a TPE Page Erase Time 19.7 — 20.1 ms TPE = 146893 FRC cycles, TA = +85°C (Note 3) D137b TPE Page Erase Time 19.5 — 20.3 ms TPE = 146893 FRC cycles, TA = +125°C (Note 3) D138a TWW Word Write Cycle Time 46.5 — 47.3 µs TWW = 346 FRC cycles, TA = +85°C (Note 3) D138b TWW Word Write Cycle Time 46.0 — 47.9 µs TWW = 346 FRC cycles, TA = +125°C (Note 3) D139a TRW Row Write Time 667 — 679 µs TRW = 4965 FRC cycles, TA = +85°C (Note 3) D139b TRW Row Write Time 660 — 687 µs TRW = 4965 FRC cycles, TA = +125°C (Note 3) Note 1: 2: 3: E/W -40C to +125C Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameter characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Other conditions: FRC = 7.37 MHz, TUN = 011111 (for Minimum), TUN = 100000 (for Maximum). This parameter depends on the FRC accuracy (see Table 30-20) and the value of the FRC Oscillator Tuning register (see Register 9-4). For complete details on calculating the Minimum and Maximum time, see Section 5.3 “Programming Operations”. DS70005258C-page 390  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 30.2 AC Characteristics and Timing Parameters This section defines the dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X family AC characteristics and timing parameters. TABLE 30-15: TEMPERATURE AND VOLTAGE SPECIFICATIONS – AC Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Operating voltage VDD range as described in Section 30.1 “DC Characteristics”. AC CHARACTERISTICS FIGURE 30-1: LOAD CONDITIONS FOR DEVICE TIMING SPECIFICATIONS Load Condition 1 – for all pins except OSC2 Load Condition 2 – for OSC2 VDD/2 CL Pin RL VSS CL Pin RL = 464 CL = 50 pF for all pins except OSC2 15 pF for OSC2 output VSS TABLE 30-16: CAPACITIVE LOADING REQUIREMENTS ON OUTPUT PINS Param Symbol No. Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions 15 pF In XT and HS modes, when external clock is used to drive OSC1 DO50 COSCO OSC2 Pin — — DO56 CIO All I/O Pins and OSC2 — — 50 pF EC mode DO58 CB SCLx, SDAx — — 400 pF In I2C mode  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 391 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-2: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q1 Q2 OS30 OS30 Q3 Q4 OSC1 OS20 OS25 OS31 OS31 CLKO OS41 OS40 TABLE 30-17: EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. OS10 FIN OS20 TOSC OS25 Min. Typ.(1) Max. Units External CLKI Frequency (External clocks allowed only in EC and ECPLL modes) DC — 60 MHz EC Oscillator Crystal Frequency 3.5 10 — — 10 40 MHz MHz XT HS Sym TCY Characteristic Conditions TOSC = 1/FOSC 8.33 — DC ns +125°C TOSC = 1/FOSC 7.14 — DC ns +85°C Instruction Cycle Time(2) 16.67 — DC ns +125°C Instruction Cycle Time(2) 14.28 — DC ns +85°C OS30 TosL, TosH External Clock in (OSC1) High or Low Time 0.45 x TOSC — 0.55 x TOSC ns EC OS31 TosR, TosF External Clock in (OSC1) Rise or Fall Time — — 20 ns EC OS40 TckR CLKO Rise Time(3,4) — 5.2 — ns (3,4) OS41 TckF CLKO Fall Time — 5.2 — ns OS42 GM External Oscillator Transconductance(4) — 12 — mA/V HS, VDD = 3.3V, TA = +25°C — 6 — mA/V XT, VDD = 3.3V, TA = +25°C Note 1: 2: 3: 4: Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Instruction cycle period (TCY) equals two times the input oscillator time base period. All specified values are based on characterization data for that particular oscillator type, under standard operating conditions, with the device executing code. Exceeding these specified limits may result in an unstable oscillator operation and/or higher than expected current consumption. All devices are tested to operate at “Minimum” values with an external clock applied to the OSC1 pin. When an external clock input is used, the “Maximum” cycle time limit is “DC” (no clock) for all devices. Measurements are taken in EC mode. The CLKO signal is measured on the OSC2 pin. This parameter is characterized but not tested in manufacturing. DS70005258C-page 392  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-18: PLL CLOCK TIMING SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Characteristic Min. Typ.(1) Max. Units FPLLI PLL Voltage Controlled Oscillator (VCO) Input Frequency Range 0.8 — 8.0 MHz OS51 FVCO On-Chip VCO System Frequency 120 — 340 MHz OS52 TLOCK PLL Start-up Time (Lock Time) 0.9 1.5 3.1 ms -3 0.5 3 % OS50 OS53 Symbol DCLK Note 1: 2: (2) CLKO Stability (Jitter) Conditions ECPLL, XTPLL modes Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. This jitter specification is based on clock cycle-by-clock cycle measurements. To get the effective jitter for individual time bases, or communication clocks used by the application, use the following formula: D CLK Effective Jitter = ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------F OSC --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------Time Base or Communication Clock For example, if FOSC = 120 MHz and the SPIx bit rate = 10 MHz, the effective jitter is as follows: D CLK D CLK D CLK Effective Jitter = -------------- = -------------- = -------------3.464 120 12 --------10 TABLE 30-19: AUXILIARY PLL CLOCK TIMING SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic Min Typ(1) Max Units OS56 FHPOUT On-Chip 16x PLL CCO Frequency 112 118 120 MHz OS57 FHPIN On-Chip 16x PLL Phase Detector Input Frequency 7.0 7.37 7.5 MHz OS58 TSU Frequency Generator Lock Time — — 10 µs Note 1: Conditions Data in “Typ” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested in manufacturing.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 393 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-20: INTERNAL FRC ACCURACY AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Characteristic Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions Internal FRC Accuracy @ FRC Frequency = 7.37 MHz(1) F20a FRC F20b FRC Note 1: -2 0.5 +2 % -40°C  TA -10°C -0.9 0.5 +0.9 % -10°C  TA +85°C VDD = 3.0-3.6V -2 1 +2 % +85°C  TA  +125°C VDD = 3.0-3.6V VDD = 3.0-3.6V Frequency is calibrated at +25°C and 3.3V. TUNx bits can be used to compensate for temperature drift. TABLE 30-21: INTERNAL LPRC ACCURACY AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Characteristic Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions LPRC @ 32.768 kHz(1) F21a LPRC -30 — +30 % -40°C  TA  -10°C VDD = 3.0-3.6V -20 — +20 % -10°C  TA  +85°C VDD = 3.0-3.6V F21b LPRC -30 — +30 % +85°C  TA  +125°C VDD = 3.0-3.6V Note 1: This is the change of the LPRC frequency as VDD changes. DS70005258C-page 394  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-3: I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS I/O Pin (Input) DI35 DI40 I/O Pin (Output) Old Value New Value DO31 DO32 Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-22: I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic Min. Typ.(1) Max. Units — 5 10 ns DO31 TIOR DO32 TIOF Port Output Fall Time — 5 10 ns DI35 TINP INTx Pin High or Low Time (input) 20 — — ns TRBP CNx High or Low Time (input) 2 — — TCY DI40 Note 1: Port Output Rise Time Conditions Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. FIGURE 30-4: BOR AND MASTER CLEAR RESET TIMING CHARACTERISTICS MCLR TMCLR (SY20) BOR TBOR (SY30) Various Delays (depending on configuration) Reset Sequence CPU Starts Fetching Code  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 395 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-23: RESET, WATCHDOG TIMER, OSCILLATOR START-UP TIMER, POWER-UP TIMER TIMING REQUIREMENTS AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Characteristic(1) Symbol Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SY00 TPU Power-up Period — 400 600 µs SY10 TOST Oscillator Start-up Time — 1024 TOSC — — TOSC = OSC1 period SY12 TWDT Watchdog Timer Time-out Period 0.81 — 1.22 ms WDTPRE = 0, WDTPOST = 0000, using LPRC tolerances indicated in F21 (see Table 30-21) at +85°C 3.25 — 4.88 ms WDTPRE = 1, WDTPOST = 0000, using LPRC tolerances indicated in F21 (see Table 30-21) at +85°C 0.68 0.72 1.2 µs SY13 TIOZ I/O High-Impedance from MCLR Low or Watchdog Timer Reset SY20 TMCLR MCLR Pulse Width (low) 2 — — µs SY30 TBOR BOR Pulse Width (low) 1 — — µs SY35 TFSCM Fail-Safe Clock Monitor Delay — 500 900 µs SY36 TVREG Voltage Regulator Standby-to-Active mode Transition Time — — 30 µs SY37 TOSCDFRC FRC Oscillator Start-up Delay — 48 — µs SY38 TOSCDLPRC LPRC Oscillator Start-up Delay — — 70 µs Note 1: 2: -40°C to +85°C These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. DS70005258C-page 396  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-5: TIMER1-TIMER5 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING CHARACTERISTICS TxCK Tx10 Tx11 Tx15 OS60 Tx20 TMRx Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-24: TIMER1 EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS(1) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. TA10 Symbol TTXH Characteristic(2) T1CK High Time Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions Synchronous mode Greater of: 20 or (TCY + 20)/N — — ns Must also meet Parameter TA15, N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) Asynchronous mode 35 — — ns Synchronous mode Greater of: 20 or (TCY + 20)/N — — ns TA11 TTXL T1CK Low Time TA15 TTXP T1CK Input Period OS60 Ft1 T1CK Oscillator Input Frequency Range (oscillator enabled by setting bit, TCS (T1CON)) TA20 TCKEXTMRL Delay from External T1CK Clock Edge to Timer Increment Note 1: 2: Asynchronous mode 10 — — ns Synchronous mode Greater of: 40 or (2 TCY + 40)/N — — ns DC — 50 kHz 0.75 TCY + 40 — 1.75 TCY + 40 ns Must also meet Parameter TA15, N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) Timer1 is a Type A timer. These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 397 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-25: TIMER2 AND TIMER4 (TYPE B TIMER) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions TB10 TtxH TxCK High Synchronous mode Time Greater of: 20 or (TCY + 20)/N — — ns Must also meet Parameter TB15, N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) TB11 TtxL TxCK Low Synchronous mode Time Greater of: 20 or (TCY + 20)/N — — ns Must also meet Parameter TB15, N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) TB15 TtxP TxCK Input Synchronous mode Period Greater of: 40 or (2 TCY + 40)/N — — ns N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) TB20 TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK 0.75 TCY + 40 Clock Edge to Timer Increment — 1.75 TCY + 40 ns Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. TABLE 30-26: TIMER3 AND TIMER5 (TYPE C TIMER) EXTERNAL CLOCK TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Characteristic(1) Symbol Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions TC10 TtxH TxCK High Time Synchronous TCY + 20 — — ns Must also meet Parameter TC15 TC11 TtxL TxCK Low Time Synchronous TCY + 20 — — ns Must also meet Parameter TC15 TC15 TtxP TxCK Input Period Synchronous with Prescaler 2 TCY + 40 — — ns N = Prescale Value (1, 8, 64, 256) TC20 0.75 TCY + 40 TCKEXTMRL Delay from External TxCK Clock Edge to Timer Increment — 1.75 TCY + 40 ns Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. DS70005258C-page 398  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-6: INPUT CAPTURE x (ICx) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS ICx IC10 IC11 IC15 Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-27: INPUT CAPTURE x MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol No. Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Characteristics(1) Min. Max. Units Conditions IC10 TCCL ICx Input Low Time Greater of: 12.5 + 25 or (0.5 TCY/N) + 25 — ns Must also meet Parameter IC15 IC11 TCCH ICx Input High Time Greater of: 12.5 + 25 or (0.5 TCY/N) + 25 — ns Must also meet Parameter IC15 IC15 TCCP ICx Input Period Greater of: 25 + 50 or (1 TCY/N) + 50 — ns Note 1: N = Prescale Value (1, 4, 16) These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 399 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-7: OUTPUT COMPARE x MODULE (OCx) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS OCx (Output Compare or PWM Mode) OC11 OC10 Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-28: OUTPUT COMPARE x MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Characteristic(1) Min. Typ. Max. Units Conditions OC10 TccF OCx Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 OC11 TccR OCx Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 Note 1: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. FIGURE 30-8: OCx/PWMx MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS OC20 OCFA OC15 OCx TABLE 30-29: OCx/PWMx MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Characteristic(1) Symbol OC15 TFD Fault Input to PWMx I/O Change OC20 TFLT Fault Input Pulse Width Note 1: Min. Typ. Max. Units — — TCY + 20 ns TCY + 20 — — ns Conditions These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. DS70005258C-page 400  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-9: HIGH-SPEED PWMx MODULE FAULT TIMING CHARACTERISTICS MP30 Fault Input (active-low) MP20 PWMx FIGURE 30-10: HIGH-SPEED PWMx MODULE TIMING CHARACTERISTICS MP11 MP10 PWMx Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-30: HIGH-SPEED PWMx MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ. Max. Units — ns See Parameter DO32 See Parameter DO31 MP10 TFPWM PWMx Output Fall Time — — MP11 TRPWM PWMx Output Rise Time — — — ns MP20 TFD Fault Input  to PWMx I/O Change — — 15 ns MP30 TFH Fault Input Pulse Width 15 — — ns Note 1: Conditions These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 401 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-31: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MAXIMUM DATA/CLOCK RATE SUMMARY(1) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Maximum Data Rate Master Transmit Only (Half-Duplex) Master Transmit/Receive (Full-Duplex) Slave Transmit/Receive (Full-Duplex) CKE CKP SMP 15 MHz Table 30-32 — — 0,1 0,1 0,1 9 MHz — Table 30-33 — 1 0,1 1 9 MHz — Table 30-34 — 0 0,1 1 15 MHz — — Table 30-35 1 0 0 11 MHz — — Table 30-36 1 1 0 15 MHz — — Table 30-37 0 1 0 — — Table 30-38 0 0 0 11 MHz Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. FIGURE 30-11: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (HALF-DUPLEX, TRANSMIT ONLY, CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SCKx (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP35 MSb SDOx SP30, SP31 Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 402  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-12: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (HALF-DUPLEX, TRANSMIT ONLY, CKE = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP36 SCKx (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP35 MSb SDOx Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-32: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (HALF-DUPLEX, TRANSMIT ONLY) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP10 FscP Maximum SCKx Frequency — — 15 MHz SP20 TscF SCKx Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP21 TscR SCKx Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDOx Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, TscL2doV SDOx Data Output Valid after SCKx Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL SDOx Data Output Setup to First SCKx Edge 30 — — ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 66.7 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 403 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-13: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP36 SCKx (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP35 MSb SDOx LSb SP30, SP31 SP40 SDIx Bit 14 - - - - - -1 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP41 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-33: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP10 SP20 FscP TscF Maximum SCKx Frequency SCKx Output Fall Time — — — — 9 — MHz ns (Note 3) See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP21 SP30 TscR TdoF SCKx Output Rise Time SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — — — — ns ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 SP35 TdoR TscH2doV, TscL2doV TdoV2sc, TdoV2scL TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL SDOx Data Output Rise Time SDOx Data Output Valid after SCKx Edge SDOx Data Output Setup to First SCKx Edge Setup Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge — — — 6 — 20 ns ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) 30 — — ns 30 — — ns TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP36 SP40 SP41 Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 111 ns. The clock generated in Master mode must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. DS70005258C-page 404  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-14: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SCKx (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP35 SP36 MSb SDOx Bit 14 - - - - - -1 SP30, SP31 SDIx MSb In LSb SP30, SP31 Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP40 SP41 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-34: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units — — 9 MHz Conditions SP10 FscP Maximum SCKx Frequency SP20 TscF SCKx Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP21 TscR SCKx Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDOx Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDOx Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCKx Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDOx Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: -40ºC to +125ºC (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 111 ns. The clock generated in Master mode must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 405 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-15: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP60 SSx SP52 SP50 SCKx (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP36 SP35 MSb SDOx Bit 14 - - - - - -1 SP72 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 SP73 LSb SP30, SP31 SDIx SP72 SP51 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 406  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-35: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCKx Input Frequency — — 15 MHz SP72 TscF SCKx Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCKx Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDOx Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDOx Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCKx Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDOx Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SSx  to SCKx  or SCKx  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SSx  to SDOx Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH TscL2ssH SSx after SCKx Edge 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) SP60 TssL2doV SDOx Data Output Valid after SSx Edge — — 50 ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 66.7 ns. Therefore, the SCKx clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 407 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-16: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP60 SSx SP52 SP50 SCKx (CKP = 0) SP73 SP70 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP72 SP36 SP35 SP72 SDOx MSb Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 SDIx MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 SP73 SP51 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 408  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-36: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCKx Input Frequency — — 11 MHz SP72 TscF SCKx Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCKx Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4 SP30 TdoF SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDOx Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDOx Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCKx Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDOx Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SSx  to SCKx  or SCKx  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SSx  to SDOx Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH TscL2ssH SSx after SCKx Edge 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) SP60 TssL2doV SDOx Data Output Valid after SSx Edge — — 50 ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 91 ns. Therefore, the SCKx clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 409 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-17: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SSx SP52 SP50 SCKx (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SP72 SP72 SP73 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP35 SP36 SDOx MSb Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP51 SP30, SP31 SDIx MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 410  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-37: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCKx Input Frequency — — 15 MHz SP72 TscF SCKx Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCKx Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4 SP30 TdoF SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDOx Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDOx Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCKx Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDOx Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SSx  to SCKx  or SCKx  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SSx  to SDOx Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH TscL2ssH SSx after SCKx Edge 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 66.7 ns. Therefore, the SCKx clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 411 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-18: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SSx SP52 SP50 SCKx (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SP72 SP72 SP73 SCKx (CKP = 1) SP35 SP36 MSb SDOx Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP51 SP30, SP31 SDIx MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 412  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-38: SPI1, SPI2 AND SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCKx Input Frequency — — 11 MHz SP72 TscF SCKx Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCKx Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDOx Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDOx Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDOx Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCKx Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDOx Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDIx Data Input to SCKx Edge 30 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SSx  to SCKx  or SCKx  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SSx  to SDOx Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH TscL2ssH SSx after SCKx Edge 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCKx is 91 ns. Therefore, the SCKx clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPIx pins. Pertaining to SPI3: dsPIC33EPXXXGS702, dsPIC33EPXXXGSX04 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX05 devices with a remappable SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 413 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-39: SPI3 MAXIMUM DATA/CLOCK RATE SUMMARY(1) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Maximum Data Rate Master Transmit Only (Half-Duplex) Master Transmit/Receive (Full-Duplex) Slave Transmit/Receive (Full-Duplex) CKE CKP SMP 25 MHz Table 30-40 — — 0,1 0,1 0,1 25 MHz — Table 30-41 — 1 0,1 1 25 MHz — Table 30-42 — 0 0,1 1 25 MHz — — Table 30-43 1 0 0 25 MHz — — Table 30-44 1 1 0 25 MHz — — Table 30-45 0 1 0 — — Table 30-46 0 0 0 25 MHz Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. FIGURE 30-19: SPI3 MASTER MODE (HALF-DUPLEX, TRANSMIT ONLY, CKE = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP35 MSb SDO3 SP30, SP31 Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 414  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-20: SPI3 MASTER MODE (HALF-DUPLEX, TRANSMIT ONLY, CKE = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP36 SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP35 MSb SDO3 Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-40: SPI3 MASTER MODE (HALF-DUPLEX, TRANSMIT ONLY) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP10 FscP Maximum SCK3 Frequency — — 25 MHz SP20 TscF SCK3 Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP21 TscR SCK3 Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, TscL2doV SDO3 Data Output Valid after SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL SDO3 Data Output Setup to First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 66.7 ns. Therefore, the clock generated in Master mode must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 415 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-21: SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP36 SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP35 MSb SDO3 LSb SP30, SP31 SP40 SDI3 Bit 14 - - - - - -1 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP41 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-41: SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP10 FscP Maximum SCK3 Frequency — — 25 MHz SP20 TscF SCK3 Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) (Note 3) SP21 TscR SCK3 Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns SP35 TscH2doV, SDO3 Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2sc, TdoV2scL SDO3 Data Output Setup to First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 15 — — ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 100 ns. The clock generated in Master mode must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. DS70005258C-page 416  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-22: SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP10 SP21 SP20 SP20 SP21 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP35 SP36 MSb SDO3 Bit 14 - - - - - -1 SP30, SP31 SD3 MSb In LSb SP30, SP31 Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP40 SP41 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. TABLE 30-42: SPI3 MASTER MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = x, SMP = 1) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP10 FscP Maximum SCK3 Frequency — — 25 MHz SP20 TscF SCK3 Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP21 TscR SCK3 Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDO3 Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDO3 Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, Setup Time of SDI3 Data TdiV2scL Input to SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL 20 — — ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: Hold Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3Edge -40ºC to +125ºC (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 100 ns. The clock generated in Master mode must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 417 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-23: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP60 SS3 SP52 SP50 SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP72 SP36 SP35 SP72 SDO3 MSb Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 SDI3 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 SP73 SP51 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 418  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-43: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCK3 Input Frequency — — 25 MHz SP72 TscF SCK3 Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCK3 Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDO3 Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDO3 Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 15 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SS3  to SCK3  or SCK3  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SS3  to SDO3 Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH TscL2ssH SS3 after SCK3 Edge 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) SP60 TssL2doV SDO3 Data Output Valid after SS3 Edge — — 50 ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 66.7 ns. Therefore, the SCK3 clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 419 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-24: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SP60 SS3 SP52 SP50 SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP72 SP36 SP35 SP72 SDO3 MSb Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP30, SP31 SDI3 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 SP73 SP51 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 420  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-44: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 1, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCK3 Input Frequency — — 25 MHz SP72 TscF SCK3 Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCK3 Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDO3 Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDO3 Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 15 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SS3  to SCK3  or SCK3  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SS3  to SDO3 Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH, SS3 after SCK3 Edge TscL2ssH 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) SP60 TssL2doV — — 50 ns Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: SDO3 Data Output Valid after SS3 Edge (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 91 ns. Therefore, the SCK3 clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 421 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-25: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SS3 SP52 SP50 SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SP72 SP72 SP73 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP35 SP36 MSb SDO3 Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP51 SP30, SP31 SDI3 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 422  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-45: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 1, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCK3 Input Frequency — — 25 MHz SP72 TscF SCK3 Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCK3 Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDO3 Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDO3 Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 15 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SS3  to SCK3  or SCK3  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SS3  to SDO3 Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH, SS3 after SCK3 Edge TscL2ssH 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 66.7 ns. Therefore, the SCK3 clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 423 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-26: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING CHARACTERISTICS(1,2) SS3 SP52 SP50 SCK3 (CKP = 0) SP70 SP73 SP72 SP72 SP73 SCK3 (CKP = 1) SP35 SP36 SDO3 MSb Bit 14 - - - - - -1 LSb SP51 SP30, SP31 SDI3 MSb In Bit 14 - - - -1 LSb In SP41 SP40 Note 1: For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin. 2: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 424  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-46: SPI3 SLAVE MODE (FULL-DUPLEX, CKE = 0, CKP = 0, SMP = 0) TIMING REQUIREMENTS(5) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units Conditions SP70 FscP Maximum SCK3 Input Frequency — — 25 MHz SP72 TscF SCK3 Input Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP73 TscR SCK3 Input Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP30 TdoF SDO3 Data Output Fall Time — — — ns See Parameter DO32 (Note 4) SP31 TdoR SDO3 Data Output Rise Time — — — ns See Parameter DO31 (Note 4) SP35 TscH2doV, SDO3 Data Output Valid after TscL2doV SCK3 Edge — 6 20 ns SP36 TdoV2scH, SDO3 Data Output Setup to TdoV2scL First SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP40 TdiV2scH, TdiV2scL Setup Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 20 — — ns SP41 TscH2diL, TscL2diL Hold Time of SDI3 Data Input to SCK3 Edge 15 — — ns SP50 TssL2scH, TssL2scL SS3  to SCK3  or SCK3  Input 120 — — ns SP51 TssH2doZ SS3  to SDO3 Output High-Impedance 10 — 50 ns (Note 4) SP52 TscH2ssH, SS3 after SCK1 Edge TscL2ssH 1.5 TCY + 40 — — ns (Note 4) Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: (Note 3) These parameters are characterized, but are not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. The minimum clock period for SCK3 is 91 ns. Therefore, the SCK3 clock generated by the master must not violate this specification. Assumes 50 pF load on all SPI3 pins. For dsPIC33EPXXXGSX06 and dsPIC33EPXXXGSX08 devices with a fixed SCK3 pin.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 425 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-27: I2Cx BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE) SCLx IM31 IM34 IM30 IM33 SDAx Stop Condition Start Condition Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. FIGURE 30-28: I2Cx BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (MASTER MODE) IM20 IM21 IM11 IM10 SCLx IM26 IM11 IM25 IM10 IM33 SDAx In IM40 IM40 IM45 SDAx Out Note: Refer to Figure 30-1 for load conditions. DS70005258C-page 426  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-47: I2Cx BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (MASTER MODE) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. IM10 IM11 IM20 IM21 IM25 IM26 IM30 IM31 IM33 IM34 IM40 IM45 IM50 IM51 Note 1: 2: 3: 4: Characteristic(4) Min.(1) Max. Units — µs TLO:SCL Clock Low Time 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs 400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) (2) 1 MHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs THI:SCL Clock High Time 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs — µs 400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) 1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs TF:SCL SDAx and SCLx 100 kHz mode — 300 ns Fall Time 300 ns 400 kHz mode 20 + 0.1 CB 1 MHz mode(2) — 100 ns TR:SCL SDAx and SCLx 100 kHz mode — 1000 ns Rise Time 400 kHz mode 20 + 0.1 CB 300 ns 1 MHz mode(2) — 300 ns TSU:DAT Data Input 100 kHz mode 250 — ns Setup Time 400 kHz mode 100 — ns (2) 1 MHz mode 40 — ns THD:DAT Data Input 100 kHz mode 0 — µs Hold Time 400 kHz mode 0 0.9 µs 1 MHz mode(2) 0.2 — µs TSU:STA Start Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs Setup Time 400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs 1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs THD:STA Start Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs Hold Time 400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG +2) — µs 1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs TSU:STO Stop Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs Setup Time 400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs (2) 1 MHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs THD:STO Stop Condition 100 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs Hold Time 400 kHz mode TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs 1 MHz mode(2) TCY/2 (BRG + 2) — µs TAA:SCL Output Valid 100 kHz mode — 3500 ns from Clock 400 kHz mode — 1000 ns 1 MHz mode(2) — 400 ns TBF:SDA Bus Free Time 100 kHz mode 4.7 — µs 400 kHz mode 1.3 — µs 1 MHz mode(2) 0.5 — µs CB Bus Capacitive Loading — 400 pF Pulse Gobbler Delay 65 390 ns TPGD 2 BRG is the value of the I C Baud Rate Generator. Maximum Pin Capacitance = 10 pF for all I2Cx pins (for 1 MHz mode only). Typical value for this parameter is 130 ns. These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Conditions CB is specified to be from 10 to 400 pF CB is specified to be from 10 to 400 pF Only relevant for Repeated Start condition After this period, the first clock pulse is generated Time the bus must be free before a new transmission can start (Note 3) DS70005258C-page 427 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-29: I2Cx BUS START/STOP BITS TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE) SCLx IS31 IS34 IS30 IS33 SDAx Stop Condition Start Condition FIGURE 30-30: I2Cx BUS DATA TIMING CHARACTERISTICS (SLAVE MODE) IS20 IS21 IS11 IS10 SCLx IS30 IS26 IS25 IS31 IS33 SDAx In IS40 IS40 IS45 SDAx Out DS70005258C-page 428  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-48: I2Cx BUS DATA TIMING REQUIREMENTS (SLAVE MODE) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic(3) IS10 TLO:SCL Clock Low Time IS11 THI:SCL IS20 IS21 IS25 IS26 IS30 IS31 IS33 IS34 IS40 IS45 IS50 IS51 Note Clock High Time Min. Max. Units 100 kHz mode 400 kHz mode 1 MHz mode(1) 100 kHz mode 4.7 1.3 0.5 4.0 — — — — µs µs µs µs 400 kHz mode 0.6 — µs 1 MHz mode(1) 0.5 — µs SDAx and SCLx 100 kHz mode — 300 ns TF:SCL Fall Time 400 kHz mode 20 + 0.1 CB 300 ns (1) 1 MHz mode — 100 ns TR:SCL SDAx and SCLx 100 kHz mode — 1000 ns Rise Time 400 kHz mode 20 + 0.1 CB 300 ns 1 MHz mode(1) — 300 ns TSU:DAT Data Input 100 kHz mode 250 — ns Setup Time 400 kHz mode 100 — ns 1 MHz mode(1) 100 — ns THD:DAT Data Input 100 kHz mode 0 — µs Hold Time 400 kHz mode 0 0.9 µs 1 MHz mode(1) 0 0.3 µs TSU:STA Start Condition 100 kHz mode 4.7 — µs Setup Time 400 kHz mode 0.6 — µs (1) 0.25 — µs 1 MHz mode THD:STA Start Condition 100 kHz mode 4.0 — µs Hold Time 400 kHz mode 0.6 — µs 0.25 — µs 1 MHz mode(1) TSU:STO Stop Condition 100 kHz mode 4.7 — µs Setup Time 400 kHz mode 0.6 — µs 1 MHz mode(1) 0.6 — µs 100 kHz mode 4 — µs THD:STO Stop Condition Hold Time 400 kHz mode 0.6 — µs 1 MHz mode(1) 0.25 µs 0 3500 ns TAA:SCL Output Valid from 100 kHz mode Clock 400 kHz mode 0 1000 ns (1) 1 MHz mode 0 350 ns 100 kHz mode 4.7 — µs TBF:SDA Bus Free Time 400 kHz mode 1.3 — µs 0.5 — µs 1 MHz mode(1) Bus Capacitive Loading — 400 pF CB TPGD Pulse Gobbler Delay 65 390 ns 1: Maximum Pin Capacitance = 10 pF for all I2Cx pins (for 1 MHz mode only). 2: Typical value for this parameter is 130 ns. 3: These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. Conditions Device must operate at a minimum of 1.5 MHz Device must operate at a minimum of 10 MHz CB is specified to be from 10 to 400 pF CB is specified to be from 10 to 400 pF Only relevant for Repeated Start condition After this period, the first clock pulse is generated Time the bus must be free before a new transmission can start (Note 2) DS70005258C-page 429 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-31: CANx MODULE I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS CxTX Pin (output) Old Value New Value CA10 CA11 CxRX Pin (input) CA20 TABLE 30-49: CANx MODULE I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic(1) Min. Typ.(2) Max. Units — — — ns See Parameter DO32 See Parameter DO31 TIOF Port Output Fall Time CA11 TIOR Port Output Rise Time — — — ns CA20 TCWF Pulse Width to Trigger CAN Wake-up Filter 120 — — ns CA10 Note 1: 2: Conditions These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typical” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. DS70005258C-page 430  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY FIGURE 30-32: UARTx MODULE I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS UA20 UxRX UXTX MSb In Bits 6-1 LSb In UA10 TABLE 30-50: UARTx MODULE I/O TIMING REQUIREMENTS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +125°C AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic(1) UA10 TUABAUD UARTx Baud Time UA11 FBAUD UARTx Baud Frequency UA20 TCWF Start Bit Pulse Width to Trigger UARTx Wake-up Note 1: 2: Min. Typ.(2) 66.67 — — ns — — 15 Mbps 500 — — ns Max. Units Conditions These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested. TABLE 30-51: ANALOG CURRENT SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +125°C AC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. AVD01 IDD Note 1: 2: Characteristic(1) Analog Modules Current Consumption Min. — Typ.(2) Max. 9 — Units mA Conditions Characterized data with the following modules enabled: APLL, 5 ADC Cores, 2 PGAs and 4 Analog Comparators These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Data in “Typ.” column is at 3.3V, +25°C unless otherwise stated. Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 431 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-52: ADC MODULE SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(5) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristics Min. Typical Max. Units Conditions Device Supply AD01 AVDD Module VDD Supply Greater of: VDD – 0.3 or 3.0 — Lesser of: VDD + 0.3 or 3.6 V Within 300 mV of VDD at all times, including device power-up AD02 AVSS Module VSS Supply VSS — VSS + 0.3 V AD06 VREFL Reference Voltage Low — AVSS — V (Note 1) AD07 VREF Absolute Reference Voltage (VREFH – VREFL) 2.7 — AVDD V (Note 3) AD08 IREF Reference Input Current — 5 10 µA ADC operating or in standby AD12 VINH-VINL Full-Scale Input Span — AVDD V Reference Inputs Analog Input AVSS AD14 VIN Absolute Input Voltage AVSS – 0.3 — AVDD + 0.3 V AD17 RIN Recommended Impedance of Analog Voltage Source — 100 —  AD66 VBG Internal Voltage Reference Source — 1.2 — V For minimum sampling time (Note 1) ADC Accuracy: Pseudodifferential Input AD20a Nr Resolution AD21a INL Integral Nonlinearity > -3 — -1 — 0 8 < 15 LSb AVSS = 0V, AVDD = 3.3V Gain Error (Shared Core) >5 15 < 22 LSb Offset Error (Dedicated Core) >0 5 < 10 LSb AVSS = 0V, AVDD = 3.3V Offset Error (Shared Core) >2 8 < 13 LSb Monotonicity — — — — AD24a EOFF AD25a Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: — 12 bits Guaranteed These parameters are not characterized or tested in manufacturing. No missing codes, limits based on characterization results. These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Characterized with a 15 kHz sine wave. The ADC module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is ensured, but not characterized. DS70005258C-page 432  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-52: ADC MODULE SPECIFICATIONS (CONTINUED) Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(5) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristics Min. Typical Max. Units Conditions ADC Accuracy: Single-Ended Input AD20b Nr Resolution AD21b INL Integral Nonlinearity >5 — -1 — 0 8 < 15 LSb AVSS = 0V, AVDD = 3.3V Gain Error (Shared Core) >5 15 < 22 LSb Offset Error (Dedicated Core) >2 9 < 15 LSb AVSS = 0V, AVDD = 3.3V Offset Error (Shared Core) >5 17 < 22 LSb — — — — Guaranteed AD24b EOFF AD25b — Monotonicity 12 bits Dynamic Performance AD31b SINAD Signal-to-Noise and Distortion AD34b ENOB Effective Number of Bits Note 1: 2: 3: 4: 5: 63 — > 65 dB (Notes 3, 4) 10.3 — — bits (Notes 3, 4) These parameters are not characterized or tested in manufacturing. No missing codes, limits based on characterization results. These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. Characterized with a 15 kHz sine wave. The ADC module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is ensured, but not characterized.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 433 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-53: ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERSION TIMING REQUIREMENTS AC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(2) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Typ.(1) Max. Characteristics Min. 14.28 — Units Conditions Clock Parameters AD50 TAD ADC Clock Period — AD51 FTP SH0-SH3 — — 3.25 SH4 — — 3.25 ns Throughput Rate Note 1: 2: Msps 70 MHz ADC clock, 12 bits, no pending Msps conversion at time of trigger These parameters are characterized but not tested in manufacturing. The ADC module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is ensured, but not characterized. TABLE 30-54: HIGH-SPEED ANALOG COMPARATOR MODULE SPECIFICATIONS AC/DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(2) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units -35 ±5 35 mV Comments CM10 VIOFF Input Offset Voltage CM11 VICM Input Common-Mode Voltage Range(1) 0 — AVDD V CM13 CMRR Common-Mode Rejection Ratio 60 — — dB CM14 TRESP Large Signal Response — 15 — ns V+ input step of 100 mV while V- input is held at AVDD/2. Delay measured from analog input pin to PWMx output pin. CM15 VHYST Input Hysteresis 5 10 20 mV Depends on HYSSEL CM16 TON Comparator Enabled to Valid Output — — 1 µs Note 1: 2: These parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested in manufacturing. The comparator module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is tested, but not characterized. DS70005258C-page 434  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-55: DACx MODULE SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(2) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC/DC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. Symbol Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units 1 — AVDD V DA01 EXTREF External Voltage Reference(1) DA02 CVRES Resolution DA03 INL Integral Nonlinearity Error -16 -12 0 LSB DA04 DNL Differential Nonlinearity Error -1.8 ±1 1.8 LSB LSB 12 bits DA05 EOFF Offset Error -8 3 15 DA06 EG Gain Error -1.2 -0.5 0 % DA07 TSET Settling Time(1) — 700 — ns Note 1: 2: Comments Output with 2% of desired output voltage with a 10-90% or 90-10% step Parameters are for design guidance only and are not tested in manufacturing. The DACx module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is tested, but not characterized. TABLE 30-56: DACx OUTPUT (DACOUTx PIN) SPECIFICATIONS DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. DA11 RLOAD Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(1) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units Resistive Output Load Impedance 10k — — Ohm Comments DA11a CLOAD Output Load Capacitance — — 35 pF Including output pin capacitance DA12 IOUT Output Current Drive Strength — 300 — µA Sink and source DA13 VRANGE Output Drive Voltage Range at Current Drive of 300 µA AVSS + 250 mV — AVDD – 900 mV V DA14 VLRANGE Output Drive Voltage AVSS + 50 mV Range at Reduced Current Drive of 50 µA — AVDD – 500 mV V DA15 IDD Current Consumed when Module is Enabled — — 1.3 x IOUT µA DA30 VOFFSET Input Offset Voltage — 5 — mV Note 1: Module will always consume this current, even if no load is connected to the output The DACx module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is tested, but not characterized.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 435 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-57: PGAx MODULE SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(1) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended AC/DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units Comments PA01 VIN Input Voltage Range AVSS – 0.3 — AVDD + 0.3 V PA02 VCM Common-Mode Input Voltage Range AVSS — AVDD – 1.6 V PA03 PA04 VOS VOS Input Offset Voltage Input Offset Voltage Drift with Temperature -10 — — 15 10 — mV µV/C PA05 RIN+ Input Impedance of Positive Input — >1M || 7 pF — || pF PA06 RIN- Input Impedance of Negative Input — 10k || 7 pF — || pF PA07 GERR Gain Error -2 -3 — — 2 3 % % Gain = 4x, 8x Gain = 16x PA08 LERR Gain Nonlinearity Error -4 — — — 4 0.5 % % Gain = 32x, 64x % of full scale, Gain = 16x PA09 IDD Current Consumption — 2.0 — mA Small Signal G = 4x Bandwidth (-3 dB) G = 8x G = 16x — 10 — MHz PA10b PA10c — — 5 2.5 — — MHz MHz PA10d PA10e G = 32x G = 64x — — 1.25 0.625 — — MHz MHz PA10a BW PA11 OST PA12 PA13 PA14 Note 1: — 0.4 — µs SR Output Settling Time to 1% of Final Value Output Slew Rate — 40 — V/µs TGSEL TON Gain Selection Time Module Turn On/Setting Time — — 1 — — 10 µs µs Module is enabled with a 2-volt P-P output voltage swing Gain = 16x, 100 mV input step change Gain = 16x The PGAx module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is tested, but not characterized. DS70005258C-page 436  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY TABLE 30-58: CONSTANT-CURRENT SOURCE SPECIFICATIONS Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated)(1) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended DC CHARACTERISTICS Param Symbol No. CC01 CC02 IDD IREG CC03 IOUT Note 1: Characteristic Min. Typ. Max. Units Current Consumption Regulation of Current with Voltage On Current Output at Terminal — — 30 ±3 — — µA % — 10 — µA Conditions The constant-current source module is functional at VBORMIN < VDD < VDDMIN, but with degraded performance. Unless otherwise stated, module functionality is tested, but not characterized. TABLE 30-59: DMA MODULE TIMING REQUIREMENTS AC CHARACTERISTICS Param No. DM1 Note 1: 2: Characteristic DMA Byte/Word Transfer Latency Standard Operating Conditions: 3.0V to 3.6V (unless otherwise stated) Operating temperature -40°C  TA  +85°C for Industrial -40°C  TA  +125°C for Extended Min. Typ.(1) Max. Units 1 TCY(2) — — ns Conditions These parameters are characterized, but not tested in manufacturing. Because DMA transfers use the CPU data bus, this time is dependent on other functions on the bus.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 437 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 438  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DC AND AC DEVICE CHARACTERISTICS GRAPHS Note: The graphs provided following this note are a statistical summary based on a limited number of samples and are provided for design guidance purposes only. The performance characteristics listed herein are not tested or guaranteed. In some graphs, the data presented may be outside the specified operating range (e.g., outside specified power supply range) and therefore, outside the warranted range. FIGURE 31-1: FIGURE 31-3: VOH – 4x DRIVER PINS VOH (V) -0.050 3.6V 0.045 -0.040 3.3V 0.035 3V IOL(A) IOH(A) -0.030 -0.025 -0.020 Absolute Maximum -0.015 3.3V 0.040 -0.035 IOH(A) VOL(V) 0.050 3.6V -0.045 3V 0.030 0.025 0.020 Absolute Maximum 0.015 -0.010 0.010 -0.005 0.005 0.000 0.000 0.00 0.50 -0.080 1.00 1.50 2.00 2.50 3.00 3.50 0.00 4.00 VOH – 8x DRIVER PINS FIGURE 31-2: FIGURE 31-4: 0.50 1.00 1.50 2.00 3.00 0.070 -0.060 3.3V 0.060 3V DS70005258C-page 439 IOL(A) IOH(A) -0.050 -0.040 0 030 -0.030 3V 0.050 0.040 0.030 Absolute Maximum Absolute Maximum -0.020 0 020 0.020 -0.010 0.010 0.000 0.000 0.50 1.00 1.50 2.00 2.50 3.00 3.50 4.00 4.00 3.6V 0.080 3.3V 3.50 8X VOL(V) 3.6V 0.00 2.50 VOL – 8x DRIVER PINS VOH(V) -0.070 IOH(A) VOL – 4x DRIVER PINS 0.00 0.50 1.00 1.50 2.00 2.50 3.00 3.50 4.00 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. 31.0 TYPICAL IDOZE CURRENT @ VDD = 3.3V, +25°C FIGURE 31-7: 300 30.0 250 25.0 200 20.0 IDOZE (mA) IPD (µA) TYPICAL IPD CURRENT @ VDD = 3.3V 150 100 50 15.0 10.0 5.0 0 0.0 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 1:1 120 1:2 Temperature (°C) FIGURE 31-6: 1:64 1:128 Doze Ratio TYPICAL IDD CURRENT @ VDD = 3.3V, +25°C FIGURE 31-8: TYPICAL IIDLE CURRENT @ VDD = 3.3V, +25°C 12.0 30 10.0 25 IDD (mA)  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. IIDLE (mA) 8.0 20 15 6.0 4.0 10 2.0 0.0 5 10 20 30 40 MIPS 50 60 70 10 20 30 40 MIPS 50 60 70 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY DS70005258C-page 440 FIGURE 31-5: TYPICAL FRC FREQUENCY @ VDD = 3.3V FIGURE 31-10: 7400 TYPICAL LPRC FREQUENCY @ VDD = 3.3V 34.4 34.2 Frequency (kHz) Frequency (kHz) 7350 7300 7250 34 33.8 33.6 33.4 7200 33.2 33 7150 -40 -20 0 20 40 60 Temperature (°C) 80 100 120 -40 -20 0 20 40 Temperature (°C) 60 80 100 120 DS70005258C-page 441 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. FIGURE 31-9: dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY NOTES: DS70005258C-page 442  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 32.0 PACKAGING INFORMATION 32.1 Package Marking Information 28-Lead SOIC (7.50 mm) XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN 28-Lead UQFN (6x6x0.55 mm) XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX YYWWNNN XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXX YYWWNNN 1810017 Example Example 33EP128 GS702 1810017 44-Lead TQFP (10x10x1 mm) XXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN Note: dsPIC33EP128GS702 33EP128 GS702 1810017 28-Lead QFN-S (6x6x0.9 mm) Legend: XX...X Y YY WW NNN Example Example dsPIC33EP 64GS804 1810017 Customer-specific information Year code (last digit of calendar year) Year code (last 2 digits of calendar year) Week code (week of January 1 is week ‘01’) Alphanumeric traceability code In the event the full Microchip part number cannot be marked on one line, it will be carried over to the next line, thus limiting the number of available characters for customer-specific information.  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 443 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 32.1 Package Marking Information (Continued) 44-Lead QFN (8x8 mm) XXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN 48-Lead TQFP (7x7x1.0 mm) 1 XXXXXXX XXXYYWW NNN 64-Lead TQFP (10x10x1 mm) XXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN 80-Lead TQFP (12x12x1 mm) XXXXXXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXXXXX YYWWNNN DS70005258C-page 444 Example dsPIC33EP 64GS804 1810017 Example 1 EP64GS 8051810 017 Example dsPIC33EP 64GS806 1810017 Example dsPIC33EP64 GS808 1810017  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 32.2 Note: Package Details For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 445 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging DS70005258C-page 446  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 447 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 28-Lead Ultra Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (2N) - 6x6x0.55 mm Body [UQFN] With 4.65x4.65 mm Exposed Pad and Corner Anchors Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D A B N NOTE 1 1 2 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.10 C 2X 0.10 C TOP VIEW A C A1 0.10 C SEATING PLANE (A3) 28X SIDE VIEW 8X b1 0.08 C 0.10 C A B D2 0.10 C A B 8X b2 E2 2 1 28X K 2X P N e NOTE 1 L 28X b BOTTOM VIEW 0.10 0.05 C A B C Microchip Technology Drawing C04-385 Rev C Sheet 1 of 2 DS70005258C-page 448  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 28-Lead Ultra Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (2N) - 6x6x0.55 mm Body [UQFN] With 4.65x4.65 mm Exposed Pad and Corner Anchors Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Units Dimension Limits Number of Terminals N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Width E Exposed Pad Width E2 Overall Length D Exposed Pad Length D2 Exposed Pad Corner Chamfer P b Terminal Width b1 Corner Anchor Pad Corner Pad, Metal Free Zone b2 Terminal Length L K Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad MIN 0.45 0.00 4.55 4.55 0.25 0.35 0.15 0.30 0.20 MILLIMETERS NOM 28 0.65 BSC 0.50 0.02 0.127 REF 6.00 BSC 4.65 6.00 BSC 4.65 0.35 0.30 0.40 0.20 0.40 - MAX 0.55 0.05 4.75 4.75 0.35 0.43 0.25 0.50 - Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-385 Rev C Sheet 2 of 2  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 449 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 28-Lead Ultra Thin Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (2N) - 6x6x0.55 mm Body [UQFN] With 4.65x4.65 mm Exposed Pad and Corner Anchors Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C2 Y2 EV 28 Y3 X1 1 ØV 2 Y4 G1 C1 EV G2 Y1 X4 X3 E SILK SCREEN RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X28) X1 Contact Pad Length (X28) Y1 Corner Anchor (X4) X3 Y3 Corner Anchor (X4) Corner Anchor Chamfer (X4) X4 Corner Anchor Chamfer (X4) Y4 Contact Pad to Pad (X28) G1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X28) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.65 BSC MAX 4.75 4.75 6.00 6.00 0.35 0.80 1.00 1.00 0.35 0.35 0.20 0.20 0.33 1.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2385B Note: Corner anchor pads are not connected internally and are designed as mechanical features when the package is soldered to the PCB. DS70005258C-page 450  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 451 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY DS70005258C-page 452  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY /HDG3ODVWLF4XDG)ODW1R/HDG3DFNDJH 00 ±[[PP%RG\>4)16@ ZLWKPP&RQWDFW/HQJWK 1RWH )RUWKHPRVWFXUUHQWSDFNDJHGUDZLQJVSOHDVHVHHWKH0LFURFKLS3DFNDJLQJ6SHFLILFDWLRQORFDWHGDW KWWSZZZPLFURFKLSFRPSDFNDJLQJ  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 453 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 44-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 10x10x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D A D1 NOTE 2 B (DATUM A) (DATUM B) E1 A NOTE 1 2X 0.20 H A B E A N 2X 1 2 3 0.20 H A B TOP VIEW 4X 11 TIPS 0.20 C A B A A2 C SEATING PLANE 0.10 C SIDE VIEW A1 1 2 3 N NOTE 1 44 X b 0.20 e C A B BOTTOM VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-076C Sheet 1 of 2 DS70005258C-page 454  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 44-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 10x10x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging H c L θ (L1) SECTION A-A Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Leads N e Lead Pitch A Overall Height Standoff A1 A2 Molded Package Thickness Overall Width E Molded Package Width E1 D Overall Length D1 Molded Package Length b Lead Width c Lead Thickness Lead Length L Footprint L1 Foot Angle θ MIN 0.05 0.95 0.30 0.09 0.45 0° MILLIMETERS NOM 44 0.80 BSC 1.00 12.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 12.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 0.37 0.60 1.00 REF 3.5° MAX 1.20 0.15 1.05 0.45 0.20 0.75 7° 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Exact shape of each corner is optional. 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-076C Sheet 2 of 2  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 455 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging DS70005258C-page 456  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 44-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) - 8x8 mm Body [QFN or VQFN] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D A B N NOTE 1 1 2 E (DATUM B) (DATUM A) 2X 0.20 C 2X TOP VIEW 0.20 C 0.10 C C SEATING PLANE A1 A 44X A3 0.08 C SIDE VIEW L 0.10 C A B D2 0.10 C A B E2 K 2 1 NOTE 1 N 44X b 0.07 0.05 e C A B C BOTTOM VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-103D Sheet 1 of 2  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 457 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 44-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) - 8x8 mm Body [QFN or VQFN] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging Units Dimension Limits Number of Pins N e Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A3 Terminal Thickness Overall Width E E2 Exposed Pad Width Overall Length D D2 Exposed Pad Length b Terminal Width Terminal Length L K Terminal-to-Exposed-Pad MIN 0.80 0.00 6.25 6.25 0.20 0.30 0.20 MILLIMETERS NOM 44 0.65 BSC 0.90 0.02 0.20 REF 8.00 BSC 6.45 8.00 BSC 6.45 0.30 0.40 - MAX 1.00 0.05 6.60 6.60 0.35 0.50 - Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Package is saw singulated 3. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-103D Sheet 2 of 2 DS70005258C-page 458  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 44-Lead Plastic Quad Flat, No Lead Package (ML) - 8x8 mm Body [QFN or VQFN] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 X2 EV 44 G2 1 2 ØV EV C2 Y2 G1 Y1 E SILK SCREEN X1 RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits E Contact Pitch Optional Center Pad Width X2 Optional Center Pad Length Y2 Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X44) X1 Contact Pad Length (X44) Y1 Contact Pad to Contact Pad (X40) G1 Contact Pad to Center Pad (X44) G2 Thermal Via Diameter V Thermal Via Pitch EV MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.65 BSC MAX 6.60 6.60 8.00 8.00 0.35 0.85 0.30 0.28 0.33 1.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing No. C04-2103C  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 459 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 48-Lead Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging 48X TIPS 0.20 C A-B D D D1 D1 2 D A B E1 E A E1 4 NOTE 1 A E1 2 N 1 2 4X 0.20 H A-B D D1 4 48x b 0.08 e C A-B D TOP VIEW 0.10 C C SEATING PLANE A H A2 0.08 C A1 SIDE VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-300-PT Rev A Sheet 1 of 2 DS70005258C-page 460  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 48-Lead Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D H c E L T (L1) SECTION A-A Units Dimension Limits Number of Leads N e Lead Pitch Overall Height A Standoff A1 A2 Molded Package Thickness L Foot Length Footprint L1 I Foot Angle Overall Width E Overall Length D Molded Package Width E1 Molded Package Length D1 c Lead Thickness b Lead Width D Mold Draft Angle Top E Mold Draft Angle Bottom MIN 0.05 0.95 0.45 0° 0.09 0.17 11° 11° MILLIMETERS NOM 48 0.50 BSC 1.00 0.60 1.00 REF 3.5° 9.00 BSC 9.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 7.00 BSC 0.22 12° 12° MAX 1.20 0.15 1.05 0.75 7° 0.16 0.27 13° 13° Notes: 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Chamfers at corners are optional; size may vary. 3. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.25mm per side. 4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. 5. Datums A-B and D to be determined at center line between leads where leads exit plastic body at datum plane H Microchip Technology Drawing C04-300-PT Rev A Sheet 2 of 2  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 461 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 48-Lead Thin Quad Flatpack (PT) - 7x7x1.0 mm Body [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging C1 G C2 SILK SCREEN 48 Y1 1 2 X1 E RECOMMENDED LAND PATTERN Units Dimension Limits Contact Pitch E Contact Pad Spacing C1 Contact Pad Spacing C2 Contact Pad Width (X48) X1 Contact Pad Length (X48) Y1 Distance Between Pads G MIN MILLIMETERS NOM 0.50 BSC 8.40 8.40 MAX 0.30 1.50 0.20 Notes: 1. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. 2. For best soldering results, thermal vias, if used, should be filled or tented to avoid solder loss during reflow process Microchip Technology Drawing C04-2300-PT Rev A DS70005258C-page 462  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 64-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT)-10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging D D1 D1/2 D NOTE 2 A B E1/2 E1 A E A SEE DETAIL 1 N 4X N/4 TIPS 0.20 C A-B D 1 3 2 4X NOTE 1 0.20 H A-B D TOP VIEW A2 A 0.05 C SEATING PLANE 0.08 C 64 X b 0.08 e A1 C A-B D SIDE VIEW Microchip Technology Drawing C04-085C Sheet 1 of 2  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 463 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY 64-Lead Plastic Thin Quad Flatpack (PT)-10x10x1 mm Body, 2.00 mm Footprint [TQFP] Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging H c E L (L1) T X=A—B OR D X SECTION A-A e/2 DETAIL 1 Notes: Units Dimension Limits Number of Leads N e Lead Pitch Overall Height A Molded Package Thickness A2 Standoff A1 Foot Length L Footprint L1 I Foot Angle Overall Width E Overall Length D Molded Package Width E1 Molded Package Length D1 c Lead Thickness b Lead Width D Mold Draft Angle Top E Mold Draft Angle Bottom MIN 0.95 0.05 0.45 0° 0.09 0.17 11° 11° MILLIMETERS NOM 64 0.50 BSC 1.00 0.60 1.00 REF 3.5° 12.00 BSC 12.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 10.00 BSC 0.22 12° 12° MAX 1.20 1.05 0.15 0.75 7° 0.20 0.27 13° 13° 1. Pin 1 visual index feature may vary, but must be located within the hatched area. 2. Chamfers at corners are optional; size may vary. 3. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold flash or protrusions. Mold flash or protrusions shall not exceed 0.25mm per side. 4. Dimensioning and tolerancing per ASME Y14.5M BSC: Basic Dimension. Theoretically exact value shown without tolerances. REF: Reference Dimension, usually without tolerance, for information purposes only. Microchip Technology Drawing C04-085C Sheet 2 of 2 DS70005258C-page 464  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY Note: For the most current package drawings, please see the Microchip Packaging Specification located at http://www.microchip.com/packaging  2016-2018 Microchip Technology Inc. DS70005258C-page 465 dsPIC33EPXXXGS70X/80X FAMILY /HDG3ODVWLF7KLQ4XDG)ODWSDFN 37 ±[[PP%RG\PP>74)3@ 1RWH )RUWKHPRVWFXUUHQWSDFNDJHGUDZLQJVSOHDVHVHHWKH0LFURFKLS3DFNDJLQJ6SHFLILFDWLRQORFDWHGDW KWWSZZZPLFURFKLSFRPSDFNDJLQJ D D1 E e E1 N b NOTE 1 12 3 α NOTE 2 A c β φ A2 A1 L1 L 8QLWV 'LPHQVLRQ/LPLWV 1XPEHURI/HDGV 0,//,0(7(56 0,1 1 120 0$;  /HDG3LWFK H 2YHUDOO+HLJKW $ ± %6& ± 0ROGHG3DFNDJH7KLFNQHVV $    6WDQGRII $  ±  )RRW/HQJWK /    )RRWSULQW /  5() )RRW$QJOH I 2YHUDOO:LGWK ( ƒ %6& ƒ 2YHUDOO/HQJWK ' %6& 0ROGHG3DFNDJH:LGWK ( %6& 0ROGHG3DFNDJH/HQJWK ' %6& ƒ /HDG7KLFNQHVV F  ±  /HDG:LGWK E    0ROG'UDIW$QJOH7RS D ƒ ƒ ƒ 0ROG'UDIW$QJOH%RWWRP E ƒ ƒ ƒ 1RWHV  3LQYLVXDOLQGH[IHDWXUHPD\YDU\EXWPXVWEHORFDWHGZLWKLQWKHKDWFKHGDUHD  &KDPIHUVDWFRUQHUVDUHRSWLRQDOVL]HPD\YDU\  'LPHQVLRQV'DQG(GRQRWLQFOXGHPROGIODVKRUSURWUXVLRQV0ROGIODVKRUSURWUXVLRQVVKDOOQRWH[FHHGPPSHUVLGH  'LPHQVLRQLQJDQGWROHUDQFLQJSHU$60(
DSPIC33EP64GS808-I/PT 价格&库存

很抱歉,暂时无法提供与“DSPIC33EP64GS808-I/PT”相匹配的价格&库存,您可以联系我们找货

免费人工找货